Search Legislation

Communications Act 2003

Status:

Point in time view as at 17/11/2021.

Changes to legislation:

Communications Act 2003 is up to date with all changes known to be in force on or before 15 August 2024. There are changes that may be brought into force at a future date. Changes that have been made appear in the content and are referenced with annotations. Help about Changes to Legislation

Close

Changes to Legislation

Changes and effects yet to be applied by the editorial team are only applicable when viewing the latest version or prospective version of legislation. They are therefore not accessible when viewing legislation as at a specific point in time. To view the ‘Changes to Legislation’ information for this provision return to the latest version view using the options provided in the ‘What Version’ box above.

SCHEDULES

Section 2

SCHEDULE 1U.K.Functions transferred to OFCOM

Wireless telegraphy functionsU.K.

F11U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F1Sch. 1 para. 1 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

F22U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2Sch. 1 para. 2 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I1Sch. 1 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Functions in relation to the licensing etc. of television servicesU.K.

3U.K.The following functions of the Independent Television Commission are transferred to OFCOM—

(a)the function of granting or awarding licences under Part 1 of the 1990 Act (independent television services) and Part 1 of the 1996 Act (digital television broadcasting);

(b)the Commission’s functions under those Parts in relation to, and to applications for, licences under either of those Parts;

(c)the function of securing the provision of a nationwide system of television broadcasting services known as Channel 3;

(d)the function of securing the provision of the television broadcasting service known as Channel 5.

Commencement Information

I2Sch. 1 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Functions in relation to C4CU.K.

4U.K.The functions conferred on the Independent Television Commission by or under section 23 of the 1990 Act and under Schedule 3 to that Act (appointment of members of C4C and related administrative functions) are transferred to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I3Sch. 1 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Functions in relation to the licensing of radio servicesU.K.

5U.K.The following functions of the Radio Authority are transferred to OFCOM—

(a)the function of granting or awarding licences under Part 3 of the 1990 Act (independent radio services) and Part 2 of the 1996 Act (digital sound broadcasting); and

(b)the Authority’s functions under those Parts in relation to licences granted or awarded under those Parts.

Commencement Information

I4Sch. 1 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Functions in relation to the proscription of foreign satellite servicesU.K.

6U.K.The functions of the Independent Television Commission and of the Radio Authority under section 177 of the 1990 Act (proscription of foreign satellite services) are transferred to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I5Sch. 1 para. 6 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Functions in relation to Gaelic broadcastingU.K.

7U.K.The functions of the Independent Television Commission under sections 183 and 184 of the 1990 Act and the functions of that Commission and of the Radio Authority under Schedule 19 to that Act (Gaelic broadcasting) are transferred to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I6Sch. 1 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Functions in relation to the national television archiveU.K.

8U.K.The functions of the Independent Television Commission under section 185 of the 1990 Act (maintenance of the national television archive) are transferred to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I7Sch. 1 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Warrants to enter and search premises to enforce broadcasting licences provisionsU.K.

9U.K.The functions of the Independent Television Commission and of the Radio Authority under section 196(1) of the 1990 Act (entry and search for the purposes of enforcing licensing provisions of the 1990 and 1996 Acts) are transferred to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I8Sch. 1 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Variation of existing Channel 3 and Channel 5 licencesU.K.

10U.K.Any power to vary licences which is conferred on the Independent Television Commission by an order under section 28 of the 1996 Act is transferred to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I9Sch. 1 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Reports for the purposes of the review of digital broadcastingU.K.

11U.K.The functions of the Independent Television Commission and of the Radio Authority under sections 33 and 67 of the 1996 Act (reports to the Secretary of State for the purposes of his review of digital broadcasting) are transferred to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I10Sch. 1 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Functions in relation to reservation of digital capacity to the BBCU.K.

12U.K.The function of the Secretary of State under section 49(4) of the 1996 Act (reserving digital capacity on a local radio multiplex service for the BBC) is transferred to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I11Sch. 1 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Functions in relation to listed eventsU.K.

13U.K.The functions of the Independent Television Commission under Part 4 of the 1996 Act (functions in connection with listed events) are transferred to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I12Sch. 1 para. 13 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Functions relating to fairness and privacy in broadcastingU.K.

14U.K.The following functions of the Broadcasting Standards Commission under Part 5 of the 1996 Act are transferred to OFCOM—

(a)the Commission’s function of drawing up and from time to time revising a code of practice under section 107 of that Act (codes of practice relation to fairness and privacy); and

(b)their functions in relation to fairness complaints under that Part.

Commencement Information

I13Sch. 1 para. 14 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 30

SCHEDULE 2U.K.Transfer schemes

Contents of transfer schemeU.K.

1(1)A transfer scheme—U.K.

(a)shall set out the property, rights and liabilities to be transferred by the scheme; and

(b)may make incidental, supplemental, consequential and transitional provision in connection with the transfer of that property and of those rights and liabilities.

(2)The provisions of the scheme setting out the property, rights and liabilities to be transferred may do so in either or both of the following ways—

(a)by specifying them or describing them in particular; or

(b)by identifying them generally by reference to, or to a specific part of, an undertaking from which they are to be transferred.

(3)The property, rights and liabilities that are to be capable of being transferred by a transfer scheme include—

(a)property, rights and liabilities that would not otherwise be capable of being transferred or assigned by the person from whom they are transferred;

(b)property acquired and rights and liabilities arising in the period after the making of the scheme and before it comes into force;

(c)rights and liabilities arising subsequently in respect of matters occurring in that period;

(d)property situated anywhere in the United Kingdom or elsewhere and rights and liabilities under the law of any part of the United Kingdom or of any place outside the United Kingdom; and

(e)rights and liabilities under an enactment.

(4)The provision that may be made under sub-paragraph (1)(b) includes provision for the creation in favour of a pre-commencement regulator, the Secretary of State or OFCOM of rights or liabilities over or in respect of property transferred to OFCOM or property retained by a pre-commencement regulator or the Secretary of State.

(5)The transfers to which effect may be given by a transfer scheme, and the rights that may be created by means of such a scheme, include transfers that are to take effect, and rights that are to arise, in accordance with the scheme as if there were—

(a)no such requirement to obtain a person’s consent or concurrence,

(b)no such liability in respect of any contravention of any other requirement, and

(c)no such interference with any interest or right,

as there would be, in the case of a transaction apart from this Act (whether under any enactment or agreement or otherwise), by reason of any provision having effect in relation to the terms on which a pre-commencement regulator or the Secretary of State is entitled or subject to any property, right or liability.

Commencement Information

I14Sch. 2 para. 1 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

Effect of transfer schemeU.K.

2(1)Property transferred by a transfer scheme shall, on the coming into force of the scheme, vest in OFCOM without further assurance.U.K.

(2)Where any transfer scheme comes into force, any agreement made, transaction effected or other thing done by or in relation to the person from whom any transfers for which the scheme provides are made shall have effect, so far as necessary for the purposes of those transfers, as if—

(a)it had been made, effected or done by or in relation to OFCOM; and

(b)OFCOM were the same person in law as the person from whom the transfer is made.

(3)Accordingly, references in any agreement, document, process or instrument of any description to the person from whom anything is transferred by means of a transfer scheme shall have effect, so far as necessary for the purpose of giving effect to the transfer from the coming into force of the scheme, as references to OFCOM.

(4)Where any agreement, document, process or instrument of any description has effect, in relation to anything transferred by means of a transfer scheme, as referring (whether expressly or by implication)—

(a)to a member or to an officer of a pre-commencement regulator, or

(b)to an officer of the Secretary of State,

that agreement, document, process or instrument shall have effect so far as necessary for the purposes of the transfers effected by the scheme and in consequence of them, as referring instead to the person mentioned in sub-paragraph (5).

(5)That person is—

(a)the person nominated for the purposes of the transfer by OFCOM; or

(b)in default of a nomination, the member or employee of OFCOM who most closely corresponds to the member or officer originally referred to.

(6)Nothing in sub-paragraph (3) or (4) is to apply in relation to any reference in an enactment or in subordinate legislation.

Commencement Information

I15Sch. 2 para. 2 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

Retrospective modification of a transfer schemeU.K.

3(1)If at any time after the coming into force of a transfer scheme it appears to the Secretary of State that it is appropriate to do so, he may by order provide for the scheme to be deemed to have come into force with such modifications (including modifications retrospective to the time of the coming into force of the scheme) as may be provided for in the order.U.K.

(2)The power under this paragraph to provide by order for the modification of a transfer scheme shall be exercisable for the purpose only of making provision that could have been made by the scheme.

(3)Before making an order under this paragraph the Secretary of State must consult OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I16Sch. 2 para. 3 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

CompensationU.K.

4(1)Where, in consequence of any provision included in a transfer scheme, the interests, rights or liabilities of a third party are modified as mentioned in sub-paragraph (2), the third party is to be entitled to such compensation as may be just in respect of—U.K.

(a)any diminution in the value of any of his interests or rights, or

(b)any increase in the burden of his liabilities,

which is attributable to that modification.

(2)The modifications mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) are modifications by virtue of which—

(a)an interest of the third party in any property is transformed into, or replaced by—

(i)an interest in only part of that property; or

(ii)separate interests in different parts of that property;

(b)a right of the third party against any of the pre-commencement regulators or against the Secretary of State is transformed into, or replaced by, two or more rights which do not include a right which, on its own, is equivalent (disregarding the person against whom it is enforceable) to the right against that regulator or (as the case may be) against the Secretary of State; or

(c)a liability of the third party to any of the pre-commencement regulators or to the Secretary of State is transformed into, or replaced by, two or more separate liabilities at least one of which is a liability enforceable by a person other than the person by whom it was enforceable before being so transformed.

(3)Where—

(a)a third party would, apart from any provision of a transfer scheme, have become entitled to, or to exercise, any interest or right arising or exercisable in respect of the transfer or creation in accordance with such a scheme of any property, rights or liabilities, and

(b)the provisions of that scheme have the effect of preventing that person’s entitlement to, or to exercise, that interest or right from arising on any occasion in respect of anything mentioned in paragraph (a), and

(c)provision is not made by a transfer scheme for securing that an entitlement to, or to exercise, that interest or right or an equivalent interest or right, is preserved or created so as to arise in respect of the first occasion when corresponding circumstances next occur after the coming into force of the transfers for which the scheme provides,

the third party is to be entitled to such compensation as may be just in respect of the extinguishment of the interest or right.

(4)A liability to pay compensation under this paragraph shall fall on the persons mentioned in sub-paragraph (5) who (as the case may be)—

(a)have interests in the whole or any part of the property affected by the modification in question,

(b)are subject to the rights of the person to be compensated which are affected by the modification in question,

(c)are entitled to enforce the liabilities of the person to be compensated which are affected by that modification, or

(d)benefit from the extinguishment of the entitlement mentioned in sub-paragraph (3),

and that liability shall be apportioned between those persons in such manner as may be appropriate having regard to the extent of their respective interests, rights or liabilities or the extent of the benefit they respectively obtain from the extinguishment.

(5)Those persons are the pre-commencement regulators and the Secretary of State.

(6)Sub-paragraph (4) shall have effect subject to so much of any transfer scheme (including the one that gives rise to the liability) as makes provision for the transfer of any liability under that sub-paragraph to OFCOM.

(7)Any dispute as to whether, or as to the person by whom, any compensation is to be paid under this paragraph, and any dispute as to the amount of compensation to be paid by a person, shall be referred to and determined—

(a)where the claimant requires the matter to be determined in England and Wales or in Northern Ireland, by an arbitrator appointed by the Lord Chancellor, or

(b)where the claimant requires the matter to be determined in Scotland, by an arbiter appointed by the Lord President of the Court of Session.

(8)In this paragraph “third party”, in relation to provisions capable of giving rise to compensation under this paragraph, means any person other than—

(a)a pre-commencement regulator; and

(b)the Secretary of State.

Commencement Information

I17Sch. 2 para. 4 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

Stamp dutyU.K.

5(1)Stamp duty is not to be chargeable—U.K.

(a)on a transfer scheme; or

(b)on an instrument or agreement certified by the Secretary of State to the Commissioners of Inland Revenue as made for the purposes of a transfer scheme, or as made for purposes connected with such a scheme.

(2)But a transfer scheme, or an instrument or agreement so certified, is to be treated as duly stamped only if—

(a)in accordance with section 12 of the Stamp Act 1891 (c. 39) it has been stamped with a stamp denoting either that it is not chargeable to duty or that it has been duly stamped; or

(b)it is stamped with the duty to which it would be chargeable apart from this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I18Sch. 2 para. 5 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

Stamp duty land taxU.K.

[F35A.(1)For the purposes of stamp duty land tax, a land transaction effected by, or for the purposes of, or for purposes connected with, a transfer scheme is exempt from charge.

(2)Relief under this paragraph must be claimed in a land transaction return or an amendment of such a return.

(3)In this paragraph—

  • “land transaction” has the meaning given by section 43(1) of the Finance Act 2003;

  • “land transaction return” has the meaning given by section 76(1) of that Act.]

Interpretation of ScheduleU.K.

6U.K.In this Schedule “transfer scheme” means a scheme made by a pre-commencement regulator or by the Secretary of State under section 30.

Commencement Information

I19Sch. 2 para. 6 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

Section 106

F4SCHEDULE 3U.K.Amendments of Schedule 2 to the Telecommunications Act 1984

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Section 106

[F5SCHEDULE 3AU.K.The electronic communications code

Textual Amendments

F5Sch. 3A inserted (31.7.2017 for the purpose of making regulations under Sch. 3A para. 95, 22.11.2017 but only in relation to Sch. 3A para. 106, 28.12.2017 in so far as not already in force) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 1 (with Sch. 2); S.I. 2017/765, reg. 2(ii)(jj); S.I. 2017/1136, reg. 2; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(b)

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

PART 1U.K.Key concepts

IntroductoryU.K.

1(1)This Part defines some key concepts used in this code.U.K.

(2)For definitions of other terms used in this code, see—

(a)paragraph 94 (meaning of “the court”).

(b)paragraph 105 (meaning of “occupier”),

(c)paragraph 108 (general interpretation),

(d)section 32 (meaning of electronic communications networks and services), and

(e)section 405 (general interpretation).

The operatorU.K.

2U.K.In this code “operator” means—

(a)where this code is applied in any person's case by a direction under section 106, that person, and

(b)where this code applies by virtue of section 106(3)(b), the Secretary of State or (as the case may be) the Northern Ireland department in question.

The code rightsU.K.

3U.K.For the purposes of this code a “code right”, in relation to an operator and any land, is a right for the statutory purposes—

(a)to install electronic communications apparatus on, under or over the land,

(b)to keep installed electronic communications apparatus which is on, under or over the land,

(c)to inspect, maintain, adjust, alter, repair, upgrade or operate electronic communications apparatus which is on, under or over the land,

(d)to carry out any works on the land for or in connection with the installation of electronic communications apparatus on, under or over the land or elsewhere,

(e)to carry out any works on the land for or in connection with the maintenance, adjustment, alteration, repair, upgrading or operation of electronic communications apparatus which is on, under or over the land or elsewhere,

(f)to enter the land to inspect, maintain, adjust, alter, repair, upgrade or operate any electronic communications apparatus which is on, under or over the land or elsewhere,

(g)to connect to a power supply,

(h)to interfere with or obstruct a means of access to or from the land (whether or not any electronic communications apparatus is on, under or over the land), or

(i)to lop or cut back, or require another person to lop or cut back, any tree or other vegetation that interferes or will or may interfere with electronic communications apparatus.

The statutory purposesU.K.

4U.K.In this code “the statutory purposes”, in relation to an operator, means—

(a)the purposes of providing the operator's network, or

(b)the purposes of providing an infrastructure system.

Electronic communications apparatus, lines and structuresU.K.

5(1)In this code “electronic communications apparatus” means—U.K.

(a)apparatus designed or adapted for use in connection with the provision of an electronic communications network,

(b)apparatus designed or adapted for a use which consists of or includes the sending or receiving of communications or other signals that are transmitted by means of an electronic communications network,

(c)lines, and

(d)other structures or things designed or adapted for use in connection with the provision of an electronic communications network.

(2)References to the installation of electronic communications apparatus are to be construed accordingly.

(3)In this code—

  • line” means any wire, cable, tube, pipe or similar thing (including its casing or coating) which is designed or adapted for use in connection with the provision of any electronic communications network or electronic communications service;

  • structure” includes a building only if the sole purpose of that building is to enclose other electronic communications apparatus.

The operator's networkU.K.

6U.K.In this code “network” in relation to an operator means—

(a)if the operator falls within paragraph 2(a), so much of any electronic communications network or infrastructure system provided by the operator as is not excluded from the application of the code under section 106(5), and

(b)if the operator falls within paragraph 2(b), the electronic communications network which the Secretary of State or the Northern Ireland department is providing or proposing to provide.

Infrastructure systemU.K.

7(1)In this code “infrastructure system” means a system of infrastructure provided so as to be available for use by providers of electronic communications networks for the purposes of the provision by them of their networks.U.K.

(2)References in this code to provision of an infrastructure system include references to establishing or maintaining such a system.

PART 2U.K.Conferral of code rights and their exercise

IntroductoryU.K.

8U.K.This Part of this code makes provision about—

(a)the conferral of code rights,

(b)the persons who are bound by code rights, and

(c)the exercise of code rights.

Who may confer code rights?U.K.

9U.K.A code right in respect of land may only be conferred on an operator by an agreement between the occupier of the land and the operator.

Who else is bound by code rights?U.K.

10(1)This paragraph applies if, [F6in accordance with this Part] [F6pursuant to an agreement under this Part or Part 4A], a code right is conferred on an operator in respect of land by a person (“O”) who is the occupier of the land when the code right is conferred.U.K.

(2)If O has an interest in the land when the code right is conferred, the code right also binds—

(a)the successors in title to that interest,

(b)a person with an interest in the land that is created after the right is conferred and is derived (directly or indirectly) out of—

(i)O's interest, or

(ii)the interest of a successor in title to O's interest, and

(c)any other person at any time in occupation of the land whose right to occupation was granted by—

(i)O, at a time when O was bound by the code right, or

(ii)a person within paragraph (a) or (b).

(3)A successor in title who is bound by a code right by virtue of sub-paragraph (2)(a) is to be treated as a party to the agreement by which O conferred the right.

(4)The code right also binds any other person with an interest in the land who has [F7, pursuant to an agreement under this Part or Part 4A,] agreed to be bound by it.

(5)If such a person (“P”) agrees to be bound by the code right, the code right also binds—

(a)the successors in title to P's interest,

(b)a person with an interest in the land that is created after P agrees to be bound and is derived (directly or indirectly) out of—

(i)P's interest, or

(ii)the interest of a successor in title to P's interest, and

(c)any other person at any time in occupation of the land whose right to occupation was granted by—

(i)P, at a time when P was bound by the code right, or

(ii)a person within paragraph (a) or (b).

(6)A successor in title who is bound by a code right by virtue of sub-paragraph (5)(a) is to be treated as a party to the agreement by which P agreed to be bound by the right.

Requirements for agreementsU.K.

11(1)An agreement under this Part—U.K.

(a)must be in writing,

(b)must be signed by or on behalf of the parties to it,

(c)must state for how long the code right is exercisable, and

(d)must state the period of notice (if any) required to terminate the agreement.

(2)Sub-paragraph (1)(a) and (b) also applies to the variation of an agreement under this Part.

(3)The agreement as varied must still comply with sub-paragraph (1)(c) and (d).

Exercise of code rightsU.K.

12(1)A code right is exercisable only in accordance with the terms subject to which it is conferred.U.K.

(2)Anything done by an operator in the exercise of a code right conferred under this Part [F8or Part 4A] in relation to any land is to be treated as done in the exercise of a statutory power.

(3)Sub-paragraph (2) does not apply against a person who—

(a)is the owner of the freehold estate in the land or the lessee of the land, and

(b)is not for the time being bound by the code right.

(4)Sub-paragraph (2) does not apply against a person who has the benefit of a covenant or agreement entered into as respects the land, if—

(a)the covenant or agreement was entered into under a enactment, and

(b)by virtue of the enactment, it binds or will bind persons who derive title or otherwise claim—

(i)under the covenantor, or

(ii)under a party to the agreement.

(5)In the application of sub-paragraph (3) to Scotland the reference to a person who is the owner of the freehold estate in the land is to be read as a reference to a person who is the owner of the land.

Access to landU.K.

13(1)This paragraph applies to an operator by whom any of the following rights is exercisable in relation to land—U.K.

(a)a code right within paragraph (a) to (g) or (i) of paragraph 3;

(b)a right under Part 8 (street works rights);

(c)a right under Part 9 (tidal water rights);

(d)a right under paragraph 74 (power to fly lines).

(2)The operator may not exercise the right so as to interfere with or obstruct any means of access to or from any other land unless, in accordance with this code, the occupier of the other land has conferred or is otherwise bound by a code right within paragraph (h) of paragraph 3.

(3)A reference in this code to a means of access to or from land includes a means of access to or from land that is provided for use in emergencies.

(4)This paragraph does not require a person to whom sub-paragraph (5) applies to agree to the exercise of any code right on land other than the land mentioned in that sub-paragraph.

(5)This sub-paragraph applies to a person who is the occupier of, or owns an interest in, land which is—

(a)a street in England and Wales or Northern Ireland,

(b)a road in Scotland, or

(c)tidal water or lands within the meaning of Part 9 of this code.

Code rights and land registrationU.K.

14U.K.Where an enactment requires interests, charges or other obligations affecting land to be registered, the provisions of this code about who is bound by a code right have effect whether or not that right is registered.

PART 3U.K.Assignment of code rights, and upgrading and sharing of apparatus

IntroductoryU.K.

15U.K.This Part of this code makes provision for—

(a)operators to assign agreements under Part 2,

(b)operators to upgrade electronic communications apparatus to which such an agreement relates, and

(c)operators to share the use of any such electronic communications apparatus.

Assignment of code rightsU.K.

16(1)Any agreement under Part 2 of this code is void to the extent that—U.K.

(a)it prevents or limits assignment of the agreement to another operator, or

(b)it makes assignment of the agreement to another operator subject to conditions (including a condition requiring the payment of money).

(2)Sub-paragraph (1) does not apply to a term that requires the assignor to enter into a guarantee agreement (see sub-paragraph (7)).

(3)In this paragraph references to “the assignor” or “the assignee” are to the operator by whom or to whom an agreement under Part 2 of this code is assigned or proposed to be assigned.

(4)From the time when the assignment of an agreement under Part 2 of this code takes effect, the assignee is bound by the terms of the agreement.

(5)The assignor is not liable for any breach of a term of the agreement that occurs after the assignment if (and only if), before the breach took place, the assignor or the assignee gave a notice in writing to the other party to the agreement which—

(a)identified the assignee, and

(b)provided an address for service (for the purposes of paragraph 91(2)(a)) for the assignee.

(6)Sub-paragraph (5) is subject to the terms of any guarantee agreement.

(7)A “guarantee agreement” is an agreement, in connection with the assignment of an agreement under Part 2 of this code, under which the assignor guarantees to any extent the performance by the assignee of the obligations that become binding on the assignee under sub-paragraph (4) (the “relevant obligations”).

(8)An agreement is not a guarantee agreement to the extent that it purports—

(a)to impose on the assignor a requirement to guarantee in any way the performance of the relevant obligations by a person other than the assignee, or

(b)to impose on the assignor any liability, restriction or other requirement of any kind in relation to a time after the relevant obligations cease to be binding on the assignee.

(9)Subject to sub-paragraph (8), a guarantee agreement may—

(a)impose on the assignor any liability as sole or principal debtor in respect of the relevant obligations;

(b)impose on the assignor liabilities as guarantor in respect of the assignee's performance of the relevant obligations which are no more onerous than those to which the assignor would be subject in the event of the assignor being liable as sole or principal debtor in respect of any relevant obligation;

(c)make provision incidental or supplementary to any provision within paragraph (a) or (b).

(10)In the application of this paragraph to Scotland references to assignment of an agreement are to be read as references to assignation of an agreement.

(11)Nothing in the Landlord and Tenant Amendment (Ireland) Act 1860 applies in relation to an agreement under Part 2 of this code so as to—

(a)prevent or limit assignment of the agreement to another operator, or

(b)relieve the assignor from liability for any breach of a term of the agreement that occurs after the assignment.

Power for operator to upgrade or share apparatusU.K.

17(1)An operator (“the main operator”) who has entered into an agreement under Part 2 of this code may, if the conditions in sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) are met—U.K.

(a)upgrade the electronic communications apparatus to which the agreement relates, or

(b)share the use of such electronic communications apparatus with another operator.

(2)The first condition is that any changes as a result of the upgrading or sharing to the electronic communications apparatus to which the agreement relates have no adverse impact, or no more than a minimal adverse impact, on its appearance.

(3)The second condition is that the upgrading or sharing imposes no additional burden on the other party to the agreement.

(4)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (3) an additional burden includes anything that—

(a)has an additional adverse effect on the other party's enjoyment of the land, or

(b)causes additional loss, damage or expense to that party.

(5)Any agreement under Part 2 of this code is void to the extent that—

(a)it prevents or limits the upgrading or sharing, in a case where the conditions in sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) are met, of the electronic communications apparatus to which the agreement relates, or

(b)it makes upgrading or sharing of such apparatus subject to conditions to be met by the operator (including a condition requiring the payment of money).

(6)References in this paragraph to sharing electronic communications apparatus include carrying out works to the apparatus to enable such sharing to take place.

Effect of agreements enabling sharing between operators and othersU.K.

18(1)This paragraph applies where—U.K.

(a)this code has been applied by a direction under section 106 in a person's case,

(b)this code expressly or impliedly imposes a limitation on the use to which electronic communications apparatus installed by that person may be put or on the purposes for which it may be used, and

(c)that person is a party to a relevant agreement or becomes a party to an agreement which (after the person has become a party to it) is a relevant agreement.

(2)The limitation does not preclude—

(a)the doing of anything in relation to that apparatus, or

(b)its use for particular purposes,

to the extent that the doing of that thing, or the use of the apparatus for those purposes, is in pursuance of the relevant agreement.

(3)This paragraph is not to be construed, in relation to a person who is entitled or authorised by or under a relevant agreement to share the use of apparatus installed by another party to the agreement, as affecting any consent requirement imposed (whether by an agreement, an enactment or otherwise) on that person.

(4)In this paragraph—

  • consent requirement”, in relation to a person, means a requirement for the person to obtain consent or permission to or in connection with—

    (a)

    the installation by the person of apparatus, or

    (b)

    the doing by the person of any other thing in relation to apparatus the use of which the person is entitled or authorised to share;

  • relevant agreement” means an agreement in relation to electronic communications apparatus which—

    (a)

    relates to the sharing by different parties to the agreement of the use of that apparatus, and

    (b)

    is an agreement that satisfies the requirements of sub-paragraph (5).

(5)An agreement satisfies the requirements of this sub-paragraph if—

(a)every party to the agreement is a person in whose case this code applies by virtue of a direction under section 106, or

(b)one or more of the parties to the agreement is a person in whose case this code so applies and every other party to the agreement is a qualifying person.

(6)A person is a qualifying person for the purposes of sub-paragraph (5) if the person is either—

(a)a person who provides an electronic communications network without being a person in whose case this code applies, or

(b)a designated provider of an electronic communications service consisting in the distribution of a programme service by means of an electronic communications network.

(7)In sub-paragraph (6)—

  • designated” means designated by regulations made by the Secretary of State;

  • programme service” has the same meaning as in the Broadcasting Act 1990.

PART 4U.K.Power of court to impose agreement

IntroductoryU.K.

19U.K.This Part of this code makes provision about—

(a)[F9the circumstances] [F9certain circumstances] in which the court can impose an agreement on a person by which the person confers or is otherwise bound by a code right [F10(see also Part 4A)],

(b)the test to be applied by the court in deciding whether to impose such an agreement,

(c)the effect of such an agreement and its terms,

(d)the imposition of an agreement on a person on an interim or temporary basis.

When can the court impose an agreement?U.K.

20(1)This paragraph applies where the operator requires a person (a “relevant person”) to agree—U.K.

(a)to confer a code right on the operator, or

(b)to be otherwise bound by a code right which is exercisable by the operator.

(2)The operator may give the relevant person a notice in writing—

(a)setting out the code right, [F11the land to which it relates] and all of the other terms of the agreement that the operator seeks, and

(b)stating that the operator seeks the person's agreement to those terms.

(3)The operator may apply to the court for an order under this paragraph if—

(a)the relevant person does not, before the end of 28 days beginning with the day on which the notice is given, agree to confer or be otherwise bound by the code right, or

(b)at any time after the notice is given, the relevant person gives notice in writing to the operator that the person does not agree to confer or be otherwise bound by the code right.

(4)An order under this paragraph is one which imposes on the operator and the relevant person an agreement between them which—

(a)confers the code right on the operator, or

(b)provides for the code right to bind the relevant person.

What is the test to be applied by the court?U.K.

21(1)Subject to sub-paragraph (5), the court may make an order under paragraph 20 if (and only if) the court thinks that both of the following conditions are met.U.K.

(2)The first condition is that the prejudice caused to the relevant person by the order is capable of being adequately compensated by money.

(3)The second condition is that the public benefit likely to result from the making of the order outweighs the prejudice to the relevant person.

(4)In deciding whether the second condition is met, the court must have regard to the public interest in access to a choice of high quality electronic communications services.

(5)The court may not make an order under paragraph 20 if it thinks that the relevant person intends to redevelop all or part of the land to which the code right would relate, or any neighbouring land, and could not reasonably do so if the order were made.

What is the effect of an agreement imposed under paragraph 20?U.K.

22U.K.An agreement imposed by an order under paragraph 20 takes effect for all purposes of this code as an agreement under Part 2 of this code between the operator and the relevant person.

What are the terms of an agreement imposed under paragraph 20?U.K.

23(1)An order under paragraph 20 may impose an agreement which gives effect to the code right sought by the operator with such modifications as the court thinks appropriate.U.K.

(2)An order under paragraph 20 must require the agreement to contain such terms as the court thinks appropriate, subject to sub-paragraphs (3) to (8).

[F12(2A)In determining the terms of the agreement the court may take into account, among other things, any breach by the operator of an agreement between the operator and the relevant person which was imposed by an order under Part 4A (whether or not in force).]

(3)The terms of the agreement must include terms as to the payment of consideration by the operator to the relevant person for the relevant person's agreement to confer or be bound by the code right (as the case may be).

(4)Paragraph 24 makes provision about the determination of consideration under sub-paragraph (3).

(5)The terms of the agreement must include the terms the court thinks appropriate for ensuring that the least possible loss and damage is caused by the exercise of the code right to persons who—

(a)occupy the land in question,

(b)own interests in that land, or

(c)are from time to time on that land.

(6)Sub-paragraph (5) applies in relation to a person regardless of whether the person is a party to the agreement.

(7)The terms of the agreement must include terms specifying for how long the code right conferred by the agreement is exercisable.

(8)The court must determine whether the terms of the agreement should include a term—

(a)permitting termination of the agreement (and, if so, in what circumstances);

(b)enabling the relevant person to require the operator to reposition or temporarily to remove the electronic communications equipment to which the agreement relates (and, if so, in what circumstances).

How is consideration to be determined under paragraph 23?U.K.

24(1)The amount of consideration payable by an operator to a relevant person under an agreement imposed by an order under paragraph 20 must be an amount or amounts representing the market value of the relevant person's agreement to confer or be bound by the code right (as the case may be).U.K.

(2)For this purpose the market value of a person's agreement to confer or be bound by a code right is, subject to sub-paragraph (3), the amount that, at the date the market value is assessed, a willing buyer would pay a willing seller for the agreement—

(a)in a transaction at arm's length,

(b)on the basis that the buyer and seller were acting prudently and with full knowledge of the transaction, and

(c)on the basis that the transaction was subject to the other provisions of the agreement imposed by the order under paragraph 20.

(3)The market value must be assessed on these assumptions—

(a)that the right that the transaction relates to does not relate to the provision or use of an electronic communications network;

(b)that paragraphs 16 and 17 (assignment, and upgrading and sharing) do not apply to the right or any apparatus to which it could apply;

(c)that the right in all other respects corresponds to the code right;

(d)that there is more than one site which the buyer could use for the purpose for which the buyer seeks the right.

(4)The terms of the agreement may provide for consideration to be payable—

(a)as a lump sum or periodically,

(b)on the occurrence of a specified event or events, or

(c)in such other form or at such other time or times as the court may direct.

What rights to the payment of compensation are there?U.K.

25(1)If the court makes an order under paragraph 20 the court may also order the operator to pay compensation to the relevant person for any loss or damage that has been sustained or will be sustained by that person as a result of the exercise of the code right to which the order relates.U.K.

(2)An order under sub-paragraph (1) may be made—

(a)at the time the court makes an order under paragraph 20, or

(b)at any time afterwards, on the application of the relevant person.

(3)An order under sub-paragraph (1) may—

(a)specify the amount of compensation to be paid by the operator, or

(b)give directions for the determination of any such amount.

(4)Directions under sub-paragraph (3)(b) may provide—

(a)for the amount of compensation to be agreed between the operator and the relevant person;

(b)for any dispute about that amount to be determined by arbitration.

(5)An order under this paragraph may provide for the operator—

(a)to make a lump sum payment,

(b)to make periodical payments,

(c)to make a payment or payments on the occurrence of an event or events, or

(d)to make a payment or payments in such other form or at such other time or times as the court may direct.

(6)Paragraph 84 makes further provision about compensation in the case of an order under paragraph 20.

Interim code rightsU.K.

26(1)An operator may apply to the court for an order which imposes on the operator and a person, on an interim basis, an agreement between them which—U.K.

(a)confers a code right on the operator, or

(b)provides for a code right to bind that person.

[F13(1A)But an operator may not make an application under this paragraph if there is a relevant Part 4A agreement in effect between the operator and the person.

(1B)In sub-paragraph (1A) “relevant Part 4A agreement” means an agreement imposed by an order under Part 4A by which the person—

(a)confers a Part 4A code right on the operator, or

(b)otherwise agrees to be bound by a Part 4A code right which is exercisable by the operator,

where the Part 4A code right is in respect of the same land as the code right mentioned in sub-paragraph (1).]

(2)An order under this paragraph imposes an agreement on the operator and a person on an interim basis if it provides for them to be bound by the agreement—

(a)for the period specified in the order, or

(b)until the occurrence of an event specified in the order.

(3)The court may make an order under this paragraph if (and only if) the operator has given the person mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) a notice which complies with paragraph 20(2) stating that an agreement is sought on an interim basis and—

(a)the operator and that person have agreed to the making of the order and the terms of the agreement imposed by it, or

(b)the court thinks that there is a good arguable case that the test in paragraph 21 for the making of an order under paragraph 20 is met.

(4)Subject to sub-paragraphs (5) and (6), the following provisions apply in relation to an order under this paragraph and an agreement imposed by it as they apply in relation to an order under paragraph 20 and an agreement imposed by it—

(a)paragraph 20(3) (time at which operator may apply for agreement to be imposed);

(b)paragraph 22 (effect of agreement imposed under paragraph 20);

(c)paragraph 23 (terms of agreement imposed under paragraph 20);

(d)paragraph 24 (payment of consideration);

(e)paragraph 25 (payment of compensation);

(f)paragraph 84 (compensation where agreement imposed).

(5)The court may make an order under this paragraph even though the period mentioned in paragraph 20(3)(a) has not elapsed (and paragraph 20(3)(b) does not apply) if the court thinks that the order should be made as a matter of urgency.

(6)Paragraphs [F1420(3), 22,] 23, 24 and 25 apply by virtue of sub-paragraph (4) as if—

(a)references to the relevant person were to the person mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) of this paragraph, and

(b)the duty in paragraph 23 to include terms as to the payment of consideration to that person in an agreement were a power to do so.

(7)Sub-paragraph (8) applies if—

(a)an order has been made under this paragraph imposing an agreement relating to a code right on an operator and a person in respect of any land, and

(b)the period specified under sub-paragraph (2)(a) has expired or, as the case may be, the event specified under sub-paragraph (2)(b) has occurred without (in either case) an agreement relating to the code right having been imposed on the person by order under paragraph 20.

(8)From the time when the period expires or the event occurs, that person has the right, subject to and in accordance with Part 6 of this code, to require the operator to remove any electronic communications apparatus placed on the land under the agreement imposed under this paragraph.

Temporary code rightsU.K.

27(1)This paragraph applies where—U.K.

(a)an operator gives a notice under paragraph 20(2) to a person in respect of any land,

(b)the notice also requires that person's agreement on a temporary basis in respect of a right which is to be exercisable (in whole or in part) in relation to electronic communications apparatus which is already installed on, under or over the land, and

(c)the person has the right to require the removal of the apparatus in accordance with paragraph 37 or as mentioned in paragraph 40(1) but the operator is not for the time being required to remove the apparatus.

(2)The court may, on the application of the operator, impose on the operator and the person an agreement between them which confers on the operator, or provides for the person to be bound by, such temporary code rights as appear to the court reasonably necessary for securing the objective in sub-paragraph (3).

(3)That objective is that, until the proceedings under paragraph 20 and any proceedings under paragraph 40 are determined, the service provided by the operator's network is maintained and the apparatus is properly adjusted and kept in repair.

(4)Subject to sub-paragraphs (5) and (6), the following provisions apply in relation to an order under this paragraph and an agreement imposed by it as they apply in relation to an order under paragraph 20 and an agreement imposed by it—

(a)paragraph 20(3) (time at which operator may apply for agreement to be imposed);

(b)paragraph 22 (effect of agreement imposed under paragraph 20);

(c)paragraph 23 (terms of agreement imposed under paragraph 20);

(d)paragraph 24 (payment of consideration);

(e)paragraph 25 (payment of compensation);

(f)paragraph 84 (compensation where agreement imposed).

(5)The court may make an order under this paragraph even though the period mentioned in paragraph 20(3)(a) has not elapsed (and paragraph 20(3)(b) does not apply) if the court thinks that the order should be made as a matter of urgency.

(6)Paragraphs [F1520(3), 22,] 23, 24 and 25 apply by virtue of sub-paragraph (4) as if—

(a)references to the relevant person were to the person mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) of this paragraph, and

(b)the duty in paragraph 23 to include terms as to the payment of consideration to that person in an agreement were a power to do so.

(7)Sub-paragraph (8) applies where, in the course of the proceedings under paragraph 20, it is shown that a person with an interest in the land was entitled to require the removal of the apparatus immediately after it was installed.

(8)The court must, in determining for the purposes of paragraph 20 whether the apparatus should continue to be kept on, under or over the land, disregard the fact that the apparatus has already been installed there.

[F16PART 4AU.K.Code rights in respect of land connected to leased premises: unresponsive occupiers

Textual Amendments

F16Sch. 3A Pt. 4A inserted (15.3.2021 for specified purposes, 26.12.2022 for E.W. in so far as not already in force, 1.7.2023 for S. in so far as not already in force) by Telecommunications Infrastructure (Leasehold Property) Act 2021 (c. 7), ss. 1, 3(3)(b)(4); S.I. 2022/1308, reg. 3(a)

IntroductoryU.K.

27AThis Part of this code makes provision for the court to make an order imposing an agreement which provides that code rights are exercisable by an operator for the purpose of providing an electronic communications service to leased premises where—

(a)the rights are required in respect of land which is connected to the leased premises, and

(b)the occupier or another person with an interest in the land has not responded to repeated notices given by the operator seeking agreement to confer or otherwise be bound by the rights.

Circumstances in which an application for an order under this Part can be madeU.K.

27B(1)Paragraphs 27C and 27D apply where—

(a)premises within the scope of this Part are occupied under a lease (the “target premises”),

(b)the lessee in occupation requests an operator to provide an electronic communications service to the target premises,

(c)in order to fulfil that request, the operator requires a person (the “required grantor”) to agree—

(i)to confer on the operator a code right in respect of connected land, or

(ii)otherwise to be bound by such a code right exercisable by the operator,

(d)the operator has, on or after the day on which section 1 of the Telecommunications Infrastructure (Leasehold Property) Act 2021 comes fully into force, given the required grantor a notice in accordance with paragraph 20(2) of this code seeking that agreement (the “request notice”), and

(e)the required grantor has not responded to the operator.

(2)Premises are within the scope of this Part if they—

(a)form part of a multiple dwelling building (see paragraph 27I(1)), or

(b)are other premises of a description specified in regulations made by the Secretary of State.

(3)In this Part “connected land”, in relation to the target premises, means land which—

(a)is in common ownership with the target premises (see paragraph 27I(2)), and

(b)is held or used for access to, or otherwise in connection with, the target premises.

(4)For the purposes of this paragraph, the required grantor responds to the operator if the required grantor—

(a)agrees or refuses, in writing, to confer or otherwise be bound by the code right specified in the request notice on the terms that the operator seeks, or

(b)otherwise acknowledges the request notice in writing.

Requirements to be met before applying for an order under this PartU.K.

27C(1)Before applying to the court for an order under this Part (a “Part 4A order”) (see paragraph 27E(2)) the operator must, in accordance with this paragraph, give the required grantor—

(a)two warning notices, and

(b)a final notice.

(2)A “warning notice” is a notice in writing which—

(a)includes a copy of the request notice,

(b)states that it is the first or (as the case may be) second of three notices that, unless the required grantor responds to the operator, will allow the operator to apply for a Part 4A order, and

(c)explains the effect of a Part 4A order.

(3)The first warning notice may only be given after the end of the period of seven days beginning with the day on which the request notice was given.

(4)The second warning notice may only be given after the end of the period of seven days beginning with the day on which the first one was given.

(5)A “final notice” is a notice in writing which—

(a)includes a copy of the request notice,

(b)states that unless the required grantor responds to the operator before the end of the period of 14 days beginning with the day on which the final notice is given, the operator intends to apply for a Part 4A order, and

(c)explains the effect of a Part 4A order.

(6)A final notice may only be given within the permitted period.

(7)The “permitted period” means the period which—

(a)begins immediately after the end of whichever of the following ends last—

(i)the period of seven days beginning with the day on which the second warning notice was given;

(ii)the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which the request notice was given, and

(b)ends at the end of the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which the second warning notice was given.

(8)The Secretary of State may by regulations specify other conditions that the operator must satisfy before giving the required grantor a final notice.

27D(1)The operator may apply to the court for a Part 4A order in relation to the code right specified in the request notice if—

(a)the operator has satisfied the notice requirements set out in paragraph 27C,

(b)the period of 14 days beginning with the day on which the final notice was given has ended,

(c)the required grantor has not responded to the operator, and

(d)the operator has satisfied any other specified conditions.

(2)An application for a Part 4A order may not be made after the end of the specified period beginning with the day on which the final notice is given.

(3)The operator must give the required grantor notice of an application for a Part 4A order.

(4)For the purposes of this paragraph, the required grantor responds to the operator if the required grantor—

(a)agrees or refuses, in writing, to confer or otherwise be bound by the code right specified in the request notice on the terms that the operator seeks, or

(b)otherwise acknowledges, in writing, the request notice, a warning notice or the final notice.

(5)In this paragraph “specified” means specified in regulations made by the Secretary of State.

When a Part 4A order can be made and its effectU.K.

27E(1)The court may make a Part 4A order if (and only if)—

(a)it is satisfied that the requirements for applying for the order have been met, and

(b)the required grantor has not objected to the making of the order.

(2)A Part 4A order is an order which imposes on the operator and the required grantor an agreement between them—

(a)by which the required grantor confers on the operator the code right identified in the request notice in respect of the connected land so identified, or

(b)which provides for the code right identified in that notice, which is exercisable by the operator in respect of the connected land so identified, otherwise to bind the required grantor.

(3)In this code, a “Part 4A code right” means a code right which is conferred by or otherwise binds the required grantor pursuant to an agreement imposed by a Part 4A order.

(4)The terms of an agreement imposed by a Part 4A order are to be those specified in regulations made by the Secretary of State.

(5)Regulations under sub-paragraph (4) must, in particular, provide for an agreement to include terms—

(a)relating to the provision by the operator to the required grantor of details of the works to be carried out in the exercise of the Part 4A code right (“the works”);

(b)relating to the obtaining by the operator of any consent, permit, licence, permission, authorisation or approval which is necessary for the works to be carried out;

(c)relating to the giving of notice by the operator to the required grantor or other specified persons before entering on the connected land in the exercise of the Part 4A code right or carrying out the works;

(d)restricting the operator's right to enter on the connected land to specified times, except in cases of emergency;

(e)as to the manner in which the works are to be carried out by the operator;

(f)relating to the restoration by the operator of the connected land at the end of the works, to the reasonable satisfaction of the required grantor;

(g)relating to the need for insurance cover or indemnification of the required grantor;

(h)relating to the maintenance or upgrading by the operator of apparatus installed on, under or over the connected land in the exercise of the Part 4A code right (“the apparatus”);

(i)imposing requirements or restrictions on the required grantor for the purposes of—

(i)preventing damage to the apparatus,

(ii)facilitating access to the apparatus for the operator, or

(iii)otherwise preventing or minimising disruption to the operation of the apparatus;

(j)relating to assignment of the agreement;

(k)aimed at ensuring that nothing done by the operator in the exercise of the Part 4A code right unnecessarily prevents or inhibits the provision of an electronic communications service by any other operator.

(6)Before making regulations under sub-paragraph (4), the Secretary of State must consult—

(a)operators,

(b)persons appearing to the Secretary of State to represent owners of interests in land who are likely to be affected by the regulations, and

(c)any other persons the Secretary of State thinks appropriate.

(7)In sub-paragraph (5), “specified” mean specified, or of a description specified, in the regulations.

Exercise of Part 4A code rightsU.K.

27F(1)A Part 4A code right may be exercised by the operator in respect of the connected land for the provision of an electronic communications service to—

(a)the target premises, and

(b)other premises, but only if the provision of the service to the other premises in addition to the target premises imposes no additional burden on the required grantor.

(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(b), an additional burden includes anything that—

(a)has an additional adverse effect on the required grantor's enjoyment of the connected land, or

(b)causes additional loss, damage or expense to the required grantor.

Expiry of Part 4A code rightsU.K.

27G(1)A Part 4A code right ceases to be conferred on the operator by, or otherwise to bind, the required grantor—

(a)if a replacement agreement comes into effect, in accordance with that agreement,

(b)if the court decides to refuse an application by the operator for the imposition of a replacement agreement, in accordance with that decision, or

(c)if the right has not ceased to have that effect as mentioned in paragraph (a) or (b) before the end of the specified period beginning with the day on which the agreement imposed by the Part 4A order comes into effect, at the end of that period.

(2)In sub-paragraph (1) a “replacement agreement”, in relation to a Part 4A code right, means an agreement under Part 2 by which the required grantor confers a code right on the operator, or otherwise agrees to be bound by a code right which is exercisable by the operator, where that right is in respect of the same land as the Part 4A code right.

(3)In sub-paragraph (1)(c) “specified period” means the period, of no more than 18 months, specified in regulations made by the Secretary of State.

(4)The required grantor has the right, subject to and in accordance with Part 6 of this code, to require the operator to remove any electronic communications apparatus placed on the connected land in the exercise of a Part 4A code right which has ceased to have effect, or otherwise to bind, the required grantor.

CompensationU.K.

27H(1)This paragraph applies where the court has made a Part 4A order.

(2)The court may, on the application of the required grantor, order the operator to pay compensation to the required grantor for any loss or damage that has been sustained or will be sustained by the required grantor as a result of the exercise by the operator of the Part 4A code right.

(3)An application for an order under this paragraph may be made at any time after the Part 4A order is made (including at a time when the Part 4A code right has ceased to be conferred on the operator by, or otherwise to bind, the required grantor).

(4)An order under this paragraph may—

(a)specify the amount of compensation to be paid by the operator, or

(b)give directions for the determination of any such amount.

(5)Directions under sub-paragraph (4)(b) may provide—

(a)for the amount of compensation to be agreed between the operator and the required grantor;

(b)for any dispute about that amount to be determined by arbitration.

(6)An order under this paragraph may provide for the operator—

(a)to make a lump sum payment,

(b)to make periodical payments,

(c)to make a payment or payments on the occurrence of an event or events, or

(d)to make a payment or payments in such other form or at such other time or times as the court may direct.

(7)Paragraph 84 makes further provision about compensation in the case of a Part 4A order.

Interpretation of this PartU.K.

27I(1)In this Part—

  • connected land” has the meaning given by paragraph 27B(3);

  • multiple dwelling building” means a building which contains two or more sets of premises which are used as, or intended to be used as, a separate dwelling;

  • Part 4A order” has the meaning given by paragraph 27C(1);

  • premises” includes a part of premises;

  • request notice” has the meaning given by paragraph 27B(1)(d);

  • required grantor” has the meaning given by paragraph 27B(1)(c);

  • target premises” has the meaning given by paragraph 27B(1)(a).

(2)For the purposes of this Part, land is in “common ownership” with the target premises if a person with a relevant interest in the land also has a relevant interest (whether or not of the same sort) in the target premises.

(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2), a person has a “relevant interest” in land if—

(a)the person owns the freehold estate in the land (or, in relation to Scotland, is the owner of the land), or

(b)the person is the lessee of the land.]

PART 5U.K.Termination and modification of agreements

IntroductoryU.K.

28U.K.This Part of this code makes provision about—

(a)the continuation of code rights after the time at which they cease to be exercisable under an agreement,

(b)the procedure for bringing an agreement to an end,

(c)the procedure for changing an agreement relating to code rights, and

(d)the arrangements for the making of payments under an agreement whilst disputes under this Part are resolved.

Application of this PartU.K.

29(1)This Part of this code applies to an agreement under Part 2 of this code, subject to sub-paragraphs (2) to (4).U.K.

(2)This Part of this code does not apply to a lease of land in England and Wales if—

(a)its primary purpose is not to grant code rights, and

(b)it is a lease to which Part 2 of the Landlord and Tenant Act 1954 (security of tenure for business, professional and other tenants) applies.

(3)In determining whether a lease is one to which Part 2 of the Landlord and Tenant Act 1954 applies, any agreement under section 38A (agreements to exclude provisions of Part 2) of that Act is to be disregarded.

(4)This Part of this code does not apply to a lease of land in Northern Ireland if—

(a)its primary purpose is not to grant code rights, and

(b)it is a lease to which the Business Tenancies (Northern Ireland) Order 1996 (SI 1996/725 (NI 5)) applies.

(5)An agreement to which this Part of this code applies is referred to in this code as a “code agreement”.

Continuation of code rightsU.K.

30(1)Sub-paragraph (2) applies if—U.K.

(a)a code right is conferred by, or is otherwise binding on, a person (the “site provider”) as the result of a code agreement, and

(b)under the terms of the agreement—

(i)the right ceases to be exercisable or the site provider ceases to be bound by it, or

(ii)the site provider may bring the code agreement to an end so far as it relates to that right.

(2)Where this sub-paragraph applies the code agreement continues so that—

(a)the operator may continue to exercise that right, and

(b)the site provider continues to be bound by the right.

(3)Sub-paragraph (2) does not apply to a code right which is conferred by, or is otherwise binding on, a person by virtue of an order under paragraph 26 (interim code rights) or 27 (temporary code rights).

(4)Sub-paragraph (2) is subject to the following provisions of this Part of this code.

How may a person bring a code agreement to an end?U.K.

31(1)A site provider who is a party to a code agreement may bring the agreement to an end by giving a notice in accordance with this paragraph to the operator who is a party to the agreement.U.K.

(2)The notice must—

(a)comply with paragraph 89 (notices given by persons other than operators),

(b)specify the date on which the site provider proposes the code agreement should come to an end, and

(c)state the ground on which the site provider proposes to bring the code agreement to an end.

(3)The date specified under sub-paragraph (2)(b) must fall—

(a)after the end of the period of 18 months beginning with the day on which the notice is given, and

(b)after the time at which, apart from paragraph 30, the code right to which the agreement relates would have ceased to be exercisable or to bind the site provider or at a time when, apart from that paragraph, the code agreement could have been brought to an end by the site provider.

(4)The ground stated under sub-paragraph (2)(c) must be one of the following—

(a)that the code agreement ought to come to an end as a result of substantial breaches by the operator of its obligations under the agreement;

(b)that the code agreement ought to come to an end because of persistent delays by the operator in making payments to the site provider under the agreement;

(c)that the site provider intends to redevelop all or part of the land to which the code agreement relates, or any neighbouring land, and could not reasonably do so unless the code agreement comes to an end;

(d)that the operator is not entitled to the code agreement because the test under paragraph 21 for the imposition of the agreement on the site provider is not met.

What is the effect of a notice under paragraph 31?U.K.

32(1)Where a site provider gives a notice under paragraph 31, the code agreement to which it relates comes to an end in accordance with the notice unless—U.K.

(a)within the period of three months beginning with the day on which the notice is given, the operator gives the site provider a counter-notice in accordance with sub-paragraph (3), and

(b)within the period of three months beginning with the day on which the counter-notice is given, the operator applies to the court for an order under paragraph 34.

(2)Sub-paragraph (1) does not apply if the operator and the site provider agree to the continuation of the code agreement.

(3)The counter-notice must state—

(a)that the operator does not want the existing code agreement to come to an end,

(b)that the operator wants the site provider to agree to confer or be otherwise bound by the existing code right on new terms, or

(c)that the operator wants the site provider to agree to confer or be otherwise bound by a new code right in place of the existing code right.

(4)If, on an application under sub-paragraph (1)(b), the court decides that the site provider has established any of the grounds stated in the site provider's notice under paragraph 31, the court must order that the code agreement comes to an end in accordance with the order.

(5)Otherwise the court must make one of the orders specified in paragraph 34.

How may a party to a code agreement require a change to the terms of an agreement which has expired?U.K.

33(1)An operator or site provider who is a party to a code agreement by which a code right is conferred by or otherwise binds the site provider may, by notice in accordance with this paragraph, require the other party to the agreement to agree that—U.K.

(a)the code agreement should have effect with modified terms,

(b)where under the code agreement more than one code right is conferred by or otherwise binds the site provider, that the agreement should no longer provide for an existing code right to be conferred by or otherwise bind the site provider,

(c)the code agreement should—

(i)confer an additional code right on the operator, or

(ii)provide that the site provider is otherwise bound by an additional code right, or

(d)the existing code agreement should be terminated and a new agreement should have effect between the parties which—

(i)confers a code right on the operator, or

(ii)provides for a code right to bind the site provider.

(2)The notice must—

(a)comply with paragraph 88 or 89, according to whether the notice is given by an operator or a site provider,

(b)specify—

(i)the day from which it is proposed that the modified terms should have effect,

(ii)the day from which the agreement should no longer provide for the code right to be conferred by or otherwise bind the site provider,

(iii)the day from which it is proposed that the additional code right should be conferred by or otherwise bind the site provider, or

(iv)the day on which it is proposed the existing code agreement should be terminated and from which a new agreement should have effect,

(as the case may be), and

(c)set out details of—

(i)the proposed modified terms,

(ii)the code right it is proposed should no longer be conferred by or otherwise bind the site provider,

(iii)the proposed additional code right, or

(iv)the proposed terms of the new agreement,

(as the case may be).

(3)The day specified under sub-paragraph (2)(b) must fall—

(a)after the end of the period of 6 months beginning with the day on which the notice is given, and

(b)after the time at which, apart from paragraph 30, the code right to which the existing code agreement relates would have ceased to be exercisable or to bind the site provider or at a time when, apart from that paragraph, the code agreement could have been brought to an end by the site provider.

(4)Sub-paragraph (5) applies if, after the end of the period of 6 months beginning with the day on which the notice is given, the operator and the site provider have not reached agreement on the proposals in the notice.

(5)Where this paragraph applies, the operator or the site provider may apply to the court for the court to make an order under paragraph 34.

What orders may a court make on an application under paragraph 32 or 33?U.K.

34(1)This paragraph sets out the orders that the court may make on an application under paragraph 32(1)(b) or 33(5).U.K.

(2)The court may order that the operator may continue to exercise the existing code right in accordance with the existing code agreement for such period as may be specified in the order (so that the code agreement has effect accordingly).

(3)The court may order the modification of the terms of the code agreement relating to the existing code right.

(4)Where under the code agreement more than one code right is conferred by or otherwise binds the site provider, the court may order the modification of the terms of the code agreement so that it no longer provides for an existing code right to be conferred by or otherwise bind the site provider.

(5)The court may order the terms of the code agreement relating to the existing code right to be modified so that—

(a)it confers an additional code right on the operator, or

(b)it provides that the site provider is otherwise bound by an additional code right.

(6)The court may order the termination of the code agreement relating to the existing code right and order the operator and the site provider to enter into a new agreement which—

(a)confers a code right on the operator, or

(b)provides for a code right to bind the site provider.

(7)The existing code agreement continues until the new agreement takes effect.

(8)This code applies to the new agreement as if it were an agreement under Part 2 of this code.

(9)The terms conferring or providing for an additional code right under sub-paragraph (5), and the terms of a new agreement under sub-paragraph (6), are to be such as are agreed between the operator and the site provider.

(10)If the operator and the site provider are unable to agree on the terms, the court must on an application by either party make an order specifying those terms.

(11)Paragraphs 23(2) to (8), 24, 25 and 84 apply—

(a)to an order under sub-paragraph (3), (4) or (5), so far as it modifies or specifies the terms of the agreement, and

(b)to an order under sub-paragraph (10)

as they apply to an order under paragraph 20.

(12)In the case of an order under sub-paragraph (10) the court must also have regard to the terms of the existing code agreement.

(13)In determining which order to make under this paragraph, the court must have regard to all the circumstances of the case, and in particular to—

(a)the operator's business and technical needs,

(b)the use that the site provider is making of the land to which the existing code agreement relates,

(c)any duties imposed on the site provider by an enactment, and

(d)the amount of consideration payable by the operator to the site provider under the existing code agreement.

(14)Where the court makes an order under this paragraph, it may also order the operator to pay the site provider the amount (if any) by which A exceeds B, where—

(a)A is the amount of consideration that would have been payable by the operator to the site provider for the relevant period if that amount had been assessed on the same basis as the consideration payable as the result of the order, and

(b)B is the amount of consideration payable by the operator to the site provider for the relevant period.

(15)In sub-paragraph (14) the relevant period is the period (if any) that—

(a)begins on the date on which, apart from the operation of paragraph 30, the code right to which the existing code agreement relates would have ceased to be exercisable or to bind the site provider or from which, apart from that paragraph, the code agreement could have been brought to an end by the site provider, and

(b)ends on the date on which the order is made.

What arrangements for payment can be made pending determination of the application?U.K.

35(1)This paragraph applies where—U.K.

(a)a code right continues to be exercisable under paragraph 30 after the time at which, apart from the operation of that paragraph, the code right would have ceased to be exercisable or to bind the site provider or from which, apart from that paragraph, the code agreement relating to the right could have been brought to an end by the site provider, and

(b)the operator or the site provider has applied to the court for an order under paragraph 32(1)(b) or 33(5).

(2)The site provider may—

(a)agree with the operator that, until the application has been finally determined, the site provider will continue to receive the payments of consideration from the operator to which the site provider is entitled under the agreement relating to the existing code right,

(b)agree with the operator that, until that time, the site provider will receive different payments of consideration under that agreement, or

(c)apply to the court for the court to determine the payments of consideration to be made by the operator to the site provider under that agreement until that time.

(3)The court must determine the payments under sub-paragraph (2)(c) on the basis set out in paragraph 24 (calculation of consideration).

PART 6U.K.Rights to require removal of electronic communications apparatus

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

C3Sch. 3A Pt. 6 applied by 1985 c. 68, s. 298(2) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 19; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C4Sch. 3A Pt. 6 excluded by 1996 c. 61, Sch. 15 Pt. 4 para. 2(1) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 38(3); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

IntroductoryU.K.

36U.K.This Part of this code makes provision about—

(a)the cases in which a person has the right to require the removal of electronic communications apparatus or the restoration of land,

(b)the means by which a person can discover whether apparatus is on land pursuant to a code right, and

(c)the means by which a right to require removal of apparatus or restoration of land can be enforced.

When does a landowner have the right to require removal of electronic communications apparatus?U.K.

37(1)A person with an interest in land (a “landowner”) has the right to require the removal of electronic communications apparatus on, under or over the land if (and only if) one or more of the following conditions are met.U.K.

(2)The first condition is that the landowner has never since the coming into force of this code been bound by a code right entitling an operator to keep the apparatus on, under or over the land.

(3)The second condition is that a code right entitling an operator to keep the apparatus on, under or over the land has come to an end or has ceased to bind the landowner—

(a)as mentioned in paragraph 26(7) and (8),

[F17(aa)as mentioned in paragraph 27G(1) and (4);]

(b)as the result of paragraph 32(1), or

(c)as the result of an order under paragraph 32(4) or 34(4) or (6), or

(d)where the right was granted by a lease to which Part 5 of this code does not apply.

This is subject to sub-paragraph (4).

(4)The landowner does not meet the first or second condition if—

(a)the land is occupied by a person who—

(i)conferred a code right (which is in force) entitling an operator to keep the apparatus on, under or over the land, or

(ii)is otherwise bound by such a right, and

(b)that code right was not conferred in breach of a covenant enforceable by the landowner.

(5)In the application of sub-paragraph (4)(b) to Scotland the reference to a covenant enforceable by the landowner is to be read as a reference to a contractual term which is so enforceable.

(6)The third condition is that—

(a)an operator has the benefit of a code right entitling the operator to keep the apparatus on, under or over the land, but

(b)the apparatus is not, or is no longer, used for the purposes of the operator's network, and

(c)there is no reasonable likelihood that the apparatus will be used for that purpose.

(7)The fourth condition is that—

(a)this code has ceased to apply to a person so that the person is no longer entitled under this code to keep the apparatus on, under or over the land,

(b)the retention of the apparatus on, under or over the land is not authorised by a scheme contained in an order under section 117, and

(c)there is no other person with a right conferred by or under this code to keep the apparatus on, under or over the land.

(8)The fifth condition is that—

(a)the apparatus was kept on, under or over the land pursuant to—

(i)a transport land right (see Part 7), or

(ii)a street work right (see Part 8),

(b)that right has ceased to be exercisable in relation to the land by virtue of paragraph 54(9), and

(c)there is no other person with a right conferred by or under this code to keep the apparatus on, under or over the land.

(9)This paragraph does not affect rights to require the removal of apparatus under another enactment (see paragraph 41).

Textual Amendments

F17Sch. 3A para. 37(3)(aa) inserted (15.3.2021 for specified purposes) by Telecommunications Infrastructure (Leasehold Property) Act 2021 (c. 7), s. 3(3)(b)(4), Sch. para. 4(9)

When does a landowner or occupier of neighbouring land have the right to require removal of electronic communications apparatus?U.K.

38(1)A landowner or occupier of any land (“neighbouring land”) has the right to require the removal of electronic communications apparatus kept on, under or over other land in exercise of a right mentioned in paragraph 13(1), if both of the following conditions are met.U.K.

(2)The first condition is that the apparatus interferes with or obstructs a means of access to or from the neighbouring land.

(3)The second condition is that the landowner or occupier of the neighbouring land is not bound by a code right within paragraph 3(h) entitling an operator to cause the interference or obstruction.

(4)A landowner of neighbouring land who is not the occupier of the land does not meet the second condition if—

(a)the land is occupied by a person who—

(i)conferred a code right (which is in force) entitling an operator to cause the interference or obstruction, or

(ii)is otherwise bound by such a right, and

(b)that code right was not conferred in breach of a covenant enforceable by the landowner.

(5)In the application of sub-paragraph (4)(b) to Scotland the reference to a covenant enforceable by the landowner is to be read as a reference to a contractual term which is so enforceable.

How does a landowner or occupier find out whether apparatus is on land pursuant to a code right?U.K.

39(1)A landowner may by notice require an operator to disclose whether—U.K.

(a)the operator owns electronic communications apparatus on, under or over land in which the landowner has an interest or uses such apparatus for the purposes of the operator's network, or

(b)the operator has the benefit of a code right entitling the operator to keep electronic communications apparatus on, under or over land in which the landowner has an interest.

(2)A landowner or occupier of neighbouring land may by notice require an operator to disclose whether—

(a)the operator owns electronic communications apparatus on, under or over land that forms (or, but for the apparatus, would form) a means of access to the neighbouring land, or uses such apparatus for the purposes of the operator's network, or

(b)the operator has the benefit of a code right entitling the operator to keep electronic communications apparatus on, under or over land that forms (or, but for the apparatus, would form) a means of access to the neighbouring land.

(3)The notice must comply with paragraph 89 (notices given by persons other than operators).

(4)Sub-paragraph (5) applies if—

(a)the operator does not, before the end of the period of three months beginning with the date on which the notice under sub-paragraph (1) or (2) was given, give a notice to the landowner or occupier that—

(i)complies with paragraph 88 (notices given by operators), and

(ii)discloses the information sought by the landowner or occupier,

(b)the landowner or occupier takes action under paragraph 40 to enforce the removal of the apparatus, and

(c)it is subsequently established that—

(i)the operator owns the apparatus or uses it for the purposes of the operator's network, and

(ii)the operator has the benefit of a code right entitling the operator to keep the apparatus on, under or over the land.

(5)The operator must nevertheless bear the costs of any action taken by the landowner or occupier under paragraph 40 to enforce the removal of the apparatus.

How does a landowner or occupier enforce removal of apparatus?U.K.

40(1)The right of a landowner or occupier to require the removal of electronic communications apparatus on, under or over land, under paragraph 37 or 38, is exercisable only in accordance with this paragraph.U.K.

(2)The landowner or occupier may give a notice to the operator whose apparatus it is requiring the operator—

(a)to remove the apparatus, and

(b)to restore the land to its condition before the apparatus was placed on, under or over the land.

(3)The notice must—

(a)comply with paragraph 89 (notices given by persons other than operators), and

(b)specify the period within which the operator must complete the works.

(4)The period specified under sub-paragraph (3) must be a reasonable one.

(5)Sub-paragraph (6) applies if, within the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which the notice was given, the landowner or occupier and the operator do not reach agreement on any of the following matters—

(a)that the operator will remove the apparatus;

(b)that the operator will restore the land to its condition before the apparatus was placed on, under or over the land;

(c)the time at which or period within which the apparatus will be removed;

(d)the time at which or period within which the land will be restored.

(6)The landowner or occupier may make an application to the court for—

(a)an order under paragraph 44(1) (order requiring operator to remove apparatus etc), or

(b)an order under paragraph 44(3) (order enabling landowner to sell apparatus etc).

(7)If the court makes an order under paragraph 44(1), but the operator does not comply with the agreement imposed on the operator and the landowner or occupier by virtue of paragraph 44(7), the landowner or occupier may make an application to the court for an order under paragraph 44(3).

(8)On an application under sub-paragraph (6) or (7) the court may not make an order in relation to apparatus if an application under paragraph 20(3) has been made in relation to the apparatus and has not been determined.

How are other rights to require removal of apparatus enforced?U.K.

41(1)The right of a person (a “third party”) under an enactment other than this code, or otherwise than under an enactment, to require the removal of electronic communications apparatus on, under or over land is exercisable only in accordance with this paragraph.U.K.

(2)The third party may give a notice to the operator whose apparatus it is, requiring the operator—

(a)to remove the apparatus, and

(b)to restore the land to its condition before the apparatus was placed on, under or over the land.

(3)The notice must—

(a)comply with paragraph 89 (notices given by persons other than operators), and

(b)specify the period within which the operator must complete the works.

(4)The period specified under sub-paragraph (3) must be a reasonable one.

(5)Within the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which notice under sub-paragraph (2) is given, the operator may give the third party notice (“counter-notice”)—

(a)stating that the third party is not entitled to require the removal of the apparatus, or

(b)specifying the steps which the operator proposes to take for the purpose of securing a right as against the third party to keep the apparatus on the land.

(6)If the operator does not give counter-notice within that period, the third party is entitled to enforce the removal of the apparatus.

(7)If the operator gives the third party counter-notice within that period, the third party may enforce the removal of the apparatus only in pursuance of an order of the court that the third party is entitled to enforce the removal of the apparatus.

(8)If the counter-notice specifies steps under paragraph (5)(b), the court may make an order under sub-paragraph (7) only if it is satisfied—

(a)that the operator is not intending to take those steps or is being unreasonably dilatory in taking them; or

(b)that taking those steps has not secured, or will not secure, for the operator as against the third party any right to keep the apparatus installed on, under or over the land or to re-install it if it is removed.

(9)Where the third party is entitled to enforce the removal of the apparatus, under sub-paragraph (6) or under an order under sub-paragraph (7), the third party may make an application to the court for—

(a)an order under paragraph 44(1) (order requiring operator to remove apparatus etc), or

(b)an order under paragraph 44(3) (order enabling third party to sell apparatus etc).

(10)If the court makes an order under paragraph 44(1), but the operator does not comply with the agreement imposed on the operator and the third party by virtue of paragraph 44(7), the third party may make an application to the court for an order under paragraph 44(3).

(11)An order made on an application under this paragraph need not include provision within paragraph 44(1)(b) or (3)(d) unless the court thinks it appropriate.

(12)Sub-paragraph (9) is without prejudice to any other method available to the third party for enforcing the removal of the apparatus.

How does paragraph 40 apply if a person is entitled to require apparatus to be altered in consequence of street works?U.K.

42(1)This paragraph applies where the third party's right in relation to which paragraph 41 applies is a right to require the alteration of the apparatus in consequence of the stopping up, closure, change or diversion of a street or road or the extinguishment or alteration of a public right of way.U.K.

(2)The removal of the apparatus in pursuance of paragraph 41 constitutes compliance with a requirement to make any other alteration.

(3)A counter-notice under paragraph 41(5) may state (in addition to, or instead of, any of the matters mentioned in paragraph 41(5)(b)) that the operator requires the third party to reimburse the operator in respect of any expenses incurred by the operator in or in connection with the making of any alteration in compliance with the requirements of the third party.

(4)An order made under paragraph 41 on an application by the third party in respect of a counter-notice containing a statement under sub-paragraph (3) must, unless the court otherwise thinks fit, require the third party to reimburse the operator in respect of the expenses referred to in the statement.

(5)Paragraph 44(3)(b) to (e) do not apply.

(6)In this paragraph—

  • road” means a road in Scotland;

  • street” means a street in England and Wales or Northern Ireland.

When can a separate application for restoration of land be made?U.K.

43(1)This paragraph applies if—U.K.

(a)the condition of the land has been affected by the exercise of a code right, and

(b)restoration of the land to its condition before the code right was exercised does not involve the removal of electronic communications apparatus from any land.

(2)The occupier of the land, the owner of the freehold estate in the land or the lessee of the land (“the relevant person”) has the right to require the operator to restore the land if the relevant person is not for the time being bound by the code right.

(3)The relevant person does not have that right if—

(a)the land is occupied by a person who—

(i)conferred a code right (which is in force) entitling the operator to affect the condition of the land in the same way as the right mentioned in sub-paragraph (1), or

(ii)is otherwise bound by such a right, and

(b)that code right was not conferred in breach of a covenant enforceable by the relevant person.

(4)In the application of sub-paragraph (3)(b) to Scotland the reference to a covenant enforceable by the relevant person is to be read as a reference to a contractual term which is so enforceable.

(5)A person who has the right conferred by this paragraph may give a notice to the operator requiring the operator to restore the land to its condition before the code right was exercised.

(6)The notice must—

(a)comply with paragraph 89 (notices given by persons other than operators), and

(b)specify the period within which the operator must complete the works.

(7)The period specified under sub-paragraph (6) must be a reasonable one.

(8)Sub-paragraph (9) applies if, within the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which the notice was given, the landowner and the operator do not reach agreement on any of the following matters—

(a)that the operator will restore the land to its condition before the code right was exercised;

(b)the time at which or period within which the land will be restored.

(9)The landowner may make an application to the court for—

(a)an order under paragraph 44(2) (order requiring operator to restore land), or

(b)an order under paragraph 44(4) (order enabling landowner to recover cost of restoring land).

(10)If the court makes an order under paragraph 44(2), but the operator does not comply with the agreement imposed on the operator and the landowner by virtue of paragraph 44(7), the landowner may make an application to the court for an order under paragraph 44(4).

(11)In the application of sub-paragraph (2) to Scotland the reference to a person who is the owner of the freehold estate in the land is to be read as a reference to a person who is the owner of the land.

What orders may the court make on an application under paragraphs 40 to 43?U.K.

44(1)An order under this sub-paragraph is an order that the operator must, within the period specified in the order—U.K.

(a)remove the electronic communications apparatus, and

(b)restore the land to its condition before the apparatus was placed on, under or over the land.

(2)An order under this sub-paragraph is an order that the operator must, within the period specified in the order, restore the land to its condition before the code right was exercised.

(3)An order under this sub-paragraph is an order that the landowner, occupier or third party may do any of the following—

(a)remove or arrange the removal of the electronic communications apparatus;

(b)sell any apparatus so removed;

(c)recover the costs of any action under paragraph (a) or (b) from the operator;

(d)recover from the operator the costs of restoring the land to its condition before the apparatus was placed on, under or over the land;

(e)retain the proceeds of sale of the apparatus to the extent that these do not exceed the costs incurred by the landowner, occupier or third party as mentioned in paragraph (c) or (d).

(4)An order under this sub-paragraph is an order that the landowner may recover from the operator the costs of restoring the land to its condition before the code right was exercised.

(5)An order under this paragraph on an application under paragraph 40 may require the operator to pay compensation to the landowner for any loss or damage suffered by the landowner as a result of the presence of the apparatus on the land during the period when the landowner had the right to require the removal of the apparatus from the land but was not able to exercise that right.

(6)Paragraph 84 makes further provision about compensation under sub-paragraph (5).

(7)An order under sub-paragraph (1) or (2) takes effect as an agreement between the operator and the landowner, occupier or third party that—

(a)requires the operator to take the steps specified in the order, and

(b)otherwise contains such terms as the court may so specify.

PART 7U.K.Conferral of transport land rights and their exercise

IntroductoryU.K.

45U.K.This Part of this code makes provision about—

(a)the conferral of transport land rights, and

(b)the exercise of transport land rights.

Transport land and transport undertakersU.K.

46U.K.In this Part of this code—

  • transport land” means land which is used wholly or mainly—

    (a)

    as a railway, canal or tramway, or

    (b)

    in connection with a railway, canal or tramway on the land;

  • transport undertaker”, in relation to transport land, means the person carrying on the railway, canal or tramway undertaking.

Conferral of transport land rightsU.K.

47(1)An operator may exercise a transport land right for the statutory purposes.U.K.

(2)But that is subject to the following provisions of this Part of this code.

The transport land rightsU.K.

48(1)For the purposes of this code a “transport land right”, in relation to an operator, is—U.K.

(a)a right to cross any transport land with a line;

(b)a right, for the purposes of crossing any transport land with a line—

(i)to install and keep the line and any other electronic communications apparatus on, under or over the transport land;

(ii)to inspect, maintain, adjust, alter, repair, upgrade or operate electronic communications apparatus on, under or over the transport land;

(iii)a right to carry out any works on the transport land for or in connection with the exercise of a right under sub-paragraph (i) or (ii);

(iv)a right to enter the transport land to inspect, maintain, adjust, alter, repair, upgrade or operate the line or other electronic communications apparatus.

(2)A line installed in the exercise of a transport land right need not cross the transport land in question by a direct route or the shortest route from the point at which the line enters the transport land.

(3)But the line must not cross the transport land by any route which, in the horizontal plane, exceeds that shortest route by more than 400 metres.

(4)The transport land rights do not authorise an operator to install a line or other electronic communications apparatus in any position on transport land in which the line or other apparatus would interfere with traffic on the railway, canal or tramway.

Non-emergency works: when can an operator exercise the transport land rights?U.K.

49(1)Before exercising a transport land right in order to carry out non-emergency works, the operator must give the transport undertaker notice of the intention to carry out the works (“notice of proposed works”).U.K.

(2)Notice of proposed works must contain a plan and section of the works; but, if the transport undertaker agrees, the notice may instead contain a description of the works (whether or not in the form of a diagram).

(3)The operator must not begin the proposed works until the notice period has ended.

(4)But the operator's power to carry out the proposed works is subject to paragraph 50.

(5)In this paragraph—

  • non-emergency works” means any works which are not emergency works under paragraph 51;

  • notice period” means the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which notice of proposed works is given.

What is the effect of the transport undertaker giving notice of objection to the operator?U.K.

50(1)This paragraph applies if an operator gives a transport undertaker notice of proposed works under paragraph 49.U.K.

(2)The transport undertaker may, within the notice period, give the operator notice objecting to the proposed works (“notice of objection”).

(3)If notice of objection is given, the operator or the transport undertaker may, within the arbitration notice period, give the other notice that the objection is to be referred to arbitration under paragraph 52 (“arbitration notice”).

(4)In a case where notice of objection is given, the operator may exercise a transport land right in order to carry out the proposed works only if they are permitted under sub-paragraph (5) or (6).

(5)Works are permitted in a case where—

(a)the arbitration notice period has ended, and

(b)no arbitration notice has been given.

(6)In a case where arbitration notice has been given, works are permitted in accordance with an award made on the arbitration.

(7)In this paragraph—

(a)arbitration notice period” means the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which objection notice is given;

(b)expressions defined in paragraph 49 have the same meanings as in that paragraph.

Emergency works: when can an operator exercise the transport land rights?U.K.

51(1)An operator may exercise a transport land right in order to carry out emergency works.U.K.

(2)If the operator exercises a transport land right to carry out emergency works, the operator must give the transport undertaker an emergency works notice as soon as reasonably practicable after starting the works.

(3)An “emergency works notice” is a notice which—

(a)identifies the emergency works;

(b)contains a statement of the reason why the works are emergency works; and

(c)contains either—

(i)the matters which would be included in a notice of proposed works (if one were given in relation to the works), or

(ii)a reference to a notice of proposed works which relates to the works that are emergency works (if one has been given).

(4)A transport undertaker may, within the compensation notice period, give the operator notice which requires the operator to pay compensation for loss or damage sustained in consequence of the carrying out of emergency works (“compensation notice”).

(5)The operator must pay the transport undertaker any compensation which is required by a compensation notice (if given within the compensation notice period).

(6)The amount of compensation payable under sub-paragraph (5) is to be agreed between the operator and the transport undertaker.

(7)But if—

(a)the compensation agreement period has ended, and

(b)the operator and the transport undertaker have not agreed the amount of compensation payable under sub-paragraph (6),

the operator or the transport undertaker may give the other notice that the disagreement is to be referred to arbitration under paragraph 52.

(8)A reference in this paragraph to emergency works includes a reference to any works which are included in a notice of proposed works but become emergency works before the operator is authorised by paragraph 50 or 51 to carry them out.

(9)In this paragraph—

  • compensation agreement period” means the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which a compensation notice is given;

  • compensation notice period” means the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which an emergency works notice is given;

  • emergency works” means works carried out in order to stop anything already occurring, or to prevent anything imminent from occurring, which is likely to cause—

    (a)

    danger to persons or property,

    (b)

    the interruption of any service provided by the operator's network, or

    (c)

    substantial loss to the operator,

    and any other works which it is reasonable (in all the circumstances) to carry out with those works;

  • notice of proposed works” means such notice given under paragraph 49.

What happens if a dispute about the transport land rights is referred to arbitration?U.K.

52(1)This paragraph applies if notice is given under paragraph 50(3) or 51(7) that the following matter (the “matter in dispute”) is to be referred to arbitration—U.K.

(a)an objection to proposed works;

(b)a disagreement about an amount of compensation.

(2)The matter in dispute is to be referred to the arbitration of a single arbitrator appointed—

(a)by agreement between the parties, or

(b)in the absence of such agreement, by the President of the Institution of Civil Engineers.

(3)If the matter in dispute is an objection to proposed works, the arbitrator has the following powers—

(a)power to require the operator to give the arbitrator a plan and section in such form as the arbitrator thinks appropriate;

(b)power to require the transport undertaker to give the arbitrator any observations on such a plan or section in such form as the arbitrator thinks appropriate;

(c)power to impose on either party any other requirements which the arbitrator thinks appropriate (including a requirement to provide information in such form as the arbitrator thinks appropriate);

(d)power to make an award—

(i)requiring modifications to the proposed works, and

(ii)specifying the terms on which, and the conditions subject to which, the proposed works may be carried out;

(e)power to award one or both of the following, payable to the transport undertaker—

(i)compensation for loss or damage sustained by that person in consequence of the carrying out of the works;

(ii)consideration for the right to carry out the works.

(4)If the matter in dispute is a disagreement about an amount of compensation, the arbitrator has the following powers—

(a)power to impose on either party any requirements which the arbitrator thinks appropriate (including a requirement to provide information in such form as the arbitrator thinks appropriate);

(b)power to award compensation, payable to the transport undertaker, for loss or damage sustained by that person in consequence of the carrying out of the emergency works.

(5)The arbitrator may make an award conditional upon a party complying with a requirement imposed under sub-paragraph (3)(a), (b) or (c) or (4)(a).

(6)In determining what award to make, the matters to which the arbitrator must have regard include the public interest in there being access to a choice of high quality electronic communications services.

(7)The arbitrator's power under sub-paragraph (3) or (4) to award compensation for loss includes power to award compensation for any increase in the expenses incurred by the transport undertaker in carrying on its railway, canal or tramway undertaking.

(8)An award of consideration under sub-paragraph (3)(e)(ii) must be determined on the basis of what would have been fair and reasonable if the transport undertaker had willingly given authority for the works to be carried out on the same terms, and subject to the same conditions (if any), as are contained in the award.

(9)In this paragraph “party” means—

(a)the operator, or

(b)the transport undertaker.

When can a transport undertaker require an operator to alter communications apparatus?U.K.

53(1)A transport undertaker may give an operator notice which requires the operator to alter a line or other electronic communications apparatus specified in the notice (“notice requiring alterations”) on the ground that keeping the apparatus on, under or over transport land interferes with, or is likely to interfere with—U.K.

(a)the carrying on of the transport undertaker's railway, canal or tramway undertaking, or

(b)anything done or to be done for the purposes of its railway, canal or tramway undertaking.

(2)The operator may, within the notice period, give the transport undertaker notice (“counter-notice”) specifying the respects in which the operator is not prepared to comply with the notice requiring alterations.

(3)The operator must comply with the notice requiring alterations, within a reasonable time and to the reasonable satisfaction of the transport undertaker, if—

(a)the notice period has ended, and

(b)no counter-notice has been given.

(4)If counter-notice has been given (within the notice period), the transport undertaker may apply to the court for an order requiring the operator to alter any of the specified apparatus.

(5)The court must not make an order unless it is satisfied that the order is necessary on one of the grounds mentioned in sub-paragraph (1).

(6)In determining whether to make an order, the matters to which the court must also have regard include the public interest in there being access to a choice of high quality electronic communications services.

(7)An order under this paragraph may take such form and be on such terms as the court thinks fit.

(8)In particular, the order—

(a)may impose such conditions, and

(b)may contain such directions to the operator or the transport undertaker,

as the court thinks necessary for resolving any difference between the operator and the transport undertaker and for protecting their respective interests.

(9)In this paragraph—

  • notice period” means the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which notice requiring alterations is given;

  • specified apparatus” means the line or other electronic communications apparatus specified in notice requiring alterations.

What happens to the transport land rights if land ceases to be transport land?U.K.

54(1)This paragraph applies if an operator is exercising a transport land right in relation to land immediately before a time when it ceases to be transport land.U.K.

(2)After that time, this Part of this code — except for paragraph 53 — continues to apply to the land as if it were still transport land (and, accordingly, the operator may continue to exercise any transport land right in relation to the land as if it were still transport land).

(3)But sub-paragraph (2) is subject to sub-paragraphs (4) to (9).

(4)In the application of this Part of this code to land in accordance with sub-paragraph (2), references to the transport undertaker have effect as references to the occupier of the land.

(5)The application of this Part of this code to land in accordance with sub-paragraph (2) does not authorise the operator—

(a)to cross the land with any line that is not in place at the time when the land ceases to be transport land, or

(b)to install and keep any line or other electronic communications apparatus that is not in place at the time when the land ceases to be transport land.

(6)But sub-paragraph (5) does not affect the power of the operator to replace an existing line or other apparatus (whether in place at the time when the land ceased to be transport land or a replacement itself authorised by this sub-paragraph) with a new line or apparatus which—

(a)is not substantially different from the existing line or apparatus, and

(b)is not in a significantly different position.

(7)The occupier of the land may, at any time after the land ceases to be transport land, give the operator notice specifying a date on which this Part of this code is to cease to apply to the land in accordance with this paragraph (“notice of termination”).

(8)That date specified in the notice of termination must fall after the end of the period of 12 months beginning with the day on which the notice of termination is given.

(9)On the date specified in notice of termination in accordance with sub-paragraph (8), the transport land rights cease to be exercisable in relation to the land in accordance with this paragraph.

Offence: operators who do not comply with this Part of this codeU.K.

55(1)An operator is guilty of an offence if the operator starts any works in contravention of any provision of paragraph 49, paragraph 50 or paragraph 51.U.K.

(2)An operator guilty of an offence under this paragraph is liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding level 3 on the standard scale.

(3)In a case where this Part of this code applies in accordance with paragraph 54, the reference in this paragraph to paragraph 49, paragraph 50 or paragraph 51 is a reference to that paragraph as it applies in accordance with paragraph 54.

PART 8U.K.Conferral of street work rights and their exercise

IntroductoryU.K.

56U.K.This Part of this code makes provision about—

(a)the conferral of street work rights, and

(b)the exercise of street work rights.

Streets and roadsU.K.

57U.K.In this Part of this code—

  • road” means—

    (a)

    a road in Scotland which is a public road;

    (b)

    a road in Northern Ireland;

  • street” means a street in England and Wales which is a maintainable highway (within the meaning of Part 3 of New Roads and Street Works Act 1991), other than one which is a footpath, bridleway or restricted byway that crosses, and forms part of, any agricultural land or any land which is being brought into use for agriculture.

Conferral of street work rightsU.K.

58(1)An operator may exercise a street work right for the statutory purposes.U.K.

(2)But that is subject to the following provisions of this Part of this code.

The street work rightsU.K.

59(1)For the purposes of this code a “street work right”, in relation to an operator, is—U.K.

(a)a right to install and keep electronic communications apparatus in, on, under, over, along or across a street or a road;

(b)a right to inspect, maintain, adjust, alter, repair, upgrade or operate electronic communications apparatus which is installed or kept by the exercise of the right under paragraph (a);

(c)a right to carry out any works in, on, under, over, along or across a street or road for or in connection with the exercise of a right under paragraph (a) or (b);

(d)a right to enter any street or road to inspect, maintain, adjust, alter, repair, upgrade or operate electronic communications apparatus which is installed or kept by the exercise of the right under paragraph (a).

(2)The works that may be carried out under sub-paragraph (1)(c) include—

(a)breaking up or opening a street or a road;

(b)tunnelling or boring under a street or a road;

(c)breaking up or opening a sewer, drain or tunnel.

PART 9U.K.Conferral of tidal water rights and their exercise

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

C5Sch. 3A Pt. 9 applied by 2010 asp 5, s. 36(1) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 56; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C6Sch. 3A Pt. 9 excluded by 1985 c. 48, s. 8A (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 22; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

IntroductoryU.K.

60U.K.This Part of this code makes provision about—

(a)the conferral of tidal water rights, and

(b)the exercise of tidal water rights.

Tidal water or landsU.K.

61U.K.In this Part of this code “tidal water or lands” includes—

(a)any estuary or branch of the sea,

(b)the shore below mean high water springs, and

(c)the bed of any tidal water.

Conferral of tidal water rightsU.K.

62(1)An operator may exercise a tidal water right for the statutory purposes.U.K.

(2)But that is subject to the following provisions of this Part of this code.

The tidal water rightsU.K.

63(1)For the purposes of this code a “tidal water right”, in relation to an operator, is—U.K.

(a)a right to install and keep electronic communications apparatus on, under or over tidal water or lands;

(b)a right to inspect, maintain, adjust, alter, repair, upgrade or operate electronic communications apparatus on, under or over the tidal water or lands;

(c)a right to carry out any works on, under or over any tidal water or lands for or in connection with the exercise of a right under paragraph (a) or (b);

(d)a right to enter any tidal water or lands to inspect, maintain, adjust, alter, repair, upgrade or operate electronic communications apparatus which is installed or kept by the exercise of the right under paragraph (a).

(2)The works that may be carried out under sub-paragraph (1)(c) include placing a buoy or seamark.

Exercise of tidal water right: Crown landU.K.

64(1)An operator may not exercise a tidal water right in relation to land in which a Crown interest subsists unless agreement to the exercise of the right in relation to the land has been given in respect of that interest by the appropriate authority in accordance with paragraph 104.U.K.

(2)Where, in connection with an agreement between the operator and the appropriate authority for the exercise of such a right, the operator and the appropriate authority cannot agree the consideration to be paid by the operator, the operator or the appropriate authority may apply to the appointed valuer for a determination of the market value of the right.

(3)An application under sub-paragraph (2) must be made in writing and must include—

(a)the proposed terms of the agreement, and

(b)the reasoned evidence of the operator and of the appropriate authority as to the market value of the right.

(4)As soon as reasonably practicable after receiving such an application, the appointed valuer must—

(a)determine the market value of the tidal water right; and

(b)notify the operator and the appropriate authority in writing of its determination and the reasons for it.

(5)If the agreement mentioned in sub-paragraph (2) or an agreement in substantially the same terms is concluded following a determination under sub-paragraph (4), the consideration payable by the operator must not be more than the market value notified under sub-paragraph (4)(b).

(6)For this purpose the market value of a tidal water right is, subject to sub-paragraph (7), the amount that, at the date the market value is assessed, a willing buyer would pay a willing seller for the right—

(a)in a transaction at arm's length,

(b)on the basis that the buyer and seller were acting prudently and with full knowledge of the transaction, and

(c)on the basis that the transaction was subject to the proposed terms set out in the application.

(7)The market value must be assessed on these assumptions—

(a)that the right that the transaction relates to does not relate to the provision or use of an electronic communications network;

(b)that the right in all other respects corresponds to the tidal water right;

(c)that there is more than one site which the buyer could use for the purpose for which the buyer seeks the right.

(8)The appointed valuer may charge a fee in respect of the consideration of an application under sub-paragraph (4) and may apportion the fee between the operator and the appropriate authority as the appointed valuer considers appropriate.

(9)In this paragraph “the appointed valuer” means—

(a)such person as the operator and the appropriate authority may agree;

(b)if no person is agreed, such person as may be nominated, on the application of the operator or the appropriate authority, by the President of the Royal Institution of Chartered Surveyors.

PART 10U.K.Undertaker's works affecting electronic communications apparatus

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

C7Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1984 c. 54, s. 50(3) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 14(2); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C8Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1958 c. 69, s. 45(2) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 5(2); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C9Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1986 c. 31, s. 62(1) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 25(2); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C10Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1962 c. 58, s. 40(2) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 7; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C11Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1964 c. 40, s. 53 (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 8; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C12Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1993 c. 42, Sch. 2 para. 16 (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 33; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C13Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1991 c. 56, Sch. 13 para. 4 (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 30(a)(b); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C14Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by S.I. 1996/275 (N.I. 2), Sch. 3 para. 3(2) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 39(3); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C15Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1991 c. 57, Sch. 22 para. 5 (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 31(a); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C16Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by S.I. 1992/231 N.I. 1), Sch. 4 para. 3(2) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 32; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C17Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1995 c. 45, Sch. 4 para. 2(7) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 37; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C18Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1980 c. 66, s. 177(12) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 11; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C19Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1989 c. 22, Sch. 4 para. 4 (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 27; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C20Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1984 c. 54, s. 75(9) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 15(2); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C21Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1989 c. 29, Sch. 16 para. 1(6) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 28; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C22Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1958 c. 24, s. 17 (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 6; S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C23Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by 1980 c. 66, s. 334(8) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 12(2); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C24Sch. 3A Pt. 10 applied by S.I. 1994/426 (N.I. 1), art. 12(1) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 35(2); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

IntroductoryU.K.

65U.K.This Part of this code makes provision about the carrying out of undertaker's works by undertakers or operators.

Key definitionsU.K.

66(1)In this Part of this code—U.K.

  • undertaker” means a person (including a local authority) of a description set out in any of the entries in the first column of the following table;

  • undertaker's works”, in relation to an undertaker of a description set out in a particular entry in the first column of the table, means works of the description set out in the corresponding entry in the second column of the table.

“undertaker” “undertaker's works”
A person authorised by any enactment (whether public general or local) or by any order or scheme made under or confirmed by any enactment to carry on any railway, tramway, road transport, water transport, canal, inland navigation, dock, harbour, pier or lighthouse undertakingWorks that the undertaker is authorised to carry out for the purposes of, or in connection with, the undertaking which it carries on
A person (apart from the operator) to whom this code is applied by a direction under section 106 of the Communications Act 2003Works that the undertaker is authorised to carry out by or in accordance with any provision of this code
Any person to whom this Part of this code is applied by any enactment (whenever passed or made)Works for the purposes of which this paragraph is applied to the undertaker

(2)In this Part of this code—

(a)a reference to undertaker's works which interfere with a network is a reference to any undertaker's works which involve, or are likely to involve, an alteration of any electronic communications apparatus kept on, under or over any land for the purposes of an operator's network;

(b)a reference to an alteration of any electronic communications apparatus is a reference to a temporary or permanent alteration of the apparatus.

When can an undertaker carry out non-emergency undertaker's works?U.K.

67(1)Before carrying out non-emergency undertaker's works which interfere with a network, an undertaker must give the operator notice of the intention to carry out the works (“notice of proposed works”).U.K.

(2)Notice of proposed works must specify—

(a)the nature of the proposed undertaker's works,

(b)the alteration of the electronic communications apparatus which the works involve or are likely to involve, and

(c)the time and place at which the works will begin.

(3)The undertaker must not begin the proposed undertaker's works (including the proposed alteration of electronic communications apparatus) until the notice period has ended.

(4)But the undertaker's power to alter electronic communications apparatus (in carrying out the proposed undertaker's works) is subject to paragraph 68.

(5)In this paragraph—

  • non-emergency undertaker's works” means any undertaker's works which are not emergency works under paragraph 71;

  • notice period” means the period of 10 days beginning with the day on which notice of proposed works is given.

What is the effect of the operator giving counter-notice to the undertaker?U.K.

68(1)This paragraph applies if an undertaker gives an operator notice of proposed works under paragraph 67.U.K.

(2)The operator may, within the notice period, give the undertaker notice (“counter-notice”) stating either—

(a)that the operator requires the undertaker to make any alteration of the electronic communications apparatus that is necessary or expedient because of the proposed undertaker's works—

(i)under the supervision of the operator, and

(ii)to the satisfaction of the operator; or

(b)that the operator intends to make any alteration of the electronic communications apparatus that is necessary or expedient because of the proposed undertaker's works.

(3)In a case where counter-notice contains a statement under sub-paragraph (2)(a), the undertaker must act in accordance with the counter-notice when altering electronic communications apparatus (in carrying out the proposed undertaker's works).

(4)But, if the operator unreasonably fails to provide the required supervision, the undertaker must act in accordance with the counter-notice only insofar as it requires alterations to be made to the satisfaction of the operator.

(5)In a case where counter-notice contains a statement under sub-paragraph (2)(b) (operator intends to make alteration), the undertaker must not alter electronic communications apparatus (in carrying out the proposed undertaker's works).

(6)But that does not prevent the undertaker from making any alteration of electronic communications apparatus which the operator fails to make within a reasonable time.

(7)Expressions defined in paragraph 67 have the same meanings in this paragraph.

What expenses must the undertaker pay?U.K.

69(1)This paragraph applies if an undertaker carries out any non-emergency undertaker's works in accordance with paragraph 67 (including in a case where counter-notice is given under paragraph 68).U.K.

(2)The undertaker must pay the operator the amount of any loss or damage sustained by the operator in consequence of any alteration being made to electronic communications apparatus (in carrying out the works).

(3)The undertaker must pay the operator any expenses incurred by the operator in, or in connection with, supervising the undertaker when altering electronic communications apparatus (in carrying out the works).

(4)Any amount which is not paid in accordance with this paragraph is to be recoverable by the operator from the undertaker in any court of competent jurisdiction.

When can the operator alter apparatus in connection with non-emergency undertaker's works?U.K.

70(1)An operator may make an alteration of electronic communications apparatus if—U.K.

(a)notice of proposed works has been given,

(b)the notice period has ended, and

(c)counter-notice has been given which states (in accordance with paragraph 68(2)(b)) that the operator intends to make the alteration.

(2)If the operator makes any alteration in accordance with this paragraph, the undertaker must pay the operator—

(a)any expenses incurred by the operator in, or in connection with, making the alteration; and

(b)the amount of any loss or damage sustained by the operator in consequence of the alteration being made.

(3)Any amount which is not paid in accordance with sub-paragraph (2) is to be recoverable by the operator from the undertaker in any court of competent jurisdiction.

(4)Expressions defined in paragraph 67 have the same meanings in this paragraph.

When can an undertaker carry out emergency undertaker's works?U.K.

71(1)An undertaker may, in carrying out emergency undertaker's works, make an alteration of any electronic communications apparatus kept on, under or over any land for the purposes of an operator's network.U.K.

(2)The undertaker must give the operator notice of the emergency undertaker's works as soon as practicable after beginning them.

(3)This paragraph does not authorise the undertaker to make an alteration of apparatus after any failure by the undertaker to give notice in accordance with sub-paragraph (2).

(4)The undertaker must make the alteration to the satisfaction of the operator.

(5)If the undertaker makes any alteration in accordance with this paragraph, the undertaker must pay the operator—

(a)any expenses incurred by the operator in, or in connection with, supervising the undertaker when making the alteration; and

(b)the amount of any loss or damage sustained by the operator in consequence of the alteration being made.

(6)Any amount which is not paid in accordance with sub-paragraph (5) is to be recoverable by the operator from the undertaker in any court of competent jurisdiction.

(7)In this paragraph “emergency undertaker's works” means undertaker's works carried out in order to stop anything already occurring, or to prevent anything imminent from occurring, which is likely to cause—

(a)danger to persons or property,

(b)interference with the exercise of any functions conferred or imposed on the undertaker by or under any enactment, or

(c)substantial loss to the undertaker,

and any other works which it is reasonable (in all the circumstances) to carry out with those works.

Offence: undertakers who do not comply with this Part of this codeU.K.

72(1)An undertaker, or an agent of an undertaker, is guilty of an offence if that person—U.K.

(a)makes an alteration of electronic communications apparatus in carrying out non-emergency undertaker's works, and

(b)does so—

(i)without notice of proposed works having been given in accordance with paragraph 67, or

(ii)(in a case where such notice is given) before the end of the notice period under paragraph 67.

(2)An undertaker, or an agent of an undertaker, is guilty of an offence if that person—

(a)makes an alteration of electronic communications apparatus in carrying out non-emergency undertaker's works, and

(b)unreasonably fails to comply with any reasonable requirement of the operator under this Part of this code when doing so.

(3)An undertaker, or an agent of an undertaker, is guilty of an offence if that person—

(a)makes an alteration of electronic communications apparatus in carrying out emergency undertaker's works, and

(b)does so without notice of emergency undertaker's works having been given in accordance with paragraph 71.

(4)A person guilty of an offence under this paragraph is liable on summary conviction to—

(a)a fine not exceeding level 4 on the standard scale, if the service provided by the operator's network is interrupted by the works or failure, or

(b)a fine not exceeding level 3 on the standard scale, if that service is not interrupted.

(5)This paragraph does not apply to a Northern Ireland department.

PART 11U.K.Overhead apparatus

IntroductoryU.K.

73U.K.This Part of this code—

(a)confers a power on operators to install and keep certain overhead apparatus, and

(b)imposes a duty on operators to affix notices to certain overhead apparatus.

Power to fly linesU.K.

74(1)This paragraph applies where any electronic communications apparatus is kept on or over any land for the purposes of an operator's network.U.K.

(2)The operator has the right, for the statutory purposes, to install and keep lines which—

(a)pass over other land adjacent to, or in the vicinity of, the land on or over which the apparatus is kept,

(b)are connected to that apparatus, and

(c)are not, at any point where they pass over the other land, less than three metres above the ground or within two metres of any building over which they pass.

(3)Sub-paragraph (2) does not authorise the installation or keeping on or over any land of—

(a)any electronic communications apparatus used to support, carry or suspend a line installed under sub-paragraph (2), or

(b)any line which, as a result of its position, interferes with the carrying on of any business carried on on that land.

(4)In this paragraph “business” includes a trade, profession or employment and includes any activity carried on by a body of persons (whether corporate or unincorporate).

Duty to attach notices to overhead apparatusU.K.

75(1)This paragraph applies where—U.K.

(a)an operator has, for the purposes of the operator's network, installed any electronic communications apparatus, and

(b)the whole or part of the apparatus is at a height of three metres or more above the ground.

(2)The operator must, before the end of the period of three days beginning with the day after that on which the installation is completed, in a secure and durable manner attach a notice—

(a)to every major item of apparatus installed, or

(b)if no major item of apparatus is installed, to the nearest major item of electronic communications apparatus to which the apparatus that is installed is directly or indirectly connected.

(3)A notice attached under sub-paragraph (2)—

(a)must be attached in a position where it is reasonably legible, and

(b)must give the name of the operator and an address in the United Kingdom at which any notice of objection may be given under paragraph 77(5) in respect of the apparatus in question.

(4)Any person giving such a notice at that address in respect of that apparatus is to be treated as having given that address for the purposes of paragraph 91(2).

(5)An operator who breaches the requirements of this paragraph is guilty of an offence and liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding level 2 on the standard scale.

(6)In any proceedings for an offence under this paragraph it is a defence for the person charged to prove that the person took all reasonable steps and exercised all due diligence to avoid committing the offence.

PART 12U.K.Rights to object to certain apparatus

IntroductoryU.K.

76U.K.This Part of this code makes provision conferring rights to object to certain kinds of apparatus, and makes provision about—

(a)the cases in which and persons by whom a right can be exercised, and

(b)the power and procedures of the court if an objection is made.

When and by whom can a right to object be exercised?U.K.

77(1)A right to object under this Part of this code is available where, pursuant to the right in paragraph 62, an operator keeps electronic communications apparatus installed on, under or over tidal water or lands within the meaning of Part 9 of this code.U.K.

(2)In that case a person has a right to object under this Part of this code if the person—

(a)is an occupier of, or has an interest in, the tidal water or lands,

(b)is not bound by a code right enabling the operator to keep the apparatus installed on, under or over the tidal water or lands, and

(c)is not a person with the benefit of a Crown interest in the tidal water or lands.

(3)A right to object under this Part of this code is available where an operator keeps a line installed over land pursuant to the right in paragraph 74.

(4)In that case a person has a right to object under this Part of this code if the person—

(a)is an occupier of, or has an interest in, the land, and

(b)is not bound by a code right enabling the operator to keep the apparatus installed over the land.

(5)A right to object under this Part of this code is available where—

(a)electronic communications apparatus is kept on or over land for the purposes of an operator's network, and

(b)the whole or any part of that apparatus is at a height of three metres or more above the ground.

(6)In that case a person has a right to object under this Part of this code if—

(a)the person is an occupier of, or has an interest in, any neighbouring land, and

(b)because of the nearness of the neighbouring land to the land on or over which the apparatus is kept—

(i)the enjoyment of the neighbouring land is capable of being prejudiced by the apparatus, or

(ii)any interest in that land is capable of being prejudiced by the apparatus.

(7)There is no right to object under this Part of this code in respect of electronic communications apparatus if the apparatus—

(a)replaces any electronic communications apparatus which is not substantially different from the new apparatus, and

(b)is not in a significantly different position.

How may a right to object be exercised?U.K.

78(1)A person with a right to object under this Part (“the objector”) may exercise the right by giving a notice to the operator.U.K.

(2)The right to object that the person has, and the procedure that applies to that right, depends on whether—

(a)the notice is given before the end of the period of 12 months beginning with the date on which installation of the apparatus was completed (see paragraph 79), or

(b)the notice is given after the end of that period (see paragraph 80).

What is the procedure if the objection is made within 12 months of installation?U.K.

79(1)This paragraph applies if the notice is given before the end of the period of 12 months beginning with the date on which installation of the apparatus was completed.U.K.

(2)At any time after the end of the period of two months beginning with the date on which the notice is given, but before the end of the period of four months beginning with that date, the objector may apply to the court to have the objection upheld.

(3)The court must uphold the objection if the following conditions are met.

(4)The first condition is that the apparatus appears materially to prejudice the objector's enjoyment of, or interest in, the land by reference to which the objection is made.

(5)The second condition is that the court is not satisfied that the only possible alterations of the apparatus will—

(a)substantially increase the cost or diminish the quality of the service provided by the operator's network to persons who have, or may in future have, access to it,

(b)involve the operator in substantial additional expenditure (disregarding any expenditure caused solely by the fact that any proposed alteration was not adopted originally or, as the case may be, that the apparatus has been unnecessarily installed), or

(c)give to any person a case at least as good as the objector has to have an objection under this paragraph upheld.

(6)If the court upholds an objection under this paragraph it may by order do any of the following—

(a)direct the alteration of the apparatus to which the objection relates;

(b)authorise the installation (instead of the apparatus to which the objection relates), in a manner and position specified in the order, of any apparatus specified in the order;

(c)direct that no objection may be made under this paragraph in respect of any apparatus the installation of which is authorised by the court.

(7)Where an objector has both given a notice under paragraph 78 and applied for compensation under any of the other provisions of this code—

(a)the court may give such directions as it thinks fit for ensuring that no compensation is paid until any proceedings under this paragraph have been disposed of, and

(b)if the court makes an order under this paragraph, it may provide in that order for some or all of the compensation otherwise payable under this code to the objector not to be so payable, or, if the case so requires, for some or all of any compensation paid under this code to the objector to be repaid to the operator.

(8)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (5)(c), the court has the power on an application under this paragraph to give the objector directions for bringing the application to the notice of such other interested persons as it thinks fit.

(9)This paragraph is subject to paragraph 81.

What is the procedure if the objection is made later than 12 months after installation?U.K.

80(1)This paragraph applies if the notice is given after the end of the period of 12 months beginning with the date on which installation of the apparatus was completed.U.K.

(2)At any time after the end of the period of two months beginning with the date on which the notice is given, but before the end of the period of four months beginning with that date, the objector may apply to the court to have the objection upheld.

(3)The court may uphold the objection only if it is satisfied that—

(a)the alteration is necessary to enable the objector to carry out a proposed improvement of the land by reference to which the objection is made, and

(b)the alteration will not substantially interfere with any service which is or is likely to be provided using the operator's network.

(4)If the court upholds an objection under this paragraph it may by order direct the alteration of the apparatus to which the objection relates.

(5)An order under this paragraph may provide for the alteration to be carried out with such modifications, on such terms and subject to such conditions as the court thinks fit.

(6)But the court must not include any such modifications, terms or conditions in its order without the consent of the objector, and if such consent is not given may refuse to make an order under this paragraph.

(7)An order made under this paragraph must, unless the court otherwise thinks fit, require the objector to reimburse the operator in respect of any expenses which the operator incurs in or in connection with the execution of any works in compliance with the order.

(8)This paragraph is subject to paragraph 81.

(9)In this paragraph “improvement” includes development and change of use.

What limitations are there on the court's powers under paragraph 79 or 80?U.K.

81(1)This paragraph applies where the court is considering making—U.K.

(a)an order under paragraph 79 directing the alteration of any apparatus or authorising the installation of any apparatus, or

(b)an order under paragraph 80 directing the alteration of any apparatus.

(2)The court must not make the order unless it is satisfied—

(a)that the operator has all such rights as it appears to the court appropriate that the operator should have for the purpose of making the alteration or, as the case may be, installing the apparatus, or

(b)that—

(i)the operator would have all those rights if the court, on an application under paragraph 20, imposed an agreement on the operator and another person, and

(ii)it would be appropriate for the court, on such an application, to impose such an agreement.

(3)For the purposes of avoiding the need for the agreement of any person to the alteration or installation of any apparatus, the court has the same powers as it would have if an application had been duly made under paragraph 20 for an order imposing such an agreement.

(4)For the purposes of this paragraph, the court has the power on an application under paragraph 79 or 80 to give the objector directions for bringing the application to the notice of such other interested persons as it thinks fit.

PART 13U.K.Rights to lop trees

Rights to lop treesU.K.

82(1)This paragraph applies where—U.K.

(a)a tree or other vegetation overhangs a street in England and Wales or Northern Ireland or a road in Scotland, and

(b)the tree or vegetation—

(i)obstructs, or will or may obstruct, relevant electronic communications apparatus, or

(ii)interferes with, or will or may interfere with, such apparatus.

(2)In sub-paragraph (1) “relevant electronic communications apparatus” means electronic communications apparatus which—

(a)is installed, or about to be installed, on land, and

(b)is used, or to be used, for the purposes of an operator's network.

(3)The operator may, by notice to the occupier of the land on which the tree or vegetation is growing, require the tree to be lopped or the vegetation to be cut back to prevent the obstruction or interference.

(4)If, within the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which the notice is given, the occupier gives the operator a counter-notice objecting to the lopping of the tree or cutting back of the vegetation, the notice has effect only if confirmed by an order of the court.

(5)Sub-paragraph (6) applies if at any time a notice under sub-paragraph (3) has not been complied with and—

(a)the period of 28 days beginning with the day on which the notice was given has expired without a counter-notice having been given, or

(b)an order of the court confirming the notice has come into force.

(6)The operator may cause the tree to be lopped or the vegetation to be cut back.

(7)Where the operator lops a tree or cuts back vegetation in exercise of the power in sub-paragraph (6) the operator must do so in a husband-like manner and in such a way as to cause the minimum damage to the tree or vegetation.

(8)Sub-paragraph (9) applies where—

(a)a notice under sub-paragraph (3) is complied with (either without a counter-notice having been given or after the notice has been confirmed), or

(b)the operator exercises the power in sub-paragraph (6).

(9)The court must, on an application made by a person who has sustained loss or damage in consequence of the lopping of the tree or cutting back of the vegetation or who has incurred expenses in complying with the notice, order the operator to pay that person such compensation in respect of the loss or damage as it thinks fit.

PART 14U.K.Compensation under the code

IntroductoryU.K.

83U.K.This Part of this code makes provision about compensation under this code.

Compensation where agreement imposed or apparatus removedU.K.

84(1)This paragraph applies to the following powers of the court to order an operator to pay compensation to a person—U.K.

(a)the power in paragraph 25(1) (compensation where order made imposing agreement on person);

[F18(aa)the power in paragraph 27H(2) (compensation where Part 4A order made);]

(b)the power in paragraph 44(5) (compensation in relation to removal of the apparatus from the land).

(2)Depending on the circumstances, the power of the court to order the payment of compensation for loss or damage includes power to order payment for—

(a)expenses (including reasonable legal and valuation expenses, subject to the provisions of any enactment about the powers of the court by whom the order for compensation is made to award costs or, in Scotland, expenses),

(b)diminution in the value of the land, and

(c)costs of reinstatement.

(3)For the purposes of assessing such compensation for diminution in the value of land, the following provisions apply with any necessary modifications as they apply for the purposes of assessing compensation for the compulsory purchase of any interest in land—

(a)in relation to England and Wales, rules (2) to (4) set out in section 5 of the Land Compensation Act 1961;

(b)in relation to Scotland, rules (2) to (4) set out in section 12 of the Land Compensation (Scotland) Act 1963;

(c)in relation to Northern Ireland, rules (2) to (4) set out in Article 6(1) of the Land Compensation (Northern Ireland) Order 1982 (SI 1982/712 (NI 9)).

(4)In the application of this paragraph to England and Wales, section 10(1) to (3) of the Land Compensation Act 1973 (compensation in respect of mortgages, trusts of land and settled land) applies in relation to such compensation for diminution in the value of land as it applies in relation to compensation under Part 1 of that Act.

(5)In the application of this paragraph to Scotland, section 10(1) and (2) of the Land Compensation (Scotland) Act 1973 (compensation in respect of restricted interests in land) applies in relation to such compensation for diminution in the value of land as it applies in relation to compensation under Part 1 of that Act.

(6)In the application of this paragraph to Northern Ireland, Article 13(1) to (3) of the Land Acquisition and Compensation (Northern Ireland) Order 1973 (SI 1973/1896 (NI 21)) (compensation in respect of mortgages, trusts for sale and settlements) applies in relation to such compensation for diminution in the value of land as it applies in relation to compensation under Part II of that Order.

(7)Where a person has a claim for compensation to which this paragraph applies and a claim for compensation under any other provision of this code in respect of the same loss, the compensation payable to that person must not exceed the amount of that person's loss.

Compensation for injurious affection to neighbouring land etcU.K.

85(1)This paragraph applies where a right conferred by or in accordance with any provision of Parts 2 to 9 of this code is exercised by an operator.U.K.

(2)In the application of this paragraph to England and Wales, compensation is payable by the operator under section 10 of the Compulsory Purchase Act 1965 (compensation for injurious affection to neighbouring land) as if that section applied in relation to injury caused by the exercise of such a right as it applies in relation to injury caused by the execution of works on land that has been compulsorily acquired.

(3)In the application of this paragraph to Scotland, compensation is payable by the operator under section 6 of the Railway Clauses Consolidation (Scotland) Act 1845 as if that section applied in relation to injury caused by the exercise of such a right as it applies in relation to injury caused by the execution of works on land that has been taken or used for the purpose of a railway.

(4)Any question as to a person's entitlement to compensation by virtue of sub-paragraph (3), or as to the amount of that compensation, is, in default of agreement, to be determined by the Lands Tribunal for Scotland.

(5)In the application of this paragraph to Northern Ireland, compensation is payable by the operator under Article 18 of the Land Compensation (Northern Ireland) Order 1982 (SI 1982/712 (NI 9)) as if that section applied in relation to injury caused by the exercise of such a right as it applies in relation to injury caused by the execution of works on land that has been compulsorily acquired.

(6)Any question as to a person's entitlement to compensation by virtue of sub-paragraph (5), or as to the amount of that compensation, is, in default of agreement, to be determined by the Lands Tribunal for Northern Ireland.

(7)Compensation is payable on a claim for compensation under this paragraph only if the amount of the compensation exceeds £50.

(8)Compensation is payable to a person under this paragraph irrespective of whether the person claiming the compensation has any interest in the land in relation to which the right referred to in sub-paragraph (1) is exercised.

(9)Compensation under this paragraph may include reasonable legal and valuation expenses, subject to the provisions of any enactment about the powers of the court or tribunal by whom an order for compensation is made to award costs or, in Scotland, expenses.

No other compensation availableU.K.

86U.K.Except as provided by any provision of Parts 2 to 13 of this code or this Part, an operator is not liable to compensate any person for, and is not subject to any other liability in respect of, any loss or damage caused by the lawful exercise of any right conferred by or in accordance with any provision of those Parts.

PART 15U.K.Notices under the code

IntroductoryU.K.

87U.K.This Part makes provision—

(a)about requirements for the form of notices given under this code by operators,

(b)about requirements for the form of notices given under this code by persons other than operators, and

(c)about procedures for giving notices.

Notices given by operatorsU.K.

88(1)A notice given under this code by an operator must—U.K.

(a)explain the effect of the notice,

(b)explain which provisions of this code are relevant to the notice, and

(c)explain the steps that may be taken by the recipient in respect of the notice.

(2)If OFCOM have prescribed the form of a notice which may or must be given by an operator under a provision of this code, a notice given by an operator under that provision must be in that form.

(3)A notice which does not comply with this paragraph is not a valid notice for the purposes of this code.

(4)Sub-paragraph (3) does not prevent the person to whom the notice is given from relying on the notice if the person chooses to do so.

(5)In any proceedings under this code a certificate issued by OFCOM stating that a particular form of notice has been prescribed by them as mentioned in this paragraph is conclusive evidence of that fact.

Notices given by othersU.K.

89(1)Sub-paragraph (2) applies to a notice given under paragraph 31(1), 33(1), 39(1) or 40(2) by a person other than an operator.U.K.

(2)If OFCOM have prescribed the form of a notice given under the provision in question by a person other than an operator, the notice must be in that form.

(3)A notice which does not comply with sub-paragraph (2) is not a valid notice for the purposes of this code.

(4)Sub-paragraph (3) does not prevent the operator to whom the notice is given from relying on the notice if the operator chooses to do so.

(5)Sub-paragraph (6) applies to a notice given under any other provision of this code by a person other than an operator if—

(a)OFCOM have prescribed the form of a notice given under that provision by a person other than an operator,

(b)the notice is given in response to a notice given by an operator, and

(c)the operator has, in giving the notice, drawn the person's attention to the form prescribed by OFCOM.

(6)The notice is a valid notice for the purposes of this code, but the person giving the notice must bear any costs incurred by the operator as a result of the notice not being in that form.

(7)In any proceedings under this code a certificate issued by OFCOM stating that a particular form of notice has been prescribed by them as mentioned in this paragraph is conclusive evidence of that fact.

Prescription of notices by OFCOMU.K.

90(1)OFCOM must prescribe the form of a notice to be given under each provision of this code that requires a notice to be given.U.K.

(2)OFCOM may from time to time amend or replace a form prescribed under sub-paragraph (1).

(3)Before prescribing a form for the purposes of this code, OFCOM must consult operators and such other persons as OFCOM think appropriate.

(4)Sub-paragraph (3) does not apply to the amendment or replacement of a form prescribed under sub-paragraph (1).

Procedures for giving noticeU.K.

91(1)A notice given under this code must not be sent by post unless it is sent by a registered post service or by recorded delivery.U.K.

(2)For the purposes, in the case of a notice under this code, of section 394 of this Act (service of notifications and other documents) and section 7 of the Interpretation Act 1978 (references to service by post), the proper address of a person (“P”) is—

(a)if P has given the person giving the notice an address for service under this code, that address, and

(b)otherwise, the address given by section 394.

(3)Sub-paragraph (4) applies if it is not practicable, for the purposes of giving a notice under this code, to find out after reasonable enquiries the name and address of a person who is the occupier of land for the purposes of this code.

(4)A notice may be given under this code to the occupier —

(a)by addressing it to a person by the description of “occupier” of the land (and describing the land), and

(b)by delivering it to a person who is on the land or, if there is no person on the land to whom it can be delivered, by affixing it, or a copy of it, to a conspicuous object on the land.

(5)Sub-paragraph (6) applies if it is not practicable, for the purposes of giving a notice under this code, to find out after reasonable enquiries the name and address of the owner of an interest in land.

(6)A notice may be given under this code to the owner—

(a)by addressing it to a person by the description of “owner” of the interest (and describing the interest and the land), and

(b)by delivering it to a person who is on the land or, if there is no person on the land to whom it can be delivered, by affixing it, or a copy of it, to a conspicuous object on the land.

PART 16U.K.Enforcement and dispute resolution

IntroductoryU.K.

92U.K.This Part of this code makes provision about—

(a)the court or tribunal by which agreements and rights under this code may be enforced,

(b)the meaning of references to “the court” in this code, and

(c)the power of the Secretary of State by regulations to confer jurisdiction under this code on other tribunals.

Enforcement of agreements and rightsU.K.

93U.K.An agreement under this code, and any right conferred by this code, may be enforced—

(a)in the case of an agreement imposed by a court or tribunal, by the court or tribunal which imposed the agreement,

(b)in the case of any agreement or right, by any court or tribunal which for the time being has the power to impose an agreement under this code, or

(c)in the case of any agreement or right, by any court of competent jurisdiction.

Meaning of “the court”U.K.

94(1)In this code “the court” means—U.K.

(a)in relation to England and Wales, the county court,

(b)in relation to Scotland, the sheriff court, and

(c)in relation to Northern Ireland, a county court.

(2)Sub-paragraph (1) is subject to provision made by regulations under paragraph 95.

Power to confer jurisdiction on other tribunalsU.K.

95(1)The Secretary of State may by regulations provide for a function conferred by this code on the court to be exercisable by any of the following—U.K.

(a)in relation to England, the First-tier Tribunal;

[F19(aa)in relation to Wales, the First-tier Tribunal, but only in connection with proceedings under Part 4A;]

(b)in relation to England and Wales, the Upper Tribunal;

(c)in relation to Scotland, the Lands Tribunal for Scotland;

(d)in relation to Northern Ireland, the Lands Tribunal for Northern Ireland.

(2)Regulations under sub-paragraph (1) may make provision for the function to be exercisable by a tribunal to which the regulations apply—

(a)instead of by the court, or

(b)as well as by the court.

(3)The Secretary of State may by regulations make provision—

(a)requiring proceedings to which regulations under sub-paragraph (1) apply to be commenced in the court or in a tribunal to which the regulations apply;

(b)enabling the court or such a tribunal to transfer such proceedings to a tribunal which has jurisdiction in relation to them by virtue of such regulations or to the court.

(4)The power in section 402(3)(c) for regulations under sub-paragraph (1) or (3) to make consequential provision includes power to make provision which amends, repeals or revokes or otherwise modifies the application of any enactment.

(5)Before making regulations under sub-paragraph (1) or (3) the Secretary of State must—

(a)so far as the regulations relate to Scotland, consult the Scottish Ministers;

(b)so far as the regulations relate to Northern Ireland, consult the Department of Justice in Northern Ireland.

Award of costs by tribunalU.K.

96(1)Where in any proceedings a tribunal exercises functions by virtue of regulations under paragraph 95(1), it may make such order as it thinks fit as to costs, or, in Scotland, expenses.U.K.

(2)The matters a tribunal must have regard to in making such an order include in particular the extent to which any party is successful in the proceedings.

Applications to the courtU.K.

97U.K.Regulation 3 of the Electronic Communications and Wireless Telegraphy Regulations 2011 (SI 2011/1210) makes provision about the time within which certain applications to the court under this code must be determined.

Appeals in Northern IrelandU.K.

98U.K.Article 60 of the County Courts (Northern Ireland) Order 1980 (ordinary appeals from the county court in civil cases) is to apply in relation to any determination of the court in Northern Ireland under this code in the same manner as it applies in relation to any decree of the court made in the exercise of the jurisdiction conferred by Part 3 of that Order.

PART 17U.K.Supplementary provisions

Relationship between this code and existing lawU.K.

99(1)This code does not authorise the contravention of any provision of an enactment passed or made before the coming into force of this code.U.K.

(2)Sub-paragraph (1) does not apply if and to the extent that an enactment makes provision to the contrary.

Relationship between this code and agreements with operatorsU.K.

100(1)This code does not affect any rights or liabilities arising under an agreement to which an operator is a party.U.K.

(2)Sub-paragraph (1) does not apply in relation to paragraph 99 or Parts 3 to 6 of this code.

Ownership of propertyU.K.

101U.K.The ownership of property does not change merely because the property is installed on or under, or affixed to, any land by any person in exercise of a right conferred by or in accordance with this code.

ConduitsU.K.

102(1)This code does not authorise an operator to do anything inside a relevant conduit without the agreement of the authority with control of the conduit.U.K.

(2)The agreement of the authority with control of a public sewer is sufficient in all cases to authorise an operator to exercise any of the rights under this code in order to do anything wholly inside that sewer.

(3)In this paragraph the following expressions have the same meanings as in section 98 of the Telecommunications Act 1984—

(a)“public sewer” and “relevant conduit”;

(b)references to the authority with control of a relevant conduit.

Duties for OFCOM to prepare codes of practiceU.K.

103(1)OFCOM must prepare and publish a code of practice dealing with—U.K.

(a)the provision of information for the purposes of this code by operators to persons who occupy or have an interest in land;

(b)the conduct of negotiations for the purposes of this code between operators and such persons;

(c)the conduct of operators in relation to persons who occupy or have an interest in land adjoining land on, under or over which electronic communications apparatus is installed;

(d)such other matters relating to the operation of this code as OFCOM think appropriate.

(2)OFCOM must prepare and publish standard terms which may (but need not) be used in agreements under this code.

(3)OFCOM may from time to time—

(a)amend or replace a code of practice or standard terms published under this paragraph;

(b)publish the code or terms as amended or (as the case may be) the replacement code or terms.

(4)Before publishing a code of practice or standard terms under this paragraph, OFCOM must consult operators and such other persons as OFCOM think appropriate.

(5)Sub-paragraph (4) does not apply to—

(a)the publication of amendments to a code of practice or standard terms, or

(b)the publication of a replacement code or replacement terms.

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

C27Sch. 3A para. 103(2) applied by S.I. 1993/3160 (N.I. 15), Sch. 9 para. 2(2) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 34(2); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C28Sch. 3A para. 103(2) applied by 2003 asp 2, Sch. 1 para. 12 (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 49(2); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C29Sch. 3A para. 103(2) applied by 1997 c. 8, s. 212(7) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 41(2); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C30Sch. 3A para. 103(2) applied by 1984 c. 54, s. 132(4) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 16(3); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

C31Sch. 3A para. 103(2) applied by 1990 c. 8, s. 256(5) (as amended (28.12.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), s. 118(6), Sch. 3 para. 29(2); S.I. 2017/1286, reg. 2(d))

Application of this code to the CrownU.K.

104(1)This code applies in relation to land in which there subsists, or at any material time subsisted, a Crown interest as it applies in relation to land in which no such interest subsists.U.K.

(2)In this code “Crown interest” means—

(a)an interest which belongs to Her Majesty in right of the Crown,

(b)an interest which belongs to Her Majesty in right of the Duchy of Lancaster,

(c)an interest which belongs to the Duchy of Cornwall,

(d)an interest which belongs to a government department or which is held in trust for Her Majesty for the purposes of a government department, or

(e)an interest which belongs to an office-holder in the Scottish Administration or which is held in trust for Her Majesty for the purposes of the Scottish Administration by such an office-holder.

(3)This includes, in particular—

(a)an interest which belongs to Her Majesty in right of Her Majesty's Government in Northern Ireland, and

(b)an interest which belongs to a Northern Ireland department or which is held in trust for Her Majesty for the purposes of a Northern Ireland department.

(4)Where an agreement is required by this code to be given in respect of any Crown interest subsisting in any land, the agreement must be given by the appropriate authority.

(5)Where a notice under this code is required to be given in relation to land in which a Crown interest subsists, the notice must be given by or to the appropriate authority (as the case may require).

(6)In this paragraph “the appropriate authority” means—

(a)in the case of land belonging to Her Majesty in right of the Crown, the Crown Estate Commissioners or the relevant person or, as the case may be, the government department or office-holder in the Scottish Administration having the management of the land in question;

(b)in the case of land belonging to Her Majesty in right of the Duchy of Lancaster, the Chancellor of the Duchy of Lancaster;

(c)in the case of land belonging to the Duchy of Cornwall, such person as the Duke of Cornwall, or the possessor for the time being of the Duchy of Cornwall, appoints;

(d)in the case of land belonging to an office-holder in the Scottish Administration or held in trust for Her Majesty by such an office-holder for the purposes of the Scottish Administration, the office-holder;

(e)in the case of land belonging to Her Majesty in right of Her Majesty's Government in Northern Ireland, the Northern Ireland department having the management of the land in question;

(f)in the case of land belonging to a government department or a Northern Ireland department or held in trust for Her Majesty for the purposes of a government department or a Northern Ireland department, that department.

(7)In sub-paragraph (6)(a) “relevant person”, in relation to land to which section 90B(5) of the Scotland Act 1998 applies, means the person having the management of that land.

(8)Any question as to the authority that is the appropriate authority in relation to any land is to be referred to the Treasury, whose decision is final.

(9)Paragraphs 55 (offence in relation to transport land rights) and 75(5) (offence in relation to notices on overhead apparatus) do not apply where this code applies in the case of the Secretary of State or a Northern Ireland department by virtue of section 106(3)(b).

(10)References in this paragraph to an office-holder in the Scottish Administration are to be construed in accordance with section 126(7) of the Scotland Act 1998.

Meaning of “occupier”U.K.

105(1)References in this code to an occupier of land are to the occupier of the land for the time being.U.K.

(2)References in this code to an occupier of land, in relation to a footpath or bridleway that crosses and forms part of agricultural land, are to the occupier of that agricultural land.

(3)Sub-paragraph (4) applies in relation to land which is—

(a)a street in England and Wales or Northern Ireland, other than a footpath or bridleway within sub-paragraph (2), or

(b)a road in Scotland, other than such a footpath or bridleway.

(4)References in this code to an occupier of land—

(a)in relation to such a street in England and Wales, are to the street managers within the meaning of Part 3 of the New Roads and Street Works Act 1991,

(b)in relation to such a street in Northern Ireland, are to the street managers within the meaning of the Street Works (Northern Ireland) Order 1995 (SI 1995/3210 (NI 19)), and

(c)in relation to such a road in Scotland, are to the road managers within the meaning of Part 4 of the New Roads and Street Works Act 1991.

(5)Sub-paragraph (6) applies in relation to land which—

(a)is unoccupied, and

(b)is not a street in England and Wales or Northern Ireland or a road in Scotland.

(6)References in this code to an occupier of land, in relation to land within sub-paragraph (5), are to—

(a)the person (if any) who for the time being exercises powers of management or control over the land, or

(b)if there is no person within paragraph (a), to every person whose interest in the land would be prejudicially affected by the exercise of a code right in relation to the land.

(7)In this paragraph—

(a)agricultural land” includes land which is being brought into use for agriculture, and

(b)references in relation to England and Wales to a footpath or bridleway include a restricted byway.

Lands Tribunal for Scotland procedure rulesU.K.

106U.K.The power to make rules under section 3(6) of the Lands Tribunal Act 1949 (Lands Tribunal for Scotland procedure rules) for the purposes of this code or regulations made under it is exercisable by the Scottish Ministers instead of by the Secretary of State (and any reference there to the approval of the Treasury does not apply).

Arbitrations in ScotlandU.K.

107U.K.Until the Arbitration (Scotland) Act 2010 is in force in relation to any arbitrations carried out under or by virtue of this code, that Act applies as if it were in force in relation to those arbitrations.

General interpretationU.K.

108(1)In this code—U.K.

  • “agriculture” and “agricultural”—

    (a)

    in relation to England and Wales, have the same meanings as in the Highways Act 1980,

    (b)

    in relation to Scotland, have the same meanings as in the Town and Country Planning (Scotland) Act 1997, and

    (c)

    in relation to Northern Ireland, have the same meanings as in the Agriculture Act (Northern Ireland) 1949;

  • “bridleway” and “footpath”—

    (a)

    in relation to England and Wales, have the same meanings as in the Highways Act 1980,

    (b)

    in relation to Scotland, have the same meanings as Part 3 of the Countryside (Scotland) Act 1967, and

    (c)

    in relation to Northern Ireland, mean a way over which the public have, by virtue of the Access to the Countryside (Northern Ireland) Order 1983 (SI 1983/1895 (NI 18)), a right of way (respectively) on horseback and on foot;

  • code agreement” has the meaning given by paragraph 29(5);

  • Crown interest” has the meaning given by paragraph 104(2) and (3);

  • enactment” includes—

    (a)

    an enactment comprised in subordinate legislation within the meaning of the Interpretation Act 1978,

    (b)

    an enactment comprised in, or in an instrument made under, a Measure or Act of the National Assembly for Wales,

    (c)

    an enactment comprised in, or in an instrument made under, an Act of the Scottish Parliament, and

    (d)

    an enactment comprised in, or in an instrument made under, Northern Ireland legislation;

  • land” does not include electronic communications apparatus;

  • landowner” has the meaning given by paragraph 37(1);

  • [F20lease” includes—

    (a)

    in relation to England and Wales and Northern Ireland, any leasehold tenancy (whether in the nature of a head lease, sub-lease or underlease) and any agreement to grant such a tenancy but not a mortgage by demise or sub-demise, and

    (b)

    in relation to Scotland, any sub-lease and any agreement to grant a sub-lease,

    and “lessee” is to be construed accordingly;]

  • [F20“lease”—

    (a)

    in relation to England and Wales and Northern Ireland, includes—

    (i)

    any head lease, sub-lease or underlease,

    (ii)

    any tenancy (including a sub-tenancy), and

    (iii)

    any agreement to grant any such lease or tenancy,

    but does not include a mortgage by demise or sub-demise;

    (b)

    in relation to Scotland, includes any sub-lease and any agreement to grant a sub-lease,

    and “leased premises” and “lessee” are to be read accordingly;]

  • [F21Part 4A code right” has the meaning given by paragraph 27E(3);]

  • relevant person” has the meaning given by paragraph 20(1);

  • restricted byway” has the same meaning as in Part 2 of the Countryside and Rights of Way Act 2000;

  • “road”—

    (a)

    in relation to Scotland, has the same meaning as in Part 4 of the New Roads and Street Works Act 1991;

    (b)

    in relation to Northern Ireland, has the same meaning as in the Roads (Northern Ireland) Order 1993 (SI 1993/3160 (NI 15));

  • site provider” has the meaning given by paragraph 30(1);

  • “street”—

    (a)

    in relation to England and Wales, has the same meaning as in Part 3 of the New Roads and Street Works Act 1991, and

    (b)

    in relation to Northern Ireland, has the same meaning as in the Street Works (Northern Ireland) Order 1995 (SI 1995/3210 (NI 19)).

(2)In this code, references to the alteration of any apparatus include references to the moving, removal or replacement of the apparatus.]

Textual Amendments

F20Words in Sch. 3A para. 108(1) substituted (15.3.2021 for specified purposes, 26.12.2022 for E.W. in so far as not already in force) by Telecommunications Infrastructure (Leasehold Property) Act 2021 (c. 7), s. 3(3)(b)(4), Sch. para. 4(12)(a); S.I. 2022/1308, reg. 3(c)

F21Words in Sch. 3A para. 108(1) inserted (15.3.2021 for specified purposes, 26.12.2022 for E.W. in so far as not already in force) by Telecommunications Infrastructure (Leasehold Property) Act 2021 (c. 7), s. 3(3)(b)(4), Sch. para. 4(12)(b); S.I. 2022/1308, reg. 3(c)

Section 118

SCHEDULE 4U.K.Compulsory purchase and entry for exploratory purposes

InterpretationU.K.

1U.K.In this Schedule—

  • code operator” means a provider of an electronic communications network in whose case the electronic communications code is applied by a direction under section 106; and

  • the operator’s network”, in relation to a code operator, means so much of the electronic communications network provided by the operator as is not excluded from the application of the electronic communications code under section 106(5).

Commencement Information

I20Sch. 4 para. 1 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I21Sch. 4 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

General duties with respect to powers under ScheduleU.K.

2U.K.In exercising his powers under this Schedule it shall be the duty of the Secretary of State to have regard, in particular, to each of the following—

(a)the duties imposed on OFCOM by sections 3 and 4;

(b)the need to protect the environment and, in particular, to conserve the natural beauty and amenity of the countryside;

(c)the need to ensure that highways are not damaged or obstructed, and traffic not interfered with, to any greater extent than is reasonably necessary;

(d)the need to encourage the sharing of the use of electronic communications apparatus.

Commencement Information

I22Sch. 4 para. 2 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I23Sch. 4 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Compulsory purchase of land: England and WalesU.K.

3(1)Subject to sub-paragraph (2), the Secretary of State may authorise a code operator to purchase compulsorily any land in England and Wales which is required by the operator—U.K.

(a)for, or in connection with, the establishment or running of the operator’s network; or

(b)as to which it can reasonably be foreseen that it will be so required.

(2)No order is to be made authorising a compulsory purchase under this paragraph by a code operator except with OFCOM’s consent.

(3)This power to purchase land compulsorily includes power to acquire an easement or other right over land by the creation of a new right.

(4)The Acquisition of Land Act 1981 (c. 67) is to apply to any compulsory purchase under this paragraph as if the code operator were a local authority within the meaning of that Act.

(5)The provisions of the Town and Country Planning Act 1990 (c. 8) specified in sub-paragraph (6) have effect in relation to land acquired compulsorily by a code operator under this paragraph as they have effect in relation to land acquired compulsorily by statutory undertakers.

(6)Those provisions are—

(a)sections 238 to 240 (use and development of consecrated land and burial ground);

(b)section 241 (use and development of land for open spaces); and

(c) sections 271 to 274(extinguishment of rights of way, and rights as to apparatus, of statutory undertakers).

(7)Where a code operator has acquired land under this paragraph, he must not dispose of that land, or of an interest or right in or over it, except with OFCOM’s consent.

Commencement Information

I24Sch. 4 para. 3 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I25Sch. 4 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Compulsory purchase of land: ScotlandU.K.

4(1)Subject to sub-paragraph (2), the Secretary of State may authorise a code operator to purchase compulsorily any land in Scotland which is required by the operator—U.K.

(a)for, or in connection with, the establishment or running of the operator’s network; or

(b)as to which it can reasonably be foreseen that it will be so required.

(2)No order is to be made authorising a compulsory purchase under this paragraph except with OFCOM’s consent.

(3)This power to purchase land compulsorily includes power to acquire a servitude or other right over land by the creation of a new right.

(4)The Acquisition of Land (Authorisation Procedure) (Scotland) Act 1947 (c. 42) applies to any compulsory purchase under this paragraph as if—

(a)the code operator were a local authority within the meaning of that Act; and

(b)this paragraph had been in force immediately before the commencement of that Act.

(5)The provisions of the Town and Country Planning (Scotland) Act 1997 (c. 8) specified in sub-paragraph (6) have effect in relation to land acquired compulsorily by a code operator under this paragraph as they have effect in relation to land acquired compulsorily by statutory undertakers.

(6)Those provisions are—

(a)section 197 (provisions as to churches and burial grounds);

(b)section 198 (use and development of land for open spaces); and

(c)sections 224 to 227 (extinguishment of rights of way, and rights as to apparatus, of statutory undertakers).

(7)Where a code operator has acquired land under this paragraph, he must not dispose of that land, or of any interest or right in or over it, except with OFCOM’s consent.

Commencement Information

I26Sch. 4 para. 4 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I27Sch. 4 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Compulsory purchase of land: Northern IrelandU.K.

5(1)Where a code operator proposes to acquire, otherwise than by agreement, any land in Northern Ireland required by him—U.K.

(a)for, or in connection with, the establishment or running of the operator’s network, or

(b)as to which it can reasonably be foreseen that it will be so required,

he may, with OFCOM’s consent, apply to the Secretary of State for an order vesting that land in him.

(2)On such an application the Secretary of State is to have power to make such an order.

(3)This power to acquire land compulsorily includes power to acquire an easement or other right over land by the creation of a new right.

(4)Where a code operator has acquired land under this paragraph, he must not dispose of that land, or of any interest or right in or over it, except with OFCOM’s consent.

(5)The following provisions—

(a)Schedule 6 to the Local Government Act (Northern Ireland) 1972 (c. 9 (N.I.)) (acquisition of land by vesting order), and

(b)Schedule 8 to the Health and Personal Social Services (Northern Ireland) Order 1972 (S.I. 1972/1265 (N.I. 14)) (provisions as to inquiries),

have effect for the purposes of the acquisition of land by means of a vesting order under this paragraph as they have effect for the purposes of that Act and that Order but subject to the modifications set out in sub-paragraph (6).

(6)Those modifications are—

(a)for any reference to the Department substitute a reference to the Secretary of State;

(b)for any reference to the Act or Order in question substitute a reference to this Act;

(c)for any reference in Schedule 6 to the Local Government Act (Northern Ireland) 1972 to a council substitute a reference to the code operator;

(d)in paragraph 6(2) of that Schedule, for the words from “the fund” onwards substitute “ funds of the code operator (in this Schedule referred to as “the compensation fund”) and shall be discharged by payments made by the code operator ”; and

(e)in paragraph 12(2) of that Schedule for “the clerk of the council” substitute “ such person as may be designated for the purposes of this Schedule by the code operator ”.

(7)The enactments for the time being in force relating to the assessment of compensation in respect of land vested in a district council by an order made under Schedule 6 to the Local Government Act (Northern Ireland) 1972 are to apply, subject to any necessary modifications, in relation to land vested in a code operator by an order made under this paragraph.

(8)In this paragraph, “land” has the meaning assigned to it by section 45(1)(a) of the Interpretation Act (Northern Ireland) 1954 (c. 33 (N.I.)).

Commencement Information

I28Sch. 4 para. 5 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I29Sch. 4 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Entry on land for exploratory purposes: England and WalesU.K.

6(1)A person—U.K.

(a)nominated by a code operator, and

(b)duly authorised in writing by the Secretary of State,

may, at any reasonable time, enter upon and survey land in England and Wales for the purpose of ascertaining whether the land would be suitable for use by the code operator for, or in connection with, the establishment or running of the operator’s network.

(2)This paragraph does not apply in relation to land covered by buildings or used as a garden or pleasure ground.

(3)Sections 324(8) and 325(1) to (5), (8) and (9) of the Town and Country Planning Act 1990 (c. 8) (supplementary provisions relating to powers of entry) have effect in relation to the power conferred by this paragraph—

(a)as they have effect in relation to the powers conferred by section 324 of that Act; but

(b)subject to the modifications set out in sub-paragraph (4).

(4)Those modifications are—

(a)in section 324(8) (power to search and bore for the purpose of ascertaining the nature of the subsoil or the presence of minerals) omit “or the presence of minerals therein”; and

(b)in section 325(1) (24 hours' notice to be given of an intended entry upon occupied land) for “24 hours” substitute “ 28 days ”.

(5)Where, in an exercise of the power conferred by this paragraph, any damage is caused to land or to chattels, the code operator must—

(a)make good the damage; or

(b)pay compensation in respect of the damage to every person interested in the land or chattels.

(6)Where, in consequence of an exercise of the power conferred by this paragraph, a person is disturbed in his enjoyment of land or chattels, the code operator must pay that person compensation in respect of the disturbance.

(7)Section 118 of the Town and Country Planning Act 1990 (c. 8) (determination of disputes as to compensation) applies to any question of disputed compensation under this paragraph as it applies to such questions under Part 4 of that Act.

Commencement Information

I30Sch. 4 para. 6 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I31Sch. 4 para. 6 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Entry on land for exploratory purposes: ScotlandU.K.

7(1)A person—U.K.

(a)nominated by a code operator, and

(b)duly authorised in writing by the Secretary of State,

may, at any reasonable time, enter upon and survey any land in Scotland for the purpose of ascertaining whether the land would be suitable for use by the code operator for, or in connection with, the establishment or running of the operator’s network.

(2)This paragraph does not apply in relation to land covered by buildings or used as a garden or pleasure ground.

(3)Sections 269(6) and 270(1) to (5), (8) and (9) of the Town and Country Planning (Scotland) Act 1997 (c. 8) (supplementary provisions relating to powers of entry) have effect in relation to the power conferred by this paragraph—

(a)as they have effect in relation to the powers conferred by section 269 of that Act; but

(b)subject to the modifications set out in sub-paragraph (4).

(4)Those modifications are—

(a)in section 269(6) (power to search and bore for the purpose of ascertaining the nature of the subsoil or the presence of minerals), omit “or the presence of minerals therein”; and

(b)in section 270(1) (24 hours' notice to be given of an intended entry upon occupied land) for “24 hours” substitute “ 28 days ”.

(5)Where, in an exercise of the power conferred by this paragraph, damage is caused to land or to corporeal moveables, the code operator must—

(a)make good the damage; or

(b)pay compensation in respect of the damage to every person interested in the land or corporeal moveables.

(6)Where, in consequence of an exercise of the power conferred by this paragraph, a person is disturbed in his enjoyment of any land or corporeal moveables, the code operator must pay that person compensation in respect of the disturbance.

(7)A dispute arising under this paragraph—

(a)as to the effect of damage, or

(b)as to the amount of compensation,

must be determined by arbitration by a single arbiter appointed by agreement between the parties or, in default of an agreement, by the Secretary of State.

Commencement Information

I32Sch. 4 para. 7 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I33Sch. 4 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Entry on land for exploratory purposes: Northern IrelandU.K.

8(1)A person—U.K.

(a)nominated by a code operator, and

(b)duly authorised in writing by the Secretary of State,

may, at any reasonable time, enter upon and survey any land in Northern Ireland for the purpose of ascertaining whether the land would be suitable for use by the code operator for, or in connection with, the establishment or running of the operator’s network.

(2)This paragraph does not apply in relation to land covered by buildings or used as a garden or pleasure ground.

(3)Subsections (2) to (5) and (8) of section 40 of the Land Development Values (Compensation) Act (Northern Ireland) 1965 (c. 23 (N.I.)) (supplementary provisions relating to powers of entry) have effect in relation to the power of entry conferred by this paragraph—

(a)as they have effect in relation to the power conferred by that section; but

(b)subject to the modifications set out in sub-paragraph (4).

(4)Those modifications are—

(a)in section 40(2) (power to search and bore for the purpose of ascertaining the nature of the subsoil or the presence of minerals) omit “or the presence of minerals therein”; and

(b)in section 40(3)(b) (three days' notice to be given of an intended entry upon occupied land) for the word “three” substitute “ twenty eight ”.

(5)Where, in an exercise of the power conferred by this paragraph, damage is caused to land or to chattels, the code operator must—

(a)make good the damage; or

(b)pay compensation in respect of the damage to every person interested in the land or chattels.

(6)Where, in consequence of an exercise of the power conferred by this paragraph, a person is disturbed in his enjoyment of any land or chattels, the code operator must pay that person compensation in respect of the disturbance.

(7)Section 31 of the Land Development Values (Compensation) Act (Northern Ireland) 1965 (determination of disputes as to compensation) applies to any question of disputed compensation under this paragraph as it applies to such questions under Part 3 of that Act.

Commencement Information

I34Sch. 4 para. 8 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I35Sch. 4 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Acquisition of land by agreementU.K.

9(1)For the purpose of the acquisition by agreement by a code operator of land in England and Wales, the provisions of Part 1 of the Compulsory Purchase Act 1965 (c. 56) (so far as applicable), other than sections 4 to 8 (time limits, notices to treat etc.) and section 31 (ecclesiastical property), apply as they apply for the purposes of that Act.U.K.

(2)For the purpose of the acquisition by agreement by a code operator of land in Scotland, section 109(2) of the Town and Country Planning (Scotland) Act 1972 (c. 52) (incorporation of Lands Clauses Acts) applies, with any necessary modifications, for the purposes of this Act as it applies for the purposes of that Act.

(3)For the purpose of the acquisition by agreement by a code operator of land in Northern Ireland, the Lands Clauses Acts, except for sections 127 to 132 (sale of superfluous land) and sections 150 and 151 (access to the special Act) of the Lands Clauses Consolidation Act 1845 (c. 18), apply as they apply for the purposes of those Acts.

Commencement Information

I36Sch. 4 para. 9 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I37Sch. 4 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Section 159

F22SCHEDULE 5U.K.Procedure for grants of recognised spectrum access

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

Prospective

Section 180

F22SCHEDULE 6U.K.Fixed penalties for wireless telegraphy offences

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Section 182

F22SCHEDULE 7U.K.Seizure and forfeiture of apparatus

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Section 192

SCHEDULE 8U.K.Decisions not subject to appeal

Prosecutions and civil proceedingsU.K.

1U.K.A decision to institute, bring or carry on any criminal or civil proceedings.

Commencement Information

I38Sch. 8 para. 1 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I39Sch. 8 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

2U.K.A decision (other than one under section 119) to take preliminary steps for the purpose of enabling any such proceedings to be instituted.

Commencement Information

I40Sch. 8 para. 2 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I41Sch. 8 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

This ActU.K.

3U.K.A decision relating to the making or revision of a statement under section 38.

Commencement Information

I42Sch. 8 para. 3 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I43Sch. 8 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

4U.K.A decision required to be published in a notification under section 44(4).

Commencement Information

I44Sch. 8 para. 4 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I45Sch. 8 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

5U.K.A decision given effect to by an order under section 55.

Commencement Information

I46Sch. 8 para. 5 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I47Sch. 8 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

6U.K.A decision given effect to by regulations under section 66.

Commencement Information

I48Sch. 8 para. 6 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I49Sch. 8 para. 6 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

7U.K.A decision given effect to by regulations under section 71 [F23or under section 71(4) to (7) as applied by section 72H(4)].

Textual Amendments

Commencement Information

I50Sch. 8 para. 7 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I51Sch. 8 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

[F247DU.K.A decision to impose a duty under section 105Z14.]

8U.K.A decision required to be published in a notification under section 108(4).

Commencement Information

I52Sch. 8 para. 8 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I53Sch. 8 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

9U.K.A decision given effect to by an order under section 122.

Commencement Information

I54Sch. 8 para. 9 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I55Sch. 8 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

[F259AU.K.A decision relating to any of sections 124A to 124N or to anything done under them.]

Textual Amendments

F25Sch. 8 para. 9A inserted (8.6.2010) by Digital Economy Act 2010 (c. 24), ss. 16(3), 47(1)

10U.K.A decision relating to the making or revision of a statement under section 131.

Commencement Information

I56Sch. 8 para. 10 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I57Sch. 8 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

11U.K.A decision given effect to by an order under section 134(6).

Commencement Information

I58Sch. 8 para. 11 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I59Sch. 8 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

[F2611AU.K.A decision to require information under section 135, so far as the information is required for the purpose of preparing a report under section 105Z12.]

12U.K.A decision relating to the making or revision of a statement under section 145.

Commencement Information

I60Sch. 8 para. 12 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I61Sch. 8 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

F2713U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2714U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2715U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2716U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2717U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2718U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2719U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2720U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2721U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2722U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2723U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2724U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2725U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2726U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949U.K.

F2727U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2728U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2729U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2730U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2731U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2732U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

Wireless Telegraphy Act 1998U.K.

F2733U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2734U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2735U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F2736U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

[F28Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006U.K.

Textual Amendments

F28Sch. 8 paras. 37-46 and cross-heading inserted (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 7 para. 36

37U.K.A decision relating to the publication of the United Kingdom Plan for Frequency Authorisation.

38U.K.A decision in exercise of the functions conferred on OFCOM by section 1 as to—

(a)the services, records and advice to be provided, maintained or given by them;

(b)the research to be carried out or the arrangements made for carrying it out; or

(c)the making or terms of any grant.

39U.K.A decision under section 4 or 7.

40U.K.A decision given effect to—

(a)by regulations under section 8(3), 12, 14, 18, 21, 23, 27, 30, 45 [F29 , 53A(7), 53D ] or 54 or paragraph 1 of Schedule 1 or paragraph 1 of Schedule 2;

(b)by an order under section 29 or 62.

41U.K.A decision relating to the recovery of a sum payable to OFCOM under section 15[F30 , 24 or 53D(6) ].

Textual Amendments

F30Words in Sch. 8 para. 41 substituted (31.7.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), ss. 8(5)(b), 118(6); S.I. 2017/765, reg. 2(c)

42U.K.A decision given effect to by regulations under section 31 and any decision under any such regulations.

43U.K.A decision relating to the making or revision of a statement under—

(a)section 34, F31...

(b)section 44[F32, or

(c)section 53H.]

Textual Amendments

F31Word in Sch. 8 para. 43 omitted (31.7.2017) by virtue of Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), ss. 8(5)(c), 118(6); S.I. 2017/765, reg. 2(c)

F32Sch. 8 para. 43(c) and word inserted (31.7.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), ss. 8(5)(c), 118(6); S.I. 2017/765, reg. 2(c)

44U.K.A decision to impose a penalty under section 42(1) [F33for a relevant multiplex contravention].

Textual Amendments

F33Words in Sch. 8 para. 44 inserted (27.6.2017) by Digital Economy Act 2017 (c. 30), ss. 9(11), 118(2) (with s. 9(13))

45U.K.A decision for the purposes of section 59.

46U.K.A decision relating to an authority under section 62(5).]

Section 199

SCHEDULE 9U.K.Arrangements about carrying on of C4C’s activities

Notification of requirement to submit proposalsU.K.

1(1)It shall be the duty of OFCOM to give a notification under this paragraph to C4C—U.K.

(a)as soon as practicable after the commencement of this Schedule,

[F34(aa)as soon as practicable after the day on which section 198A comes into force,] and

(b)as soon as practicable in the last twelve months preceding each date on which the replacement licence granted in accordance with section 231 would expire if not renewed.

(2)A notification under this paragraph is one requiring C4C to submit proposals to OFCOM in accordance with this Schedule for the relevant licence period.

(3)A notification under this paragraph must specify the period within which C4C must submit their proposals.

(4)The period specified under sub-paragraph (3) must be a period ending not less than three months after the day of the giving of the notification.

Textual Amendments

F34Sch. 9 para. 1(1)(aa) inserted (8.6.2010) by Digital Economy Act 2010 (c. 24), ss. 22(3)(a), 47(1)

Commencement Information

I62Sch. 9 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Submission of proposed arrangementsU.K.

2(1)This paragraph applies where C4C have received a notification under paragraph 1.U.K.

(2)C4C must, within the period set out in the notification, submit proposals to OFCOM for the arrangements under which they are proposing to secure, so far as reasonably practicable, that all significant risks that their other activities will have an adverse effect on the carrying out, during the relevant licence period, of their primary functions are—

(a)identified;

(b)evaluated; and

(c)properly managed.

(3)The proposals must include proposals for the arrangements that C4C consider appropriate for securing the transparency objectives during the relevant licence period.

(4)For the purposes of this Schedule the transparency objectives are—

(a)an appropriate financial and organisational separation between the activities of C4C that relate to the carrying out of their primary functions and their other activities; and

(b)an appropriate degree of transparency in financial and other reporting where resources are shared between separated activities or where there is some other financial or practical connection between otherwise separated activities.

(5)The matters to which the proposals submitted under this paragraph may relate include, in particular, the procedures and other practices to be followed by C4C in the case of—

(a)the initiation and management of new ventures;

(b)the exercise of particular powers;

(c)the assessment of risks;

(d)the imposition of charges; and

(e)the keeping of records.

(6)The determination of what is appropriate for the purposes of sub-paragraphs (3) and (4) is not to be confined to a determination of what is appropriate for securing the matters mentioned in sub-paragraph (2).

(7)The arrangements proposed by C4C must contain provision for compliance with the arrangements to be checked regularly by a person appointed in accordance with that provision.

(8)That person must be a person other than the person for the time being holding an appointment for the purposes of paragraph 12(2) of Schedule 3 to the 1990 Act (C4C’s auditor).

Commencement Information

I63Sch. 9 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Consideration and approval of proposalsU.K.

3(1)OFCOM must consider every proposal or revised proposal submitted to them by C4C under paragraph 2 or this paragraph and may do one of the following—U.K.

(a)approve the proposed arrangements;

(b)approve them with such modifications as they may notify to C4C;

(c)require C4C to submit revised proposals in accordance with directions given by OFCOM.

(2)Before—

(a)making modifications of proposed arrangements for the purpose of approving them, or

(b)requiring the submission of revised proposals,

OFCOM must consult C4C.

Commencement Information

I64Sch. 9 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Duration of approval and modification of arrangementsU.K.

4(1)Arrangements approved under this Schedule are to remain in force (subject to the following provisions of this paragraph) throughout the licence period to which they relate.U.K.

(2)The arrangements for the time being approved under this Schedule for any licence period may be modified, by agreement between OFCOM and C4C, at any time during the licence period for which they apply.

(3)OFCOM may carry out a review of the arrangements for the time being approved under this Schedule.

(4)The reviews that may be carried out under this paragraph in any one licence period are confined to either—

(a)one review relating to all the arrangements; or

(b)two reviews carried out at separate times as follows—

(i)one (whether the first or second) relating to the arrangements for securing the transparency objectives; and

(ii)the other relating to other matters.

(5)On a review under this paragraph, OFCOM may require C4C to submit proposals for modifying the arrangements for the time being approved under this Schedule so far as they relate to the matters under review.

(6)Paragraph 3 applies where proposals are submitted to OFCOM under sub-paragraph (5) as it applies where they are submitted under paragraph 2.

Commencement Information

I65Sch. 9 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Publication of approved arrangementsU.K.

5(1)OFCOM must publish all arrangements approved by them under this Schedule.U.K.

(2)The publication of anything under this paragraph must be in such manner as OFCOM consider appropriate for bringing it to the attention of members of the public.

Commencement Information

I66Sch. 9 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Duty of C4C to act in accordance with the approved arrangementsU.K.

6U.K.It shall be the duty of C4C to act in accordance with the arrangements for the time being in force under this Schedule.

Commencement Information

I67Sch. 9 para. 6 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

nforcement of dutiesU.K.

7(1)This paragraph applies to—U.K.

(a)every duty of C4C under this Schedule to submit proposals to OFCOM; and

(b)the duty imposed on C4C by paragraph 6.

(2)Each of those duties shall be enforceable in civil proceedings by OFCOM—

(a)for an injunction;

(b)for specific performance of a statutory duty under section 45 of the Court of Session Act 1988 (c. 36); or

(c)for any other appropriate remedy or relief.

Commencement Information

I68Sch. 9 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Penalty for contravention of the arrangementsU.K.

8(1)OFCOM may impose a penalty on C4C if C4C have contravened—U.K.

(a)a requirement of this Schedule to submit proposals to OFCOM;

(b)a requirement of arrangements for the time being approved under this Schedule.

(2)The amount of the penalty must not exceed 3 per cent. of C4C’s qualifying revenue for their last complete accounting period before the contravention.

(3)Before imposing a penalty on C4C under this paragraph OFCOM must give C4C a reasonable opportunity of making representations to OFCOM about their proposal to impose the penalty.

(4)Where OFCOM impose a penalty on C4C under this paragraph, they shall—

(a)notify C4C; and

(b)in that notification, fix a reasonable period after it is given as the period within which the penalty is to be paid.

(5)In the case of a continuing contravention—

(a)separate penalties may be imposed in respect of different periods during which the contravention continues;

(b)the notification of the penalty must specify the period in respect of which the penalty is imposed; and

(c)the reference in sub-paragraph (2) to the last complete accounting period before the contravention is a reference to the last complete accounting period before the end of the period in respect of which the penalty is imposed.

(6)A penalty imposed under this paragraph must be paid to OFCOM within the period fixed by them.

(7)Section 19(2) to (6) of the 1990 Act and Part 1 of Schedule 7 to that Act (calculation of qualifying revenue), with any necessary modifications, have effect in relation to C4C for the purposes of this paragraph as they have effect in relation to the holder of a Channel 3 licence for the purposes of Part 1 of that Act.

Commencement Information

I69Sch. 9 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

OFCOM’s duty to take account of need to support C4C’s primary functionsU.K.

9U.K.In exercising their powers under this Schedule OFCOM must have regard, in particular, to the need to secure, so far as practicable, that all significant risks that C4C’s other activities will have an adverse effect on the carrying out of their primary functions are—

(a)identified;

(b)evaluated; and

(c)properly managed.

Commencement Information

I70Sch. 9 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Interpretation of ScheduleU.K.

10U.K.In this Schedule—

  • arrangements” means arrangements about the procedures and other practices to be followed by C4C and about other matters connected with the carrying on by them of any of their activities;

  • licence period” means—

    (a)

    the period for which the replacement licence is granted to C4C in accordance with section 231; or

    (b)

    any subsequent period for which it is renewed;

  • primary functions” is to be construed in accordance with section 199(2);

  • “relevant licence period”—

    (a)

    in relation to the first notification to be given under paragraph 1, the licence period mentioned in paragraph (a) of the definition of that period;

    (aa)

    [F35in relation to the notification under paragraph 1(1)(aa), the period beginning on the day on which section 198A comes into force and ending on the last day of the first licence period to expire after that day;] and

    (b)

    in relation to [F36any other notification under paragraph 1] , the first licence period to begin after the giving of the notification;

  • transparency objectives” is to be construed in accordance with paragraph 2(4).

Textual Amendments

F35Words in Sch. 9 para. 10 inserted (8.6.2010) by Digital Economy Act 2010 (c. 24), ss. 22(3)(b), 47(1)

F36Words in Sch. 9 para. 10 substituted (8.6.2010) by Digital Economy Act 2010 (c. 24), ss. 22(3)(c), 47(1)

Commencement Information

I71Sch. 9 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 219

SCHEDULE 10U.K.Licensing the public teletext service

Part 1U.K.Applications for and award of licence

Notice of proposal to grant licenceU.K.

1(1)Where OFCOM propose to grant a licence to provide the public teletext service they must publish a notice stating that they are proposing to do so.U.K.

(2)The notice must—

(a)specify the digital capacity which is available for the public teletext service on television multiplex services;

(b)specify whether the licence will require the public teletext service to comprise a service to be provided for broadcasting in analogue form;

(c)invite applications for the licence;

(d)specify the closing date for applications;

(e)specify the fee payable on the making of an application for the licence; and

(f)specify the percentage of qualifying revenue for each accounting period of the licence holder which OFCOM have determined to be the percentage of that revenue that will have to be paid to them.

(3)Where the licence is to comprise an analogue teletext service the notice must specify—

(a)the television broadcasting service or services on whose frequency or frequencies the services are to be provided; and

(b)the extent and nature of the spare capacity which is to be allocated by the licence.

(4)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2)(f)—

(a)different percentages may be determined and specified for different accounting periods; and

(b)the percentages that may be determined and specified for an accounting period include a nil percentage.

(5)A notice under this paragraph is to be published in such manner as OFCOM consider appropriate.

Commencement Information

I72Sch. 10 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Guidance as to applicationsU.K.

2(1)When publishing a notice under paragraph 1, OFCOM must publish with it some general guidance to applicants about what is likely to make proposals relating to the matters mentioned in paragraph 3(1)(c) to (e) acceptable to them.U.K.

(2)Guidance published under this paragraph must include examples.

Commencement Information

I73Sch. 10 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Applications for the licenceU.K.

3(1)An application made in response to a notice under paragraph 1 must be accompanied by—U.K.

(a)the fee specified in the notice as payable on the making of the application;

(b)a technical plan complying with sub-paragraph (2);

(c)the applicant’s proposals for providing, or securing the provision of, a service that fulfils the public service remit for the public teletext service;

(d)the applicant’s proposals for including news items in the service and for securing that the news items included in the service are up to date and regularly revised;

(e)the applicant’s proposals for the inclusion in the service of material that is of particular interest to persons living in different parts of the United Kingdom;

(f)the applicant’s cash bid in respect of the licence; and

(g)such information as OFCOM may reasonably require about the matters mentioned in sub-paragraph (3).

(2)The technical plan must indicate—

(a)the nature of the public teletext service which the applicant is proposing to provide; and

(b)the nature of any services the provision of which, in accordance with proposals made by another person, would be secured by the applicant in accordance with provision made under section 220.

(3)The matters about which OFCOM may require information under sub-paragraph (1)(g) are—

(a)the applicant’s present financial position; and

(b)his projected financial position during the period for which the licence would be in force.

(4)At any time after receiving an application under this Schedule and before disposing of it, OFCOM may require the applicant to furnish additional information about any one or more of the following—

(a)the matters that must be indicated in the technical plan;

(b)the applicant’s proposals with respect to the matters mentioned in sub-paragraph (1)(c) to (e); and

(c)the matters mentioned in sub-paragraph (3).

(5)Any information to be furnished to OFCOM under this paragraph must be in such form, and must be verified, in such manner as they may require.

Commencement Information

I74Sch. 10 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Notice inviting public representationsU.K.

4(1)As soon as reasonably practicable after the date specified in a notice under paragraph 1 as the closing date for applications, OFCOM must publish—U.K.

(a)the name of every person who has made an application to them in response to their notice;

(b)particulars of the technical plan submitted by each applicant;

(c)the proposals submitted by each applicant with respect to the matters mentioned in paragraph 3(1)(c) to (e);

(d)such other information connected with each application as OFCOM consider appropriate; and

(e)a notice under sub-paragraph (2).

(2)The notice required by this paragraph is one that—

(a)invites representations to be made to OFCOM with respect to the other matters published under this paragraph; and

(b)specifies the manner in which, and the time by which, such representations have to be made.

(3)Publication of any information or notice under this paragraph is to be in such manner as OFCOM consider appropriate.

Commencement Information

I75Sch. 10 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Determination of applicationsU.K.

5(1)This paragraph applies where, in response to a notice under paragraph 1, a person has made an application for a licence to provide the public teletext service.U.K.

(2)OFCOM must not proceed to consider whether to award the applicant the licence in accordance with the following provisions of this paragraph unless it appears to them—

(a)that the applicant’s technical plan, in so far as it involves the use of an electronic communications network, contains proposals that are acceptable to them;

(b)that the applicant’s proposals with respect to the matters mentioned in paragraph 3(1)(c) to (e) are acceptable to them; and

(c)that the services proposed to be provided under the licence would be capable of being maintained throughout the period for which the licence would be in force.

(3)In determining whether it appears to them as mentioned in sub-paragraph (2), OFCOM must take account of any representations made to them in response to the invitation published under paragraph 4.

(4)Sections 17 and 17A of the 1990 Act (award of licence to highest cash bidder and financial conditions) apply in relation to a licence to provide the public teletext service as they apply in relation to a Channel 3 licence, but with the modifications set out in sub-paragraphs (5) and (6).

(5)In the application of section 17 of the 1990 Act in accordance with sub-paragraph (4)—

(a)any reference to an applicant is to be construed as a reference to an applicant in whose case it appears to OFCOM as mentioned in sub-paragraph (2);

(b)the provisions of subsection (4) down to the end of paragraph (b) are to be omitted;

(c)in subsection (7)(a), the reference to section 19(1) of the 1990 Act is to be construed as a reference to paragraph 7 of this Schedule;

(d)subsection (12) shall have effect with the substitution of the following paragraph for paragraph (b)—

(b)the name of every other applicant in whose case it appeared to OFCOM as mentioned in paragraph 5(2) of Schedule 10 to the Communications Act 2003;

(e)in subsection (14), the references to a notice under section 15(1) of the 1990 Act and a notice under Part 1 of that Act shall each have effect as a reference to a notice under paragraph 1 of this Schedule.

(6)In the application of section 17A of the 1990 Act in accordance with sub-paragraph (4)—

(a)the reference in subsection (1)(b) to section 15(3)(g) of the 1990 Act shall have effect as a reference to paragraph 3(1)(g) of this Schedule; and

(b)the reference in subsection (3) to a notice under section 15(1) of the 1990 Act shall have effect as a reference to a notice under paragraph 1 of this Schedule.

Commencement Information

I76Sch. 10 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Revocation of awardU.K.

6(1)This paragraph applies if, at any time after a licence to provide the public teletext service has been awarded to a person, but before it has come into force—U.K.

(a)that person indicates to OFCOM that he does not intend to provide, or secure the provision of, the licensed service; or

(b)OFCOM have, for any other reason, reasonable grounds for believing that the licensed service will not be provided once the licence has come into force.

(2)OFCOM must revoke the licence by serving a notice of revocation on the person to whom it was awarded.

(3)OFCOM may then award the licence again in accordance with section 17 of the 1990 Act (as applied by paragraph 5 of this Schedule) as if the person whose licence is revoked had not made an application.

(4)Sub-paragraph (3) has effect subject to subsection (14) of section 17 of the 1990 Act (as so applied) (re-publication of invitation to make applications) as if the reference in that subsection to the following provisions of Part 1 of that Act included a reference to that sub-paragraph.

(5)Before acting under sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) in a case falling within sub-paragraph (1)(b), OFCOM must serve a notice on the person awarded the licence stating their grounds for believing that the licensed service will not be provided once the licence has come into force.

(6)Where such a notice is required to be given, OFCOM must not revoke the licence unless they have given the person to whom it was awarded a reasonable opportunity of making representations to them about the matters by reference to which they are proposing to revoke it.

(7)In the case of a licence to provide a service that must comprise both—

(a)an analogue teletext service, and

(b)a teletext service provided in digital form,

the references in sub-paragraphs (1) and (5) to the licensed service are references to one or both of those services.

Commencement Information

I77Sch. 10 para. 6 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Part 2U.K.Conditions and enforcement of licence

Payments to be made in respect of the public teletext serviceU.K.

7(1)A licence to provide the public teletext service must include conditions requiring the licence holder to pay the following amounts to OFCOM (in addition to any fees required to be so paid by virtue of section 4(1)(b) of the 1990 Act)—U.K.

(a)a specified amount in respect of the first complete calendar year falling within the licence period;

(b)in respect of each subsequent year falling wholly or partly within the licence period, that amount increased by the appropriate percentage;

(c)in respect of each accounting period of his falling within the licence period, an amount representing a specified percentage of qualifying revenue for that accounting period.

(2)The amount specified for the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(a) must be—

(a)in the case of the replacement licence under section 221, the amount proposed in accordance with subsection (5)(a) of that section;

(b)in the case of a licence renewed under section 222, the amount determined under section 223(1)(a); and

(c)in any other case, the amount specified in the licence holder’s cash bid.

(3)The percentage specified for the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(c) in respect of an accounting period must be—

(a)in the case of the replacement licence under section 221, nil;

(b)in the case of a licence renewed under section 222, the percentage determined under section 223(1)(b); and

(c)in any other case, the percentage determined and specified for the purposes of paragraph 1(2)(f) of this Schedule.

(4)A licence to provide the public teletext service may also include conditions—

(a)enabling OFCOM to estimate before the beginning of an accounting period the amount due for that period by virtue of any condition imposed under this paragraph; and

(b)requiring the licence holder to pay the estimated amount by monthly instalments throughout that period.

(5)Such a licence may, in particular, include conditions—

(a)authorising OFCOM to revise an estimate on one or more occasions;

(b)requiring them to alter the amounts of the instalments payable by the licence holder to take account of the revised estimate;

(c)providing for the adjustment of an overpayment or underpayment.

(6)This paragraph has effect subject to sections 225 and 226 and to the requirement in section 221(5)(b).

(7)In this paragraph “the appropriate percentage” has the same meaning as in section 19 of the 1990 Act.

Commencement Information

I78Sch. 10 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Corrections and statements of findings by the public teletext providerU.K.

8(1)Section 40 of the 1990 Act (power to direct correction or a statement of findings) shall have effect in relation to the public teletext service as it has effect in relation to a Channel 3 service but as if the references in subsection (4) to a programme were references to an item.U.K.

(2)OFCOM’s powers by virtue of this paragraph in relation to any matter are not affected by any prior exercise by them in relation to that matter of their powers under either or both of paragraphs 9 and 10.

Commencement Information

I79Sch. 10 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of the licence for the public teletext serviceU.K.

9(1)If OFCOM are satisfied that the holder of the licence to provide the public teletext service has—U.K.

(a)contravened a condition of the licence, or

(b)failed to comply with a direction given to him by OFCOM under or by virtue of a provision of the 1990 Act, the 1996 Act or Part 3 of this Act,

they may serve on him a notice requiring him to pay a specified financial penalty to them.

(2)The maximum amount which a person may be required to pay by way of a penalty under this paragraph is 5 per cent. of the qualifying revenue for his last complete accounting period.

(3)Where an accounting period by reference to which the maximum amount of a penalty falls to be calculated has not ended when the penalty is imposed, the amount taken into account in respect of that period is to be the amount estimated by OFCOM.

(4)OFCOM are not to serve a notice under this paragraph on any person unless they have given him a reasonable opportunity of making representations to them about the matters complained of.

(5)A notice requiring a person to pay a penalty under this paragraph must specify the period within which it is to be paid.

Commencement Information

I80Sch. 10 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Power to shorten licence periodU.K.

10(1)If OFCOM are satisfied that the holder of the licence to provide the public teletext service has—U.K.

(a)contravened a condition of the licence, or

(b)failed to comply with a direction given to him by OFCOM under or by virtue of any provision of the 1990 Act, the 1996 Act or Part 3 of this Act,

they may serve on him a notice reducing the period for which the licence is to be in force by a specified period not exceeding two years.

(2)OFCOM are not to serve a notice under this paragraph on any person unless they have given him a reasonable opportunity of making representations to them about the matters in respect of which it is served.

(3)Where a licence is due to expire on a particular date by virtue of a notice served on a person under this paragraph, OFCOM may, on the application of that person, revoke that notice by a further notice served on him at any time before that date.

(4)OFCOM may exercise their power under sub-paragraph (3) only if they are satisfied that, since the date of the earlier notice, the conduct of the licence holder in relation to the operation of the licensed service has been such as to justify the revocation of that notice.

Commencement Information

I81Sch. 10 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Revocation for contravention of condition or directionU.K.

11U.K.Section 42 of the 1990 Act (revocation for contravention) shall apply in relation to the licence to provide the public teletext service as it applies in relation to a licence to provide a Channel 3 service.

Commencement Information

I82Sch. 10 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Penalty on revocationU.K.

12(1)Where OFCOM revoke the licence to provide the public teletext service (whether under paragraph 6 or a provision of the 1990 Act or 1996 Act), they must serve on the licence holder a notice requiring him to pay a specified financial penalty to them.U.K.

(2)The maximum amount which a person may be required to pay by way of a penalty under this paragraph is the maximum given by sub-paragraphs (3) and (4).

(3)In a case where the licence is revoked under paragraph 6 or the penalty is imposed before the end of the first complete accounting period of the licence holder to begin in the licence period, the maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£500,000; and

(b)7 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate would have been the qualifying revenue for the first complete accounting period of the licence holder falling within the period for which the licence would have been in force.

(4)In any other case, the maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£500,000; and

(b)7 per cent. of the qualifying revenue for the last complete accounting period of the licence holder falling within the licence period.

(5)A notice requiring a person to pay a penalty under this paragraph must specify the period within which it is to be paid.

(6)A financial penalty that must be paid by virtue of this paragraph by a body of any description shall also be recoverable—

(a)as a debt due to OFCOM from the person who controls the body; or

(b)if two or more persons control it, as a debt due jointly and severally from them all.

(7)Sub-paragraph (6) is in addition to the provision for the recovery of penalties contained in section 346, but the amount recovered in respect of any one penalty must not exceed the full amount of that penalty.

(8)References in this paragraph to a person controlling a body are references to his controlling it within the meaning of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act.

Commencement Information

I83Sch. 10 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Power to modify penalties in paragraph 12U.K.

13(1)The Secretary of State may by order substitute a different sum for the sum for the time being specified in paragraph 12(3)(a) or (4)(a).U.K.

(2)No order is to be made containing provision authorised by this paragraph unless a draft of the order has been laid before Parliament and approved by a resolution of each House.

Commencement Information

I84Sch. 10 para. 13 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Part 3U.K.Interpretation of Schedule

14U.K.In this Schedule “licence period”, in relation to a licence, means the period for which the licence is in force.

Commencement Information

I85Sch. 10 para. 14 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

15(1)For the purposes of this Schedule the qualifying revenue for an accounting period of the holder of a licence to provide the public teletext service consists of the aggregate of all the following amounts—U.K.

(a)the amounts received or to be received by a person mentioned in sub-paragraph (2) in consideration of the inclusion in the licensed service in that period of advertisements or other items; and

(b)the amounts received or to be received by such a person in respect of the provision of the service from—

(i)a person authorised by the licence holder to provide the whole or a part of the licensed service; or

(ii)a person who is a connected person in relation to a person so authorised.

(2)Those persons are—

(a)the licence holder; or

(b)a person who is a connected person in relation to the licence holder without being a person authorised by the licence holder to provide the whole or a part of the licensed service.

(3)Part 1 of Schedule 7 to the 1990 Act applies for determining qualifying revenue for the purposes of this Schedule as it applies for the purposes of Part 1 of that Act.

(4)Where, in the case of the licence to provide the public teletext service—

(a)the first complete accounting period of the licence holder to fall within the licence period does not begin at the same time as the licence period, or

(b)the last complete accounting period of his to fall within the licence period does not end at the same time as the licence period,

references in this Schedule to an accounting period of the licence holder include references to such part of the accounting period preceding the first complete accounting period, or (as the case may be) following the last complete accounting period, as falls within the licence period.

(5)In this paragraph “connected person” has the same meaning as in Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act.

Commencement Information

I86Sch. 10 para. 15 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Sections 291 and 294

SCHEDULE 11U.K.Approval, imposition and modification of networking arrangements

Application of ScheduleU.K.

1(1)This Schedule applies where OFCOM’s approval of networking arrangements entered into by the holders of regional Channel 3 licences is required—U.K.

(a)for the purposes of conditions included in regional Channel 3 licences in accordance with section 291; or

(b)in order for networking arrangements made by OFCOM to cease to have effect in accordance with section 292.

(2)This Schedule also has effect as respects—

(a)the imposition by OFCOM under section 292 of networking arrangements;

(b)the modification of such arrangements following a review under section 293; and

(c)the making of proposals for modifications of networking arrangements following such a review.

Commencement Information

I87Sch. 11 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Approval required for modificationsU.K.

2(1)Where networking arrangements are approved by OFCOM for purposes mentioned in paragraph 1(1), those arrangements are not to be modified unless OFCOM have approved the modifications in accordance with this Schedule.U.K.

(2)This paragraph does not apply to modifications proposed by OFCOM under section 293.

Commencement Information

I88Sch. 11 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Procedure for giving approvalU.K.

3(1)This paragraph applies where arrangements or modifications are submitted to OFCOM for their approval.U.K.

(2)OFCOM must publish a description of the arrangements or modifications that have been submitted.

(3)The publication must be in such manner as OFCOM consider appropriate for bringing the matters published to the attention of the persons who, in OFCOM’s opinion, are likely to be affected by the arrangements or modifications.

(4)After allowing a reasonable time after the publication for the making of representations, OFCOM must consider the arrangements or modifications and decide whether or not to approve them.

Commencement Information

I89Sch. 11 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Decision of OFCOM whether or not to approve arrangements or modificationsU.K.

4(1)The decision made by OFCOM under paragraph 3(4) has to be one of the following—U.K.

(a)a decision to approve the arrangements or modifications unconditionally;

(b)a decision to give a conditional approval to the arrangements or modifications;

(c)a decision to refuse approval.

(2)A conditional approval is one that has effect only if effect is given, in relation to the proposed arrangements or modifications, to changes proposed by OFCOM.

(3)Before deciding to give a conditional approval, OFCOM must consult every holder of a regional Channel 3 licence about the changes they are proposing.

(4)When OFCOM have made their decision, they must prepare a report setting out—

(a)their decision; and

(b)their reasons for that decision.

(5)OFCOM must publish the report and send a copy of it to—

(a)the [F37Competition and Markets Authority] ; and

(b)every person to whom the relevant arrangements will apply, or do apply.

(6)The relevant arrangements are—

(a)the arrangements for which approval has been sought; or

(b)the arrangements which are the subject of the modifications for which approval has been sought.

Textual Amendments

Commencement Information

I90Sch. 11 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Notification of decisions on imposition of arrangementsU.K.

5(1)Where OFCOM impose arrangements they must prepare and publish a report setting out details of the imposed arrangements.U.K.

(2)Where OFCOM carry out a review under section 293, they must prepare and publish a report setting out—

(a)their conclusions on the review;

(b)their reasons for those conclusions; and

(c)the modifications (if any) that they are proposing, or intend to make, following the review.

(3)OFCOM must send a copy of a report prepared under this paragraph to—

(a)the [F37Competition and Markets Authority] ; and

(b)every person to whom the relevant arrangements will apply or do apply.

(4)The relevant arrangements are—

(a)the arrangements which are imposed; or

(b)the arrangements which are the subject of the modifications proposed by OFCOM or to be made by them.

Textual Amendments

Commencement Information

I91Sch. 11 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Competition tests applying to OFCOM’s decisionsU.K.

6(1)OFCOM must not—U.K.

(a)approve arrangements or modifications,

(b)impose arrangements or modify imposed arrangements, or

(c)propose modifications following a review under section 293,

unless they are satisfied that the arrangements, or the arrangements as proposed to be modified, satisfy the first or second competition test.

(2)Before making a decision about whether a competition test is satisfied OFCOM must consult the [F37Competition and Markets Authority] .

(3)Arrangements satisfy the first competition test if they do not have as their object or effect the prevention, restriction or distortion of competition within the United Kingdom.

(4)Arrangements satisfy the second competition test if—

(a)they do have such an object or effect; but

(b)they would satisfy the criteria set out in section 9 of the Competition Act 1998 (c. 41) (agreements contributing to improving the production or distribution of goods or to promoting technical or economic progress).

(5)For the purposes of the second competition test, arrangements imposed by OFCOM and modifications of such arrangements are to be treated as if they were given effect to by an agreement between undertakings.

(6)[F38Subject to paragraph 6A,] in determining whether arrangements or modified arrangements would satisfy either of the competition tests, OFCOM must act with a view to securing that there is no inconsistency between—

(a)the principles they apply and the decision they reach; and

(b)any principles or decisions referred to in sub-paragraph (7).

(7)Those principles and decisions are—

(a)the principles laid down by [F39the Treaty on the Functioning of the European Union and the European Court [F40before IP completion day], and any decisions [F41made by that court before IP completion day], that are relevant to the construction of Article 101 of that Treaty]; and

(b)any decisions under Part 1 of the Competition Act 1998, and any decisions of a court in the United Kingdom, that are relevant to the construction of a provision of that Act that is equivalent to the provisions of this Schedule imposing the competition tests.

[F42(7A)In sub-paragraph (7)(a), the reference to principles laid down before IP completion day is a reference to such principles as they have effect in EU law immediately before IP completion day, disregarding the effect of principles laid down, and decisions made, by the European Court on or after IP completion day.]

(8)In the case of a conditional approval, the requirements of this paragraph have to be satisfied in relation to the arrangements or modified arrangements as they will be after giving effect to the changes proposed by OFCOM.

(9)In this paragraph, the “European Court” includes a court attached to the European Court.

[F43Competition tests applying to OFCOM's decisions: EU principles etcU.K.

6A(1)Paragraph 6(6) does not require OFCOM to secure that there is no inconsistency with a principle or decision referred to in paragraph 6(7)(a)—U.K.

(a)so far as the principle or decision is excluded from the law of England and Wales, Scotland and Northern Ireland on or after IP completion day, or

(b)so far as doing so would be incompatible with OFCOM's duty to secure that there is no inconsistency with a decision referred to in paragraph 6(7)(b).

(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(a), a principle or decision is to be treated as not excluded from the law of England and Wales, Scotland and Northern Ireland if it is excluded only by virtue of an exclusion or revocation in the Competition (Amendment etc.) (EU Exit) Regulations 2019.

(3)Paragraph 6(6) does not require OFCOM to secure that there is no inconsistency with a principle or decision referred to in paragraph 6(7)(a) if OFCOM think that it is appropriate to act otherwise in the light of one or more of the following—

(a)differences between the competition tests and Article 101 of the Treaty on the Functioning of the European Union as it had effect immediately before IP completion day;

(b)differences between markets in the United Kingdom and markets in the European Union;

(c)developments in forms of economic activity since the time when the principle or decision referred to in paragraph 6(7)(a) was laid down or made;

(d)generally accepted principles of competition analysis or the generally accepted application of such principles;

(e)a principle laid down, or decision made, by the European Court on or after IP completion day;

(f)the particular circumstances under consideration.

Other matters to be taken into accountU.K.

7(1)OFCOM must not—U.K.

(a)approve arrangements or modifications,

(b)impose arrangements or modify imposed arrangements, or

(c)propose modifications following a review under section 293,

unless they consider that the arrangements, or the arrangements as proposed to be modified, are satisfactory.

(2)OFCOM’s consideration under sub-paragraph (1) must include consideration of the following two factors.

(3)The first factor is whether the arrangements, or the arrangements as proposed to be modified, represent a satisfactory means of achieving the purpose set out in section 290(4)(c).

(4)The second factor is the likely effect of the arrangements, or the arrangements as modified, on the ability of the persons who will be or are the holders of regional Channel 3 licences, or of any of them, to maintain the quality and range of—

(a)regional programmes included in regional Channel 3 services; and

(b)the other programmes included in such services which contribute to the regional character of the services.

(5)In this paragraph “regional programme”, in relation to a regional Channel 3 service, means a programme (including a news programme) which is of particular interest—

(a)to persons living within the area for which the service is provided;

(b)to persons living within a part of that area; or

(c)to particular communities living within that area.

Commencement Information

I93Sch. 11 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Duty to refuse approval in certain casesU.K.

8(1)This paragraph applies to a decision by OFCOMU.K.

(a)to approve arrangements or modifications;

(b)to impose arrangements or to modify imposed arrangements; or

(c)to propose modifications following a review under section 293.

(2)OFCOM must not make that decision if it appears to them that the arrangements, or the arrangements as proposed to be modified, would be likely to be prejudicial to the ability of holders of regional Channel 3 licences, or of any of them, to comply with—

(a)their public service remits;

(b)conditions imposed on them under section 286;

(c)conditions imposed on them under section 287; or

(d)conditions imposed on them under section 352.

Commencement Information

I94Sch. 11 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Appeals against decisions relating to competition testU.K.

9(1)A person holding a regional Channel 3 licence may appeal to the Tribunal against the following decisions by OFCOMU.K.

(a)a decision on how to dispose of an application for the approval of arrangements or modifications;

(b)a decision to impose arrangements or to modify imposed arrangements; or

(c)a decision to propose modifications following a review under section 293.

(2)An appeal can be made only by sending the Tribunal a notice of appeal within the period specified, in relation to the decision appealed against, in Tribunal rules.

(3)The notice of appeal must set out the grounds of appeal.

(4)The only grounds on which an appeal may be brought are—

(a)that OFCOM have wrongly decided that a competition test is or is not satisfied in relation to arrangements or modifications submitted to them for approval;

(b)that a competition test is not satisfied in the case of arrangements proposed by OFCOM;

(c)that provisions contained in arrangements proposed by OFCOM for satisfying a competition test are not required for that purpose;

(d)that the requirement to satisfy a competition test should be discharged in a different manner from that in which it would be satisfied in accordance with arrangements proposed by OFCOM.

(5)In sub-paragraph (4) “arrangements proposed by OFCOM” means—

(a)arrangements or modified arrangements as they will have effect after giving effect to changes proposed by OFCOM in giving a conditional approval;

(b)arrangements imposed by them;

(c)imposed arrangements as modified by them;

(d)arrangements as modified by proposals made by OFCOM following a review under section 293.

(6)The holder of a regional Channel 3 licence is not required by the conditions of his licence to take steps for giving effect to a decision of OFCOM at any time when an appeal under this Schedule against that decision is pending.

Commencement Information

I95Sch. 11 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Decisions on an appealU.K.

10(1)Appeals to the Tribunal under paragraph 9 are to be disposed of in accordance with this paragraph.U.K.

(2)The Tribunal shall decide the appeal on the merits and by reference to the grounds of appeal set out in the notice of appeal.

(3)The Tribunal shall decide what (if any) is the appropriate decision for OFCOM to have made in relation to the matters to which those grounds relate.

(4)The Tribunal shall then either—

(a)confirm OFCOM’s decision; or

(b)remit the matter to OFCOM with such directions (if any) as the Tribunal considers appropriate for giving effect to its decision.

(5)The Tribunal must not direct OFCOM to take any action which they would not otherwise have had power to take in relation to the matter under appeal.

(6)It shall be the duty of OFCOM to comply with every direction given to them under sub-paragraph (4).

(7)In its application to a decision of the Tribunal under this paragraph, paragraph 1(2)(b) of Schedule 4 to the Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40) (exclusion of commercial information from documents recording Tribunal decisions) is to have effect as if for the reference to the undertaking to which commercial information relates there were substituted a reference to the person to whom such information relates.

Commencement Information

I96Sch. 11 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Appeals against decisions of the TribunalU.K.

11(1)A decision of the Tribunal on an appeal under paragraph 9 may itself be appealed.U.K.

(2)An appeal under this paragraph—

(a)lies to the Court of Appeal or to the Court of Session; and

(b)must relate only to a point of law arising from the decision of the Tribunal.

(3)An appeal under this paragraph may be brought by a party to the proceedings before the Tribunal.

(4)An appeal under this paragraph requires the permission of the Tribunal or of the court to which it is to be made.

(5)In this paragraph references to a decision of the Tribunal include references to a direction given by it under paragraph 10(4).

Commencement Information

I97Sch. 11 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Information for OFCOMU.K.

12(1)OFCOM may by notice require a person—U.K.

(a)to produce to them such documents specified or described in the notice, or

(b)to furnish them with such other information so specified or described,

as they consider necessary in order to determine for the purposes of section 293 or this Schedule whether the competition tests are satisfied.

(2)A requirement imposed by a notice under this paragraph has to be complied with by producing the document, or by furnishing the required information, at the time and place specified in the notice.

(3)If the requirement is one for the furnishing of information otherwise than by the production of a document, the information must be furnished in the manner specified in the notice.

(4)The only documents that a person is required to produce by a notice under this paragraph are those that are in his custody or under his control—

(a)at the time of the notice; or

(b)at a time between that time and the time when the notice must be complied with.

Commencement Information

I98Sch. 11 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of information provisionsU.K.

13(1)The court may, on an application by OFCOM, enquire into whether any person (“the defaulter”) has refused or otherwise failed, without reasonable excuse, to comply with a requirement contained in a notice under paragraph 12.U.K.

(2)An application under sub-paragraph (1) shall include details of the possible failure which OFCOM consider has occurred.

(3)In enquiring into a case under sub-paragraph (1), the court shall hear—

(a)any witness who may be produced against or on behalf of the defaulter; and

(b)any statement which may be offered in defence.

(4)Sub-paragraphs (5) and (6) apply where the court is satisfied, after hearing any witnesses and statements as mentioned in sub-paragraph (3), that the defaulter has refused or failed, without reasonable excuse, to comply with the requirement contained in the notice under paragraph 12.

(5)The court may punish the defaulter as it would have been able to punish him had he been guilty of contempt of court.

(6)Where the defaulter is a body corporate, the power of the court to punish the defaulter includes power to punish a director or officer of the body corporate.

(7)Where the defaulter is a partnership constituted under the law of Scotland, the power of the court to punish the defaulter includes power to punish a member of the partnership.

(8)A person is guilty of an offence if he intentionally alters, suppresses or destroys a document which he has been required to produce by a notice under paragraph 12.

(9)A person is guilty of an offence if—

(a)he supplies information to OFCOM in purported compliance with a notice given to him under paragraph 12;

(b)the information is false or misleading in a material respect; and

(c)he knows that it is false or misleading in a material respect or is reckless as to whether it is false or misleading in a material respect.

(10)A person is guilty of an offence if—

(a)he supplies information to another person knowing that the information is to be used for complying with a notice under paragraph 12;

(b)the information is false or misleading in a material respect; and

(c)he knows that it is false or misleading in a material respect or is reckless as to whether it is false or misleading in a material respect.

(11)A person guilty of an offence under this paragraph shall be liable—

(a)on summary conviction, to a fine not exceeding the statutory maximum;

(b)on conviction on indictment, to imprisonment for a term not exceeding two years or to a fine, or to both.

(12)In this paragraph “the court” means—

(a)in relation to England and Wales, the High Court;

(b)in relation to Scotland, the Court of Session; and

(c)in relation to Northern Ireland, the High Court or a judge of the High Court.

Commencement Information

I99Sch. 11 para. 13 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Confidentiality and defamationU.K.

14(1)When publishing a report prepared under paragraph 4 or 5, OFCOM must have regard to the need to exclude from the publication, so far as practicable, the matters which are confidential in accordance with sub-paragraphs (2) and (3).U.K.

(2)A matter is confidential under this sub-paragraph if—

(a)it relates specifically to the affairs of a particular body; and

(b)publication of that matter would or might, in OFCOM’s opinion, seriously and prejudicially affect the interests of that body.

(3)A matter is confidential under this sub-paragraph if—

(a)it relates to the private affairs of an individual; and

(b)publication of that matter would or might, in OFCOM’s opinion, seriously and prejudicially affect the interests of that individual.

(4)For the purposes of the law of defamation absolute privilege attaches to every report prepared under paragraph 4 or 5.

Commencement Information

I100Sch. 11 para. 14 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Interpretation of ScheduleU.K.

15U.K.In this Schedule—

  • competition test” is to be construed in accordance with paragraph 6;

  • the Tribunal” means the Competition Appeal Tribunal; and

  • Tribunal rules” means rules made under section 15 of the Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40).]

Commencement Information

I101Sch. 11 para. 15 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

[F44SCHEDULE 11AU.K.Restrictions on product placement

IntroductoryU.K.

1.(1)In this Part “product placement”, in relation to a programme included in a television programme service, means the inclusion in the programme of, or of a reference to, a product, service or trade mark, where the inclusion—U.K.

(a)is for a commercial purpose;

(b)is in return for the making of any payment, or the giving of other valuable consideration, to any relevant provider or any person connected with a relevant provider; and

(c)is not prop placement.

(2)“Prop placement”, in relation to such a programme, means the inclusion in the programme of, or of a reference to, a product, service or trade mark where—

(a)the provision of the product, service or trade mark has no significant value; and

(b)no relevant provider, or person connected with a relevant provider, has received any payment or other valuable consideration in relation to its inclusion in, or the reference to it in, the programme, disregarding the costs saved by including the product, service or trademark, or a reference to it, in the programme.

2.U.K.The product placement requirements are—

(a)that the product placement does not fall within any of paragraphs 3 to 6;

(b)that all of the conditions in paragraph 7 are met; and

(c)that, where paragraph 8 applies, the condition in that paragraph is also met.

Prohibitions of product placementU.K.

3.[F45(1)Product placement falls within this paragraph if it is in a—U.K.

(a)children’s programme;

(b)news or current affairs programme;

(c)consumer affairs programme; or

(d)religious programme.]

(2)In sub-paragraph (1) “children’s programme” means a programme made—

(a)for a television programme service or for an on-demand programme service, and

(b)for viewing primarily by persons under the age of sixteen.

Textual Amendments

F45Sch. 11A para. 3(1) substituted (1.11.2020) by The Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2020 (S.I. 2020/1062), regs. 1(2), 18(a) (with Pt. 7)

4.U.K.Product placement falls within this paragraph if it is—

(a)of cigarettes or other tobacco products;

(b)by or on behalf of an undertaking whose principal activity is the manufacture or sale of cigarettes or other tobacco products; F46...

[F47(ba) of electronic cigarettes or electronic cigarette refill containers; F48...]

[F49(bb)by or on behalf of an undertaking whose principal activity is the manufacture or sale of electronic cigarettes or electronic cigarette refill containers; or]

(c)of prescription-only medicines.

5.U.K.Product placement of alcoholic drinks falls within this paragraph if—

(a)it is aimed specifically at persons under the age of eighteen; or

(b)it encourages immoderate consumption of such drinks.

6.(1)Product placement falls within this paragraph if it is in a programme to which this paragraph applies and—U.K.

F50(a). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

(b)the product placement is of anything within sub-paragraph (2); or

(c)the product placement is otherwise unsuitable.

(2)The following are within this sub-paragraph—

(a)F51... cigarette lighters, cigarette papers or pipes intended for smoking;

(b)medicinal products;

(c)alcoholic drinks;

(d)infant formulae or follow-on formulae;

(e)a food or drink high in fat, salt or sugar;

(f)gambling services.

(3)This paragraph applies to—

(a)a programme that has been produced or commissioned by the provider of the television programme service in which it is included, or by a person connected with that provider, and that is not a film made for cinema; and

(b)a programme that has been produced or commissioned by any other person with a view to its first showing taking place in a television programme service [F52that falls within section 211(2)].

Textual Amendments

F50Sch. 11A para. 6(1)(a) omitted (1.11.2020) by virtue of The Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2020 (S.I. 2020/1062), regs. 1(2), 18(d) (with Pt. 7)

F51Words in Sch. 11A para. 6(2)(a) omitted (20.5.2016) by virtue of The Tobacco and Related Products Regulations 2016 (S.I. 2016/507), regs. 1(2), 45(2)(c) (with reg. 57)

Conditions applying to product placementU.K.

7.(1)These are the conditions referred to in paragraph 2(b).U.K.

F53(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

(3)Condition B is that the product placement has not influenced the content or scheduling of the programme in a way that affects the editorial independence of the provider of the television programme service in which the programme is included.

(4)Condition C is that the product placement does not directly encourage the purchase or rental of goods or services, whether by making promotional reference to those goods or services or otherwise.

(5)Condition D is that the programme does not give undue prominence to the products, services or trade marks concerned.

(6)Condition E is that the product placement does not use techniques which exploit the possibility of conveying a message subliminally or surreptitiously.

(7)Condition F is that the way in which the product, service or trade mark, or the reference to it, is included in the programme by way of product placement does not—

(a)prejudice respect for human dignity;

(b)promote discrimination based on sex, racial or ethnic origin, nationality, religion or belief, disability, age or sexual orientation;

(c)encourage behaviour prejudicial to health or safety;

(d)encourage behaviour grossly prejudicial to the protection of the environment;

(e)cause physical [F54, mental] or moral detriment to persons under the age of eighteen;

[F55(ea)directly exhort such persons to purchase or rent goods or services in a manner which exploits their inexperience or credulity;]

(f)directly encourage such persons to persuade their parents or others to purchase or rent goods or services;

(g)exploit the trust of such persons in parents, teachers or others; or

(h)unreasonably show such persons in dangerous situations.

Textual Amendments

F53Sch. 11A para. 7(2) omitted (1.11.2020) by virtue of The Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2020 (S.I. 2020/1062), regs. 1(2), 18(e) (with Pt. 7)

F54Word in Sch. 11A para. 7(7)(e) inserted (1.11.2020) by The Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2020 (S.I. 2020/1062), regs. 1(2), 18(f)(i) (with Pt. 7)

8.(1)This paragraph applies where the programme featuring the product placement has been produced or commissioned by the provider of the television programme service in which it is included or by a person connected with that provider.U.K.

(2)The condition referred to in paragraph 2(c) is that the television programme service in which the programme is included signals appropriately the fact that product placement is contained in a programme no less frequently than—

(a)at the start and end of such a programme; and

(b)in the case of a television programme service which includes advertising breaks within it, at the recommencement of the programme after each such advertising break.

Minor definitionsU.K.

9.U.K.In this Schedule—

  • “connected” has the same meaning as it has in the Broadcasting Act 1990 by virtue of section 202 of that Act;

  • [F56“electronic cigarette” has the meaning given in section 368R;

  • “electronic cigarette refill container” has the meaning given in section 368R;]

  • “film made for cinema” means a film made with a view to its being shown to the general public first in a cinema;

  • “follow-on formulae” has the meaning given in Article 2 of Commission Directive 2006/141/EC on infant formulae and follow-on formulae and amending Directive 1999/21/EC;

  • “infant formulae” has the meaning given in Article 2 of Commission Directive 2006/141/EC on infant formulae and follow-on formulae and amending Directive 1999/21/EC;

  • “medicinal product” has the meaning given in section 130 of the Medicines Act 1968;

  • “prescription-only medicine” means a medicinal product of a description or falling within a class specified in an order made under section 58 of the Medicines Act 1968;

  • “producer”, in relation to a programme, means the person by whom the arrangements necessary for the making of the programme are undertaken;

  • “programme” does not include an advertisement;

  • “relevant provider”, in relation to a programme, means—

    (a)

    the provider of the television programme service in which the programme is included; and

    (b)

    the producer of the programme;

  • “residual value” means any monetary or other economic value in the hands of the relevant provider other than the cost saving of including the product, service or trademark, or a reference to it, in a programme;

  • “significant value” means a residual value that is more than trivial;

  • “tobacco product” has the meaning given in section 1 of the Tobacco Advertising and Promotion Act 2002;

  • “trade mark”, in relation to a business, includes any image (such as a logo) or sound commonly associated with that business or its products or services.]

Textual Amendments

F56Words in Sch. 11A para. 9 inserted (20.5.2016) by The Tobacco and Related Products Regulations 2016 (S.I. 2016/507), regs. 1(2), 45(2)(d) (with reg. 57)

Section 338

SCHEDULE 12U.K.Corresponding obligations of the BBC and Welsh Authority

Part 1U.K.The BBC

Quotas for independent productionsU.K.

1(1)It shall be the duty of the BBC to secure that, in each year, not less than 25 per cent. of the total amount of time allocated to the broadcasting of qualifying programmes included in the television broadcasting services provided by the BBC is allocated to the broadcasting of a range and diversity of independent productions.U.K.

(2)In this paragraph—

(a)a reference to qualifying programmes is a reference to programmes of such description as the Secretary of State may by order specify as describing the programmes that are to be qualifying programmes for the purposes of this paragraph;

(b)a reference to independent productions is a reference to programmes of such description as the Secretary of State may by order specify as describing the programmes that are to be independent productions for the purposes of this paragraph; and

(c)a reference to a range of independent productions is a reference to a range of such productions in terms of cost of acquisition as well as in terms of the types of programme involved.

(3)The Secretary of State may by order amend sub-paragraph (1) by substituting a different percentage for the percentage for the time being specified in that sub-paragraph.

(4)The Secretary of State may also by order provide for the BBC to have the duty set out in sub-paragraph (5), either instead of or as well as the one set out in sub-paragraph (1).

(5)That duty is a duty to secure that, in each year, not less than the percentage specified in the order of the programming budget for that year for the television broadcasting services provided by the BBC is applied in the acquisition of independent productions.

(6)The power to make an order under sub-paragraph (4) includes power to provide that the BBC are again to be subject to a duty to which they have previously ceased to be subject by virtue of such an order, in addition to or instead of the duty to which they are subject (apart from the exercise of that power) by virtue of this paragraph.

(7)The Secretary of State is not to make an order for the BBC to be or to cease to be subject to the duty mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) or (5) unless—

(a)OFCOM have made a recommendation to him that the BBC should be subject to that duty, or should cease to be subject to it; and

(b)the order gives effect to that recommendation.

(8)Where television broadcasting services are designated by or under the BBC Charter and Agreement—

(a)as services that must be treated separately for the purposes of the duty imposed by sub-paragraph (1) or a duty imposed under sub-paragraph (4), or

(b)as services that must be included in a group of services that must be taken together for the purposes of such a duty,

that duty is to have effect in accordance with sub-paragraph (9).

(9)A duty having effect in accordance with this sub-paragraph is to have effect as if (instead of applying to all the television broadcasting services provided by the BBC, taken together) it applied separately—

(a)in relation to each service that is required to be treated separately; and

(b)in relation to each group of services that are required to be taken together.

(10)The BBC must comply with directions given to them by OFCOM for the purpose of—

(a)carrying forward to one or more subsequent years determined in accordance with the direction any shortfall for any year in their compliance with the duties imposed by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) or (4); and

(b)thereby increasing the percentage applicable for the purposes of those duties to the subsequent year or years.

(11)For the purposes of this paragraph—

(a)the amount of the programming budget for a year, and

(b)the means of determining the amount of that budget that is applied for any purpose,

are to be computed in accordance with such provision as may be set out in an order made by the Secretary of State, or as may be determined by OFCOM in accordance with such an order.

(12)Before making an order under this paragraph the Secretary of State must consult OFCOM and the BBC.

(13)No order is to be made containing provision authorised by this paragraph unless a draft of the order has been laid before Parliament and approved by a resolution of each House.

(14)In this paragraph—

  • acquisition”, in relation to a programme, includes commissioning and acquiring a right to include it in a service or to have it broadcast; and

  • programming budget” means the budget for the production and acquisition of qualifying programmes.

Commencement Information

I102Sch. 12 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Duty to publicise complaints procedures etc.U.K.

2(1)It shall be the duty of the BBC to make arrangements for securing that the matters mentioned in sub-paragraph (2) are brought to the attention of the public (whether by means of broadcasts or otherwise).U.K.

(2)Those matters are—

(a)OFCOM’s functions under Part 5 of the 1996 Act in relation to services provided by the BBC; and

(b)any procedures established by OFCOM or the BBC for the handling and resolution of complaints about the observance by the BBC of standards set under section 319 [F57or about compliance by the BBC with the requirements imposed by section 368D] [F58and section 368E(4)].

Textual Amendments

F57Words in Sch. 12 para. 2(2)(b) inserted (19.12.2009) by Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2009 (S.I. 2009/2979), regs. 1(1), 3(2)

Commencement Information

I103Sch. 12 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Part 2U.K.The Welsh Authority

Public service remits of the Welsh Authority servicesU.K.

3(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to secure that the public service remits for each of their public television services is fulfilled.U.K.

(2)The public service remit for S4C is the provision of a broad range of high quality and diverse programming in a service in which—

(a)a substantial proportion of the programmes consists of programmes in Welsh;

(b)the programmes broadcast for viewing between 6:30 PM and 10:00 PM on every day of the week consist mainly of programmes in Welsh; and

(c)the programmes that are not in Welsh are normally programmes which are being, have been or are to be broadcast on Channel 4.

(3)The public service remit for S4C Digital is the provision of a broad range of high quality and diverse programming in a service in which a substantial proportion of the programmes consists of programmes in Welsh.

(4)The public service remit for a television programme service provided by the Welsh Authority with the approval of the Secretary of State under section 205 is the remit set out in the order approving the provision of the service.

(5)The Secretary of State may by order modify sub-paragraphs (2) and (3).

(6)Before making an order specifying or modifying the public service remit for any of the Welsh Authority’s public television services, the Secretary of State must consult—

(a)the Authority; and

(b)where the order relates to the inclusion in any service of programmes that are not in Welsh, C4C.

(7)An order modifying the public service remit for S4C or S4C Digital must not contain provision inconsistent with a requirement that each service must—

(a)represent a public service for the dissemination of information, education and entertainment; and

(b)include programmes a substantial proportion of which consists of programmes in Welsh.

(8)No order is to be made containing provision authorised by sub-paragraph (5) unless a draft of the order has been laid before Parliament and approved by a resolution of each House.

Commencement Information

I104Sch. 12 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Statements of programme policyU.K.

4(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority—U.K.

(a)as soon as practicable after the coming into force of this paragraph, and subsequently at annual intervals, to prepare a statement of programme policy; and

(b)to monitor their own performance in the carrying out of the proposals contained in statements made under this paragraph.

(2)Every statement of programme policy prepared under this paragraph must set out the Welsh Authority’s proposals for securing that, during the following year—

(a)the public service remit for each of their public television services to be provided during that year will be fulfilled; and

(b)the Welsh Authority’s duties under the provisions of this Schedule will be performed.

(3)Every such statement must contain a report on the performance of the Welsh Authority in the carrying out during the period since the previous statement of the proposals contained in that previous statement.

(4)When preparing such a statement, the Welsh Authority must consider—

(a)any guidance by OFCOM that is in force for the purposes of section 266; and

(b)any reports previously published by OFCOM under section 264 or 358.

(5)Every such statement must be published by the Welsh Authority as soon as practicable after its preparation is complete.

(6)OFCOM may direct that any statement of policy which—

(a)was made by the Welsh Authority before the coming into force of this paragraph, and

(b)is specified in the direction,

is to be treated for the purposes of this Act as if it were a statement made in relation to such period as may be so specified in pursuance of this paragraph.

(7)A direction under sub-paragraph (6) cannot contain provision the effect of which is to postpone the time at which the Welsh Authority would otherwise be required to make its first statement of programme policy.

Commencement Information

I105Sch. 12 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Prospective

Must-offer obligations in relation to networks and satellite servicesU.K.

5(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to ensure that each of their public digital services is at all times offered as available (subject to the need to agree terms)—U.K.

(a)to be broadcast or distributed by means of every appropriate network; and

(b)to be broadcast by means of every satellite television service that is available for reception by members of the public in Wales.

(2)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to do their best to secure that arrangements are entered into, and kept in force, that ensure—

(a)that each of their public digital services is broadcast or distributed on appropriate networks; and

(b)that the broadcasting and distribution of each of their public digital services, in accordance with those arrangements, result in the service being available for reception, by means of appropriate networks, by as many members of its intended audience as practicable.

(3)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to do their best to secure that arrangements are entered into, and kept in force, that ensure—

(a)that each of their public digital services is broadcast by means of satellite television services that are broadcast so as to be available for reception by members of the public in Wales; and

(b)that the broadcasting, in accordance with those arrangements, of each of the Authority’s public digital services by means of satellite television services results in its being available for reception in an intelligible form and by means of those services by as many members of its intended audience as practicable.

(4)The Welsh Authority must secure that the arrangements entered into and kept in force for the purposes of sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) prohibit the imposition, for or in connection with the provision of an appropriate network or a satellite television service, of any charge that is attributable (whether directly or indirectly) to the conferring of an entitlement to receive each of the Authority’s public digital services in an intelligible form by means of that network or service.

(5)OFCOM may, by a direction to the Welsh Authority, require arrangements made or kept in force for the purposes of sub-paragraphs (2) or (3) to apply in the case of every service which is an ancillary service by reference to one of their public digital services as they apply to the service itself.

(6)For the purposes of this paragraph a public digital service of the Welsh Authority is to be treated, in relation to particular appropriate networks and satellite television services, as constituting such services comprised in or provided with that public digital service—

(a)as may be determined by agreement between the Welsh Authority and OFCOM; or

(b)in default of agreement, as may be directed by OFCOM.

(7)This paragraph—

(a)so far as it relates to the broadcasting or distribution of any of the Welsh Authority’s public digital services by means of appropriate networks, applies only in relation to times when that service is included in the list of must-carry services in section 64; and

(b)so far as it relates to the broadcasting of such a public digital service by means of a satellite television service, applies only in relation to times when that service is included in the list of must-provide services in section 275.

(8)In this paragraph—

  • appropriate network” means an electronic communications network by means of which public electronic communications services are provided that are used by a significant number of end-users in Wales as their principal means of receiving television programmes;

  • intended audience”, in relation to a public digital service of the Welsh Authority, means—

    (a)

    if the service is one provided only for a particular area or locality of Wales, members of the public in that area or locality;

    (b)

    if the service is one provided for members of a particular community, members of that community; and

    (c)

    in any other case, members of the public in Wales;

  • public digital service”, in relation to the Welsh Authority, means any of their public television services so far as it is provided in digital form; and

  • satellite television service” means a service which—

    (a)

    consists in or involves the broadcasting of television programme services from a satellite; and

    (b)

    is used by a significant number of the persons by whom the broadcasts are received in an intelligible form as their principal means of receiving television programmes.

(9)For the purposes of this paragraph an electronic communications network is not an appropriate network in relation to so much of a channel or other service as is provided only for a particular area or locality of Wales unless it is a network by means of which electronic communications services are provided to persons in that area or locality

(10)In sub-paragraph (8) “public electronic communications service” and “end-user” each has the same meaning as in Chapter 1 of Part 2.

(11)An order under section 411 must not appoint a day for provisions of this paragraph to come into force that falls less than six months after the day on which the order is made.

Prospective

Supply of services by satellite in certain areasU.K.

6U.K.It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority—

(a)to join with the providers of other must-provide services in entering into and maintaining arrangements satisfying the requirements of section 274; and

(b)to comply with the requirements of any arrangements imposed by OFCOM for the purposes of conditions under subsection (2) of that section.

Programming quotas for independent productionsU.K.

7(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to secure that, in each year, not less than 25 per cent. of the total amount of time allocated to the broadcasting of qualifying programmes included in their designated public services (taken together) is allocated to the broadcasting of a range and diversity of independent productions.U.K.

(2)In this paragraph—

(a)a reference to qualifying programmes is a reference to programmes of such description as the Secretary of State may by order specify as describing the programmes that are to be qualifying programmes for the purposes of this paragraph;

(b)a reference to independent productions is a reference to programmes of such description as the Secretary of State may by order specify as describing the programmes that are to be independent productions for the purposes of this paragraph; and

(c)a reference to a range of independent productions is a reference to a range of such productions in terms of cost of acquisition as well as in terms of the types of programme involved.

(3)The Secretary of State may by order amend sub-paragraph (1) by substituting a different percentage for the percentage for the time being specified in that sub-paragraph.

(4)The Secretary of State may also by order provide for the Welsh Authority to have the duty set out in sub-paragraph (5), either instead of or as well as the one set out in sub-paragraph (1).

(5)That duty is a duty to secure that, in each year, not less than the percentage specified in the order of the programming budget for that year for the designated public services (taken together) is applied in the acquisition of independent productions.

(6)The power to make an order under sub-paragraph (4) includes power to provide that the Welsh Authority are again to be subject to a duty to which they have previously ceased to be subject by virtue of such an order, in addition to or instead of the duty to which they are subject (apart from the exercise of that power) by virtue of this paragraph.

(7)The Secretary of State is not to make an order for the Welsh Authority to be or to cease to be subject to the duty mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) or (5) unless—

(a)OFCOM have made a recommendation to him that the Authority should be subject to that duty, or should cease to be subject to it; and

(b)the order gives effect to that recommendation.

(8)The Welsh Authority must comply with directions given to them by OFCOM for the purpose of—

(a)carrying forward to one or more subsequent years determined in accordance with the direction any shortfall for any year in their compliance with the duties imposed by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) or (4); and

(b)thereby increasing the percentage applicable for the purposes of those duties to the subsequent year or years.

(9)For the purposes of this paragraph—

(a)the amount of the programming budget for a year, and

(b)the means of determining the amount of that budget that is applied for any purpose,

are to be computed in accordance with such provision as may be set out in an order made by the Secretary of State, or as may be determined by OFCOM in accordance with such an order.

(10)Before making an order under this paragraph the Secretary of State must consult OFCOM, the BBC and the Welsh Authority.

(11)No order is to be made containing provision authorised by this paragraph unless a draft of the order has been laid before Parliament and approved by a resolution of each House.

(12)The services that are designated public services for the purposes of this paragraph are—

(a)S4C;

(b)S4C Digital; and

(c)any of the Welsh Authority’s other public television services which is designated for the purposes of this paragraph by the order under section 205 approving its provision.

(13)In this paragraph—

  • acquisition”, in relation to a programme, includes commissioning and acquiring a right to include it in a service or to have it broadcast;

  • programme” does not include an advertisement; and

  • programming budget” means the budget for the production and acquisition of qualifying programmes.

Commencement Information

I106Sch. 12 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Programme quotas for original productionsU.K.

8(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority, in relation to their designated public services (taken together) to secure—U.K.

(a)that the time allocated, in each year, to the broadcasting of original productions included in those services is no less than the proportion fixed under sub-paragraph (2) of the total amount of time allocated to the broadcasting of all the programmes included in those services; and

(b)that the time allocated to the broadcasting of original productions is split in the manner so fixed between peak viewing times and other times.

(2)The fixing for the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) of a proportion or manner of splitting allocated time is to be—

(a)by agreement between the Welsh Authority and OFCOM; or

(b)in default of agreement, by a direction given by OFCOM to the Authority fixing the proportion or manner according to whatever OFCOM consider appropriate for ensuring that the service is consistently of a high quality.

(3)The agreement or direction may, for the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(b), fix a proportion for the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(a) in terms of the cumulative effect of two different minimum proportions, one applying to peak viewing times and the other to other times.

(4)The agreement or direction may provide that specified descriptions of programmes are to be excluded in determining the programmes a proportion of which is to constitute original productions.

(5)It may also provide that, in determining whether a programme is of a description of programmes excluded by an agreement or direction by virtue of sub-paragraph (4), regard is to be had to any guidance prepared and published, and from to time revised, by OFCOM.

(6)References in this paragraph, in relation to the designated public services of the Welsh Authority, to original productions are references to programmes of such description as the Secretary of State may by order specify as describing the programmes that are to be original productions for the purposes of this paragraph.

(7)The power to specify descriptions of programmes by order under sub-paragraph (6) includes power to confer such discretions on OFCOM as the Secretary of State thinks fit.

(8)Before making an order under this paragraph the Secretary of State must consult OFCOM, the BBC and the Welsh Authority.

(9)No order is to be made containing provision authorised by this paragraph unless a draft of the order has been laid before Parliament and approved by a resolution of each House.

(10)The services that are designated public services for the purposes of this paragraph are—

(a)S4C;

(b)S4C Digital; and

(c)any of the Welsh Authority’s other public television services which is designated for the purposes of this paragraph by the order under section 205 approving its provision.

(11)In this paragraph—

  • peak viewing time”, in relation to the designated public services of the Welsh Authority, means a time that is determined in accordance with sub-paragraph (12) to be a peak viewing time for one or more of those services; and

  • programme” does not include an advertisement.

(12)The determination for the purposes of this paragraph of peak viewing times is to be—

(a)by agreement between the Welsh Authority and OFCOM; or

(b)in default of agreement, by a direction given by OFCOM to the Authority determining those times.

Commencement Information

I107Sch. 12 para. 8 in force at 1.7.2004 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 4(4)(c) (with art. 11) (as amended (4.3.2004) by S.I. 2004/545, art. 2(2)(3)(c))

News and current affairs programmesU.K.

9(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority, in relation to their designated public services, to secure—U.K.

(a)that the programmes included in each service include news programmes and current affairs programmes;

(b)that the news programmes and current affairs programmes included in each service deal with both national and international matters; and

(c)that the news programmes so included are broadcast for viewing at intervals throughout the period for which the service is provided.

(2)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority, in relation to each of their designated public services, to ensure that the news programmes and current affairs programmes included in each service are of high quality.

(3)It shall also be the duty of the Welsh Authority, in relation to each of their designated public services, to secure that in each year—

(a)the time allocated to the broadcasting of news programmes included in the service, and

(b)the time allocated to the broadcasting of current affairs programmes so included,

each constitutes no less than the proportion fixed under sub-paragraph (5) of the time allocated to the broadcasting of all the programmes included in the service.

(4)It is the further duty of the Welsh Authority, in relation to each of their designated public services, to secure that the time allocated—

(a)to the broadcasting of news programmes included in the service, and

(b)to the broadcasting of current affairs programmes so included,

is, in each case, split, in the manner fixed under sub-paragraph (5), between peak viewing times and other times.

(5)The fixing for the purposes of sub-paragraph (3) or (4) of a proportion or manner of splitting allocated time is to be—

(a)by agreement between the Welsh Authority and OFCOM; or

(b)in default of agreement, by a direction given by OFCOM to the Authority fixing the proportion or manner according to whatever OFCOM consider appropriate.

(6)The agreement or direction may, for the purposes of sub-paragraph (4), fix a proportion for the purposes of sub-paragraph (3) in terms of the cumulative effect of two different minimum proportions, one applying to peak viewing times and the other to other times.

(7)The services that are designated public services for the purposes of this paragraph are—

(a)S4C;

(b)S4C Digital; and

(c)any of the Welsh Authority’s other public television services which is designated for the purposes of this paragraph by the order under section 205 approving its provision.

(8)In this paragraph “peak viewing time”, in relation to a service, means a time that is determined in accordance with sub-paragraph (9) to be a peak viewing time for that service.

(9)The determination for the purposes of this paragraph of a peak viewing time is to be—

(a)by agreement between the Welsh Authority and OFCOM; or

(b)in default of agreement, by a direction given by OFCOM to the Authority determining that time.

Commencement Information

I108Sch. 12 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Code relating to programme commissioningU.K.

10(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to draw up and from time to time revise a code of practice setting out the principles that are to be applied when they or an S4C company are for a relevant purpose agreeing terms for the commissioning of independent productions.U.K.

(2)A relevant purpose is a purpose connected with the provision by the Welsh Authority or an S4C company of a programme service.

(3)It shall also be the duty of the Welsh Authority—

(a)at all times to comply with the code of practice which is for the time being in force under this paragraph;

(b)to take all reasonable steps for securing that the code is complied with by S4C companies;

(c)to exercise their power to revise that code to take account of revisions from time to time of the guidance issued by OFCOM for the purposes of this paragraph; and

(d)to comply with such directions as may be given to the Authority by OFCOM for securing that they properly perform their duties under paragraphs (a) and (b).

(4)The code for the time being in force under this paragraph must be such as to secure, in the manner described in guidance issued by OFCOM—

(a)that a reasonable timetable is applied to negotiations for the commissioning of an independent production and for the conclusion of a binding agreement;

(b)that there is sufficient clarity when an independent production is commissioned about the different categories of rights to broadcast or otherwise to make use of or exploit the commissioned production that are being disposed of;

(c)that there is sufficient transparency about the amounts to be paid in respect of each category of rights;

(d)that satisfactory arrangements are made about the duration and exclusivity of those rights;

(e)that procedures exist for reviewing the arrangements adopted in accordance with the code and for demonstrating compliance with it;

(f)that those procedures include requirements for the monitoring of the application of the code and for the making of reports to OFCOM;

(g)that provision is made for resolving disputes arising in respect of the provisions of the code (by independent arbitration or otherwise) in a manner that appears to OFCOM to be appropriate.

(5)The Welsh Authority must also ensure that the drawing up or revision of a code by virtue of this paragraph is in accordance with guidance issued by OFCOM as to—

(a)the times when the code is to be drawn up or reviewed with a view to revision;

(b)the consultation to be undertaken before a code is drawn up or revised;

(c)the publication of every code or revised code.

(6)The Welsh Authority must submit to OFCOM for approval a draft of—

(a)every code that is required to be drawn up under this paragraph; and

(b)every revision made by that Authority of such a code.

(7)A code drawn up by the Welsh Authority or a revision of such a code —

(a)is to have effect for the purposes of this paragraph only if approved by OFCOM; and

(b)if approved by OFCOM subject to modifications, is to have effect with those modifications.

(8)OFCOM—

(a)must issue and may from time to time revise guidance for the purposes of this paragraph;

(b)must ensure that there is always guidance for those purposes in force;

(c)must, before issuing their guidance or revised guidance, consult the providers of licensed public service channels, persons who make independent productions (or persons appearing to OFCOM to represent them), the BBC and the Welsh Authority; and

(d)must publish their guidance or revised guidance in such manner as they think appropriate.

(9)Guidance issued by OFCOM for the purposes of this paragraph must be general guidance and is not to specify particular terms to be included in agreements to which the guidance relates.

(10)OFCOM may by a direction to the Welsh Authority specify that a code which—

(a)was drawn up by the Authority before the commencement of this paragraph, and

(b)is identified in the direction,

is to be treated as drawn up in pursuance of this paragraph and approved by OFCOM.

(11)In this paragraph “independent production” has the same meaning as in paragraph 7.

Commencement Information

I109Sch. 12 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Co-operation with the public teletext providerU.K.

11(1)The Welsh Authority must grant access to the public teletext provider to the facilities that are reasonably required by him for the purposes of, or in connection with, the provision of the public teletext service.U.K.

(2)The Welsh Authority may require the public teletext provider to pay a reasonable charge in respect of facilities access to which is granted under this paragraph.

(3)In the event of a dispute, the amount of the charge is to be determined by OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I110Sch. 12 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Programme standardsU.K.

12U.K.It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority in relation to their public television services to observe the standards set under section 319.

Commencement Information

I111Sch. 12 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

13U.K.It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to comply with a direction given to them by OFCOM with respect to the establishment of procedures for the handling and resolution of complaints about the observance by the Authority of standards set under section 319.

Commencement Information

I112Sch. 12 para. 13 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

14(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to comply with directions given to them by OFCOM with respect to any of the matters mentioned in sub-paragraph (2).U.K.

(2)Those matters are—

(a)the exclusion from any of the Authority’s public television services of a particular advertisement, or its exclusion in particular circumstances;

(b)the descriptions of advertisements and methods of advertising to be excluded from the services so provided (whether generally or in particular circumstances); F59...

(c)the methods of sponsorship to be excluded from those services (whether generally or in particular circumstances) [F60; and

(d)the forms and methods of product placement to be excluded from those services (including descriptions of products, services or trade marks product placement of which is to be excluded) (whether generally or in particular circumstances).]

Textual Amendments

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

Commencement Information

I113Sch. 12 para. 14 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

15(1)This paragraph applies if OFCOM are satisfied—U.K.

[F61(a)that the Welsh Authority have failed in any respect to perform any of their duties under—

(i)paragraphs 12 to 14,

(ii)paragraph 23A,

(iii)section 368D(1) except so far as it relates to advertising,

(iv)section 368D(2),

(v)section 368D(3)(zza), (zb), (a) or (b), or

(vi)section 368E(4) except so far as it relates to advertising; and]

(b)that the failure can be appropriately remedied by the inclusion in any or all of the Authority’s public television services [F62or on-demand programme services] of a correction or a statement of findings.

(2)OFCOM may direct the Welsh Authority to include a correction or a statement of findings (or both) in any one or more of their public television services [F63or on-demand programme services] .

(3)A direction may require the correction or statement of findings to be in such form, and to be included in programmes at such time or times, as OFCOM may determine.

(4)OFCOM are not to give a direction under this paragraph unless they have given the Welsh Authority a reasonable opportunity of making representations to them about the matters appearing to OFCOM to provide grounds for the giving of the direction.

(5)Where the Welsh Authority include a correction or a statement of findings in any of their public television services [F64or on-demand programme services] in pursuance of a direction under this paragraph, the Authority may announce that they are doing so in pursuance of such a direction.

(6)For the purposes of this paragraph a statement of findings, in relation to a case in which OFCOM are satisfied that the Welsh Authority have failed to perform a duty [F65mentioned in sub-paragraph (1)(a)] , is a statement of OFCOM’s findings in relation to that failure.

Textual Amendments

F62Words in Sch. 12 para. 15(1)(b) inserted (19.12.2009) by Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2009 (S.I. 2009/2979), regs. 1(1), 4(2)(b)

F63Words in Sch. 12 para. 15(2) inserted (19.12.2009) by Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2009 (S.I. 2009/2979), regs. 1(1), 4(2)(b)

F64Words in Sch. 12 para. 15(5) inserted (19.12.2009) by Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2009 (S.I. 2009/2979), regs. 1(1), 4(2)(b)

F65Words in Sch. 12 para. 15(6) substituted (18.3.2010) by The Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2010 (S.I. 2010/419), regs. 1(1), 14(3)

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

Commencement Information

I114Sch. 12 para. 15 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Directions with respect to advertisingU.K.

16(1)The Welsh Authority must comply with directions given to them by OFCOM with respect to any of the matters mentioned in sub-paragraph (2).U.K.

(2)Those matters are—

(a)the maximum amount of time to be given to advertisements in any hour or other period;

(b)the minimum interval which must elapse between any two periods given over to advertisements;

(c)the number of such periods to be allowed in any programme or in any hour or day; and

(d)the exclusion of advertisements from a specified part of S4C or S4C Digital.

(3)Directions under this paragraph—

(a)may be either general or specific;

(b)may be qualified or unqualified; and

(c)may make different provision for different parts of the day, different days of the week, different types of programmes or for other differing circumstances.

(4)In giving a direction under this paragraph, OFCOM shall take account of such of the international obligations of the United Kingdom as the Secretary of State may notify to them for the purposes of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I115Sch. 12 para. 16 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Fairness standardsU.K.

17U.K.It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to secure the observance—

(a)in connection with the provision of their public television services, and

(b)in relation to the programmes included in those services,

of the code for the time being in force under section 107 of the 1996 Act (the fairness code).

Commencement Information

I116Sch. 12 para. 17 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Party political broadcastsU.K.

18(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to include—U.K.

(a)party political broadcasts, and

(b)referendum campaign broadcasts,

in every designated public service of theirs.

(2)The Welsh Authority must prepare, publish and from time to time review and revise their policy with respect to—

(a)party political broadcasts and referendum campaign broadcasts; and

(b)the manner in which they propose to perform their duty under sub-paragraph (1).

(3)The Welsh Authority’s policy may, in particular, include provision for determining—

(a)the political parties on whose behalf party political broadcasts may be made;

(b)in relation to each political party on whose behalf such broadcasts may be made, the length and frequency of the broadcasts; and

(c)in relation to each designated organisation on whose behalf referendum campaign broadcasts are required to be broadcast, the length and frequency of such broadcasts.

(4)That policy is to have effect subject to sections 37 and 127 of the Political Parties, Elections and Referendums Act 2000 (c. 41) (only registered parties and designated organisations to be entitled to party political broadcasts or referendum campaign broadcasts).

(5)In preparing or revising their policy with respect to the inclusion of party political broadcasts or referendum campaign broadcasts in their designated public services, the Welsh Authority must have regard to—

(a)any views expressed for the purposes of this paragraph by the Electoral Commission; and

(b)any rules made by OFCOM under section 333.

(6)The services that are designated public services for the purposes of this paragraph are—

(a)S4C;

(b)S4C Digital; and

(c)any of the Welsh Authority’s other public television services which is designated for the purposes of this paragraph by the order under section 205 approving its provision.

(7)In this paragraph—

  • designated organisation”, in relation to a referendum, means a person or body designated by the Electoral Commission under section 108 of the Political Parties, Elections and Referendums Act 2000 in respect of that referendum; and

  • referendum campaign broadcast” has the meaning given by section 127 of that Act.

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

Commencement Information

I117Sch. 12 para. 18 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Duty to publicise complaints procedures etc.U.K.

19(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to make arrangements for securing that the matters mentioned in sub-paragraph (2) are brought to the attention of the public (whether by means of broadcasts or otherwise).U.K.

(2)Those matters are—

(a)OFCOM’s functions under Part 5 of the 1996 Act in relation to services provided by the Welsh Authority; and

(b)any procedures established by OFCOM or the Authority for the handling and resolution of complaints about the observance by the Authority of standards set under section 319 [F66or about compliance by the Authority with the requirements imposed by section 368D [F67and section 368E(4)], except the [F68requirements mentioned in sub-paragraph (3)]].

[F69(3)The requirements mentioned in this sub-paragraph are—

(a)the requirements imposed by sections 368D(1) and 368E(4) so far as they relate to advertising, and

(b)the requirement imposed by section 368D(3)(za).]

Textual Amendments

F66Words in Sch. 12 para. 19(2)(b) inserted (19.12.2009) by Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2009 (S.I. 2009/2979), regs. 1(1), 4(3)

F68Words in Sch. 12 para. 19(2)(b) substituted (18.3.2010) by virtue of The Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2010 (S.I. 2010/419), regs. 1(1), 14(4)

Commencement Information

I118Sch. 12 para. 19 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Monitoring of programmesU.K.

20(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority—U.K.

(a)in respect of every programme included in any of their public television services, to retain a recording of the programme in the form, and for the period, specified by OFCOM;

(b)to comply with any request to produce such recordings to OFCOM for examination or reproduction; and

(c)to comply, to the extent that they are able to do so, with any request to produce to OFCOM a script or transcript of a programme included in any of their public television services.

(2)The period specified for the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(a) must be a period not exceeding ninety days.

Commencement Information

I119Sch. 12 para. 20 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Compliance with international obligationsU.K.

21(1)OFCOM may give the Welsh Authority such directions as OFCOM consider appropriate for securing that all relevant international obligations are complied with.U.K.

(2)It shall be the duty of the Authority to comply with a direction under this paragraph.

(3)Before giving a direction under this paragraph, OFCOM must consult the Authority.

(4)In this paragraph “relevant international obligations” means the international obligations of the United Kingdom which have been notified to OFCOM by the Secretary of State for the purposes of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I120Sch. 12 para. 21 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Services for [F70people with disabilities] U.K.

22U.K.It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to observe the code for the time being in force under section 303 in the provision of—

(a)S4C Digital; and

(b)so much of any of the Welsh Authority’s other public television services as is provided in digital form.

Commencement Information

I121Sch. 12 para. 22 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Equality of opportunityU.K.

23(1)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to make such arrangements as they consider appropriate for promoting, in relation to employment with the Authority, equality of opportunity—U.K.

(a)between men and women; and

(b)between persons of different racial groups.

(2)It shall be the duty of the Welsh Authority to make arrangements for promoting, in relation to employment with the Authority, the equalisation of opportunities for disabled persons.

(3)The Welsh Authority shall also make such arrangements as they consider appropriate for the training and retraining of persons whom they employ in or in connection with—

(a)the provision of one or more of their public services; or

(b)the making of programmes to be included in one or more of those services.

(4)The Welsh Authority—

(a)shall take all such steps as they consider appropriate for making persons affected by any arrangements made in pursuance of sub-paragraphs (1) to (3) aware of the arrangements (including the publication of the arrangements in such manner as they think fit);

(b)shall review the arrangements from time to time; and

(c)shall, from time to time (and at least annually), publish, in such manner as they consider appropriate, their observations on the current operation and effectiveness of the arrangements.

(5)Before making any arrangements in pursuance of any of sub-paragraphs (1) to (3) or determining the manner in which they will comply with sub-paragraph (4), the Welsh Authority must consult OFCOM.

(6)In this paragraph—

  • disabled” has the same meaning as in [F71the Equality Act 2010 or, in Northern Ireland,] the Disability Discrimination Act 1995 (c. 50);

  • racial group” has the same meaning as in the [F72Race Relations Act 1976 (c. 74)] [F72the Equality Act 2010] or, in Northern Ireland, the Race Relations (Northern Ireland) Order 1997 (S.I. 1997/869 (N.I. 6)).

(7)The Secretary of State may by order amend sub-paragraph (1) by adding any other form of equality of opportunity that he considers appropriate to that sub-paragraph.

(8)No order is to be made containing provision authorised by sub-paragraph (7) unless a draft of the order has been laid before Parliament and approved by a resolution of each House.

Textual Amendments

F71Words in Sch. 12 para. 23(6) inserted by virtue of 2010 c. 15, Sch. 26 Pt. 1 para. 56(a) (as inserted (E.W.S.) (1.10.2010) by The Equality Act 2010 (Consequential Amendments, Saving and Supplementary Provisions) Order 2010 (S.I. 2010/2279), art. 1(2), Sch. 1 para. 5) (see S.I. 2010/2317, art. 2)

F72Words in Sch. 12 para. 23(6) substituted by 2010 c. 15, Sch. 26 Pt. 1 para. 56(b) (as inserted (E.W.S.) (1.10.2010) by The Equality Act 2010 (Consequential Amendments, Saving and Supplementary Provisions) Order 2010 (S.I. 2010/2279), art. 1(2), Sch. 1 para. 5) (see S.I. 2010/2317, art. 2)

Commencement Information

I122Sch. 12 para. 23 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

[F73On-demand programme servicesU.K.

Textual Amendments

F73Sch. 12 para. 23A and cross-heading inserted (19.12.2009) by Audiovisual Media Services Regulations 2009 (S.I. 2009/2979), regs. 1(1), 4(4)

23A.(1)It is the duty of the Welsh Authority to comply with a direction given to them by OFCOM in relation to the establishment of procedures for the handling and resolution of complaints about compliance by the Authority with the requirements imposed by section 368D or [F74section 368E(4)].U.K.

[F75(2)But OFCOM must not give any such direction in relation to the handling and resolution of complaints about compliance with—

(a)the requirements imposed by section 368D(1) or 368E(4) so far as they relate to advertising, or

(b)the requirement imposed by section 368D(3)(za).]]

Meaning of Welsh Authority’s public servicesU.K.

24(1)In this Part of this Schedule, references to the Welsh Authority’s public services are references to the following—U.K.

(a)S4C;

(b)S4C Digital; and

(c)the services the provision of which by the Authority is authorised by or under section 205.

(2)References in this Schedule to a public television service of the Welsh Authority are references to any public service of the Authority which is a television programme service.

Commencement Information

I123Sch. 12 para. 24 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 345

SCHEDULE 13U.K.Financial penalties under the Broadcasting Acts

Part 1U.K.Broadcasting Act 1990

PreliminaryU.K.

1U.K.The 1990 Act shall be amended as follows.

Commencement Information

I124Sch. 13 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Revocation of television services licenceU.K.

2(1)In subsection (3) of section 18 (penalty on revocation of television services licence), for “a financial penalty of the prescribed amount” there shall be substituted “ a specified financial penalty ”.U.K.

(2)For subsection (4) of that section (amount of penalty) there shall be substituted—

(3A)The maximum amount which a person may be required to pay by way of a penalty under subsection (3) is the maximum penalty given by subsections (3B) and (3C).

(3B)In a case where the licence is revoked under this section or the penalty is imposed before the end of the first complete accounting period of the licence holder to fall within the period for which the licence is in force, the maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£500,000; and

(b)7 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate would have been the qualifying revenue for the first complete accounting period of the licence holder falling within the period for which the licence would have been in force.

(3C)In any other case, the maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£500,000; and

(b)7 per cent. of the qualifying revenue for the last complete accounting period of the licence holder falling within the period for which the licence is in force.

(3D)Section 19(2) to (6) applies for estimating or determining qualifying revenue for the purposes of subsection (3B) or (3C) above.

(3)This paragraph applies only in a case of a revocation in relation to which—

(a)the notice required by section 18(2) of the 1990 Act, or

(b)the notice revoking the licence,

is served after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I125Sch. 13 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licences for Channel 3 services and for Channels 4 and 5U.K.

3(1)For subsection (2) of section 41 (penalties for failure by holder of licence for Channel 3 services, Channel 4 or Channel 5 to comply with licence conditions or directions) there shall be substituted—U.K.

(1A)The amount of a financial penalty imposed on a person in pursuance of subsection (1)(a) shall not exceed 5 per cent. of the qualifying revenue for the licence holder’s last complete accounting period falling within the period for which his licence has been in force (“the relevant period”).

(1B)In relation to a person whose first complete accounting period falling within the relevant period has not ended when the penalty is imposed, subsection (1A) is to be construed as referring to 5 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate to be the qualifying revenue for that accounting period.

(1C)Section 19(2) to (6) applies for determining or estimating qualifying revenue for the purposes of subsection (1A) or (1B) above.

(2)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I126Sch. 13 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Restricted services licencesU.K.

4(1)In subsection (2) of section 42B (application of sections 40 to 42 to licensing of restricted services), for “subsections (3) and (4)” there shall be substituted “ subsections (3) to (3C) ”.U.K.

(2)In subsection (3) of that section—

(a)for “subsection (2)” there shall be substituted “ subsections (1A) to (1C) ”; and

(b)for the words from “shall not exceed whichever is the greater” onwards there shall be substituted “ is the maximum penalty given by subsection (3A). ”

(3)For subsection (4) of that section (penalties for failure to comply with conditions or directions) there shall be substituted—

(3A)The maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£250,000; and

(b)5 per cent. of the qualifying revenue for the licence holder’s last complete accounting period falling within the period for which his licence has been in force (“the relevant period”).

(3B)In relation to a person whose first complete accounting period falling within the relevant period has not ended when the penalty is imposed, subsection (3A)(b) is to be construed as referring to 5 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate to be the qualifying revenue for that accounting period.

(3C)Section 19(2) to (6) applies for determining or estimating qualifying revenue for the purposes of subsection (3A) or (3B) above.

(4)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I127Sch. 13 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional television services licencesU.K.

5(1)For subsection (2) of section 55 (penalties for failure by holder of licence for additional television service to comply with licence conditions or directions) there shall be substituted—U.K.

(1A)The amount of a financial penalty imposed on a person in pursuance of subsection (1) shall not exceed 5 per cent. of the qualifying revenue for the licence holder’s last complete accounting period falling within the period for which his licence has been in force (“the relevant period”).

(1B)In relation to a person whose first complete accounting period falling within the relevant period has not ended when the penalty is imposed, subsection (1A) is to be construed as referring to 5 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate to be the qualifying revenue for that accounting period.

(1C)Section 52(2) applies for determining or estimating qualifying revenue for the purposes of subsection (1A) or (1B) above.

(2)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I128Sch. 13 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Revocation of national sound broadcasting licenceU.K.

6(1)In subsection (3) of section 101 (penalty on revocation of national sound broadcasting licence), for “a financial penalty of the prescribed amount” there shall be substituted “ a specified financial penalty ”.U.K.

(2)For subsection (4) of that section (amount of penalty) there shall be substituted—

(3A)The maximum amount which a person may be required to pay by way of a penalty under subsection (3) is the maximum penalty given by subsections (3B) and (3C).

(3B)In a case where the licence is revoked under this section or the penalty is imposed before the end of the first complete accounting period of the licence holder to fall within the period for which the licence is in force, the maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£250,000; and

(b)7 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate would have been the qualifying revenue for the first complete accounting period of the licence holder falling within the period for which the licence would have been in force.

(3C)In any other case, the maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£250,000; and

(b)7 per cent. of the qualifying revenue for the last complete accounting period of the licence holder falling within the period for which the licence is in force.

(3D)Section 102(2) to (6) applies for estimating or determining qualifying revenue for the purposes of subsection (3B) or (3C) above.

(3)This paragraph applies only in a case of a revocation in relation to which—

(a)the notice required by section 101(2) of the 1990 Act, or

(b)the notice revoking the licence,

is served after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I129Sch. 13 para. 6 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licences for analogue sound servicesU.K.

7(1)For subsection (2) of section 110 (penalties for failure by holder of national sound broadcasting licence to comply with licence conditions or directions) there shall be substituted—U.K.

(1A)The maximum amount which the holder of a national licence may be required to pay by way of a financial penalty imposed in pursuance of subsection (1)(a) is the maximum penalty given by subsection (1B).

(1B)The maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£250,000; and

(b)5 per cent. of the qualifying revenue for his last complete accounting period falling within the period for which his licence has been in force (“the relevant period”).

(1C)In relation to a person whose first complete accounting period falling within the relevant period has not ended when the penalty is imposed, subsection (1B)(b) is to be construed as referring to 5 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate to be the qualifying revenue for that accounting period.

(1D)Section 102(2) to (6) applies for determining or estimating qualifying revenue for the purposes of subsection (1B) or (1C) above.

(2)In subsection (3) of that section (maximum penalty for failure by holder of a sound broadcasting licence that is not a national licence to comply with licence conditions or directions), for “£50,000” there shall be substituted “ £250,000 ”.

(3)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I130Sch. 13 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional radio services licencesU.K.

8(1)For subsection (2) of section 120 (penalties for failure by holder of additional radio services licence to comply with licence conditions or directions) there shall be substituted—U.K.

(1A)The amount of a financial penalty imposed on a person in pursuance of subsection (1) shall not exceed 5 per cent. of the qualifying revenue for the licence holder’s last complete accounting period falling within the period for which his licence has been in force (“the relevant period”).

(1B)In relation to a person whose first complete accounting period falling within the relevant period has not ended when the penalty is imposed, subsection (1A) is to be construed as referring to 5 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate to be the qualifying revenue for that accounting period.

(1C)Section 118(2) applies for determining or estimating qualifying revenue for the purposes of subsection (1A) or (1B) above.

(2)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I131Sch. 13 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Power to amend penalties under the 1990 ActU.K.

9(1)The Secretary of State may by order amend any of the provisions of the 1990 Act specified in sub-paragraph (2) by substituting a different sum for the sum for the time being specified in that provision.U.K.

(2)Those provisions are—

(a)section 18(3B)(a) and (3C)(a);

(b)section 42B(3A)(a);

(c)section 101(3B)(a) and (3C)(a);

(d)section 110(1B)(a) and (3).

(3)No order is to be made under this paragraph unless a draft of the order has been laid before Parliament and approved by a resolution of each House.

Commencement Information

I132Sch. 13 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Part 2U.K.Broadcasting Act 1996

PreliminaryU.K.

10U.K.The 1996 Act shall be amended as follows.

Commencement Information

I133Sch. 13 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Revocation of television multiplex licencesU.K.

11(1)In subsection (5) of section 11 (penalty on revocation of television multiplex licence), the words from “not exceeding” onwards shall be omitted.U.K.

(2)For subsection (6) of that section (amount of penalty) there shall be substituted—

(5A)The maximum amount which a person may be required to pay by way of a penalty under subsection (5) is the maximum penalty given by subsections (5B) and (5C).

(5B)In a case where the licence is revoked under this section or the penalty is imposed before the end of the first complete accounting period of the licence holder to fall within the period for which the licence is in force, the maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£500,000; and

(b)7 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate would have been the multiplex revenue for the first complete accounting period of the licence holder falling within the period for which the licence would have been in force.

(5C)In any other case, the maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£500,000; and

(b)7 per cent. of the multiplex revenue for the last complete accounting period of the licence holder falling within the period for which the licence is in force.

(5D)Section 14 applies for estimating or determining multiplex revenue for the purposes of subsection (5B) or (5C) above.

(3)This paragraph applies only in a case of a revocation in relation to which—

(a)the notice required by section 11(2) of the 1996 Act, or

(b)the notice revoking the licence,

is served after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I134Sch. 13 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Attribution of television multiplex revenueU.K.

12(1)In subsection (1) of section 15 (attribution of multiplex revenue for the purposes of section 17(3)), for “17(3)” there shall be substituted “ 17(2A) and (2B) ”.U.K.

(2)In subsection (2) of that section (attribution for the purposes of sections 23(3) and 27(3)), for “section 23(3) or section 27(3)” there shall be substituted “ sections 23(2A) to (5) and 27(2A) to (5) ”.

(3)This paragraph has effect in relation only to cases in which section 17, 23 or 27 applies as amended by this Schedule.

Commencement Information

I135Sch. 13 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Multiplex licencesU.K.

13(1)In subsection (2) of section 17 (penalty for failure by holder of television multiplex licence to comply with licence conditions or directions), for the words from “whichever is the greater” onwards there shall be substituted “ the maximum penalty given by subsection (2A). ”U.K.

(2)For subsection (3) of that section (maximum penalties) there shall be substituted—

(2A)The maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£250,000; and

(b)5 per cent. of the share of multiplex revenue attributable to the licence holder for his last complete accounting period falling within the period for which his licence has been in force (“the relevant period”).

(2B)In relation to a person whose first complete accounting period falling within the relevant period has not ended when the penalty is imposed, subsection (2A)(b) is to be construed as referring to 5 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate to be the share of multiplex revenue attributable to him for that accounting period.

(2C)Section 15(1) and (3) applies for determining or estimating the share of multiplex revenue attributable to a person for the purposes of subsection (2A) or (2B) above.

(3)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I136Sch. 13 para. 13 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Digital television programme licencesU.K.

14(1)In subsection (2) of section 23 (penalty for failure by holder of digital television programme licence to comply with licence conditions or directions), for the words from “whichever is the greater” onwards there shall be substituted “ the maximum penalty given by subsection (2A). ”U.K.

(2)For subsection (3) of that section (maximum penalties) there shall be substituted—

(2A)The maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£250,000; and

(b)5 per cent. of the aggregate amount of the shares of multiplex revenue attributable to him in relation to television multiplex services and general multiplex services in respect of relevant accounting periods.

(3)In subsection (4) of that section (meaning of “relevant accounting period”), for “subsection (3)(a)” there shall be substituted “ subsection (2A) ”.

(4)In subsection (5) of that section, for “not yet ended, then for the purposes of subsection (3)” there shall be substituted “ not ended when the penalty is imposed, then for the purposes of this section ”.

(5)Before subsection (6) of that section there shall be inserted—

(5B)Section 15(2) and (3) applies for determining or estimating the share of multiplex revenue attributable to a person for the purposes of subsection (2A) or (5) above.

(6)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I137Sch. 13 para. 14 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Digital additional television services licencesU.K.

15(1)In subsection (2) of section 27 (penalty for failure by holder of digital additional services licence to comply with licence conditions or directions), for the words from “whichever is the greater” onwards there shall be substituted “ the maximum penalty given by subsection (2A). ”U.K.

(2)For subsection (3) of that section (maximum penalties) there shall be substituted—

(2A)The maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£250,000; and

(b)5 per cent. of the aggregate amount of the shares of multiplex revenue attributable to him in relation to television multiplex services and general multiplex services in respect of relevant accounting periods.

(3)In subsection (4) of that section (meaning of “relevant accounting period”), for “subsection (3)(a)” there shall be substituted “ subsection (2A) ”.

(4)In subsection (5) of that section, for “not yet ended, then for the purposes of subsection (3)” there shall be substituted “ not ended when the penalty is imposed, then for the purposes of this section ”.

(5)Before subsection (6) of that section there shall be inserted—

(5B)Section 15(2) and (3) applies for determining or estimating the share of multiplex revenue attributable to a person for the purposes of subsection (2A) or (5) above.

(6)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I138Sch. 13 para. 15 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Power to amend digital television penaltiesU.K.

16U.K.For section 36(2) and (3) (provisions that may be amended and negative resolution procedure) there shall be substituted—

(2)The provisions referred to in subsection (1) are—

(a)section 11(5B)(a) and (5C)(a);

(b)section 17(2A)(a);

(c)section 23(2A)(a); and

(d)section 27(2A)(a).

(3)No order is to be made under subsection (1) unless a draft of the order has been laid before Parliament and approved by a resolution of each House.

Commencement Information

I139Sch. 13 para. 16 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Revocation of radio multiplex licencesU.K.

17(1)In section 53(5) (maximum penalty on revocation of radio multiplex licence), for “£50,000”, in both places, there shall be substituted “ £250,000 ”.U.K.

(2)This paragraph applies only in a case of a revocation in relation to which—

(a)the notice required by section 53(2) of the 1996 Act, or

(b)the notice revoking the licence,

is served after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I140Sch. 13 para. 17 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Attribution of radio multiplex revenueU.K.

18(1)In subsection (1) of section 57 (attribution of multiplex revenue for the purposes of sections 59(3)), for “59(3)” there shall be substituted “ 59(2A) and (2B) ”.U.K.

(2)In subsection (2) of that section, (attribution for the purposes of sections 62(3) and 66(3)), for “section 62(3) or section 66(3)” there shall be substituted “ sections 62(2A) to (5) and 66(2A) to (5) ”.

(3)This paragraph has effect in relation only to cases in which section 59, 62 or 66 applies as amended by this Schedule.

Commencement Information

I141Sch. 13 para. 18 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Contraventions of conditions of radio multiplex licencesU.K.

19(1)In subsection (2) of section 59 (penalty for failure by holder of radio multiplex licence to comply with licence conditions or directions), for the words from “whichever is the greater” onwards there shall be substituted “ the maximum penalty given by subsection (2A). ”U.K.

(2)For subsection (3) of that section (maximum penalties) there shall be substituted—

(2A)The maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£250,000; and

(b)5 per cent. of the aggregate amount of the share of multiplex revenue attributable to him for his last complete accounting period falling within a period for which his licence has been in force (“the relevant period”).

(2B)In relation to a person whose first complete accounting period falling within the relevant period has not ended when the penalty is imposed, subsection (2A)(b) is to be construed as referring to 5 per cent. of the amount which OFCOM estimate to be the share of multiplex revenue attributable to him for that accounting period.

(2C)Section 57(1) and (3) applies for determining or estimating the share of multiplex revenue attributable to a person for the purposes of subsection (2A) or (2B) above.

(3)In subsection (4) of that section (maximum penalty to be imposed on holder of local radio multiplex licences for failure to comply with conditions or directions), for “£50,000” there shall be substituted “ £250,000 ”.

(4)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I142Sch. 13 para. 19 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Digital sound programme licencesU.K.

20(1)In subsection (2) of section 62 (penalty for failure by holder of digital sound programme licence to comply with licence conditions or directions), for the words from “whichever is the greater” onwards there shall be substituted “ the maximum penalty given by subsection (2A). ”U.K.

(2)For subsection (3) of that section (maximum penalties) there shall be substituted—

(2A)The maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£250,000; and

(b)5 per cent. of the aggregate amount of the shares of multiplex revenue attributable to him in relation to relevant multiplex services in respect of relevant accounting periods.

(3)In subsection (4) of that section (meaning of “relevant accounting period”), for “subsection (3)” there shall be substituted “ subsection (2A) ”.

(4)In subsection (5) of that section, for “not yet ended, then for the purposes of subsection (3)” there shall be substituted “ not ended when the penalty is imposed, then for the purposes of this section ”.

(5)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(5A)A determination or estimate for the purposes of subsection (2A) or (5) above of the share of multiplex revenue attributable to a person in relation to national radio multiplex services is to be in accordance with section 57(2) and (3).

(5B)A determination or estimate for the purposes of subsection (2A) or (5) above of the share of multiplex revenue attributable to a person in relation to television multiplex services or general multiplex services is to be in accordance with section 15(2) and (3).

(6)In subsection (6) of that section (maximum penalty where licence is a local digital sound programme licence), for “£50,000” there shall be substituted “ £250,000 ”.

(7)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I143Sch. 13 para. 20 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licences for digital additional sound servicesU.K.

21(1)In subsection (2) of section 66 (penalty for failure by holder of digital additional sound services licence to comply with licence conditions or directions), for the words from “whichever is the greater” onwards there shall be substituted “ the maximum penalty given by subsection (2A). ”U.K.

(2)For subsection (3) of that section (maximum penalties) there shall be substituted—

(2A)The maximum penalty is whichever is the greater of—

(a)£250,000; and

(b)5 per cent. of the aggregate amount of the shares of multiplex revenue attributable to him in relation to relevant multiplex services in respect of relevant accounting periods.

(3)In subsection (4) of that section (maximum penalty where licence is a local digital sound programme licence), for “£50,000” there shall be substituted “ £250,000 ”.

(4)In subsection (5) of that section (meaning of “relevant accounting period”) for “subsection (3)” there shall be substituted “ subsection (2A) ”.

(5)In subsection (6) of that section, for “not yet ended, then for the purposes of subsection (3)” there shall be substituted “ not ended when the penalty is imposed, then for the purposes of this section ”.

(6)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(6A)A determination or estimate for the purposes of subsection (2A) or (6) above of the share of multiplex revenue attributable to a person in relation to national radio multiplex services is to be in accordance with section 57(2) and (3).

(6B)A determination or estimate for the purposes of subsection (2A) or (6) above of the share of multiplex revenue attributable to a person in relation to general multiplex services is to be in accordance with section 15(2) and (3).

(7)This paragraph applies in relation to a failure to comply with a condition or direction only if it is one occurring after the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I144Sch. 13 para. 21 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Power to amend digital television penaltiesU.K.

22U.K.For section 69(2) and (3) (provisions that may be amended and negative resolution procedure) there shall be substituted—

(2)The provisions referred to in subsection (1) are—

(a)section 53(5)(a) and (b)(i);

(b)section 59(2A)(a) and (4);

(c)section 62(2A)(a) and (6); and

(d)section 66(2A)(a) and (4).

(3)No order is to be made under subsection (1) unless a draft of the order has been laid before Parliament and approved by a resolution of each House.

Commencement Information

I145Sch. 13 para. 22 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 350

SCHEDULE 14U.K.Media ownership rules

Part 1U.K.Channel 3 services

Ban on newspaper proprietors holding Channel 3 licencesU.K.

1(1)A person is not to hold a licence to provide a Channel 3 service if—U.K.

(a)he runs a national newspaper which for the time being has a national market share of 20 per cent. or more; or

(b)he runs national newspapers which for the time being together have a national market share of 20 per cent. or more.

F76(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

(3)For the purposes of this paragraph, where there is a licence to provide a Channel 3 service, each of the following shall be treated as holding that licence—

(a)the actual licence holder; and

(b)every person connected with the actual licence holder.

Textual Amendments

F76Sch. 14 para. 1(2) omitted (15.6.2011) by virtue of The Media Ownership (Radio and Cross-media) Order 2011 (S.I. 2011/1503), arts. 1, 3

Commencement Information

I146Sch. 14 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Restrictions on participationU.K.

2(1)A person who is—U.K.

(a)the proprietor of a national newspaper which for the time being has a national market share of 20 per cent. or more, or

(b)the proprietor of national newspapers which for the time being together have a national market share of 20 per cent. or more,

is not to be a participant with more than a 20 per cent. interest in a body corporate which is the holder of a licence to provide a Channel 3 service.

(2)A person who is the holder of a licence to provide a Channel 3 service is not to be a participant with more than a 20 per cent. interest in a body corporate which is a relevant national newspaper proprietor.

(3)A body corporate is not to be a participant with more than a 20 per cent. interest in a body corporate which holds a licence to provide a Channel 3 service if the first body corporate is one in which a relevant national newspaper proprietor is a participant with more than a 20 per cent. interest.

(4)A restriction imposed by this paragraph on participation in a body corporate which is the holder of a Channel 3 licence applies equally to participation in a body corporate which controls the holder of such a licence.

(5)Any restriction on participation imposed by this paragraph—

(a)on the proprietor of a newspaper, or

(b)on the holder of a licence,

is to apply as if he and every person connected with him were one person.

(6)In this paragraph “a relevant national newspaper proprietor” means a person who runs—

(a)a national newspaper which for the time being has a national market share of 20 per cent. or more; or

(b)national newspapers which for the time being together have a national market share of 20 per cent. or more.

Commencement Information

I147Sch. 14 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

National and local newspapers and their respective national and local market sharesU.K.

3(1)In this Part of this Schedule references to a national or local newspaper are references to a national or local newspaper circulating wholly or mainly in the United Kingdom or in a part of the United Kingdom.U.K.

(2)Where a newspaper is published in different regional editions on the same day, OFCOM have the power to determine whether those regional editions should be treated for the purposes of this Part of this Schedule as constituting—

(a)one national newspaper;

(b)two or more local newspapers; or

(c)one national newspaper and one or more local newspapers.

(3)In the case of a newspaper which would otherwise be neither a national nor a local newspaper for the purposes of this Part of this Schedule, OFCOM have the power to determine, if they consider it appropriate to do so in the light of—

(a)its circulation and influence in the United Kingdom, or

(b)its circulation or influence in a part of the United Kingdom,

that the newspaper is to be treated as a national or as a local newspaper for such of those purposes as they may determine.

(4)For the purposes of this Part of this Schedule, the national market share of a national newspaper at any time is the percentage of the total number of copies of all national newspapers sold in the United Kingdom in the relevant six months which is represented by the total number of copies of that newspaper sold in the United Kingdom in that six months.

F77(5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

(6)In [F78sub-paragraph (4)]the relevant six months” means the six months ending with the last whole calendar month to end before the time in question.

(7)For the purposes of [F79sub-paragraph (4)] , the number of copies of a newspaper sold in the United KingdomF80... during any period may be taken to be such number as is estimated by OFCOM—

(a)in such manner, or

(b)by reference to such statistics prepared by any other person,

as they think fit.

(8)In relation to a newspaper which is distributed free of charge (rather than sold), references in this paragraph to the number of copies sold include references to the number of copies distributed.

Textual Amendments

F77Sch. 14 para. 3(5) omitted (15.6.2011) by virtue of Media Ownership (Radio and Cross-media) Order 2011 (S.I. 2011/1503), arts. 1, 6(2)

F78Words in Sch. 14 para. 3(6) substituted (15.6.2011) by Media Ownership (Radio and Cross-media) Order 2011 (S.I. 2011/1503), arts. 1, 6(3)

F79Words in Sch. 14 para. 3(7) substituted (15.6.2011) by Media Ownership (Radio and Cross-media) Order 2011 (S.I. 2011/1503), arts. 1, 6(4)

F80Words in Sch. 14 para. 3(7) omitted (15.6.2011) by virtue of Media Ownership (Radio and Cross-media) Order 2011 (S.I. 2011/1503), arts. 1, 6(4)

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

Commencement Information

I148Sch. 14 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Construction of references to running a newspaperU.K.

4U.K.For the purposes of this Part of this Schedule a person runs a F81... newspaper if—

(a)he is the proprietor of the newspaper; or

(b)he controls a body which is the proprietor of the newspaper.

Textual Amendments

F81Words in Sch. 14 para. 4 omitted (15.6.2011) by virtue of Media Ownership (Radio and Cross-media) Order 2011 (S.I. 2011/1503), arts. 1, 7

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

Commencement Information

I149Sch. 14 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Coverage area for a Channel 3 serviceU.K.

F825U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F82Sch. 14 para. 5 omitted (15.6.2011) by virtue of Media Ownership (Radio and Cross-media) Order 2011 (S.I. 2011/1503), arts. 1, 8

Commencement Information

I150Sch. 14 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Power to amend Part 1 of ScheduleU.K.

6U.K.The Secretary of State may by order repeal or otherwise modify any of the restrictions imposed by this Part of this Schedule.

Commencement Information

I151Sch. 14 para. 6 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F83Part 2U.K.F83...

Textual Amendments

F83...U.K.

F837U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Commencement Information

I152Sch. 14 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F83...U.K.

F838U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Commencement Information

I153Sch. 14 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F83...U.K.

F839U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Commencement Information

I154Sch. 14 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F83...U.K.

F8310U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Commencement Information

I155Sch. 14 para. 10 in force at 12.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 2 (with art. 11)

Part 3U.K.Local sound programme services

Restriction on holding of local sound broadcasting licencesU.K.

11(1)The Secretary of State may by order impose—U.K.

(a)requirements prohibiting the holding at the same time by the same person, in the circumstances described in the order, of more than the number of local sound broadcasting licences that is determined in the manner set out in the order;

(b)requirements prohibiting a person from holding even one local sound broadcasting licence in the circumstances described in the order.

(2)The circumstances by reference to which a person may be prohibited under sub-paragraph (1) from holding a local sound broadcasting licence, and the factors that may be used for determining the number of such licences that he may hold, include, in particular—

(a)whether and to what extent the coverage areas of different services provided by that person under different local sound broadcasting licences would overlap;

(b)the sizes of the potential audiences for those services and the times when those services would be made available;

(c)whether and to what extent members of the potential audiences for those services would also be members of the potential audiences for services provided under local sound broadcasting licences held by other persons;

(d)in a case in which members of potential audiences for services so provided by that person would also be members of the potential audiences for services so provided by other persons—

(i)the number of those other persons;

(ii)the coverage areas of their services;

(iii)the sizes of the potential audiences for their services; and

(iv)the times when their services are or will be made available;

(e)whether that person runs one or more national newspapers, and their national market share;

(f)whether and to what extent the whole or a part of the coverage area for a service for which that person would hold a local sound broadcasting licence is or includes an area in which one or more local newspapers run by him is circulating, and the newspapers' local market share;

(g)whether and to what extent the whole or a part the coverage area for which that person would hold a local sound broadcasting licence is or is included in the coverage area of a regional Channel 3 service for which he also holds a licence.

(3)For the purposes of this paragraph the coverage area for a service provided under a local sound broadcasting licence or a Channel 3 licence is the area in the United Kingdom within which that service is capable of being received at a level satisfying such technical standards as may have been laid down by OFCOM for the purposes of the provisions of an order under this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I156Sch. 14 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Restriction applying to local digital sound programme servicesU.K.

12(1)The Secretary of State may by order impose requirements, on persons holding local digital sound programme licences, prohibiting the provision by the same person, in the circumstances described in the order, of more than the number of local digital sound programme services that is determined in the manner set out in the order.U.K.

(2)The circumstances by reference to which a person may be prohibited under sub-paragraph (1) from providing a local digital sound programme service, and the factors that may be used for determining the number of such services that he may provide, include, in particular—

(a)whether and to what extent the coverage areas of different local digital sound programme services provided by that person would overlap;

(b)the capacity used by those services on the relevant multiplexes;

(c)the sizes of the potential audiences for those services and the times when those services would be made available;

(d)whether and to what extent members of the potential audiences for those services would also be members of the potential audiences for local digital sound programme services provided by other persons;

(e)in a case in which members of the potential audiences for the services provided by that person would also be members of the potential audiences for local digital sound programme services provided by other persons—

(i)the number of those other persons;

(ii)the coverage areas of their services;

(iii)the capacity used by their services on the relevant multiplexes;

(iv)the sizes of the potential audiences for their services; and

(v)the times when their services are or will be made available.

(3)For the purposes of this paragraph the coverage area for a service provided under a local digital sound programme licence is the area in the United Kingdom within which the relevant multiplex is capable of being received at a level satisfying such technical standards as may have been laid down by OFCOM for the purposes of the provisions of an order under this paragraph.

(4)In this paragraph “the relevant multiplex”, in relation to a service provided under a local digital sound programme licence, means the local radio multiplex service in which the service provided under that licence is or is to be included.

(5)For the purposes of this paragraph a person who holds a licence to provide local digital sound programme services provides such a service if, and only if—

(a)the service is one provided by him and is included in a local radio multiplex service for which he holds a local radio multiplex licence; or

(b)under a contract between that person and a person who holds a licence to provide a local radio multiplex service, the person holding the licence to provide the radio multiplex service is required to include that local digital sound programme service in that multiplex service.

Commencement Information

I157Sch. 14 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Powers supplemental to powers under paragraphs 11 and 12U.K.

13(1)An order under paragraph 11 or 12 may make provision for treating—U.K.

(a)persons who are connected with a person who holds a licence,

(b)persons who are associates of a person who holds a licence or of a person who is connected with a person who holds a licence, and

(c)persons who (whether alone or together with such persons as may be described in the order) participate in a body which holds a licence or is treated as doing so by virtue of paragraph (a) or (b),

as if each of them were also a holder of the licence for the purposes of a requirement imposed under that paragraph.

(2)An order under paragraph 12 may make provision for treating—

(a)persons who are connected with a person who provides a local digital sound programme service,

(b)persons who are associates of a person who provides such a service or of a person who is connected with a person who provides such a service, and

(c)persons who (whether alone or together with such persons as may be described in the order) participate in a body who provides such a service or is treated as doing so by virtue of paragraph (a) or (b),

as if each of them were also a person providing the service for the purposes of a requirement imposed under that paragraph.

(3)An order under paragraph 11 or 12 may also make provision for treating—

(a)persons who are connected with each other,

(b)persons who are associates of each other, and

(c)persons who (whether alone or together with such persons as may be described in the order) participate in a body,

as if they and such other persons who are connected with, associates of or participators in any of them as may be described in the order were the same person for the purposes of a requirement imposed under that paragraph.

(4)An order under paragraph 11 may make provision—

(a)as to the circumstances in which a newspaper is to be treated as a national newspaper or a local newspaper for the purposes of a requirement imposed under that paragraph;

(b)as to the person or persons who are to be treated for any such purposes as running a newspaper;

(c)as to the determination for any such purposes of the area within which a local newspaper is circulating; and

(d)as to what is to constitute the national market share or local market share of any newspaper or of a number of newspapers taken together;

and provision made by virtue of this paragraph may apply, with or without modifications, any of the provisions of paragraph 3 or 4 of this Schedule [F84or section 5(6AA) to (6AD) of the Broadcasting Act 1990] .

(5)Power to make provision with respect to any matter by any order under paragraph 11 or 12 includes power—

(a)to make provision with respect to that matter by reference to the making or giving by OFCOM, in accordance with the order, of any determination, approval or consent; and

(b)to confer such other discretions on OFCOM as the Secretary of State thinks fit.

(6)Sub-paragraph (5) of paragraph 12 applies for the purposes of this paragraph as it applies for the purposes of that paragraph.

Textual Amendments

F84Words in Sch. 14 para. 13(4) inserted (15.6.2011) by The Media Ownership (Radio and Cross-media) Order 2011 (S.I. 2011/1503), arts. 1, 9

Commencement Information

I158Sch. 14 para. 13 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Transitional provision for orders under paragraphs 11 and 12U.K.

14(1)This paragraph applies where—U.K.

(a)immediately after the coming into force of an order under paragraph 11 or 12, a person (“the person in contravention”) is in contravention, in any respect, of a requirement imposed under that paragraph; and

(b)immediately before the coming into force of the order, that person—

(i)held one or more relevant licences; but

(ii)was not, in that respect, in contravention of a requirement imposed under that paragraph.

(2)This paragraph does not apply in the case of the first order to be made under paragraph 11 or 12 if the person in contravention was, immediately before the coming into force of the order, in contravention, in relation to one or more of the relevant licences, of a requirement imposed under Part 3 or 4 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act.

(3)In sub-paragraphs (1) and (2) the reference to a relevant licence is—

(a)in relation to the coming into force of an order under paragraph 11, a local sound broadcasting licence; and

(b)in relation to the coming into force of an order under paragraph 12, a local digital sound programme licence.

(4)The contravention mentioned in sub-paragraph (1)(a), to the extent that it arises by reason of the coming into force of the order, is to be disregarded (in the case of the person in contravention) in relation to any time which falls—

(a)after the coming into force of the order; and

(b)before there is a relevant change of circumstances.

(5)Where the contravention is one arising under paragraph 11 in the case of a person who held one or more local sound broadcasting licences immediately before the coming into force of the order, there is a relevant change of circumstances if—

(a)another person becomes the holder of any of those licences, otherwise than in consequence of a transaction under which the person in contravention ceases to be a holder of the licence; or

(b)the person in contravention becomes the holder of another local sound broadcasting licence.

(6)A change of circumstances is not a relevant change of circumstances by virtue of sub-paragraph (5)(b) unless the licence of which the person in contravention becomes the holder is one the holding of which, with the holding of licences already held by him, would (apart from sub-paragraph (4)) constitute a contravention of a requirement imposed under paragraph 11.

(7)Where the contravention is one arising under paragraph 12 in the case of a person who, under a local digital sound programme licence, was providing one or more local digital sound programme services immediately before the coming into force of the order, there is a relevant change of circumstances if—

(a)another person becomes the holder of that licence, otherwise than in consequence of a transaction under which the person in contravention ceases to be a holder of the licence; or

(b)the person in contravention becomes the provider of another local digital sound programme service provided under that licence.

(8)A change of circumstances is not a relevant change of circumstances by virtue of sub-paragraph (7)(b) unless the service of which the person in contravention becomes the provider is one the provision of which, with the services already provided by him, would (apart from sub-paragraph (4)) constitute a contravention of a requirement imposed under paragraph 12.

(9)For the purposes of this paragraph, in its application in relation to a contravention of a requirement imposed under paragraph 11 or 12—

(a)references to holding a licence or providing a local digital sound programme service are to be construed in accordance with the provision having effect for the purposes of that requirement; and

(b)the persons who are taken to be holding a local digital sound programme licence immediately before the coming into force of the order include every person who at that time would, in accordance with that provision, be treated as providing local digital sound programme services that were being provided at that time under that licence.

Commencement Information

I159Sch. 14 para. 14 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Part 4U.K.Religious bodies etc.

Approval required for religious bodies etc. to hold licencesU.K.

15(1)A person mentioned in paragraph 2(1) of Part 2 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act (religious bodies etc.) is not to hold a Broadcasting Act licence not mentioned in paragraph 2(1A) of that Part unless—U.K.

(a)OFCOM have made a determination in his case as respects a description of licences applicable to that licence; and

(b)that determination remains in force.

(2)OFCOM are to make a determination under this paragraph in a person’s case and as respects a particular description of licence if, and only if, they are satisfied that it is appropriate for that person to hold a licence of that description.

(3)OFCOM are not to make a determination under this paragraph except on an application made to them for the purpose.

(4)OFCOM must publish guidance for persons making applications to them under this paragraph as to the principles that they will apply when determining for the purposes of sub-paragraph (2) what is appropriate.

(5)OFCOM must have regard to guidance for the time being in force under sub-paragraph (4) when making determinations under this paragraph.

(6)OFCOM may revise any guidance under sub-paragraph (4) by publishing their revisions of it.

(7)The publication of guidance under sub-paragraph (4), or of any revisions of it, is to be in whatever manner OFCOM consider appropriate.

Commencement Information

I160Sch. 14 para. 15 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 5)

Power to amend Part 4 of ScheduleU.K.

16U.K.The Secretary of State may by order repeal or otherwise modify the restriction imposed by this Part of this Schedule.

Commencement Information

I161Sch. 14 para. 16 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 5)

Part 5U.K.Supplemental provisions of Schedule

Procedure for ordersU.K.

17(1)Before making an order under any provision of this Schedule (other than one that is confined to giving effect to recommendations made by OFCOM in a report of a review under section 391), the Secretary of State must consult OFCOM.U.K.

(2)No order is to be made containing provision authorised by any provision of this Schedule unless a draft of the order has been laid before Parliament and approved by a resolution of each House.

Commencement Information

I162Sch. 14 para. 17 in force at 18.9.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 5)

I163Sch. 14 para. 17 in force at 12.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 2 (with art. 11)

I164Sch. 14 para. 17 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Interpretation of ScheduleU.K.

18(1)Part 1 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act applies for construing this Schedule as it applies for construing Part 2 of that Schedule.U.K.

(2)References in this paragraph to an area overlapping another include references to its being the same as, or lying wholly inside, the other area.

Commencement Information

I165Sch. 14 para. 18 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 360

SCHEDULE 15U.K.Amendments of Broadcasting Acts

Part 1U.K.Amendments of the 1990 Act

Licences under Part 1U.K.

1(1)Section 3 of the 1990 Act (licensing under Part 1) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), for “Chapter II, III, IV or V of this Part” there shall be substituted “ Chapter 2 or 5 of this Part or section 235 of the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(4)For subsection (8) (saving for telecommunications licences) there shall be substituted—

(8)The holding by a person of a licence under this Part shall not relieve him of—

(a)any liability in respect of a failure to hold a licence under section 1 of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949; or

(b)any obligation to comply with requirements imposed by or under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of the Communications Act 2003 (electronic communications networks and electronic communications services).

Commencement Information

I166Sch. 15 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

General licence conditionsU.K.

2(1)Section 4 of the 1990 Act (general licence conditions) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), in each of paragraphs (a) and (c), after “this Act” there shall be inserted “ , the Broadcasting Act 1996 or the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(4)In subsection (3) (fixing of fees), the words from “and the amount” onwards shall be omitted.

(5)In subsection (5) (provision of false information to be breach of condition)—

(a)for “imposed under this Part” there shall be substituted “ contained in the licence ”; and

(b) after “and 42” there shall be inserted “ or (as the case may be) sections 237 and 238 of the Communications Act 2003 (enforcement of television licensable content service licences) ”.

Commencement Information

I167Sch. 15 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Restrictions on licence holdingU.K.

3(1)Section 5 of the 1990 Act (restrictions on licence holding) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “The Commission” and “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2) (incidental requirements to provide information), after paragraph (d) there shall be inserted—

(da)impose conditions in a licence requiring the licence holder, if a body corporate, to give OFCOM notice, after they have occurred and irrespective of whether proposals for them have fallen to be notified, of changes, transactions or events affecting—

(i)shareholdings in the body; or

(ii)the directors of the body;

(db)impose conditions in a licence enabling OFCOM to require the licence holder to provide them with such information as they may reasonably require for determining—

(i)whether the licence holder is a disqualified person in relation to that licence by virtue of Part 2 of Schedule 2; or

(ii)whether any such requirements as are mentioned in subsection (1)(b) have been and are being complied with by or in relation to the licence holder;.

(4)In subsection (6)—

(a)in paragraph (a), for “complained of” there shall be substituted “ constituting their grounds for revoking the licence ”; and

(b)in paragraph (b)(i), for “Parts III and IV of Schedule 2” there shall be substituted “ the requirements imposed by or under Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003, ”.

(5)In subsection (6A)—

(a)paragraph (a) shall cease to have effect; and

(b)in paragraph (b), for “Part IV of that Schedule” there shall be substituted “ Part 1 of Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(6)Subsection (6B) shall cease to have effect.

(7)In subsection (7), for the words from “a failure” to the end of paragraph (c) there shall be substituted “ a disqualification under Part 2 of Schedule 2 to this Act or a contravention of a requirement imposed by or under Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003 ”.

Commencement Information

I168Sch. 15 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Repeal of previous regulatory regimeU.K.

4U.K.Sections 6 to 12 of the 1990 Act (which contain the mechanism for regulation in relation to licences under Part 1 of that Act) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I169Sch. 15 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Prohibition on providing television services without a licenceU.K.

5(1)Section 13 of the 1990 Act (prohibition on providing television services without a licence) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1) (offence of providing such service without a licence), for “service falling within section 2(1)(a), (aa), (b), (c), (cc) or (d)” there shall be substituted “ relevant regulated television service ”.

(3)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(1A)In subsection (1) “relevant regulated television service” means a service falling, in pursuance of section 211(1) of the Communications Act 2003, to be regulated by OFCOM, other than a television multiplex service.

(4)In subsection (2) (exemption orders made after consulting the ITC), for “the Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I170Sch. 15 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Television broadcasting on Channel 3U.K.

6U.K.In section 14 of the 1990 Act (establishment of Channel 3), for “The Commission” and “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I171Sch. 15 para. 6 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Applications for Channel 3 licencesU.K.

7(1)Section 15 of the 1990 Act (applications for Channel 3 licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2), for “specified in section 16(2) or (3) (as the case may be)” there shall be substituted that have to be imposed under Chapter 4 of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003 by conditions relating to—

(a)the public service remit for that service,

(b)programming quotas,

(c)news and current affairs programmes, and

(d)programme production and regional programming.

(4)In subsection (3)—

(a)in paragraph (b), for “specified in section 16(2) or (3) (as the case may be)” there shall be substituted that have to be imposed under Chapter 4 of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003 by conditions relating to—

(i)the public service remit for that service,

(ii)programming quotas,

(iii)news and current affairs programmes, and

(iv)programme production and regional programming;

(b)paragraphs (c) to (e) shall be omitted.

(5)After subsection (3) there shall be inserted—

(3A)For the purposes of subsection (1)(d)(ii)—

(a)different percentages may be specified for different accounting periods; and

(b)the percentages that may be specified for an accounting period include a nil percentage.

(6)In subsection (4), for “paragraphs (b) to (e)” there shall be substituted “ paragraphs (b) ”.

Commencement Information

I172Sch. 15 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Procedure on consideration of applications for Channel 3 licencesU.K.

8(1)Section 16 of the 1990 Act (consideration of applications for Channel 3 licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), for “specified in subsection (2) or (3) below (as the case may be)” there shall be substituted that have to be imposed under Chapter 4 of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003 by conditions relating to—

(i)the public service remit for that service,

(ii)programming quotas,

(iii)news and current affairs programmes, and

(iv)programme production and regional programming.

(4)Subsections (2) and (3) of that section shall cease to have effect.

(5)In subsection (4) of that section—

(a)for “specified in subsection (2) or (3) (as the case may be),” there shall be substituted that have to be imposed under Chapter 4 of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003 by conditions relating to—

(a)the public service remit for that service,

(b)programming quotas,

(c)news and current affairs programmes, and

(d)programme production and regional programming,;

(b)the words from “and in applying” onwards shall be omitted.

(6)Subsections (5) to (8) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I173Sch. 15 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Television broadcasting on Channel 3U.K.

9(1)Section 17 of the 1990 Act (award of licences to person submitting highest bid) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (12)(b), for “specified in section 16(2) or (3) (as the case may be)” there shall be substituted that have to be imposed under Chapter 4 of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003 by conditions relating to—

(i)the public service remit for that service,

(ii)programming quotas,

(iii)news and current affairs programmes, and

(iv)programme production and regional programming.

Commencement Information

I174Sch. 15 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Financial conditions of licence and failures to begin a serviceU.K.

10U.K.In sections 17A to 19 of the 1990 Act (financial conditions in Channel 3 licences and failures to begin a service), for “The Commission” and “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I175Sch. 15 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Changes of control in period after award of licenceU.K.

11(1)Section 21 of the 1990 Act (changes of control in period immediately after award of licence) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2), in the definition of “associated programme provider”, for the words from “appears” to “inclusion” there shall be substituted “ is or is likely to be involved, to a substantial extent, in the provision of the programmes included ”.

Commencement Information

I176Sch. 15 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Temporary provision of Channel 3 service for an additional areaU.K.

12U.K.In section 22 of the 1990 Act (temporary provision of regional Channel 3 Service for additional area), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I177Sch. 15 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Appointment of members of C4 CorporationU.K.

13U.K.In section 23 of the 1990 Act (appointment of C4C members), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I178Sch. 15 para. 13 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Channel 4 licenceU.K.

14U.K.In section 24(3) of the 1990 Act (Channel 4 licence), for “the Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I179Sch. 15 para. 14 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Channel 5U.K.

15U.K.In section 28 of the 1990 Act (Channel 5), for “The Commission” and “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I180Sch. 15 para. 15 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Application to Channel 5 of Channel 3 provisionsU.K.

16(1)In section 29 of the 1990 Act (application to Channel 5 of Channel 3 provisions)—U.K.

(a)subsection (2)(b) and the word “and” immediately preceding it, and

(b)subsection (3),

shall cease to have effect.

(2)In subsection (2)(a) of that section, for “the Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I181Sch. 15 para. 16 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Announcement of programme SchedulesU.K.

17U.K.In section 37(1) of the 1990 Act (conditions requiring announcement of programme Schedules), for “the Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I182Sch. 15 para. 17 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of conditions of Channel 3, Channel 4 and Channel 5 licencesU.K.

18(1)In sections 40 to 42 of the 1990 Act (enforcement of licences), for “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.U.K.

(2)In sections 41(1) and 42(1)(a) of that Act (which contain provisions relating to the enforcement of directions under Part 1 of that Act), after “this Part”, in each place, there shall be inserted “ , Part 5 of the Broadcasting Act 1996 or Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003 ”.

Commencement Information

I183Sch. 15 para. 18 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Restricted servicesU.K.

19U.K.In section 42B(1) of the 1990 Act (licensing of restricted services), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I184Sch. 15 para. 19 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional television servicesU.K.

20(1)Section 48 of the 1990 Act (additional services) shall be further amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1)—

(a)for “telecommunication” there shall be substituted “ electronic ”; and

(b)for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted “ on a relevant frequency ”.

(3)In subsection (2), for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted any part of the signals which—

(a)is not required for the purposes of the television broadcasting service for the purposes of which the frequency has been made available; and

(b)is determined by OFCOM to be available for the provision of additional services;.

(4)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(2A)For the purposes of this Part, if they consider it appropriate to do so, OFCOM may, while an additional services licence is in force, from time to time modify the determination made under subsection (2)(b) for the purposes of that licence in any manner that does not reduce the amount of spare capacity made available for the licensed services; and when so modified any such licence shall have effect accordingly.

(5)In subsection (3)—

(a)for “The Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”; and

(b)for “(2)(a)” there shall be substituted “ (2)(b) ”; and

(c)for paragraphs (a) to (c) there shall be substituted—

(a)to the obligations contained in any code under section 303 of the Communications Act 2003 by virtue of subsection (5) of that section; and

(aa)to any need of the person providing the television broadcasting service in question to be able to use part of the signals carrying it for providing services (in addition to those provided for satisfying those obligations) which—

(i)are ancillary to programmes included in the service and directly related to their contents; or

(ii)relate to the promotion or listing of such programmes.

(6)In subsection (4), for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted—

(a)to provide services for the satisfaction in his case of obligations mentioned in subsection (3)(a); and

(b)to provide in relation to his television broadcasting service any such services as are mentioned in subsection (3)(aa).

(7)For subsection (6) there shall be substituted—

(6)In this section—

electronic signals” means signals within the meaning of section 32 of the Communications Act 2003;

relevant frequency” means a frequency made available by OFCOM for the purposes of a television broadcasting service.

(8)This paragraph does not affect the validity of a licence granted or last renewed before the television transfer date, or the services licensed by any such licence.

Commencement Information

I185Sch. 15 para. 20(1)(2)(a) in force at 25.7.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(1), Sch. 1

I186Sch. 15 para. 20(2)(b) (3)-(8) in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licensing of additional television servicesU.K.

21(1)Section 49 of the 1990 Act (licensing of additional television services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), for the words from “of the following” to “48(1)(b)” there shall be substituted “ relevant frequency ”.

(4)For subsections (2) and (3) there shall be substituted—

(1A)An additional services licence is not required for an additional service that is comprised in the public teletext service (within the meaning of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003).

(5)In subsection (10), at the end there shall be inserted “ and “relevant frequency” has the same meaning as in section 48. ”

Modifications etc. (not altering text)

Commencement Information

I187Sch. 15 para. 21 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Applications for additional services licencesU.K.

22(1)Section 50 of the 1990 Act (applications for additional services licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1)(b)(ii), the words “(subject to the approval of the Secretary of State)” shall be omitted.

(4)Subsection (7) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I188Sch. 15 para. 22 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Procedure on application etc. for additional television services licencesU.K.

23(1)Section 51 of the 1990 Act (consideration of applications for licences for additional television services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), for paragraph (a) (requirement of approval of technical plans) there shall be substituted—

(a)that the technical plan submitted under section 50(3)(b), in so far as it involves the use of an electronic communications network (within the meaning of the Communications Act 2003), contains proposals that are acceptable to them; and.

(4)Subsections (2) and (7) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I189Sch. 15 para. 23 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional payments in respect of additional television services licencesU.K.

24U.K.In section 52 of the 1990 Act (additional payments in respect of additional television services licences), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I190Sch. 15 para. 24 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Duration of additional television services licencesU.K.

25(1)Section 53 of the 1990 Act (duration and renewal of additional television services licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for the words before paragraph (a) there shall be substituted—

(1)A licence to provide additional services on a frequency which is a relevant frequency for the purposes of section 48 or (in the case of a licence granted before the television transfer date) was assigned under section 65—.

(3)In subsection (2), after “not later than” there shall be inserted “ the day falling three months before ”.

(4)In subsections (4) to (11), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(5)In subsection (8), for the words from “payable” onwards there shall be substituted “ the cash bid of the licence holder were the licence (instead of being renewed) to be granted for the period of the renewal on an application made in accordance with section 50(3). ”

(6)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(8A)For the purposes of subsection (7)(b)—

(a)different percentages may be specified for different accounting periods; and

(b)the percentages that may be specified for an accounting period include a nil percentage.

(7)After subsection (11) there shall be inserted—

(12)A determination for the purposes of subsection (11)—

(a)must be made at least one year before the date determined; and

(b)must be notified by OFCOM to the person who holds the licence in question.

(13)In this section “the television transfer date” has the same meaning as in the Communications Act 2003.

Commencement Information

I191Sch. 15 para. 25 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional television services not to interfere with other transmissionsU.K.

26(1)Section 54 of the 1990 Act (additional television services not to interfere with other transmissions) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for “the Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)Subsection (2) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I192Sch. 15 para. 26 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of additional television services licencesU.K.

27(1)Section 55 of the 1990 Act (further provision in relation to additional television services licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (4) at the end there shall be inserted “ and, in the case of a licence renewed under section 53 as if the reference in section 42(4) to the end of the period for which the licence is to continue in force were a reference to the end of the period for which it has been renewed. ”

Commencement Information

I193Sch. 15 para. 27 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

The Welsh AuthorityU.K.

28(1)Section 58 of the 1990 Act (sources of programmes for S4C) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for “comply with their duty under section 57(2)(b)” there shall be substituted “ fulfil so much of their public service remit in relation to S4C under paragraph 3 of Schedule 12 to the Communications Act 2003 as is contained in sub-paragraph (2)(a) and (b) of that paragraph ”.

(3)In subsection (2)(a), for “comply with section 57(3)” there shall be substituted “ fulfil so much of their public service remit in relation to S4C under paragraph 3 of Schedule 12 to the Communications Act 2003 as is contained in sub-paragraph (2)(c) of that paragraph ”.

(4)After subsection (5) there shall be inserted—

(6)In this section “programme” does not include an advertisement.

Commencement Information

I194Sch. 15 para. 28 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Distribution of licensed public service channelsU.K.

29(1)Section 66 of the 1990 Act (requirements relating to transmission and distribution of services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsections (1) and (2), for “for general reception” there shall be substituted “ so as to be available for reception by members of the public ”.

(4)After subsection (2) there shall be inserted—

(2A)In subsections (1) and (2) “available for reception by members of the public” shall be construed in accordance with section 361 of the Communications Act 2003.

Commencement Information

I195Sch. 15 para. 29 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of licences held by BBC companiesU.K.

30U.K.In section 66A of the 1990 Act (enforcement of licences held by BBC companies), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I196Sch. 15 para. 30 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Interpretation of Part 1U.K.

31(1)Section 71 of the 1990 Act (interpretation) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For the definitions of “S4C” and “on S4C” there shall be substituted—

S4C” has the same meaning as in Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003;.

(3)For the definitions of “television broadcasting service” and “television programme service” there shall be substituted—

“television broadcasting service”, “television licensable content service” and “television programme service” each has the same meaning as in Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003;.

Commencement Information

I197Sch. 15 para. 31 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licensing functions of OFCOMU.K.

32(1)Section 85 of the 1990 Act (licensing of independent radio services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsections (1) and (2), for “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), for “such licences to provide independent radio services as they may determine” there shall be substituted “ licences to provide relevant independent radio services ”.

(4)Subsections (3) and (4) (duty to secure the meeting of a variety of tastes and interests and to ensure fair and effective competition) shall cease to have effect.

(5)After subsection (7) there shall be inserted—

(8)In this section “relevant independent radio services” means the following services so far as they are services falling to be regulated under section 245 of the Communications Act 2003—

(a)sound broadcasting services;

(b)radio licensable content services;

(c)additional radio services.

Commencement Information

I198Sch. 15 para. 32 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licences under Part 3 of the 1990 ActU.K.

33(1)Section 86 of the 1990 Act (licences under Part 3) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)For subsection (9) of that section there shall be substituted—

(9)The holding of a licence by a person shall not relieve him of—

(a)any liability in respect of a failure to hold a licence under section 1 of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949; or

(b)any obligation to comply with requirements imposed by or under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of the Communications Act 2003 (electronic communications networks and electronic communications services).

Commencement Information

I199Sch. 15 para. 33 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

General licence conditionsU.K.

34(1)Section 87 of the 1990 Act (general licence conditions) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), in each of paragraphs (a) and (d), after “this Act” there shall be inserted “ , the Broadcasting Act 1996 or the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(4)In subsection (2), sub-paragraph (ii) of paragraph (b) and the word “or” immediately preceding it shall be omitted.

(5)In subsection (3) (fixing of fees), the words from “and the amount” onwards shall be omitted.

Commencement Information

I200Sch. 15 para. 34 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Restrictions on holding licencesU.K.

35(1)Section 88 of the 1990 Act (restrictions on the holding of licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “The Authority” and “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2) (incidental requirements to provide information), after paragraph (d) there shall be inserted—

(da)impose conditions in a licence requiring the licence holder, if a body corporate, to give OFCOM notice, after they have occurred and irrespective of whether proposals for them have fallen to be notified, of changes, transactions or events affecting—

(i)shareholdings in the body; or

(ii)the directors of the body;

(db)impose conditions in a licence enabling OFCOM to require the licence holder to provide them with such information as they may reasonably require for determining—

(i)whether the licence holder is a disqualified person in relation to that licence by virtue of Part 2 of Schedule 2; or

(ii)whether any such requirements as are mentioned in subsection (1)(b) have been and are being complied with by or in relation to the licence holder;.

(4)In subsection (6)—

(a)in paragraph (a), for “complained of” there shall be substituted “ constituting their grounds for revoking the licence ”; and

(b)in paragraph (b)(i), for “Parts III and IV of Schedule 2” there shall be substituted “ the requirements imposed by or under Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(5)In subsection (6A)—

(a)paragraph (a) shall cease to have effect; and

(b)in paragraph (b), for “Part IV of that Schedule” there shall be substituted “ Part 1 of Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(6)Subsection (6B) shall cease to have effect.

(7)In subsection (7), for the words from “a failure” to the end of paragraph (c) there shall be substituted “ a disqualification under Part 2 of Schedule 2 to this Act or a contravention of a requirement imposed by or under Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003, ”.

Commencement Information

I201Sch. 15 para. 35 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Disqualification of persons convicted of transmission offencesU.K.

36(1)Section 89 of the 1990 Act (offences giving rise to disqualification) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for paragraph (a) there shall be substituted—

(a)an offence under section 1(1) of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949 (“the 1949 Act”) consisting in the establishment or use of a station for wireless telegraphy, or the installation or use of wireless telegraphy apparatus, for the purpose of making a broadcast (within the meaning of section 9 of the Marine, &c., Broadcasting (Offences) Act 1967);

(aa)an offence under section 1A of the 1949 Act (keeping wireless telegraphy station or apparatus available for unauthorised use) where the relevant contravention of section 1 would constitute an offence falling within paragraph (a);

(ab)an offence under section 1B or 1C of the 1949 Act (unlawful broadcasting offences);.

(3)In subsection (3), for the words from “concerned” onwards there shall be substituted concerned in—

(a)the provision of the licensed service or the making of programmes included in it; or

(b)the operation of a station for wireless telegraphy used for broadcasting the service.

(4)This paragraph does not impose a disqualification in respect of any offence committed before the commencement of this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I202Sch. 15 para. 36 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Offence of providing regulated radio servicesU.K.

37(1)Section 97 of the 1990 Act (prohibition on providing services without a licence) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for the words from “independent” to “84(1)(d), (e) or (f)” there shall be substituted “ relevant regulated radio service ”.

(3)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(1A)In subsection (1) “relevant regulated radio service” means a service falling to be regulated by OFCOM under section 245 of the Communications Act 2003, other than a radio multiplex service.

(4)In subsection (2) (exemption orders made after consulting the Radio Authority), for “the Authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I203Sch. 15 para. 37 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Applications for national licencesU.K.

38(1)Section 98 of the 1990 Act (applications for national licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (3)(a) (proposals to accompany application)—

(a)the word “both”, and

(b)sub-paragraph (ii) and the word “and” immediately preceding it,

shall be omitted.

(4)After subsection (3) there shall be inserted—

(3A)For the purposes of subsection (1)(d)(ii)—

(a)different percentages may be specified for different accounting periods; and

(b)the percentages that may be specified for an accounting period include a nil percentage.

(5)In subsection (4) (provision of further information), after “paragraphs (a),” there shall be inserted “ (aa), ”.

(6)In subsection (6)(b) (publication of details of successful applicant), after “subsection (3)(a)” there shall be inserted “ and (aa) ”.

Commencement Information

I204Sch. 15 para. 38 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Consideration of applications for a national licenceU.K.

39(1)Section 99 of the 1990 Act (consideration of applications for national licence) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In paragraph (a) of subsection (1) (proposals to accompany application)—

(a)the word “both”, and

(b)sub-paragraph (ii) and the word “and” immediately preceding it,

shall be omitted.

(4)In paragraph (b) of that subsection, after “maintain that service” there shall be inserted “ and any proposed simulcast radio service corresponding to that service ”.

Commencement Information

I205Sch. 15 para. 39 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Award of national licencesU.K.

40U.K.In section 100 of the 1990 Act (award of national licences to person submitting highest cash bid), for “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I206Sch. 15 para. 40 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Failure to begin providing licensed serviceU.K.

41(1)Section 101 of the 1990 Act (failure to begin providing licensed service) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1)—

(a)in paragraph (a) for “the service in question” there shall be substituted “ the licensed national service or that he does not intend to provide a corresponding simulcast radio service that he is required to provide by a condition imposed under section 100A ”; and

(b)in paragraph (b), for “that service” there shall be substituted “ the licensed national service or any such simulcast radio service ”.

(4)In subsection (2), for “the service in question” there shall be substituted “ the licensed national service or the simulcast radio service ”.

Commencement Information

I207Sch. 15 para. 41 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional payments in respect of national licencesU.K.

42U.K.In section 102 of the 1990 Act (additional payments in respect of national licences), for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I208Sch. 15 para. 42 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Restrictions affecting change in control of holder of national licenceU.K.

43(1)Section 103 of the 1990 Act (restrictions on change of control of national licence) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2) (interpretation)—

(a)in the definition of “associated programme provider”, for the words from “appears” to “inclusion” there shall be substituted “ is or is likely to be involved, to a substantial extent, in the provision of the programmes included ”; and

(b)in the words after the definition of “the relevant period”, for the words from “as if” onwards there shall be substituted “ as it has effect for the purposes of that Schedule. ”

Commencement Information

I209Sch. 15 para. 43 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Renewal of national licencesU.K.

44(1)Section 103A of the 1990 Act (renewal of national licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), for “eight” there shall be substituted “ twelve ”.

(4)In subsection (2), after “not later than” there shall be inserted “ the day falling three months before ”.

(5)In subsection (3), paragraph (a) and in paragraph (b) the words “in any other case” shall cease to have effect.

(6)In subsection (4), for paragraph (b) there shall be substituted—

(b)the applicant gave notice to OFCOM, within the period of one month beginning with the commencement of section 42 of the Broadcasting Act 1996, of his intention to provide a simulcast radio service, and.

(7)For subsection (7) there shall be substituted—

(7)The amount determined under subsection (6)(b) must be equal to the amount which, in OFCOM’s opinion, would have been the cash bid of the licence holder were the licence (instead of being renewed) to be granted for the period of the renewal on an application made in accordance with section 98.

(7A)For the purposes of subsection (6)(c)—

(a)different percentages may be specified for different accounting periods; and

(b)the percentages that may be specified for an accounting period include a nil percentage.

(8)After subsection (10) there shall be inserted—

(10A)In the case of a pre-transfer national licence (including one for a period extended under section 253 of the Communications Act 2003)—

(a)the licence is not to be capable of being renewed under this section if it has already been renewed under this section before the radio transfer date; and

(b)on the renewal of the licence, it shall be the duty of OFCOM to secure that the renewed licence contains only such provision as would be included in a national licence granted by OFCOM under this Part after the radio transfer date.

(9)After subsection (11) there shall be inserted—

(12)A determination for the purposes of subsection (11)—

(a)must be made at least one year before the date determined; and

(b)must be notified by OFCOM to the person who holds the licence in question.

Commencement Information

I210Sch. 15 para. 44 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Applications for local licencesU.K.

45(1)Section 104 of the 1990 Act (application for local licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (6), for the words from the beginning to “shall be made” there shall be substituted “ An application for a licence to provide a restricted service shall be made ”.

Commencement Information

I211Sch. 15 para. 45 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Renewal of local licencesU.K.

46(1)Section 104A of the 1990 Act (renewal of local licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), for “eight” there shall be substituted “ twelve ”.

(4)In subsection (3), after “not later than” there shall be inserted “ the day falling three months before ”.

(5)After subsection (12) there shall be inserted—

(12A)In the case of a pre-transfer local licence (including one for a period extended under section 253 of the Communications Act 2003)—

(a)the licence is not to be capable of being renewed under this section if it has already been renewed under this section before the radio transfer date; and

(b)on the renewal of the licence, it shall be the duty of OFCOM to secure that the renewed licence contains only such provision as would be included in a local licence granted by OFCOM under this Part after the radio transfer date.

(6)In subsection (13)(d), for “paragraph 3A of Part I of Schedule 2” there shall be substituted “ paragraph 8(2) of Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(7)After subsection (13) there shall be inserted—

(14)A determination for the purposes of subsection (13)(c)—

(a)must be made at least one year before the date determined; and

(b)must be notified by OFCOM to the person who holds the licence in question.

Commencement Information

I212Sch. 15 para. 46 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Special procedure for applications for local licencesU.K.

47(1)Section 104B of the 1990 Act (special procedure for applications for local licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)After subsection (1) there shall be inserted—

(1A)In subsection (1)(c) the reference to the service in question, in relation to a case in which it is a pre-transfer local licence that is due to expire, is a reference to the equivalent local service for which a licence is capable of being granted at times on or after the radio transfer date.

Commencement Information

I213Sch. 15 para. 47 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Special requirements relating to grant of local licencesU.K.

48(1)Section 105 of the 1990 Act (special requirements relating to grant of local licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)For paragraph (d) (duty to have regard to the extent to which proposed service supported by persons living in the area) there shall be substituted—

(d)the extent to which there is evidence that, amongst persons living in that area or locality, there is a demand for, or support for, the provision of the proposed service.

Commencement Information

I214Sch. 15 para. 48 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Requirements as to character and coverage of servicesU.K.

49U.K.In subsections (1) to (4) and (6) of section 106 of the 1990 Act (requirements as to character and coverage of services), for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I215Sch. 15 para. 49 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of licencesU.K.

50U.K.In sections 109 to 111A of the 1990 Act (enforcement of licences), for “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I216Sch. 15 para. 50 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Power to suspend licences to provide radio licensable content services from a satelliteU.K.

51(1)Section 111B of the 1990 Act (power to suspend licence to provide satellite service) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1)—

(a)in paragraph (a), for “satellite service” there shall be substituted “ radio licensable content service ”;

(b)in paragraph (b), for the words from “included in the licence” to the end of the paragraph there shall be substituted “ which in compliance with section 263 of the Communications Act 2003 is included in the licence for the purpose of securing the objective mentioned in section 319(2)(b) of that Act, and ”.

Commencement Information

I217Sch. 15 para. 51 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional radio servicesU.K.

52(1)Section 114 of the 1990 Act (additional radio services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1)—

(a)for “telecommunication” there shall be substituted “ electronic ”; and

(b)for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted “ on a relevant frequency ”.

(3)In subsection (2), for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted any part of the signals which—

(a)is not required for the purposes of the sound broadcasting service for the purposes of which the frequency has been made available; and

(b)is determined by OFCOM to be available for the provision of additional services;.

(4)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(2A)At any time while an additional services licence is in force, OFCOM may, if they consider it appropriate to do so, modify or further modify the determination made for the purposes of that licence under subsection (2)(b); and where there has been such a modification or further modification, the licence shall have effect accordingly.

(2B)A modification or further modification under subsection (2A) must not reduce the amount of spare capacity made available for the licensed services.

(5)In subsection (3), for the words from the beginning to “subsection (2)(a)” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM shall, when determining under subsection (2) ”.

(6)For subsection (6) there shall be substituted—

(6)In this section “electronic signal” means a signal within the meaning of section 32 of the Communications Act 2003.

(7)In this section and section 115 “relevant frequency” means a frequency made available by OFCOM for the purposes of a sound broadcasting service.

(7)This paragraph does not affect the validity of a licence granted or last renewed before the radio transfer date, or the services licensed by any such licence.

Commencement Information

I218Sch. 15 para. 52(1)(2)(a) in force at 25.7.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(1), Sch. 1

I219Sch. 15 para. 52(2)(b) (3)-(7) in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licensing of additional radio servicesU.K.

53(1)Section 115 of the 1990 Act (licensing of additional radio services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “The Authority” and “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), for the words from “of the following” to “114(1)(b)” there shall be substituted “ relevant frequency ”.

(4)In subsection (4), at the end there shall be inserted “ and who would not be in contravention of the requirements imposed by or under Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003 if he held such a licence ”.

(5)In subsection (8), for “local, restricted or satellite service” there shall be substituted “ local or restricted service or to provide a radio licensable content service ”.

Commencement Information

I220Sch. 15 para. 53(1) (4) in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

I221Sch. 15 para. 53(2) (3) (5) in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Applications for additional radio services licencesU.K.

54(1)Section 116 of the 1990 Act (applications for additional radio services licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1)(b)(iii), the words “(subject to the approval of the Secretary of State)” shall be omitted.

Commencement Information

I222Sch. 15 para. 54 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Procedure for awarding additional radio services licencesU.K.

55(1)Section 117 of the 1990 Act (procedure for awarding additional radio services licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), for paragraph (a) (requirement of approval of technical plans) there shall be substituted—

(a)that the technical plan submitted under section 116(3)(b), in so far as it involves the use of an electronic communications network (within the meaning of the Communications Act 2003), contains proposals that are acceptable to them; and.

(4)Subsections (2) and (7) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I223Sch. 15 para. 55 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional payments in respect of additional radio services licencesU.K.

56U.K.In section 118 of the 1990 Act (additional payments in respect of additional radio services licences), for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I224Sch. 15 para. 56 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional radio services not to interfere with other transmissionsU.K.

57(1)Section 119 of the 1990 Act (additional radio services not to interfere with other transmissions) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for “the Authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)Subsection (2) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I225Sch. 15 para. 57 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of additional radio services licencesU.K.

58U.K.In section 120 of the 1990 Act (enforcement of additional radio services licences), for “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I226Sch. 15 para. 58 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

InterpretationU.K.

59U.K.In subsection (1) of section 126 of the 1990 Act (interpretation of Part 3)—

(a)for the definition of “independent radio service” there shall be substituted—

independent radio service” means a service falling to be regulated under section 245 of the Communications Act 2003;;

(b)for the definitions of “local service”, “national service”, “restricted service” and “satellite service” there shall be substituted—

local service”, “national service” and “restricted service” each has the same meaning as in section 245 of the Communications Act 2003;

pre-transfer local licence” and “pre-transfer national licence” each has the same meaning as in section 253 of that Act;

radio licensable content service” has the same meaning as in Part 3 of that Act;

radio transfer date” has the same meaning as in that Act;;

(c)in the definition of “sound broadcasting service” for the words from “(as defined” to the end there shall be substituted “ (within the meaning of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003); ”.

Commencement Information

I227Sch. 15 para. 59 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Duty to provide advance information about programmesU.K.

60U.K.In column 1 of the Table in section 176(7) of the 1990 Act (persons who are the providers of services for the purposes of the obligations to give advance information about programmes)—

(a)for “regulation by the Independent Television Commission” there shall be substituted “ regulation by OFCOM ”;

(b)for “The television broadcasting service provided by the Welsh Authority and the service referred to in section 57(1A)(a)” there shall be substituted “ The public television services of the Welsh Authority (within the meaning of Part 2 of Schedule 12 to the Communications Act 2003) ”;

(c)for “section 84(2)(a)(i)” there shall be substituted “ section 126(1) ”;

(d)for “the Radio Authority”, in both places, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I228Sch. 15 para. 60 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Proscription of foreign satellite servicesU.K.

61(1)Section 177 of the 1990 Act (proscription of foreign satellite stations) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (2), for “the Independent Television Commission or the Radio Authority consider that the quality of any relevant” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM consider that the quality of any ”.

(3)In subsection (3), for the words from the beginning to “Authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(4)In subsection (6), the definition of “relevant foreign satellite service” shall be omitted.

Commencement Information

I229Sch. 15 para. 61 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Financing of Gaelic BroadcastingU.K.

62(1)Section 183 of the 1990 Act (financing of Gaelic Broadcasting) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2), for “by them under this section to be” there shall be substituted “ by the Independent Television Commission under this section and ”.

(4)This paragraph—

(a) so far as it relates to subsection (1) of section 183 has effect in relation only to financial years beginning after the television transfer date; and

(b)so far as it relates to subsection (2) of that section does not apply to amounts paid for earlier financial years.

Commencement Information

I230Sch. 15 para. 62 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Gaelic Broadcasting in ScotlandU.K.

63(1)Section 184 of the 1990 Act (broadcasting of programmes in Gaelic on Channel 3 in Scotland) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for the words “subsection (2)” there shall be substituted “ subsection (1)(a) ”.

(3)In subsection (3), for the words from “The conditions” to “the purpose of” there shall be substituted “ The regulatory regime for a service to which this section applies includes the conditions that OFCOM consider appropriate for ”.

(4)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(3A)Section 263 of the Communications Act 2003 (regulatory regime) applies in relation to conditions included by virtue of subsection (3) in the regulatory regime for a licensed service as it applies in relation to conditions which are so included by virtue of a provision of Chapter 4 of Part 3 of that Act.

(5)In subsection (4)(b), for “the Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I231Sch. 15 para. 63 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Maintenance of the national television archiveU.K.

64(1)In section 185 of the 1990 Act (maintenance of the national television archive)—U.K.

(a)for “The Commission” and “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(b)in subsection (5), the definition of “the Commission” shall be omitted.

(2)This paragraph so far as it relates to subsection (1) of that section has effect in relation only to financial years beginning after the television transfer date.

Commencement Information

I232Sch. 15 para. 64 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Modification of networking arrangementsU.K.

65(1)Section 193 of the 1990 Act (modification of networking arrangements in consequence of competition legislation) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for the words from “the Office of Fair Trading” to “relevant authority')” there shall be substituted “ the relevant authority ”.

(3)After subsection (2) there shall be inserted—

(2A)In subsection (1), “relevant authority” means—

(a)in relation to a relevant order falling within subsection (2)(a), the Office of Fair Trading, the Competition Commission or (as the case may be) the Secretary of State;

(b)in relation to a relevant order falling within subsection (2)(b), the Office of Fair Trading, the Competition Commission, the Secretary of State or (as the case may be) OFCOM.

(4)In subsection (4), for “section 39(1) above” there shall be substituted “ section 290(4) of the Communications Act 2003 ”.

Commencement Information

I233Sch. 15 para. 65 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Search warrantsU.K.

66(1)Section 196 of the 1990 Act (grant of search warrant to person authorised by the Independent Television Commission or the Radio Authority) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for “the relevant authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)Subsection (2) (definition of “relevant authority”) shall be omitted.

Commencement Information

I234Sch. 15 para. 66 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

NoticesU.K.

67U.K.In section 199(5) of the 1990 Act (publication of notices), for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted “ by OFCOM under section 21, 41, 42, 55, 103, 109, 110, 111 or 120 ”.

Commencement Information

I235Sch. 15 para. 67 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

InterpretationU.K.

68(1)Section 202 of the 1990 Act (general interpretation) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), after the definition of “modifications” there shall be inserted—

OFCOM” means the Office of Communications;.

(3)After subsection (6) there shall be inserted—

(6A)Subsections (2) and (3) of section 362 of the Communications Act 2003 (persons by whom services provided) are to apply for the purposes of this Act as they apply for the purposes of Part 3 of that Act.

Commencement Information

I236Sch. 15 para. 68 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Disqualified personsU.K.

69(1)Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act (restrictions on the holding of licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraph 1(1) of Part 1, after the definition of “associate” there shall be inserted—

Broadcasting Act licence” means a licence under Part 1 or 3 of this Act or Part 1 or 2 of the Broadcasting Act 1996;.

(3)In paragraph 1(6) of Part 1 (meaning of “more than a 20 per cent. interest”), for “20 per cent.”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ 5 per cent. ”.

(4)In Part 2 (disqualified persons), for “a licence granted by the Commission or the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ a Broadcasting Act licence ”.

(5)In paragraph 1(1)(i) of Part 2 (bodies controlled by persons falling within paragraphs (a) to (g)), for “(a)” there shall be substituted “ (c) ”.

(6)In paragraph 3(1) of Part 2, for “by the Authority” there shall be substituted “ under Part 3 of this Act or Part 2 of the Broadcasting Act 1996 ”.

(7)In paragraph 4(1) of Part 2, for “that body” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(8)In paragraph 4(2) of Part 2—

(a)in paragraph (a), for “by the Commission, means a body” there shall be substituted “ under Part 1 of this Act or Part 1 of the Broadcasting Act 1996, means a person ”; and

(b)in paragraph (b), for “by the Authority, means a body” there shall be substituted “ under Part 3 of this Act or Part 2 of the Broadcasting Act 1996, means a person ”.

(9)In paragraph 5A of Part 2—

(a)in sub-paragraph (1)(a), the words “granted by the Commission”,

(b)sub-paragraph (1)(b) and the word “and” immediately preceding it,

(c)in sub-paragraph (2), the words “granted by the Authority”,

shall be omitted.

Commencement Information

I237Sch. 15 para. 69 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

C4CU.K.

70(1)Schedule 3 to the 1990 Act (provision about constitution and management of C4C) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In paragraph 2(1) (persons disqualified from membership of the Corporation), for paragraphs (b) to (d) there shall be substituted or

(b)a member or employee of OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I238Sch. 15 para. 70 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

The Welsh AuthorityU.K.

71(1)Schedule 6 to the 1990 Act (provision about constitution and management of the Welsh Authority) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraph 2 (persons disqualified from membership of the Authority)—

(a)sub-paragraph (1) shall be omitted; and

(b)in sub-paragraph (2)(b), for “the Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In paragraph 12(1A), for the words from “the general fund” onwards there shall be substituted “ the assets of the Authority that are not comprised in that fund; and accordingly, the statement must deal with liabilities separately according to whether they fall to be met from that fund or from those assets. ”

Commencement Information

I239Sch. 15 para. 71 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Computation of qualifying revenueU.K.

72(1)Schedule 7 to the 1990 Act (computation of “qualifying revenue”) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In Part 1, for “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In Part 2, for “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I240Sch. 15 para. 72 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

The Gaelic Television CommitteeU.K.

73(1)Schedule 19 to the 1990 Act (Gaelic Television Committee) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)For “Committee”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ Service ”.

(4)In paragraph 8(c), the words “and (where the expenses relate to the Commission’s functions in connection with sound programmes) the Radio Authority” shall be omitted.

(5)In paragraph 11(4), the words “or the Radio Authority” and “or (as the case may be) the Authority” shall be omitted.

Commencement Information

I241Sch. 15 para. 73 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Part 2U.K.Amendments of the 1996 Act

Multiplex services and digital programme servicesU.K.

74(1)Section 1 of the 1996 Act (interpretation) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For subsection (1) there shall be substituted—

(1)In this Part “multiplex service” means (except where the context otherwise requires) a television multiplex service.

(3)In subsection (4), for “for general reception” there shall be substituted “ so as to be available for reception by members of the public ”.

(4)For subsection (4A) there shall be substituted—

(4A)In subsection (4), “available for reception by members of the public” means available for reception by members of the public (within the meaning of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003) in the United Kingdom or another EEA State, or in an area of the United Kingdom or of such a State.

(5)For subsection (7) of that section there shall be substituted—

(7)In this section “broadcast” means broadcast otherwise than from a satellite.

Commencement Information

I242Sch. 15 para. 74 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Meaning of qualifying serviceU.K.

75U.K.In section 2 of the 1996 Act (meaning of “qualifying service” etc.), for subsections (2) to (6) there shall be substituted—

(2)In this Part “qualifying service” means any of the following, so far as they are provided with a view to their being broadcast in digital form—

(a)a television broadcasting service included in Channel 3;

(b)Channel 4;

(c)Channel 5;

(d)S4C Digital;

(e)a television programme service provided by the Welsh Authority with the approval of the Secretary of State under section 205 of the Communications Act 2003;

(f)the digital public teletext service.

Commencement Information

I243Sch. 15 para. 75 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licences under Part 1U.K.

76(1)Section 3 of the 1996 Act (licences under Part 1 of that Act) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for “the Independent Television Commission (in this Part referred to as the “the Commission”)” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsections (3) to (7), for “The Commission” and “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(4)For subsection (8) there shall be substituted—

(8)The holding by a person of a licence under this Part shall not relieve him of—

(a)any liability in respect of a failure to hold a licence under section 1 of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949; or

(b)any obligation to comply with requirements imposed by or under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of the Communications Act 2003 (electronic communications networks and electronic communications services).

Commencement Information

I244Sch. 15 para. 76 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licence conditionsU.K.

77(1)Section 4 of the 1996 Act (general licence conditions) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1), in each of paragraphs (a) and (c), for “the 1990 Act or this Act” there shall be substituted “ this Act, the 1990 Act or the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(4)In subsection (3) (fixing fees), the words from “and the amount” onwards shall be omitted.

Commencement Information

I245Sch. 15 para. 77 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Restrictions on digital licence holdingU.K.

78(1)Section 5 of the 1996 Act (restrictions on holding licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “The Commission” and “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2) (incidental requirements to provide information), after paragraph (d) there shall be inserted—

(da)impose conditions in a licence requiring the licence holder, if a body corporate, to give OFCOM notice, after they have occurred and irrespective of whether proposals for them have fallen to be notified, of changes, transactions or events affecting—

(i)shareholdings in the body; or

(ii)the directors of the body;

(db)impose conditions in a licence enabling OFCOM to require the licence holder to provide them with such information as they may reasonably require for determining—

(i)whether the licence holder is a disqualified person in relation to that licence by virtue of Part 2 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act; or

(ii)whether any such requirements as are mentioned in subsection (1)(b) have been and are being complied with by or in relation to the licence holder;.

(4)In subsection (6)—

(a)in paragraph (a), for “complained of” there shall be substituted “ constituting their grounds for revoking the licence ”.

(b)in paragraph (b)(i), for “Parts III and IV of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act” there shall be substituted “ the requirements imposed by or under Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(5)In subsection (7)—

(a)paragraph (a) shall cease to have effect; and

(b)in paragraph (b), for “Part IV of that Schedule” there shall be substituted “ Part 1 of Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(6)In subsection (8), for the words from “a failure” to the end of paragraph (c) there shall be substituted “ a disqualification under Part 2 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act or a contravention of a requirement imposed by or under Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003, ”.

Commencement Information

I246Sch. 15 para. 78 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Multiplex licencesU.K.

79(1)Section 7 of the 1996 Act (multiplex licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (4)—

(a)after paragraph (c) there shall be inserted—

(ca)the applicant’s proposals as to the number (if any) of digital sound programmes services which are to be broadcast, as to the characteristics of each of those services and as to the areas in which they would be provided;

(b)in paragraph (d) for “those services” there shall be substituted “ the services mentioned in paragraphs (c) and (ca) ”.

Commencement Information

I247Sch. 15 para. 79 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Award of multiplex licencesU.K.

80(1)Section 8 of the 1996 Act (award of multiplex licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2)(f), after “digital programme service” there shall be inserted “ , digital sound programme service ”.

Commencement Information

I248Sch. 15 para. 80 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Power to require two or more multiplex licences to be granted to one personU.K.

81U.K.In section 9 of the 1996 Act (grant of two or more multiplex licences to one person), for “The Commission” and “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I249Sch. 15 para. 81 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Award of multiplex licences subject to conditionsU.K.

82(1)Section 10 of the 1996 Act (award of multiplex licences subject to conditions) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “The Commission” and “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1)(a), for “the 1990 Act or this Act” there shall be substituted “ this Act, the 1990 Act or Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003 ”.

Commencement Information

I250Sch. 15 para. 82 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Failure to provide licensed service and revocationU.K.

83U.K.In section 11 of the 1996 Act (failure to provide licensed service and revocation), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I251Sch. 15 para. 83 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Conditions attached to multiplex licencesU.K.

84U.K.In section 12 of the 1996 Act (conditions attached to multiplex licences), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I252Sch. 15 para. 84 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional payments in respect of multiplex licencesU.K.

85U.K.In section 13 of the 1996 Act (additional payments in respect of multiplex licences), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I253Sch. 15 para. 85 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Multiplex revenueU.K.

86(1)Section 14 of the 1996 Act (multiplex revenue) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1)—

(a)for “section 13(1)” there shall be substituted “ this Part ”;

(b)for “the holder of a multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ the person who is the multiplex provider in relation to any television multiplex service or any general multiplex service ”;

(c)in paragraph (a), for “the multiplex service to which the licence relates” there shall be substituted “ the relevant multiplex ”;

(d)in paragraph (b) for “of any qualifying service by means of the multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ by means of the multiplex service of any service which is a qualifying service or which (without being a qualifying service) is provided by the BBC ”;

(e)in paragraphs (c) and (d), for “the holder of the multiplex licence” and “the multiplex service”, in each place where they occur there shall be substituted, respectively, “ the multiplex provider ” and “ the relevant multiplex ”.

(3)In subsections (2) to (8)—

(a)for the words “the holder of the multiplex licence” and “the licence holder”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted, in each case, “ the multiplex provider ”; and

(b)for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(4)In subsection (9)—

(a)for “a multiplex licence”, in each place, there shall be substituted “ a television multiplex service or a general multiplex service ”;

(b)for “the multiplex service to which the licence relates”, in each place, there shall be substituted “ that multiplex service ”;

(c)after the definition of “additional services provider” there shall be inserted—

“multiplex provider”—

(a)in relation to a television multiplex service for which a person holds a licence under this Part, means the licence holder; and

(b)in relation to a television multiplex service which is not licensed under this Part or a general multiplex service, means the person who provides that service;

(d)after the definition of “programme provider” there shall be inserted—

“the relevant multiplex”—

(a)in relation to a multiplex provider falling within paragraph (a) of the definition of that expression, means the television multiplex service to which his licence relates; and

(b)in relation to any other multiplex provider, means the television multiplex service or general multiplex service which is provided by him;

and this section and section 15 shall have effect as if references in this section to digital programme services included references to digital sound programme services and references to digital additional services included references to digital additional services within the meaning of Part 2.

Commencement Information

I254Sch. 15 para. 86 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Attribution of multiplex revenue to multiplex providersU.K.

87(1)Section 15 of the 1996 Act (attribution of multiplex revenue to licence holder) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1)—

(a)for “the holder of a multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ the person who is the multiplex provider in relation to any television multiplex service ”;

(b)for “of multiplex services in that period,” there shall be substituted “ in that period of television multiplex services, ”;

(c)for “the holder of the multiplex licence” there shall be substituted, “ the multiplex provider ”.

(3)In subsection (2)—

(a)for “a multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ a television multiplex service or a general multiplex service ”;

(b)for “the holder of the multiplex licence”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the multiplex provider ”.

(4)In subsection (3)—

(a)for “the Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”; and

(b)for “the holder of the multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ the multiplex provider ”.

(5)In subsection (4)—

(a)after “additional services provider” there shall be inserted “ , ‘multiplex provider’ ”; and

(b)for “a multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ a television multiplex service or a general multiplex service ”.

Commencement Information

I255Sch. 15 para. 87 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Duration of multiplex licencesU.K.

88(1)Section 16 of the 1996 Act (duration and renewal of multiplex licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (3), after “not later than” there shall be inserted “ the day falling three months before ”.

(4)After subsection (12), there shall be inserted—

(12A)A determination for the purposes of subsection (12)—

(a)must be made at least one year before the date determined; and

(b)must be notified by OFCOM to the person who holds the licence in question.

Commencement Information

I256Sch. 15 para. 88 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of multiplex licencesU.K.

89U.K.In section 17 of the 1996 Act (enforcement of multiplex licences), for “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I257Sch. 15 para. 89 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licensing of digital programme servicesU.K.

90(1)Section 18 of the 1996 Act (licensing of digital programme services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsections (1) to (4), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)Subsections (5) and (6) (application of sections 6 to 12 of the 1990 Act) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I258Sch. 15 para. 90 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Conditions of licences for digital programme servicesU.K.

91(1)Section 19 of the 1996 Act (conditions of licences for digital programme services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (3)—

(a)for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”;

(b)in paragraphs (a) and (c), for “the holder of a multiplex licence” there shall be substituted, in each case, “ the provider of a television multiplex service or general multiplex service ”;

(c)in paragraph (a), for “by means of a multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ by means of that provider’s service ”; and

(d)in paragraph (a)(i), for “the identity of the multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ the identity of the service by means of which it will be broadcast ”.

(3)Subsections (2) and (4) to (10) of that section shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I259Sch. 15 para. 91 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Duration and enforcement of multiplex licensesU.K.

92(1)Section 23 of the 1996 Act (enforcement of digital programme licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (4), for the words from “multiplex service” onwards there shall be substituted “ television multiplex service or general multiplex service, means the last accounting period of the multiplex provider ”.

(4)In subsection (5), for “multiplex service, the first accounting period of the holder of the multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ television multiplex service or general multiplex service, the first accounting period of the multiplex provider ”.

(5)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(5A)In subsections (4) and (5) “multiplex provider” has the same meaning as in section 14.

(6)In subsection (8) for “apology” there shall be substituted “ statement of findings ”.

Commencement Information

I260Sch. 15 para. 92 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Digital additional servicesU.K.

93(1)Section 24 of the 1996 Act (digital additional services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted—

(a)is provided by a person with a view to its being broadcast in digital form (whether by him or some other person) so as to be available for reception by members of the public;

(b)is so provided with a view either—

(i)to the broadcasting being by means of a television multiplex service or by means of a general multiplex service; or

(ii)to the members of the public in question being or including members of the public in an EEA State other than the United Kingdom, or in an area of such a State;

and

(c)is not a Channel 3 service, Channel 4, Channel 5, a public television service of the Welsh Authority, the digital public teletext service, a digital programme service, a digital sound programme service, an ancillary service or a technical service.

(3)In subsection (2) (meaning of ancillary service)—

(a)for “an independent analogue broadcaster” there shall be substituted “ a relevant public service broadcaster ”; and

(b)for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted—

(a)assistance for disabled people in relation to some or all of the programmes included in a digital programme service or qualifying service provided by him;

(b)a service (apart from advertising) that relates to the promotion or listing of programmes included in such a service or in a digital sound programme service so provided; or

(c)any other service (apart from advertising) that is ancillary to one or more programmes so included, and relates directly to their contents.

(4)In subsection (3)(a), after “digital programme services” there shall be inserted “ , digital sound programme services ”.

(5)After subsection (3) there shall be inserted—

(3A)In this section—

assistance for disabled people” has the same meaning as in Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003;

available for reception by members of the public” shall be construed in accordance with section 361 of that Act;

public television service of the Welsh Authority” means—

(a)S4C Digital; or

(b)any television programme service the provision of which by the Authority is authorised by or under section 205 of that Act and which is provided in digital form;

relevant public service broadcaster” means any of the following—

(a)a person licensed under Part 1 of the 1990 Act to provide a Channel 3 service;

(b)the Channel 4 Corporation;

(c)a person licensed under Part 1 of the 1990 Act to provide Channel 5;

(d)the BBC;

(e)the Welsh Authority;

(f)the public teletext provider.

Commencement Information

I261Sch. 15 para. 93 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licensing of digital additional servicesU.K.

94(1)Section 25 of the 1996 Act (licensing of digital additional services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsections (1) to (4), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)After subsection (4) there shall be inserted—

(4A)A digital additional services licence is not required for a service that is or is comprised in a qualifying service.

(4)Subsections (5) and (6) (application of sections 6 to 12 of the 1990 Act) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I262Sch. 15 para. 94 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Conditions of digital additional services licenceU.K.

95(1)Section 26 of the 1996 Act (conditions of licences for digital additional services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (2)—

(a)for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”;

(b)in paragraphs (a) and (c), for “the holder of a multiplex licence” there shall be substituted, in each case, “ the provider of a television multiplex service or general multiplex service ”;

(c)in paragraph (a), for “by means of a multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ by means of that provider’s service ”; and

(d)in paragraph (a)(i), for “the identity of the multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ the identity of the service by means of which it will be broadcast ”.

Commencement Information

I263Sch. 15 para. 95 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of digital additional television services licencesU.K.

96(1)Section 27 of the 1996 Act (enforcement of digital additional television services licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (4), for the words from “multiplex service” onwards there shall be substituted “ television multiplex service or general multiplex service, means the last accounting period of the multiplex provider ”.

(4)In subsection (5), for “multiplex service, the first accounting period of the holder of the multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ television multiplex service or general multiplex service, the first accounting period of the multiplex provider ”.

(5)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(5A)In subsections (4) and (5) “multiplex provider” has the same meaning as in section 14.

Commencement Information

I264Sch. 15 para. 96 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Digital broadcasting of Gaelic programmesU.K.

97(1)Section 32 of the 1996 Act (digital broadcasting of Gaelic programmes) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for “the Commission to include in any multiplex licence granted in respect of one frequency to which section 28 applies” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM to include in no more than one relevant multiplex licence ”.

(3)In subsection (7), for “Comataidh Craolaidh Gaidhlig” there shall be substituted “ Seirbheis nam Meadhanan Gàidhlig ”.

(4)For subsection (9) there shall be substituted—

(9)In this section—

Gaelic” means the Gaelic language as spoken in Scotland;

relevant multiplex licence” means a multiplex licence in respect of which the Secretary of State has made an order under section 243(3) of the Communications Act 2003;

television broadcasting service” has the same meaning as in Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003.

Commencement Information

I265Sch. 15 para. 97 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Review of digital television broadcastingU.K.

98(1)Section 33 of the 1996 Act (review of digital television broadcasting) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1)(a)(ii), for the words “services specified in section 2(3), S4C Digital, the qualifying teletext service” there shall be substituted “ following services, namely, Channel 3 services, Channel 4, Channel 5, the public television services of the Welsh Authority (within the meaning of Part 2 of Schedule 12 to the Communications Act 2003), the digital public teletext service ”.

Commencement Information

I266Sch. 15 para. 98 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of licences held by BBC companiesU.K.

99U.K.In section 35 of the 1996 Act (enforcement of licences held by BBC companies), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I267Sch. 15 para. 99 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Interpretation of Part 1U.K.

100U.K.In section 39(1) (interpretation of Part 1)—

(a)after the definition of “digital programme service” there shall be inserted—

digital public teletext service” has the same meaning as in Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003;

digital sound programme service” has the same meaning as in Part 2 of this Act;

general multiplex service” has the same meaning as in that Part;.

(b)for the definition of “public teletext provider” there shall be substituted—

public teletext provider” means the person for the time being licensed under Part 1 of the 1990 Act to provide the public teletext service (within the meaning of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003);

(c)for the definitions of “S4C” and “on S4C” and of “S4C Digital” and “on S4C Digital” there shall be substituted—

S4C” and “S4C Digital” each has the same meaning as in Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003;.

(d)after the definition of “technical service” there shall be inserted—

television multiplex service” has the meaning given by section 241 of the Communications Act 2003.

Commencement Information

I268Sch. 15 para. 100 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Radio multiplex servicesU.K.

101(1)Section 40 of the 1996 Act (radio multiplex services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For subsections (1) to (3) there shall be substituted—

(1)In this Part “radio multiplex service” means a radio multiplex service within the meaning of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003.

(3)In subsection (4) (local and national multiplex services), the words “provided on a frequency or frequencies assigned to the Authority under section 45(1)” shall be omitted.

(4)In subsection (5), for “for general reception” there shall be substituted “ so as to be available for reception by members of the public ”.

(5)For subsection (8) of that section there shall be substituted—

(8)In this section—

available for reception by members of the public” shall be construed in accordance with section 361 of the Communications Act 2003;

broadcast” means broadcast otherwise than from a satellite.

Commencement Information

I269Sch. 15 para. 101 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Licences under Part 2 of the 1996 ActU.K.

102(1)Section 42 of the 1996 Act (licences under Part 2) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for “the Radio Authority (in this Part referred to as “the Authority”)” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsections (2), (5) and (6), for “The Authority” and “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(4)For subsection (3) (variation of licences) there shall be substituted—

(3)OFCOM may vary a licence by a notice served on the licence holder.

(3A)OFCOM shall not vary—

(a)the period for which a licence having effect for a specified period is to continue in force, or

(b)increase the total amount of digital capacity specified in a national radio multiplex licence for the purposes of section 48(1A),

unless the licence holder consents.

(3B)OFCOM shall not make any other variation of a licence unless the licence holder has been given a reasonable opportunity of making representations to OFCOM about the variation.

(5)In subsection (4) (exceptions from power to vary licences), for “Paragraph (a) of subsection (3)” there shall be substituted “ Paragraph (a) of subsection (3A) ”.

(6)For subsection (7) there shall be substituted—

(7)The holding of a licence by a person shall not relieve him—

(a)of any liability in respect of a failure to hold a licence under section 1 of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949; or

(b)of any obligation to comply with requirements imposed by or under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of the Communications Act 2003 (electronic communications networks and electronic communications services).

Commencement Information

I270Sch. 15 para. 102 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

General licence conditionsU.K.

103(1)Section 43 of the 1996 Act (general licence conditions) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1) (conditions may include conditions to give effect to duties imposed by or under 1990 Act or 1996 Act)—

(a)in paragraph (a), for “the 1990 Act or this Act” there shall be substituted “ this Act, the 1990 Act or the Communications Act 2003 ”; and

(b)in paragraph (d), after “this Act” there shall be inserted “ , the 1990 Act or the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(4)In subsection (2), sub-paragraph (ii) of paragraph (b) and the word “or” immediately preceding it shall be omitted.

(5)In subsection (3) (fixing of fees), the words from “and the amount” onwards shall be omitted.

Commencement Information

I271Sch. 15 para. 103 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Restrictions on holding licencesU.K.

104(1)Section 44 of the 1996 Act (restrictions on the holding of licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “The Authority” and “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2) (incidental requirements to provide information), after paragraph (d) there shall be inserted—

(da)impose conditions in a licence requiring the licence holder, if a body corporate, to give OFCOM notice, after they have occurred and irrespective of whether proposals for them have fallen to be notified, of changes, transactions or events affecting—

(i)shareholdings in the body; or

(ii)the directors of the body;

(db)impose conditions in a licence enabling OFCOM to require the licence holder to provide them with such information as they may reasonably require for determining—

(i)whether the licence holder is a disqualified person in relation to that licence by virtue of Part 2 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act; or

(ii)whether any such requirements as are mentioned in subsection (1)(b) have been and are being complied with by or in relation to the licence holder;.

(4)In subsection (6)—

(a)in paragraph (a), for “complained of” there shall be substituted “ constituting their grounds for revoking the licence ”; and

(b)in paragraph (b)(i), for “Parts III and IV of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act” there shall be substituted “ the requirements imposed by or under Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(5)In subsection (7)—

(a)paragraph (a) shall cease to have effect; and

(b)in paragraph (b), for “Part IV of that Schedule” there shall be substituted “ Part 1 of Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(6)In subsection (8), for the words from “a failure” to the end of paragraph (c) there shall be substituted “ a disqualification under Part 2 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act or a contravention of a requirement imposed by or under Schedule 14 to the Communications Act 2003, ”.

Commencement Information

I272Sch. 15 para. 104 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

National radio multiplex licencesU.K.

105(1)Section 46 of the 1996 Act (national radio multiplex licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1)(d), for “a direction” there shall be substituted “ a condition ”.

Commencement Information

I273Sch. 15 para. 105 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Award of national radio multiplex licencesU.K.

106U.K.In section 47 of the 1996 Act (award of national radio multiplex licences), for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I274Sch. 15 para. 106 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Reservation of capacity for independent national broadcastersU.K.

107(1)Section 48 of the 1996 Act (reservation of digital capacity for independent broadcasters) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For subsections (1) to (3) there shall be substituted—

(1A)OFCOM must ensure that the conditions included in national radio multiplex licences (taken together) secure that an amount of digital capacity on the multiplex frequencies is reserved for every independent national broadcaster for the broadcasting of a simulcast radio service provided by that broadcaster.

(1B)Where the conditions of a licence for a national radio multiplex service reserve capacity on the frequency made available for that service for the broadcasting of a simulcast radio service provided by an independent national broadcaster, those conditions must also include the condition specified in subsection (1C).

(1C)That condition is the condition that OFCOM consider appropriate for securing that, in consideration of the making by the independent national broadcaster of the payments which —

(a)are agreed from time to time between him and the licence holder, or

(b)in default of agreement, are determined under this section,

the licence holder uses, for the broadcasting of a simulcast radio service provided by that broadcaster, such of the reserved digital capacity as may be requested, from time to time, by that broadcaster.

(1D)Where conditions are included under this section in a national radio multiplex licence reserving capacity for an independent national broadcaster, OFCOM may include conditions relating to the broadcasting of the simulcast radio service in the licence for the national service provided by that broadcaster.

(3)In subsections (4) to (6), for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(4)In subsection (4), for “subsection (3)(a)” there shall be substituted “ subsection (1C) ”.

(5)After subsection (6) there shall be inserted—

(7)In this section “the multiplex frequencies” means the frequencies made available for the purposes of licensed national radio multiplex services.

Commencement Information

I275Sch. 15 para. 107 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Reservation of digital capacity for BBCU.K.

108(1)Section 49 of the 1996 Act (reservation of digital capacity for BBC) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsections (1) to (3) and (6), for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (4) (determination of capacity to be reserved), for the words from “If the BBC” to “the Secretary of State, who may” there shall be substituted “ If the BBC do not give their consent to the proposals within such period as OFCOM may specify in their notice under subsection (3), OFCOM shall ”.

(4)In subsection (5), for words from “the Secretary of State” onwards there shall be substituted “ OFCOM shall give the BBC an opportunity of making representations to them about their proposals. ”

(5)In subsection (6), after “and the BBC” there shall be inserted “ or (in default of agreement) determined under this section ”.

(6)After that subsection there shall be inserted—

(7)Where the holder of the licence and the BBC fail to agree—

(a)the payments to be made under a condition included in the licence in accordance with subsection (6), or

(b)the other terms that are to apply in relation to the use of digital capacity in accordance with such a condition,

either of them may refer the matter to OFCOM for determination.

(8)Before making a determination under subsection (7), OFCOM must give the licence holder and the BBC an opportunity of making representations to them about the matter.

(9)In making any determination under subsection (7), OFCOM shall have regard to—

(a)the expenses incurred, or likely to be incurred, by the licence holder in providing the local radio multiplex service in question, and

(b)the terms on which persons providing local radio multiplex services contract with persons providing local digital additional services for the broadcasting of those services.

Commencement Information

I276Sch. 15 para. 108 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Local radio multiplex licencesU.K.

109(1)Section 50 of the 1996 Act (local radio multiplex licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (1)(b), for “the Secretary of State has” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM have ”.

(4)In subsection (2)(d), for “direction under section 49” substitute “ determination under section 49(4) ”.

Commencement Information

I277Sch. 15 para. 109 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Award of local multiplex licencesU.K.

110(1)Section 51 of the 1996 Act (award of local multiplex licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2), for paragraph (f) there shall be substituted—

(f)the extent to which there is evidence that, amongst persons living in that area or locality, there is a demand for, or support for, the provision of the proposed service; and.

Commencement Information

I278Sch. 15 para. 110 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Power to require two or more local radio multiplex licences to be granted to one personU.K.

111U.K.In section 52 of the 1996 Act (power to require two or more local radio multiplex licences to be granted to one person), for “The Authority” and “the Authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I279Sch. 15 para. 111 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Failure to begin to provide licensed serviceU.K.

112U.K.In section 53 of the 1996 Act (failure to provide licensed service), for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I280Sch. 15 para. 112 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Conditions which may be attached to radio multiplex licencesU.K.

113U.K.In section 54 of the 1996 Act (conditions which may be attached to a radio multiplex licence), for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I281Sch. 15 para. 113 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Additional payments to be made in respect of national radio multiplex licencesU.K.

114U.K.In section 55 of the 1996 Act (additional payments to be made in respect of national radio multiplex licences) for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I282Sch. 15 para. 114 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Multiplex revenueU.K.

115(1)Section 56 of the 1996 Act (multiplex revenue) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1)—

(a)for “section 55(1)” there shall be substituted “ this Part ”;

(b)for “the holder of a national radio multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ the person who is the multiplex provider in relation to a national radio multiplex service ”;

(c)in paragraph (a)(i), “to which the licence relates” shall be omitted;

(d)in paragraphs (c) and (d), for “the holder of the radio multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ the multiplex provider ”.

(3)In subsections (2) to (8)—

(a)for “the holder of the radio multiplex licence”, “the licence holder” and “the holder of the multiplex licence”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted, in each case, “ the multiplex provider ”; and

(b)for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(4)In subsection (9)—

(a)for “a national radio multiplex licence”, in each place, there shall be substituted “ a national radio multiplex service ”;

(b)for “the radio multiplex service to which the licence relates”, in each place, there shall be substituted “ that radio multiplex service ”;

(c)after the definition of “additional services provider” there shall be inserted—

“multiplex provider”—

(a)in relation to a national radio multiplex service for which a person holds a licence under this Part, means the licence holder; and

(b)in relation to a national radio multiplex service which is not licensed under this Part, means the person who provides that service.

Commencement Information

I283Sch. 15 para. 115 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Attribution of radio multiplex revenueU.K.

116(1)Section 57 of the 1996 Act (attribution of radio multiplex revenue) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1)—

(a)for “the holder of a national radio multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ the person who is the multiplex provider in relation to a national radio multiplex service ”; and

(b)for “the holder of the national radio multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ the multiplex provider ”.

(3)In subsection (2), for “the holder of the radio multiplex licence”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the multiplex provider ”.

(4)In subsection (3)—

(a)for “the Authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”; and

(b)for “the holder of the national radio multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ the multiplex provider ”.

(5)In subsection (4)—

(a)after “‘additional services provider’” there shall be inserted “ ‘, multiplex provider’ ”; and

(b)for “a national radio multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ a national radio multiplex service ”.

Commencement Information

I284Sch. 15 para. 116 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Duration and renewal of radio multiplex licencesU.K.

117(1)Section 58 of the 1996 Act (duration and renewal of radio multiplex licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (3), after “not later than” there shall be inserted “ the day falling three months before ”.

(4)Subsection (5) (consent of the Secretary of State for exercise of certain powers in connection with renewal) shall cease to have effect.

(5)After subsection (12) there shall be inserted—

(12A)A determination for the purposes of subsection (12)—

(a)must be made at least one year before the date determined; and

(b)must be notified by OFCOM to the person who holds the licence in question.

Commencement Information

I285Sch. 15 para. 117 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of radio multiplex licencesU.K.

118U.K.In section 59 of the 1996 Act (enforcement of radio multiplex licences), for “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I286Sch. 15 para. 118 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Digital sound programme licensingU.K.

119(1)Section 60 of the 1996 Act (digital sound programme licensing) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)After subsection (6), there shall be inserted—

(6A)Section 89 of the 1990 Act (disqualification from being licence holder or concerned with the provision of a programme service if convicted of a transmitting offence) shall apply in relation to a licence under this section as it applies to a licence under Part 3 of that Act, but with the omission of paragraph (b) of subsection (3) of that section and of the word “or” immediately before that paragraph.

(4)Sub-paragraph (3) does not impose a disqualification in respect of any offence committed before the commencement of that sub-paragraph.

Commencement Information

I287Sch. 15 para. 119 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Conditions of digital sound programme licencesU.K.

120(1)Section 61 of the 1996 Act (conditions of licences for digital sound programme services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (2)—

(a)for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”;

(b)in paragraphs (a) and (c), for “the holder of a radio multiplex licence”, there shall be substituted, in each case, “ the provider of a radio multiplex service, of a television multiplex service or of a general multiplex service ”;

(c)in paragraph (a) for “by means of a radio multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ by means of the multiplex service ”; and

(d)in paragraph (a)(i) for “radio multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ multiplex service ”.

Commencement Information

I288Sch. 15 para. 120 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of digital sound programme licencesU.K.

121(1)Section 62 of the 1996 Act (enforcement of digital sound programme licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (4), for the words from “national radio multiplex service” onwards there shall be substituted “ relevant multiplex service, means the last accounting period of the multiplex provider ”.

(4)In subsection (5)—

(a)for “national radio multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ relevant multiplex service ”;

(b)for “holder of the national radio multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ multiplex provider ”; and

(c)for “the radio multiplex service” and “that radio multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ that relevant multiplex service ”.

(5)After subsection (5A) (inserted by Schedule 13) there shall be inserted—

(5B)For the purposes of this section, a service is a relevant multiplex service if it is—

(a)a national radio multiplex service;

(b)a television multiplex service; or

(c)a general multiplex service.

(5C)In this section, “multiplex provider”—

(a)in relation to a national radio multiplex service, means the multiplex provider within the meaning of section 56; and

(b)in relation to a television multiplex service or a general multiplex service, means the multiplex provider within the meaning of section 14.

(6)In subsection (10) for “apology” there shall be substituted “ statement of findings ”.

Commencement Information

I289Sch. 15 para. 121 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Digital additional sound servicesU.K.

122U.K.In section 64 of the 1996 Act (licensing of digital additional sound services), for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I290Sch. 15 para. 122 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Conditions of digital additional sound service U.K.

123(1)Section 65 of the 1996 Act (conditions of licences for digital additional sound services) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (2)—

(a)for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”;

(b)in paragraphs (a) and (c), for “the holder of a radio multiplex licence”, there shall be substituted, in each case, “ the provider of a radio multiplex service or of a general multiplex service ”;

(c)in paragraph (a) for “by means of a radio multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ by means of the multiplex service ”; and

(d)in paragraph (a)(i) for “radio multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ multiplex service ”.

Commencement Information

I291Sch. 15 para. 123 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enforcement of digital additional sound services licencesU.K.

124(1)Section 66 of the 1996 Act (enforcement of digital additional services licences) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (4), for “national radio multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ relevant multiplex service ”.

(4)In subsection (5), for the words from “national radio multiplex service” onwards there shall be substituted “ relevant multiplex service, means the last accounting period of the multiplex provider ”.

(5)In subsection (6)—

(a)for “national radio multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ relevant multiplex service ”;

(b)for “holder of the national radio multiplex licence” there shall be substituted “ multiplex provider ”; and

(c)for “the radio multiplex service” and “that radio multiplex service” there shall be substituted “ that relevant multiplex service ”.

(6)After subsection (6A) (inserted by Schedule 13) there shall be inserted—

(6B)For the purposes of this section, a service is a relevant multiplex service if it is—

(a)a national radio multiplex service; or

(b)a general multiplex service.

(6C)In this section, “multiplex provider”—

(a)in relation to a national radio multiplex service, means the multiplex provider within the meaning of section 56; and

(b)in relation to a general multiplex service, means the multiplex provider within the meaning of section 14.

(7)In subsection (10) for “apology” there shall be substituted “ statement of findings ”.

Commencement Information

I292Sch. 15 para. 124 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Review of digital radio broadcastingU.K.

125U.K.In section 67 of the 1996 Act (review of digital radio broadcasting), for “the Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I293Sch. 15 para. 125 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

InterpretationU.K.

126U.K.In section 72(1) of the 1996 Act (interpretation), for the definition of “radio multiplex service” there shall be substituted—

radio multiplex service” means a radio multiplex service within the meaning of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003;

the radio transfer date” has the same meaning as in the Communications Act 2003;.

Commencement Information

I294Sch. 15 para. 126 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Listed eventsU.K.

127(1)Section 98 of the 1996 Act (categories of service for the purposes of Part 4 of that Act) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (3), for the words from “television” onwards there shall be substituted “ licence for the purposes of section 363 of the Communications Act 2003 ”.

(3)In subsection (5), for “The Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(4)In subsection (6), for “transmission for general reception of television programmes by satellite” there shall be substituted “ broadcasting of television programmes from a satellite so as to be available for reception by members of the public (within the meaning of Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003) ”.

Commencement Information

I295Sch. 15 para. 127 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

128U.K.In sections 101, 101B, 102 and 103 of the 1996 Act (restrictions on, and penalties for, televising listed and designated events), for “The Commission” and “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I296Sch. 15 para. 128 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

129(1)Section 104 of the 1996 Act (code of guidance) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (4)(d), the words “by the Commission” and “by them” shall be omitted.

Commencement Information

I297Sch. 15 para. 129 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

130U.K.In section 104A of the 1996 Act (provision of information about listed and designated events), for “the Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I298Sch. 15 para. 130 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

131U.K.In section 105(1) of the 1996 Act (interpretation of Part 4 etc.), the definition of “the Commission” shall be omitted.

Commencement Information

I299Sch. 15 para. 131 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Broadcasting standardsU.K.

132(1)Part 5 of the 1996 Act (the Broadcasting Standards Commission) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “the BSC” and “The BSC”, wherever occurring in any of sections 107, 110, 111, 114, 115, 118 to 121 there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I300Sch. 15 para. 132 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

133U.K.In section 107(5)(b) of the 1996 Act (code relating to avoidance of unjust or unfair treatment etc.), for “the service referred to in section 57(1A)(a) of the 1990 Act” there shall be substituted “ any public service of the Welsh Authority (within the meaning of Part 2 of Schedule 12 to the Communications Act 2003) ”.

Commencement Information

I301Sch. 15 para. 133 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

134U.K.In section 115 of the 1996 Act (consideration of fairness complaints)

(a)in subsection (2)(d), for “to (c)” there shall be substituted “ or (b) ”; and

(b)in subsection (8), for “they shall send a statement of” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM shall send a copy of ”.

Commencement Information

I302Sch. 15 para. 134 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

135U.K.In section 117 of the 1996 Act (duty of broadcasting body to retain recordings of programmes), for “sections 115 and 116” there shall be substituted “ section 115 ”.

Commencement Information

I303Sch. 15 para. 135 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

136(1)For subsections (1) and (2) of section 119 of the 1996 Act there shall be substituted—U.K.

(1)Where OFCOM have considered and adjudicated upon a fairness complaint, they may direct the relevant person to publish the matters mentioned in subsection (3) in such manner, and within such period, as may be specified in the directions.

(2)In that section—

(a)in subsection (4), for “subsection (2)” there shall be substituted “ subsection (1) ”;

(b)in subsection (5), for “(3)(a), (b) or (c)” there shall be substituted “ (3)(a) or (b) ”;

(c)in subsection (6), for “broadcasting or regulatory body” there shall be substituted “ relevant person ” and for “them” there shall be substituted “ him ”;

(d)in subsection (8), the words “or standards complaint” and in paragraph (c) the words “, a regulatory body” shall be omitted;

(e)in subsection (10), for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted “ a relevant person ”; and

(f)subsection (12) shall cease to have effect.

(3)After subsection (11) of that section there shall be inserted—

(11A)In this section “relevant person” means—

(a)in a case where the relevant programme was broadcast by a broadcasting body, that body; and

(b)in a case where the relevant programme was included in a licensed service, the licence holder providing that service.

Commencement Information

I304Sch. 15 para. 136 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

137U.K.In section 130(1) of the 1996 Act (interpretation of Part 5), for paragraphs (b) and (c) of the definition of “licensed service” there shall be substituted—

(aa)the public teletext service,

(b)any relevant independent radio service (within the meaning of section 85 of the 1990 Act),

(c)any additional service (within the meaning of Part 1 of the 1990 Act) which is licensed under that Part,.

Commencement Information

I305Sch. 15 para. 137 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Disqualification on grounds related to political objectsU.K.

138(1)Section 143 of the 1996 Act (disqualification on grounds related to political objects) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In each of subsections (1) and (2)—

(a)for “the Independent Television Commission” and “the Commission” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”; and

(b)for “section 5(1) of the 1990 Act, or as the case may be section 5(1) of this Act” there shall be substituted “ section 5(1) or 88(1) of the 1990 Act or section 5(1) or 44(1) of this Act ”.

(3)In subsection (1), for “Part I or II of the 1990 Act or Part I of this Act” there shall be substituted “ Part 1 or 3 of the 1990 Act or Part 1 or 2 of this Act, ”.

(4)In subsection (2), for “Parts I or II of the 1990 Act or Part I of this Act” there shall be substituted “ Part 1 or 3 of the 1990 Act or Part 1 or 2 of this Act, ”.

(5)Subsections (3) and (4) shall cease to have effect.

(6)In subsection (5), for “to (4)” there shall be substituted “ and (2) ”.

(7)In subsection (6), for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted “ the duties imposed on OFCOM by sections 5(1) and 88(1) of the 1990 Act and sections 5(1) and 44(1) of this Act. ”

Commencement Information

I306Sch. 15 para. 138 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Offence of providing false informationU.K.

139(1)Section 144 of the 1996 Act (offence of providing false information) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for “to the relevant authority a statement”, in each place, there shall be substituted “ a statement to OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (2), for “the relevant authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(4)Subsection (5) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I307Sch. 15 para. 139 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Disqualification for supplying false informationU.K.

140(1)Section 145 of the 1996 Act (disqualification for offence of supplying false information) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (5), for “the relevant authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In subsection (7)—

(a)for “5(1)(a) and 88(1)(a)” there shall be substituted “ 5(1)(a) and (2)(db), 32(12) and 88(1)(a) and (2)(db) ”; and

(b)for “5(1)(a) and 44(1)(a)” there shall be substituted “ 5(1)(a) and (2)(db) and 44(1)(a) and (2)(db) ”.

(4)In subsection (8) of that section, for the definition of “licence” there shall be substituted—

licence” means a licence under Part 1 or 3 of the 1990 Act or under Part 1 or 2 of this Act;.

Commencement Information

I308Sch. 15 para. 140 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

InterpretationU.K.

141U.K.In section 147(1) of the 1996 Act (general interpretation), after the definition of “the BBC” there shall be inserted—

OFCOM” means the Office of Communications;.

Commencement Information

I309Sch. 15 para. 141 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Computation of qualifying revenueU.K.

142(1)Schedule 1 to the 1996 Act (computation of “multiplex revenue” etc.) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In Part 1, for “the Commission” and “The Commission”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

(3)In Part 2, for “the Authority” and “The Authority”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I310Sch. 15 para. 142 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 368Z1(1)

[F85SCHEDULE 15AU.K.Video-sharing platform services: appropriate measures for the purposes of section 368Z1(1)

Appropriate measuresU.K.

1.U.K.Paragraphs 2 to 9 set out the measures which it may be appropriate for a person who provides a video-sharing platform service to take in relation to that service for the purposes mentioned in section 368Z1(1).

2.U.K.Include terms and conditions to the effect that if a person uploads to the service a video that contains any restricted material, that person must bring it to the attention of the person who is providing the service.

3.U.K.Include terms and conditions to the effect that a person must not upload to the service a video containing relevant harmful material.

4.U.K.Include terms and conditions to the effect that—

(a)a person must not upload to the service a video containing an audiovisual commercial communication for a product mentioned in section 368Z(2),

(b)a person must not upload to the service a video containing an audiovisual commercial communication for an alcoholic drink unless that communication meets the requirements in section 368Z(3), (4) and (5), and

(c)a person must not upload to the service a video containing an audiovisual commercial communication for anything else unless that communication meets the requirements in section 368Z(4) and (5).

5.U.K.Provide functionality for a person uploading a video to the service to declare whether, as far as they know or can reasonably be expected to know, the video contains an audiovisual commercial communication, and include terms and conditions to the effect that a person uploading a video must use the functionality to make such a declaration.

6.U.K.Establish and operate—

(a)transparent and user-friendly mechanisms for viewers to report or flag harmful material which is available on the service to the person providing the service;

(b)systems through which the person providing the service explains to persons using the service what effect has been given to the reporting and flagging referred to in sub-paragraph (a);

(c)systems for obtaining assurance as to the age of potential viewers;

(d)easy to use systems allowing viewers to rate harmful material.

7.U.K.Provide for parental control systems in relation to restricted material.

8.U.K.In relation to the implementation of the measures set out in paragraphs 6 and 7, establish and operate a complaints procedure which must be transparent, easy to use and effective, and must not affect the ability of a person to bring a claim in civil proceedings.

9.U.K.Provide information and tools for individuals using the service with the aim of improving their media literacy, and raise awareness of the availability of such information and tools.

InterpretationU.K.

10.U.K.In this Schedule—

  • “audiovisual commercial communication” has the meaning given by section 368Z13;

  • “harmful material” means—

    (a)

    relevant harmful material, or

    (b)

    restricted material;

  • “parental control systems” means systems designed to be used by an adult responsible for a person under the age of 18, to control whether or how such persons are able to access videos or audiovisual commercial communications included in a video-sharing platform service;

  • “relevant harmful material” means—

    (a)

    material referred to in section 368E(1), or

    (b)

    material referred to in section 368E(3)(za) (read as if the reference to an on-demand programme service were to a video-sharing platform service);

  • “restricted material” means—

    (a)

    material which is prohibited material within the meaning of section 368E by virtue of falling within paragraph (a) or (b) of subsection (3) of that section, or

    (b)

    specially restricted material within the meaning of section 368E (see subsection (5) of that section);

  • “video” has the meaning given by section 368Z13;

  • “video-sharing platform service” has the meaning given by section 368S.]

Section 389

SCHEDULE 16U.K.Further amendments in connection with media mergers

Competition Act 1980 (c. 21)U.K.

1U.K.In section 11C(1) of the Competition Act 1980 (application of section 117 of the Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40)) for the words “ “the OFT,”” there shall be substituted “ “the OFT, OFCOM,” ”.

Commencement Information

I311Sch. 16 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Gas Act 1986 (c. 44)U.K.

2U.K.In section 41EB(4) of the Gas Act 1986 (application of section 117 of the Enterprise Act 2002) for the words “ “the OFT,”” there shall be substituted “ “the OFT, OFCOM,” ”.

Commencement Information

I312Sch. 16 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Electricity Act 1989 (c. 29)U.K.

3U.K.In section 56CB(4) of the Electricity Act 1989 (application of section 117 of the Enterprise Act 2002) for the words “ “the OFT,”” there shall be substituted “ “the OFT, OFCOM,” ”.

Commencement Information

I313Sch. 16 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Railways Act 1993 (c. 43)U.K.

4(1)The Railways Act 1993 shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 13B(4) of that Act (application of section 117 of the Enterprise Act 2002) for the words “ “the OFT,”” there shall be substituted “ “the OFT, OFCOM,” ”.

(3)In section 15C(2G) of that Act (application of section 117 of the Enterprise Act 2002) for the words “ “the OFT,”” there shall be substituted “ “the OFT, OFCOM,” ”.

(4)In Schedule 4A to that Act, in paragraphs 10A(4) and 15(2G) (application of section 117 of the Enterprise Act 2002) for the words “ “the OFT,”” there shall, in both places, be substituted “ “the OFT, OFCOM,” ”.

Commencement Information

I314Sch. 16 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F86...U.K.

Textual Amendments

F86Sch. 16 para. 5 and crossheading repealed (1.4.2013) by Financial Services Act 2012 (c. 21), s. 122(3), Sch. 19 (with Sch. 20); S.I. 2013/423, art. 3, Sch.

F865U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Commencement Information

I315Sch. 16 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Postal Services Act 2000 (c. 26)U.K.

F876U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F87Sch. 16 para. 6 omitted (1.10.2011) by virtue of Postal Services Act 2011 (c. 5), s. 93(2)(3), Sch. 12 para. 69; S.I. 2011/2329, art. 3

Commencement Information

I316Sch. 16 para. 6 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Transport Act 2000 (c. 38)U.K.

7(1)The Transport Act 2000 shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 12B(4) (application of section 117 of the Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40)) for the words “ “the OFT,”” there shall be substituted “ “the OFT, OFCOM,” ”.

(3)In section 18(9) (application of section 117 of the Enterprise Act 2002) for the words “ “the OFT,”” there shall be substituted “ “the OFT, OFCOM,” ”.

Commencement Information

I317Sch. 16 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40)U.K.

8(1)Section 43 of the Enterprise Act 2002 (intervention notices under section 42) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (4)(a) (final determination of matters to which intervention notice relates)—

(a)after the word “OFT” there shall be inserted “ or (if relevant) OFCOM ”; and

(b)after the word “44” there shall be inserted “ or (as the case may be) 44A ”.

(3)After subsection (5) there shall be inserted—

(6)In this Part “OFCOM” means the Office of Communications.

Commencement Information

I318Sch. 16 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

9U.K.In section 45(1)(b) of that Act (circumstances in which the Secretary of State may make a public interest reference to the Competition Commission) after the words “section 44” there shall be inserted “ , and any report of OFCOM which is required by virtue of section 44A, ”.

Commencement Information

I319Sch. 16 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

10U.K.After section 50(2) of that Act (reports on references in public interest cases) there shall be inserted—

(2A)Where the report relates to a reference under section 45 which has been made after a report of OFCOM under section 44A, the Commission shall give a copy of its report (whether or not published) to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I320Sch. 16 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

11U.K.In section 57(2) of that Act (duty to bring representations to attention of Secretary of State) after the words “the OFT”, in both places where they occur, there shall be inserted “ , OFCOM ”.

Commencement Information

I321Sch. 16 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

12U.K.In section 58(4)(b) of that Act (retrospective effect of orders modifying specified considerations) after the word “OFT,” there shall be inserted “ OFCOM, ”.

Commencement Information

I322Sch. 16 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

13U.K.In section 60(4)(a) of that Act (final determination of matters to which special intervention notice relates)—

(a)after the word “OFT” there shall be inserted “ or (if relevant) OFCOM ”; and

(b)after the word “61” there shall be inserted “ or (as the case may be) 61A ”.

Commencement Information

I323Sch. 16 para. 13 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

14U.K.In section 62(1)(b) of that Act (circumstances in which the Secretary of State may make a special public interest reference to the Competition Commission) after the words “section 61” there shall be inserted “ , and any report of OFCOM which is required by virtue of section 61A, ”.

Commencement Information

I324Sch. 16 para. 14 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

15U.K.After section 65(2) of that Act (reports on references in special public interest cases) there shall be inserted—

(2A)Where the report relates to a reference under section 62 which has been made after a report of OFCOM under section 61A, the Commission shall give a copy of its report (whether or not published) to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I325Sch. 16 para. 15 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

16U.K.In section 67(1)(b) of that Act (intervention to protect legitimate interests)—

(a)the words from “which” to “or 33” shall cease to have effect;

(b)for the words “that section” there shall be substituted “ section 22 or 33 ”; and

(c)after the word “concerned” there shall be inserted “ (whether or not there would otherwise have been a duty to make such a reference) ”.

Commencement Information

I326Sch. 16 para. 16 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

17U.K.In section 68(2)(c) of that Act (scheme for protecting legitimate interests)—

(a)the words from “which”, where it occurs for the second time, to “or 33” shall cease to have effect; and

(b)for the words “that section” there shall be substituted “ section 22 or 33 (whether or not there would otherwise have been a duty to make such a reference) ”.

Commencement Information

I327Sch. 16 para. 17 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

18(1)Section 107 of that Act (further publicity requirements) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (3) (duties of the Secretary of State to publish), after paragraph (b), there shall be inserted—

(ba)any report of OFCOM under section 44A or 61A which has been received by him;.

(3)In subsection (9)(a) (publication of reports of OFT in public interest cases) after the words “section 44” there shall be inserted “ , and any report of OFCOM under section 44A, ”.

(4)In subsection (10)(a) (publication of reports of OFT in special public interest cases) after the words “section 61” there shall be inserted “ , and any report of OFCOM under section 61A, ”.

Commencement Information

I328Sch. 16 para. 18 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

19U.K.In section 108 of that Act (defamation) after the words “the OFT,” there shall be inserted “ OFCOM, ”.

Commencement Information

I329Sch. 16 para. 19 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

20(1)Section 117 of that Act (false or misleading information) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1)(a) (offence of supplying false or misleading information to the OFT etc.) after the word “OFT,” there shall be inserted “ OFCOM, ”.

(3)In subsection (2) (offence of supplying false or misleading information to another person for use by OFT etc.) after the word “OFT,” there shall be inserted “ OFCOM, ”.

Commencement Information

I330Sch. 16 para. 20 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

21U.K.In section 118(1) of that Act (excisions from reports) before the word “or” at the end of paragraph (a) there shall be inserted—

(aa)a report of OFCOM under section 44A or 61A;.

Commencement Information

I331Sch. 16 para. 21 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

22U.K.In section 120(1) of that Act (review of decisions under Part 3) after the word “OFT,” there shall be inserted “ OFCOM, ”.

Commencement Information

I332Sch. 16 para. 22 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

23(1)Section 121 of that Act (fees) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1)—

(a)after the words “the OFT”, where they occur for the second time, there shall be inserted “ , OFCOM ”; and

(b)the words “, Part V of the Fair Trading Act 1973 (c. 41)” shall cease to have effect.

(3)In subsection (2)—

(a)at the end of paragraph (a) there shall be inserted the word “ or ”; and

(b)paragraph (b), and the word “or” at the end of the paragraph, shall cease to have effect.

(4)In subsection (4)(c)—

(a)sub-paragraph (i);

(b)the word “and” at the end of the sub-paragraph; and

(c)in sub-paragraph (ii), the words “in any other case,”;

shall cease to have effect.

(5)In subsection (8)—

(a)after the words “the OFT”, where they occur for the second time, there shall be inserted “ , OFCOM ”; and

(b)the words “, Part V of the Act of 1973” shall cease to have effect.

(6)Subsection (10) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I333Sch. 16 para. 23 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

24(1)Section 124 of that Act (orders and regulations under Part 3) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (3) after the word “34” there shall be inserted “ , 59(6A) ”.

(3)In subsection (4) after the word “40(8),” there shall be inserted “ 44(11), ”.

(4)In subsection (6) after the word “34,” there shall be inserted “ 44(11), 59(6A), ”.

Commencement Information

I334Sch. 16 para. 24 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

25(1)Section 130 of that Act (index of defined expressions) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)After the entry relating to “Anti-competitive outcome” there shall be inserted—

BroadcastingSection 44(9).

(3)After the entry relating to “Market in the United Kingdom” there shall be inserted—

Media public interest considerationSection 44(8).

(4)After the entry for “Modify” there shall be inserted—

NewspaperSection 44(10)
Newspaper enterpriseSection 58A(3).

(5)After the entry for “Notified arrangements” there shall be inserted—

OFCOMSection 43(6).

Commencement Information

I335Sch. 16 para. 25 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

26U.K.In section 180(2) of that Act (application of section 117 of that Act for the purposes of Part 4 of that Act) after the word “alone” there shall be inserted “ and as if the references to OFCOM were omitted ”.

Commencement Information

I336Sch. 16 para. 26 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 406

SCHEDULE 17U.K.Minor and Consequential Amendments

InterpretationU.K.

1(1)In any Act or instrument amended by this Schedule—U.K.

  • communications service” means any of the following services—

    (a)

    an electronic communications service;

    (b)

    the provision of directory information by means of an electronic communications network for the purpose of facilitating the use of an electronic communications service provided by means of that network;

    (c)

    the installation, maintenance, adjustment, repair, alteration, moving, removal or replacement of apparatus which is or is to be connected to an electronic communications network;

  • electronic communications apparatus” has the same meaning as in the electronic communications code;

  • the electronic communications code” has the same meaning as in Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act;

  • electronic communications code network” means—

    (a)

    so much of an electronic communications network or [F88infrastructure system] provided by an electronic communications code operator as is not excluded from the application of the electronic communications code by a direction under section 106; and

    (b)

    an electronic communications network which the Secretary of State or a Northern Ireland department is providing or proposing to provide;

  • electronic communications code operator” means a person in whose case the electronic communications code is applied by a direction under section 106;

  • electronic communications network” and “electronic communications service” each has the same meaning as in this Act;

  • former PTO” means a person—

    (a)

    who is a provider of a public electronic communications network or a public electronic communications service which, immediately before the date on which the repeal by this Act of section 7 of the Telecommunications Act 1984 (c. 12) comes into force, was designated as a public telecommunication system under section 9 of that Act; and

    (b)

    who, immediately before that date, was authorised to provide that network or service by a licence to which section 8 of that Act applied;

  • operator”, in relation to an electronic communications code network, means—

    (a)

    the electronic communications code operator providing that network; or

    (b)

    the Secretary of State or a Northern Ireland department, to the extent that they are providing or proposing to provide that network;

  • provide” and cognate expressions, in relation to an electronic communications network, an electronic communications service or associated facilities, are to be construed in accordance with section 32(4) of this Act;

  • public electronic communications network” and “public electronic communications service” each has the same meaning as in Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act.

(2)In this paragraph—

F89(a). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

(b)electronic communications code”, “electronic communications code network”, “electronic communications code operator”, “public electronic communications network” and “public electronic communications service” each has the meaning given in sub-paragraph (1).

[F90(c)“infrastructure system” has the same meaning as in the electronic communications code and references to providing an infrastructure system are to be construed in accordance with paragraph 7 of that code.]

Official Secrets Act 1911U.K.

2U.K.For the purposes of the Official Secrets Act 1911 (c. 28), any electronic communications station or office belonging to, or occupied by, the provider of a public electronic communications service shall be a prohibited place.

Commencement Information

I339Sch. 17 para. 2 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I340Sch. 17 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Law of Property Act 1925U.K.

3U.K.[F91In section 194(4) of the Law of Property Act 1925 (c. 20) (exceptions from restrictions on inclosure of commons), for the words from “telecommunication apparatus” onwards there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus installed for the purposes of an electronic communications code network. ”]

Textual Amendments

F91Sch. 17 para. 3 repealed (E.W.) (1.10.2007 for E., 1.4.2012 for W.) by Commons Act 2006 (c. 26), s. 56, Sch. 6 Pt. 2 (with s. 60); S.I. 2007/2584, art. 2(d)(ii); S.I. 2012/739, art. 2(h)

Commencement Information

I341Sch. 17 para. 3 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I342Sch. 17 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Public Health Act 1925U.K.

4U.K.In section 10 of the Public Health Act 1925 (c. 71) (Crown application), for the words from “telecommunication apparatus” to “system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus kept installed for the purposes of an electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I343Sch. 17 para. 4 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I344Sch. 17 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

London Overground Wires, etc Act 1933U.K.

5(1)The London Overground Wires, etc. Act 1933 (c. xliv) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 11 (saving for safety regulations), for “any telecommunication apparatus made” there shall be substituted “ any electronic communications apparatus made ”.

(3)In section 14 (savings in respect of telecommunications code system)—

(a)for “telecommunication apparatus kept installed for the purposes of a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus kept installed for the purposes of an electronic communications code network ”;

(b)for the words from “conferred by” onwards there shall be substituted “ conferred by or in accordance with the electronic communications code on the operator of any such network. ”

Commencement Information

I345Sch. 17 para. 5 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I346Sch. 17 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949U.K.

F926U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

F927U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I347Sch. 17 para. 7 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

F928U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

F929U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I348Sch. 17 para. 9 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I349Sch. 17 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9210U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I350Sch. 17 para. 10 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I351Sch. 17 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

F9211U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I352Sch. 17 para. 11 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I353Sch. 17 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9212U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I354Sch. 17 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9213U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I355Sch. 17 para. 13 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9214U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

F9215U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I356Sch. 17 para. 15 in force at 29.12.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1)(3), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

I357Sch. 17 para. 15 in force at 1.4.2004 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 4(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 11)

F9216U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I358Sch. 17 para. 16 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I359Sch. 17 para. 16 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

F9217U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I360Sch. 17 para. 17 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9218U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F92Sch. 17 paras. 6-18 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I361Sch. 17 para. 18 in force at 18.9.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I362Sch. 17 para. 18 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Coast Protection Act 1949U.K.

19U.K.In section 47 of the Coast Protection Act 1949 (c. 74) (savings), in paragraph (b), for the words from “the telecommunications code” to “system” there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code on the operator of an electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I363Sch. 17 para. 19 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I364Sch. 17 para. 19 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

National Parks and Access to the Countryside Act 1949U.K.

20(1)The National Parks and Access to the Countryside Act 1949 (c. 97) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 20(2) (byelaws for protection of nature reserves not to interfere with certain rights)—

(a)for “the running of a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ the provision of an electronic communications code network ”;

(b)for “the telecommunications code” there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(c)for “such system” there shall be substituted “ such network ”.

(3)In section 60(5)(f) (exceptions from rights of public where access agreement etc. in force), for “or a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ or an electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I365Sch. 17 para. 20 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I366Sch. 17 para. 20 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

London County Council (General Powers) Act 1949U.K.

21U.K.In section 7(6) of the London County Council (General Powers) Act 1949 (c. lv) (interference by works etc. for provision of heat), for “telecommunication apparatus kept installed for the purposes of a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus kept installed for the purposes of an electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I367Sch. 17 para. 21 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I368Sch. 17 para. 21 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Local Government (Miscellaneous Provisions) Act 1953U.K.

22(1)Section 6 of the Local Government (Miscellaneous Provisions) Act 1953 (c. 26) (supplementary provisions as to omnibus shelters etc.) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

(3)In subsection (1)—

(a)for “a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(b)for “that system” there shall be substituted “ that network ”.

(4)In subsection (2), for “system” there shall be substituted “ network ”.

Commencement Information

I369Sch. 17 para. 22 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I370Sch. 17 para. 22 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Army Act 1955U.K.

F9323U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F93Sch. 17 para. 23 repealed (28.3.2009 for specified purposes, 31.10.2009 in so far as not already in force) by Armed Forces Act 2006 (c. 52), s. 383(2), Sch. 17; S.I. 2009/812, art. 3(a)(b) (with transitional provisions in S.I. 2009/1059); S.I. 2009/1167, art. 4

Commencement Information

I371Sch. 17 para. 23 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I372Sch. 17 para. 23 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Air Force Act 1955U.K.

F9424U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F94Sch. 17 para. 24 repealed (28.3.2009 for specified purposes, 31.10.2009 in so far as not already in force) by Armed Forces Act 2006 (c. 52), s. 383(2), Sch. 17; S.I. 2009/812, art. 3(a)(b) (with transitional provisions in S.I. 2009/1059); S.I. 2009/1167, art. 4

Commencement Information

I373Sch. 17 para. 24 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I374Sch. 17 para. 24 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Lough Neagh and Lower Bann Drainage and Navigation Act (Northern Ireland) 1955U.K.

25U.K.In section 17(2) of the Lough Neagh and Lower Bann Drainage and Navigation Act (Northern Ireland) 1955 (c. 15 (N.I.)) (application of paragraph 23 of telecommunications code)—

(a)for “the telecommunications code” there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “telecommunication apparatus” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I375Sch. 17 para. 25 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I376Sch. 17 para. 25 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Naval Discipline Act 1957U.K.

26U.K.F95. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F95Sch. 17 para. 26 repealed (28.3.2009 for specified purposes, 31.10.2009 in so far as not already in force) by Armed Forces Act 2006 (c. 52), s. 383(2), Sch. 17; S.I. 2009/812, art. 3(a)(b) (with transitional provisions in S.I. 2009/1059); S.I. 2009/1167, art. 4

Commencement Information

I377Sch. 17 para. 26 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I378Sch. 17 para. 26 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Opencast Coal Act 1958U.K.

27(1)In section 45 of the Opencast Coal Act 1958 (c. 69) (saving for apparatus installed for the purposes of telecommunications code system)—U.K.

(a)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “the telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(d)for “that system” there shall be substituted “ that network ”.

Commencement Information

I379Sch. 17 para. 27 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I380Sch. 17 para. 27 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Pipe-lines Act 1962U.K.

28U.K.In section 40 of the Pipe-lines Act 1962 (c. 58) (avoidance of interference with telecommunications code systems)—

(a)for “telecommunication apparatus”, in both places, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “such system” there shall be substituted “ such network ”;

(d)for “the telecommunications code” there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”.

Commencement Information

I381Sch. 17 para. 28 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I382Sch. 17 para. 28 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

London County Council (General Powers) Act 1963U.K.

29U.K.In section 17(4)(a) of the London County Council (General Powers) Act 1963 (c. xvii) (interference from provision of illuminations, floodlighting, etc.), for “telecommunication apparatus kept installed for the purposes of a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus kept installed for the purposes of an electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I383Sch. 17 para. 29 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I384Sch. 17 para. 29 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Harbours Act 1964U.K.

30U.K.In section 53 of the Harbours Act 1964 (c. 40) (application of telecommunications code for certain works)—

(a)for “telecommunications code” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “telecommunication apparatus” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I385Sch. 17 para. 30 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I386Sch. 17 para. 30 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

New Towns Act (Northern Ireland) 1965U.K.

31(1)Section 25 of the New Towns Act (Northern Ireland) 1965 (c. 13 (N.I.)) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsections (9A), (9C) and (9D)—

(a)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “that system” there shall be substituted “ that network ”;

(d)for “the telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”.

(3)In subsection (9B) for “any telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ any electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I387Sch. 17 para. 31 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I388Sch. 17 para. 31 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Marine, &c., Broadcasting (Offences) Act 1967U.K.

F9632U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F96Sch. 17 paras. 32-38 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I389Sch. 17 para. 32 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

F9633U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F96Sch. 17 paras. 32-38 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I390Sch. 17 para. 33 in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

F9634U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F96Sch. 17 paras. 32-38 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I391Sch. 17 para. 34 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9635U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F96Sch. 17 paras. 32-38 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I392Sch. 17 para. 35 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9636U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F96Sch. 17 paras. 32-38 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I393Sch. 17 para. 36 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Wireless Telegraphy Act 1967U.K.

F9637U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F96Sch. 17 paras. 32-38 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I394Sch. 17 para. 37 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I395Sch. 17 para. 37 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9638U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F96Sch. 17 paras. 32-38 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I396Sch. 17 para. 38 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I397Sch. 17 para. 38 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

F9739U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

Commencement Information

I398Sch. 17 para. 39 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Countryside Act 1968U.K.

40(1)The Countryside Act 1968 (c. 41) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 41 (exceptions from powers to make byelaws etc.), in subsections (4) and (12)—

(a)for “the running of a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ the provision of an electronic communications code network ”;

(b)for “the telecommunications code” there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(c)for “such system” there shall be substituted “ such network ”.

(3)In paragraph 6 of Schedule 2 (exceptions from procedure for taking common land)—

(a)for “the telecommunications code” there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I399Sch. 17 para. 40 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I400Sch. 17 para. 40 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Greater London Council (General Powers) Act 1969U.K.

41U.K.In section 7(6) of the Greater London Council (General Powers) Act 1969 (c. lii) (effect of exercise of power to stop up streets)—

(a)for “the telecommunications code” there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I401Sch. 17 para. 41 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I402Sch. 17 para. 41 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Harbours Act (Northern Ireland) 1970U.K.

42U.K.In section 37 of the Harbours Act (Northern Ireland) 1970 (c. 1 (N.I.)) (application of telecommunications code for certain works)—

(a)for “telecommunications code” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “telecommunication apparatus” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I403Sch. 17 para. 42 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I404Sch. 17 para. 42 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Thames Barrier and Flood Prevention Act 1972U.K.

43U.K.In section 20(1)(a) of the Thames Barrier and Flood Prevention Act 1972 (c. xlv)(power to make subsidiary works etc.), for “telecommunication installations” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications installations ”.

Commencement Information

I405Sch. 17 para. 43 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I406Sch. 17 para. 43 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Fair Trading Act 1973U.K.

44U.K.In section 137(3) of the Fair Trading Act 1973 (c. 41) (meaning of “supply of services”), for paragraph (f) there shall be substituted—

(f)includes the making of arrangements, by means of such an agreement as is mentioned in paragraph 29 of Schedule 2 to the Telecommunications Act 1984, for the sharing of the use of any electronic communications apparatus, and.

Commencement Information

I407Sch. 17 para. 44 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I408Sch. 17 para. 44 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Drainage (Northern Ireland) Order 1973U.K.

45U.K.In paragraph 3 of Schedule 9 to the Drainage (Northern Ireland) Order 1973 (S.I. 1973/69 (N.I. 1))—

(a)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “telecommunications code”, wherever occurring (except in the expression “telecommunications code system”), there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”;

(d)for “any such system” and “that system” there shall be substituted, respectively, “ any such network ” and “ that network ”.

Commencement Information

I409Sch. 17 para. 45 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I410Sch. 17 para. 45 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Water and Sewerage Services (Northern Ireland) Order 1973U.K.

46[F98(1)In Article 57A(3)(b) of the Water and Sewerage Services (Northern Ireland) Order 1973 (S.I. 1973/70 (N.I. 2)) (civil liability of Department for escapes of water)—U.K.

(a)for “telecommunications code” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “a telecommunication system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

(2)In Article 58(1) of that Order (protection for telegraph and telephone lines), for “telecommunications” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications ”.]

Textual Amendments

Commencement Information

I411Sch. 17 para. 46 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I412Sch. 17 para. 46 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Consumer Credit Act 1974U.K.

47U.K.In section 16(6) of the Consumer Credit Act 1974 (c. 39) (exempt agreements) for “public telecommunications operator specified in the order” there shall be substituted “ provider of a public electronic communications service who is specified in the order ”.

Commencement Information

I413Sch. 17 para. 47 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I414Sch. 17 para. 47 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

House of Commons Disqualification Act 1975U.K.

48U.K.In Part 2 of Schedule 1 to the House of Commons Disqualification Act 1975 (c. 24) (bodies of which all members are disqualified), in the appropriate place, there shall be inserted— “ Seirbheis nam Meadhanan Gàidhlig ”.

Commencement Information

I415Sch. 17 para. 48 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Northern Ireland Assembly Disqualification Act 1975U.K.

49U.K.In Part 2 of Schedule 1 to the Northern Ireland Assembly Disqualification Act 1975 (c. 25) (bodies of which all members are disqualified), in the appropriate place, there shall be inserted— “ Seirbheis nam Meadhanan Gàidhlig ”.

Commencement Information

I416Sch. 17 para. 49 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Welsh Development Agency Act 1975U.K.

50(1)Section 19 of the Welsh Development Agency Act 1975 (c. 70) (the Agency and the media) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (9), for “the appropriate authority”, in both places, there shall be substituted “ the Office of Communications ”.

(3)In subsection (11), in the definition of “relevant licence” for “the Independent Television Commission or the Radio Authority” there shall be substituted “ the Office of Communications ”.

Commencement Information

I417Sch. 17 para. 50 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Building Regulations (Northern Ireland) Order 1979U.K.

51U.K.In paragraph 14 of Schedule 1 to the Building Regulations (Northern Ireland) Order 1979 (S.I. 1979/1709 (N.I. 16)) (building regulations), for “telecommunications services” there shall be substituted “ communications services ”.

Commencement Information

I418Sch. 17 para. 51 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I419Sch. 17 para. 51 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Local Government, Planning and Land Act 1980U.K.

52(1)Part 3 of Schedule 28 to the Local Government, Planning and Land Act 1980 (c. 65) (provisions about land acquired by urban development corporations) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraphs 5, 6, 13, 14 and 16—

(a)for “the telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system” and “any telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(d)for “such system” and “the system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted, respectively, “ such network ” and “ the network ”.

Commencement Information

I420Sch. 17 para. 52 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I421Sch. 17 para. 52 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Highways Act 1980U.K.

53U.K.In section 35(11)(c) and (12) of the Highways Act 1980 (c. 66) (regulation of rights to maintain apparatus on walkways), for “telecommunications code systems” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code networks ”.

Commencement Information

I422Sch. 17 para. 53 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I423Sch. 17 para. 53 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

54U.K.In section 115D of that Act (limits on powers to restrict access to highways), for paragraph (d) there shall be substituted—

(d)as to prevent the operator of an electronic communications code network having access to any electronic communications apparatus kept installed for the purposes of that network under, in, on or over the highway.

Commencement Information

I424Sch. 17 para. 54 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I425Sch. 17 para. 54 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

55U.K.In section 142(5) of that Act (protection of telecommunications apparatus by conditions in licences to plant trees etc. in a highway), for “telecommunications code systems” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code networks ”.

Commencement Information

I426Sch. 17 para. 55 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I427Sch. 17 para. 55 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

56(1)This paragraph applies to the following provisions of that Act—U.K.

(a)the definition of “statutory undertakers” in section 144(6) (power to erect flagpoles etc. on highways);

(b)the definition of “statutory undertakers” in section 169(4) (control of scaffolding on highways);

(c)the definition of “statutory undertakers” in section 170(3) (control of mixing mortar etc. on highways);

(d)section 177(4) and (12) (licence to build over highway not to interfere with telecommunications code systems);

(e)section 178(5) (exceptions to restriction on placing rails etc. over highways);

(f)section 329(4A) (interpretation);

(g)section 334 (savings for operators of telecommunications code systems).

(2)In the provisions to which this paragraph applies—

(a)for “a telecommunications code system” and “any telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(b)for “the telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(d)for “telecommunications code”, wherever occurring (except in the expression “telecommunications code system”), there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”;

(e)for “system”, wherever occurring (except in the expression “telecommunications code system”), there shall be substituted “ network ”.

Commencement Information

I428Sch. 17 para. 56 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I429Sch. 17 para. 56 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

New Towns Act 1981U.K.

57(1)This paragraph applies to the following provisions of the New Towns Act 1981 (c. 64)—U.K.

(a)section 16(2) (exception to extinguishment of rights over land compulsorily acquired);

(b)section 19(2) (saving from the power to override certain rights);

(c)section 24 (apparatus kept installed for purposes of telecommunications code system);

(d)section 26(8) (extinguishment of rights of way and removal of apparatus);

(e)section 39(7) (power of development corporation to transfer undertakings).

(2)In the provisions to which this paragraph applies—

(a)for “in accordance with the telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ in accordance with the electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system” and “any telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(d)for “the running of the telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ the provision of the electronic communications code network ”;

(e)for “the running of such a system” there shall be substituted “ the provision of such a network ”;

(f)for “such system” and “the system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted, respectively, “ such network ” and “ the network ”.

Commencement Information

I430Sch. 17 para. 57 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I431Sch. 17 para. 57 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Acquisition of Land Act 1981U.K.

58(1)The Acquisition of Land Act 1981 (c. 67) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 28 (acquisition of land by the creation of new rights), after paragraph (h) there shall be inserted—

(i)paragraph 3(3) of Schedule 4 to the Communications Act 2003.

(3)In section 32(6A) (exception to power to extinguish certain public rights of way)—

(a)for the words from “telecommunication apparatus” to “telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus kept installed for the purposes of an electronic communications code network ”; and

(b)in paragraph (a), for “system” there shall be substituted “ network ”.

Commencement Information

I432Sch. 17 para. 58 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I433Sch. 17 para. 58 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Housing (Northern Ireland) Order 1981U.K.

59U.K.In Article 159A of the Housing (Northern Ireland) Order 1981 (S.I. 1981/156 (N.I. 3)) (application of telecommunications code to the Northern Ireland Housing Executive)—

(a)for “telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(c)for “a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(d)for “that system” there shall be substituted “ that network ”.

Commencement Information

I434Sch. 17 para. 59 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I435Sch. 17 para. 59 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Civil Aviation Act 1982U.K.

60U.K.In section 48(7)(b) of the Civil Aviation Act 1982 (c. 16) (Secretary of State to give notice of orders stopping up highways for civil aviation purposes), for “a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I436Sch. 17 para. 60 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I437Sch. 17 para. 60 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Representation of the People Act 1983U.K.

61U.K.In section 92(1)(c) of the Representation of the People Act 1983 (c. 2) (broadcasting from outside the United Kingdom), for “the Independent Television Commission or the Radio Authority” there shall be substituted “ the Office of Communications ”.

Commencement Information

I438Sch. 17 para. 61 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

62(1)Section 93 of that Act (broadcasting of local items during election period) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (4), for the words from the beginning to “each” there shall be substituted “ The Office of Communications shall ”.

(3)In subsection (6)—

(a)in the definition of “broadcasting authority”, for “the Independent Television Commission, the Radio Authority” there shall be substituted “ the Office of Communications ”;

(b)in the definition of “relevant services”, for paragraphs (b) and (c) there shall be substituted—

(b)in relation to the Office of Communications, means services licensed under Part 1 or 3 of the Broadcasting Act 1990 or Part 1 or 2 of the Broadcasting Act 1996.

Commencement Information

I439Sch. 17 para. 62 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Telecommunications Act 1984U.K.

63(1)Sections 44 to 46 of the Telecommunications Act 1984 (c. 12) (offences relating to modification and interception of messages and to assaults on the persons engaged on the business of a telecommunications operator) shall cease to have effect.U.K.

(2)No proceedings shall be capable of being begun at any time after the commencement of this paragraph for any offence under any of those sections which was committed before the commencement of this paragraph.

(3)Any proceedings for an offence under any of those sections which have been begun before the commencement of this paragraph but in which there has not yet been a conviction must be discontinued immediately.

Commencement Information

I440Sch. 17 para. 63 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I441Sch. 17 para. 63 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

F9964U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F99Sch. 17 paras. 64-69 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I442Sch. 17 para. 64 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9965U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F99Sch. 17 paras. 64-69 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I443Sch. 17 para. 65 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9966U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F99Sch. 17 paras. 64-69 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I444Sch. 17 para. 66 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9967U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F99Sch. 17 paras. 64-69 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I445Sch. 17 para. 67 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9968U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F99Sch. 17 paras. 64-69 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I446Sch. 17 para. 68 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F9969U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F99Sch. 17 paras. 64-69 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I447Sch. 17 para. 69 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

70(1)Section 94 of that Act (directions in the interests of national security) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for “requisite or expedient” there shall be substituted “ necessary ”.

(3)In subsection (2), for “requisite or expedient” there shall be substituted “ necessary ”.

(4)After subsection (2), there shall be inserted—

(2A)The Secretary of State shall not give a direction under subsection (1) or (2) unless he believes that the conduct required by the direction is proportionate to what is sought to be achieved by that conduct.

(5)In subsection (3), for “this Act” there shall be substituted “ Part 1 or Chapter 1 of Part 2 of the Communications Act 2003 and, in the case of a direction to a provider of a public electronic communications network, notwithstanding that it relates to him in a capacity other than as the provider of such a network ”.

(6)In subsection (6), for “public telecommunications operators” there shall be substituted “ providers of public electronic communications networks ”.

(7)In subsection (8), for the words from “the Director” onwards there shall be substituted “ OFCOM and to providers of public electronic communications networks. ”

Commencement Information

I448Sch. 17 para. 70 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I449Sch. 17 para. 70 in force at 18.9.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

71(1)Section 98 of that Act (use of conduits for telecommunications purposes) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (1), for the words “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

(3)In subsection (5)(a), for the words “telecommunication purposes” there shall be substituted “ the purposes of any electronic communications network or of any electronic communications service ”.

Commencement Information

I450Sch. 17 para. 71 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I451Sch. 17 para. 71 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

72(1)Section 101 of that Act (general restrictions on disclosure of information) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

F100(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

(3)In subsection (2)(a)—

(a)the words “or transferred”shall be omitted; and

(b)for the words “, the Director or the Commission by or under this Act” there shall be substituted “ or OFCOM by or under this Act (except functions assigned by or under Part 6) ”.

(4)In subsection (2)(b), after “the Rail Regulator” there shall be inserted “ , OFCOM ”.

(5)In subsection (3), after paragraph (p) there shall be inserted—

(q)the Communications Act 2003 (excluding the provisions of that Act which are enactments relating to the management of the radio spectrum within the meaning of that Act).

(6)Subsection (4) shall cease to have effect.

(7)In subsection (6), for “the Director” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”.

Textual Amendments

F100Sch. 17 para. 72(2) repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I452Sch. 17 para. 72(1)-(3)(5)(6) in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I453Sch. 17 para. 72(1)-(3) (5) (6) in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

I454Sch. 17 para. 72(4) (7) in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

73U.K.In section 104 of that Act (orders and schemes), after subsection (1) there shall be inserted—

(1A)Section 403 of the Communications Act 2003 (procedure for regulations and orders made by OFCOM) applies to every power of OFCOM to make an order under a provision of this Act.

(1B)The approval of the Secretary of State is required for the making by OFCOM of an order under section 85 or 86 above.

(1C)A statutory instrument containing an order made by OFCOM under section 85 or 86 above shall be subject to annulment in pursuance of a resolution of either House of Parliament.

Commencement Information

I455Sch. 17 para. 73 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I456Sch. 17 para. 73 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

74U.K.In section 106(1) of that Act (general interpretation), after the definition of “modifications” there shall be inserted—

OFCOM” means the Office of Communications;.

Commencement Information

I457Sch. 17 para. 74 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

75U.K.In paragraph 18(2) of Schedule 2 to that Act (notices affixed to overhead apparatus), for “paragraph 24(4)(a)” there shall be substituted “ paragraph 24(2A)(a) ”.

Commencement Information

I458Sch. 17 para. 75 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I459Sch. 17 para. 75 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Cinemas Act 1985U.K.

76U.K.In section 21(1) of the Cinemas Act 1985 (c. 13) (interpretation), for the definition of “film exhibition” there shall be substituted—

film exhibition” means any exhibition of moving pictures other than an exhibition of items included in a programme service (within the meaning of the Communications Act 2003) that is being simultaneously received (or virtually so) by the exhibitor.

Commencement Information

I460Sch. 17 para. 76 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Surrogacy Arrangements Act 1985U.K.

77U.K.In section 3 of the Surrogacy Arrangements Act 1985 (c. 49) (advertisements about surrogacy), for “a telecommunication system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

Commencement Information

I461Sch. 17 para. 77 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I462Sch. 17 para. 77 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Bankruptcy (Scotland) Act 1985U.K.

F10178U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

Commencement Information

I463Sch. 17 para. 78 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I464Sch. 17 para. 78 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Housing Act 1985U.K.

79(1)The Housing Act 1985 (c. 68) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 295(2)(b) (extinguishment of other rights over land acquired), for “telecommunications systems” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications networks ”.

(3)In section 298(2) and (3) (telecommunications apparatus)—

(a)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “the telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(d)for “the system” and “a system” there shall be substituted, respectively, “ the network ” and “ a network ”.

Commencement Information

I465Sch. 17 para. 79 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I466Sch. 17 para. 79 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Airports Act 1986U.K.

80U.K.In section 62 of the Airports Act 1986 (c. 31) (provisions as to telecommunication apparatus)—

(a)for “the telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “telecommunication apparatus” and “telecommunications apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(c)for “a telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(d)in subsection (3), for “that system” there shall be substituted “ that network ”.

Commencement Information

I467Sch. 17 para. 80 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I468Sch. 17 para. 80 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Gas Act 1986U.K.

81U.K.In section 4AA(4)(b) of the Gas Act 1986 (c. 44) (general duties of Secretary of State and Authority), for sub-paragraph (i) there shall be substituted—

(i)communications services and electronic communications apparatus, or.

Commencement Information

I469Sch. 17 para. 81 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I470Sch. 17 para. 81 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Insolvency Act 1986U.K.

82(1)The Insolvency Act 1986 (c. 45) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 233 (supplies of telecommunications services etc. in cases of administration or liquidation)—

(a)in subsection (3), for paragraph (d) there shall be substituted—

(d)a supply of communications services by a provider of a public electronic communications service.;

(b)in subsection (5), for paragraph (d) there shall be substituted—

(d)“communications services” do not include electronic communications services to the extent that they are used to broadcast or otherwise transmit programme services (within the meaning of the Communications Act 2003).

(3)In section 372 (supplies of telecommunications services etc. in cases of bankruptcy)—

(a)in subsection (4), for paragraph (d) there shall be substituted—

(d)a supply of communications services by a provider of a public electronic communications service.;

(b)in subsection (5), for paragraph (c) there shall be substituted—

(c)“communications services” do not include electronic communications services to the extent that they are used to broadcast or otherwise transmit programme services (within the meaning of the Communications Act 2003).

(4)In Schedule 2A (exceptions to prohibition on appointment of administrative receiver), in paragraph 10, after sub-paragraph (2) there shall be inserted—

(2A)For the purposes of section 72D a business is also regulated to the extent that it consists in the provision of a public electronic communications network or a public electronic communications service.

Commencement Information

I471Sch. 17 para. 82 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I472Sch. 17 para. 82 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Company Directors Disqualification Act 1986U.K.

83U.K.In section 9E(2) of the Company Directors Disqualification Act 1986 (c. 46) (interpretation), for paragraph (a) there shall be substituted—

(a)the Office of Communications;.

Commencement Information

I473Sch. 17 para. 83 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Channel Tunnel Act 1987U.K.

84U.K.For section 32 of the Channel Tunnel Act 1987 (c. 53), there shall be substituted—

32Exclusion of rights under electronic communications code

No rights shall be exercisable by any person by virtue of the electronic communications code in relation to any land comprised in the tunnel system and lying in or under the bed of the sea.

Commencement Information

I474Sch. 17 para. 84 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I475Sch. 17 para. 84 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

85U.K.In paragraph 3(2)(b) of Schedule 2 to that Act (supplementary provisions as to scheduled works etc.), for “telecommunications” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications ”.

Commencement Information

I476Sch. 17 para. 85 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I477Sch. 17 para. 85 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

86(1)Part 10 of Schedule 7 to that Act (protection of telecommunications operators) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraph 1(1), for “a telecommunications operator” there shall be substituted “ an operator of an electronic communications code network ”.

(3)In paragraphs 2 to 7—

(a)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system”, “a telecommunication system” and “any telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “that telecommunications system” there shall be substituted “ that network ”;

(d)for “the telecommunications operator”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the operator ”;

(e)for “any telecommunications operator”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ any operator of an electronic communications code network ”;

(f)for “a system” and “that system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted, respectively, “ a network ” and “ that network ”;

(g)for “the system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I478Sch. 17 para. 86 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I479Sch. 17 para. 86 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Consumer Protection (Northern Ireland) Order 1987U.K.

87(1)Article 29 of the Consumer Protection (Northern Ireland) Order 1987 (S.I. 1987/2049 (N.I. 20)) (restrictions on disclosure of information) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraph (3), after sub-paragraph (n), there shall be inserted—

(o)the Communications Act 2003.

(3)In paragraph (6) for “the Director General of Telecommunications” there shall be substituted “ the Office of Communications ”.

Commencement Information

I480Sch. 17 para. 87 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I481Sch. 17 para. 87 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988U.K.

88U.K.In section 567(2)(b) of the Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1) (meaning of “construction operations”), for “telecommunication apparatus” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I482Sch. 17 para. 88 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I483Sch. 17 para. 88 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Norfolk and Suffolk Broads Act 1988U.K.

89U.K.In section 25(1) of the Norfolk and Suffolk Broads Act 1988 (c. 4) (interpretation), in the definition of “statutory undertaker”, for paragraph (d) there shall be substituted—

(d)any electronic communications code operator;.

Commencement Information

I484Sch. 17 para. 89 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I485Sch. 17 para. 89 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Malicious Communications Act 1988U.K.

90U.K.In section 1(2A)(a) of the Malicious Communications Act 1988 (c. 27) (offence of sending electronic communications with intent to cause distress or anxiety), for “a telecommunication system (within the meaning of the Telecommunications Act 1984)” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

Commencement Information

I486Sch. 17 para. 90 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I487Sch. 17 para. 90 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988U.K.

91(1)Section 69 of the Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 (c. 48) (no infringement of copyright by use of recordings for certain supervisory purposes) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (2)—

(a)for paragraph (a) there shall be substituted—

(a)section 167(1) of the Broadcasting Act 1990, section 115(4) or (6) or 117 of the Broadcasting Act 1996 or paragraph 20 of Schedule 12 to the Communications Act 2003;;

(b)in paragraph (b), for the words from “by virtue of” to “1990” there shall be substituted “ by virtue of section 334(1) of the Communications Act 2003 ”;

(c)in paragraph (c), for “Radio Authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”;

(d)after paragraph (c) there shall be inserted—

(d)section 334(3) of the Communications Act 2003.

(3)For subsection (3) there shall be substituted—

(3)Copyright is not infringed by the use by OFCOM in connection with the performance of any of their functions under the Broadcasting Act 1990, the Broadcasting Act 1996 or the Communications Act 2003 of—

(a)any recording, script or transcript which is provided to them under or by virtue of any provision of those Acts; or

(b)any existing material which is transferred to them by a scheme made under section 30 of the Communications Act 2003.

(4)In subsection (3), “existing material” means—

(a)any recording, script or transcript which was provided to the Independent Television Commission or the Radio Authority under or by virtue of any provision of the Broadcasting Act 1990 or the Broadcasting Act 1996; and

(b)any recording or transcript which was provided to the Broadcasting Standards Commission under section 115(4) or (6) or 116(5) of the Broadcasting Act 1996.

Commencement Information

I488Sch. 17 para. 91 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

92(1)Section 73 of that Act (no breach of copyright by certain retransmissions of [F102wireless broadcasts by cable] ) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (6)—

(a)for paragraphs (c) and (d) there shall be substituted—

(c)the public teletext service,

(d)S4C Digital, and;

(b)for the words after paragraph (e) there shall be substituted— “ and expressions used in this subsection have the same meanings as in Part 3 of the Communications Act 2003. ”

(3)For subsection (7) there shall be substituted—

(7)In this section “relevant requirement” means a requirement imposed by a general condition (within the meaning of Chapter 1 of Part 2 of the Communications Act 2003) the setting of which is authorised under section 64 of that Act (must-carry obligations).

Textual Amendments

F102Words in Sch. 17 para. 92(1) substituted (31.10.2003) by virtue of The Copyright and Related Rights Regulations 2003 (S.I. 2003/2498), reg. 1, Sch. 1 para. 23 (with regs. 31-40)

Commencement Information

I489Sch. 17 para. 92 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

93(1)Paragraph 17 of Schedule 2 to that Act (no infringement of performance rights by use of recordings for certain supervisory purposes) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In sub-paragraph (2)—

(a)for paragraph (a) there shall be substituted—

(a)section 167(1) of the Broadcasting Act 1990, section 115(4) or (6) or 117 of the Broadcasting Act 1996 or paragraph 20 of Schedule 12 to the Communications Act 2003;;

(b)in paragraph (b), for the words from “by virtue of” to “1990” there shall be substituted “ by virtue of section 334(1) of the Communications Act 2003 ”;

(c)in paragraph (c), for “Radio Authority” there shall be substituted “ OFCOM ”;

(d)after paragraph (c) there shall be inserted—

(d)section 334(3) of the Communications Act 2003.

(3)For sub-paragraph (3) there shall be substituted—

(3)The rights conferred by Part 2 are not infringed by the use by OFCOM in connection with the performance of any of their functions under the Broadcasting Act 1990, the Broadcasting Act 1996 or the Communications Act 2003 of—

(a)any recording, script or transcript which is provided to them under or by virtue of any provision of those Acts; or

(b)any existing material which is transferred to them by a scheme made under section 30 of the Communications Act 2003.

(4)In subsection (3), “existing material” means—

(a)any recording, script or transcript which was provided to the Independent Television Commission or the Radio Authority under or by virtue of any provision of the Broadcasting Act 1990 or the Broadcasting Act 1996; and

(b)any recording or transcript which was provided to the Broadcasting Standards Commission under section 115(4) or (6) or 116(5) of the Broadcasting Act 1996.

Commencement Information

I490Sch. 17 para. 93 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Housing Act 1988U.K.

94(1)Part 2 of Schedule 10 to the Housing Act 1988 (c. 50) (provisions about land acquired by a housing action trust) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraphs 4, 5, 11, 12 and 14—

(a)for “the telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system” and “any telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “telecommunications apparatus” and “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(d)for “such system” and “the system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted, respectively, “ such network ” and “ the network ”.

Commencement Information

I491Sch. 17 para. 94 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I492Sch. 17 para. 94 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Road Traffic Act 1988U.K.

95U.K.In section 21(3)(b) of the Road Traffic Act 1988 (c. 52) (exception from prohibition of driving etc on cycle tracks for statutory undertakers), for the words from “a telecommunications code system” to “1984)” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I493Sch. 17 para. 95 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I494Sch. 17 para. 95 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Water Act 1989U.K.

96(1)Section 174 of the Water Act 1989 (c. 15) (general restrictions on disclosure of information) be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (2)(d), for sub-paragraph (iv) there shall be substituted—

(iv)the Office of Communications;.

(3)In subsection (3), after paragraph (ln) there shall be inserted—

(lo)the Communications Act 2003;.

Commencement Information

I495Sch. 17 para. 96 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I496Sch. 17 para. 96 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Road Traffic (Driver Licensing and Information Systems) Act 1989U.K.

97(1)The Road Traffic (Driver Licensing and Information Systems) Act 1989 (c. 22) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For section 9(3) (requirement for licence to operate driver information systems) there shall be substituted—

(3)The holding by a person of a licence under this section shall not relieve him of—

(a)any liability in respect of a failure to hold a licence under section 1 of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949; or

(b)any obligation to comply with requirements imposed by or under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of the Communications Act 2003 (electronic communications networks and electronic communications services).

(3)In paragraph 4 of Schedule 4 (application of telecommunications code to licence holders), for the words “(application of telecommunications code)” there shall be substituted “ (procedure for works involving alteration of electronic communications apparatus) ”.

(4)In paragraph 8 of Schedule 5 (undertakers' works affecting driver information systems)—

(a)in the definition of “relevant undertaker”, for paragraph (b) there shall be substituted—

(b)any electronic communications code operator;;

(b)in the definition of “undertaker’s works”, in paragraph (b), for “a telecommunication system run by him” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network provided by him ”.

Commencement Information

I497Sch. 17 para. 97 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I498Sch. 17 para. 97 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Electricity Act 1989U.K.

98U.K.In section 3A(4)(b) of the Electricity Act 1989 (c. 29) (general duties of Secretary of State and Authority), for sub-paragraph (i) there shall be substituted—

(i)communications services and electronic communications apparatus, or.

Commencement Information

I499Sch. 17 para. 98 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I500Sch. 17 para. 98 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

99(1)Schedule 4 to that Act (other powers etc. of licence holders) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraphs 3(1)(d) and 5—

(a)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “a telecommunication system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”; and

(c)for “telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”.

(3)In paragraph 4(1), for paragraph (c) there shall be substituted—

(c)any electronic communications code operator or any former PTO; and.

Commencement Information

I501Sch. 17 para. 99 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I502Sch. 17 para. 99 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Local Government and Housing Act 1989U.K.

100U.K.In section 88(1)(e)(i) of the Local Government and Housing Act 1989 (c. 42) (electronic communication), for “a telecommunication system (within the meaning of the Telecommunications Act 1984)” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

Commencement Information

I503Sch. 17 para. 100 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I504Sch. 17 para. 100 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Insolvency (Northern Ireland) Order 1989U.K.

101(1)The Insolvency (Northern Ireland) Order 1989 (S.I. 1989/2405 (N.I. 19)) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In Article 197(3) (supplies of water, electricity, etc.) for sub-paragraph (c) to the end there shall be substituted—

(c)a supply of communications services by a provider of a public electronic communications service,

and in this paragraph “communications services” do not include electronic communications services to the extent that they are used to broadcast or transmit programme services (within the meaning of the Communications Act 2003).

(3)In Article 343(4) (supplies of water, electricity, etc.) for sub-paragraph (c) to the end there shall be substituted—

(c)a supply of communications services by a provider of a public telecommunications service,

and in this paragraph ‘communications services’ do not include electronic communications services to the extent that they are used to broadcast or transmit programme services (within the meaning of the Communications Act 2003).

Commencement Information

I505Sch. 17 para. 101 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I506Sch. 17 para. 101 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Town and Country Planning Act 1990U.K.

102U.K.In section 148(1) of the Town and Country Planning Act 1990 (c. 8) (interpretation of Chapter 1), in the definition of “statutory undertakers”, for “public telecommunications operators” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code operators and former PTOs ”.

Commencement Information

I507Sch. 17 para. 102 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I508Sch. 17 para. 102 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

103(1)This paragraph applies to the following provisions of that Act—U.K.

(a)section 236(2) (exception to extinguishment of rights over land compulsorily acquired);

(b)section 237(3) (saving from power to override certain rights);

(c)section 256 (Secretary of State’s orders affecting telecommunications apparatus);

(d)section 260 (orders by other authorities affecting telecommunication apparatus);

(e)section 272 (extinguishment of rights of telecommunications code system operators);

(f)section 273(7) and (8) (notices given to developing authority);

(g)section 274(2) (making of orders);

(h)section 279(3) (right to compensation).

(2)In each of the provisions to which this paragraph applies—

(a)for “telecommunications code”, wherever occurring (except in the expression “telecommunications code system”), there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system” and “any telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “telecommunications apparatus” and “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(d)for “the telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code network ”;

(e)for “system”, wherever occurring (except in the expression “telecommunications code system”), there shall be substituted “ network ”.

Commencement Information

I509Sch. 17 para. 103 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I510Sch. 17 para. 103 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

104U.K.In section 280 of that Act (measures of compensation)—

(a)for “a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(b)for “the running of the telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the provision of the electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I511Sch. 17 para. 104 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I512Sch. 17 para. 104 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

105U.K.In paragraph 1(a) of Schedule 13 to that Act (blighted land), for sub-paragraph (ii) there shall be substituted—

(ii)of the provision by an electronic communications code operator of an electronic communications code network or the provision by a former PTO of a public electronic communications network or a public electronic communications service, or.

Commencement Information

I513Sch. 17 para. 105 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I514Sch. 17 para. 105 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Planning (Listed Buildings and Conservation Areas) Act 1990U.K.

106(1)The Planning (Listed Buildings and Conservation Areas) Act 1990 (c. 9) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 51(2) (saving for ending of rights over land compulsorily acquired), for paragraphs (b) and (c) there shall be substituted—

(b)to any right conferred by or in accordance with the electronic communications code on the operator of an electronic communications code network, or

(c)to any electronic communications apparatus kept installed for the purposes of any such network.

(3)In section 91(3) (meaning of “statutory undertakers” in certain sections), in paragraph (a) for “a public telecommunications operator” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code operator and to a former PTO ”.

Commencement Information

I515Sch. 17 para. 106 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I516Sch. 17 para. 106 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

London Local Authorities (No. 2) Act 1990U.K.

107(1)Section 5 of the London Local Authorities (No. 2) Act 1990 (c. xxx) (crime prevention) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For subsection (1)(b) there shall be substituted—

(b)providing within their area an electronic communications service which is distributed—

(i)only to persons on a single set of premises; and

(ii)by an electronic communications network which is wholly within those premises and is not connected to an electronic communications network any part of which is outside those premises;.

(3)In subsection (1)(c), for “telecommunications system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications network or electronic communications service ”.

(4)After subsection (4), there shall be inserted—

(4A)For the purposes of subsection (1)(b)—

(a)a set of premises is a single set of premises if, and only if, the same person is the occupier of all the premises; and

(b)two or more vehicles are capable of constituting a single set of premises if, and only if, they are coupled together.

(5)For subsection (5), there shall be substituted—

(5)In this section—

premises” includes a vehicle; and

vehicle” includes a vessel, aircraft or hovercraft.

Commencement Information

I517Sch. 17 para. 107 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I518Sch. 17 para. 107 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

New Roads and Street Works Act 1991U.K.

108(1)In the New Roads and Street Works Act 1991 (c. 22)—U.K.

(a)paragraph 7 of Schedule 4 (streets with special engineering difficulties), and

(b)paragraph 7 of Schedule 6 (roads with special engineering difficulties),

shall be amended as follows.

(2)For “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

(3)In sub-paragraph (3)(c)—

(a)for “a telecommunication system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”; and

(b)for “a system” there shall be substituted “ a network ”.

Commencement Information

I519Sch. 17 para. 108 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I520Sch. 17 para. 108 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Coal Mining Subsidence Act 1991U.K.

109U.K.In section 52(1) of the Coal Mining Subsidence Act 1991 (c. 45) (interpretation) in the definition of “statutory undertakers”, in paragraph (b) for “any public telecommunications operator” there shall be substituted “ any electronic communications code operator, any former PTO ”.

Commencement Information

I521Sch. 17 para. 109 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I522Sch. 17 para. 109 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Water Industry Act 1991U.K.

110U.K.In section 219 of the Water Industry Act 1991 (c. 56) (general interpretation), in the definition of “accessories”, for “telecommunication apparatus (within the meaning of Schedule 2 to the Telecommunications Act 1984)” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I523Sch. 17 para. 110 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I524Sch. 17 para. 110 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

111(1)Schedule 13 to that Act (protective provisions in respect of certain undertakings) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraph 1(5), for paragraph (c) there shall be substituted—

(c)any undertaking consisting in the provision of an electronic communications network;.

(3)In paragraph 4, for “telecommunication apparatus” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I525Sch. 17 para. 111 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I526Sch. 17 para. 111 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

112(1)Schedule 15 to that Act (disclosure of information) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In Part 1, for “The Director General of Telecommunications” there shall be substituted “ The Office of Communications ”.

(3)In Part 2, after the entry relating to the Enterprise Act 2002, there shall be inserted— “ The Communications Act 2003. ”

Commencement Information

I527Sch. 17 para. 112 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I528Sch. 17 para. 112 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Water Resources Act 1991U.K.

113U.K.In section 221 of the Water Resources Act 1991 (c. 57) (general interpretation), in the definition of “accessories”, for “telecommunication apparatus (within the meaning of Schedule 2 to the Telecommunications Act 1984)” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I529Sch. 17 para. 113 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I530Sch. 17 para. 113 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

114(1)Schedule 22 to that Act (general provisions protecting undertakings) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraph 1(4), for paragraph (c) there shall be substituted—

(c)any undertaking consisting in the provision of an electronic communications network;.

(3)In paragraph 5, for “telecommunication apparatus” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I531Sch. 17 para. 114 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I532Sch. 17 para. 114 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

115(1)Schedule 24 to that Act (disclosure of information) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In Part 1, for “The Director General of Telecommunications” there shall be substituted “ The Office of Communications ”.

(3)In Part 2, after the entry relating to the Enterprise Act 2002, there shall be inserted— “ The Communications Act 2003. ”

Commencement Information

I533Sch. 17 para. 115 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I534Sch. 17 para. 115 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Land Drainage Act 1991U.K.

116U.K.In paragraph 1(1) of Schedule 6 to the Land Drainage Act 1991 (c. 59) (protection for particular undertakings), for paragraph (c) there shall be substituted—

(c)any undertaking consisting in the provision of an electronic communications code network;.

Commencement Information

I535Sch. 17 para. 116 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I536Sch. 17 para. 116 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Planning (Northern Ireland) Order 1991U.K.

117U.K.In Articles 103 (making of orders) and 104 (telecommunication apparatus) of the Planning (Northern Ireland) Order 1991 (S.I. 1991/1220 (N.I. 11))—

(a)for “telecommunications code”, wherever occurring (except in the expression “telecommunications code system”) there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system” and “any telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(d)for “system” (except in the expression “telecommunications code system”) there shall be substituted “ network ”.

Commencement Information

I537Sch. 17 para. 117 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I538Sch. 17 para. 117 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Charities Act 1992U.K.

118U.K.In section 60(6)(c) of the Charities Act 1992 (c. 41) (making of payments to professional fund-raisers etc.), for “telecommunication apparatus” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I539Sch. 17 para. 118 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I540Sch. 17 para. 118 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Carriage of Goods by Sea Act 1992U.K.

119U.K.In section 1(5) of the Carriage of Goods by Sea Act 1992 (c. 50), for “a telecommunication system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

Commencement Information

I541Sch. 17 para. 119 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I542Sch. 17 para. 119 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Electricity (Northern Ireland) Order 1992U.K.

120U.K.The Electricity (Northern Ireland) Order 1992 (S.I. 1992/231 (N.I. 1)) shall be amended as follows.

Commencement Information

I543Sch. 17 para. 120 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I544Sch. 17 para. 120 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

121U.K.In Article 61 (restrictions on disclosure of information)—

(a)for paragraph (2)(b)(vi) there shall be substituted—

(vi)the Office of Communications;;

(b)after paragraph (3)(u) there shall be inserted—

(v)the Communications Act 2003;.

Commencement Information

I545Sch. 17 para. 121 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I546Sch. 17 para. 121 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

122(1)Schedule 4 (other powers etc. of licence holders) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraph 1(1)—

(a)for “a public telecommunications operator” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code operator ”;

(b)for “telecommunication system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications network ”.

(3)In paragraphs 4 and 6 for “public telecommunications operator” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code operator ”.

(4)In paragraphs 3(1) and (2), 5(1), (2), (3) and (4), 6(1) and 9—

(a)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “a telecommunication system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”;

(c)for “telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”.

Commencement Information

I547Sch. 17 para. 122 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I548Sch. 17 para. 122 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

F103...U.K.

Textual Amendments

F103Sch. 17 para. 123 and crossheading repealed (1.12.2008) by Housing and Regeneration Act 2008 (c. 17), s. 325(1), Sch. 16; S.I. 2008/3068, art. 5, Sch. (with arts. 6-13)

F103123U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Commencement Information

I549Sch. 17 para. 123 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I550Sch. 17 para. 123 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Cardiff Bay Barrage Act 1993U.K.

124U.K.In Schedule 2 to the Cardiff Bay Barrage Act 1993 (c. 42) (supplementary provisions about Development Corporation works)—

(a)in paragraph 1(c), for “telecommunication” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications ”;

(b)in paragraph 16, for “telecommunication apparatus” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I551Sch. 17 para. 124 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I552Sch. 17 para. 124 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

125U.K.In paragraph 3(2)(c) of Schedule 4 to that Act (exception to extinguishment of rights over land compulsorily acquired)—

(a)for “the telecommunications code” there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “such system;” there shall be substituted “ such network. ”

Commencement Information

I553Sch. 17 para. 125 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I554Sch. 17 para. 125 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

126U.K.In paragraph 21 of Schedule 7 to that Act (powers of survey etc. in connection with groundwater damage)—

(a)in sub-paragraphs (5)(b)(ii) and (7), for “a relevant telecommunications licenceholder” there shall be substituted “ a provider of a public electronic communications network ”;

(b)in sub-paragraphs (6) and (7), for “or licenceholder” there shall be substituted “ or provider ”;

(c)in sub-paragraph (6), for “running of the telecommunication system” there shall be substituted “ provision of the public electronic communications network ”.

Commencement Information

I555Sch. 17 para. 126 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I556Sch. 17 para. 126 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Railways Act 1993U.K.

127(1)Section 145 of the Railways Act 1993 (c. 43) (general restrictions on disclosure of information) be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (2)(b), for sub-paragraph (iv) there shall be substituted—

(iv)the Office of Communications,.

(3)In subsection (3), after paragraph (qs) there shall be inserted—

(qt)the Communications Act 2003;.

Commencement Information

I557Sch. 17 para. 127 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I558Sch. 17 para. 127 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Roads (Northern Ireland) Order 1993U.K.

128(1)This paragraph applies to the following provisions of the Roads (Northern Ireland) Order 1993 (S.I. 1993/3160 (N.I. 15))—U.K.

(a)Article 12(2) (road bridges over railways);

(b)Article 70(2) (consultation on exercise of power to erect structure on road);

(c)Article 72(2) (control of scaffolding on roads);

(d)Article 73(2) (restriction on placing rails etc. over roads);

(e)Article 78(2) (excavations in a road);

(f)Article 79(2) (placing of apparatus in or under roads);

(g)Article 82(3) (excavations near a road);

(h)Article 83(2) (alteration of wall, fence or drain at the side of a road);

(i)Schedule 9 (savings for telecommunications apparatus).

(2)In each of the provisions to which this paragraph applies—

(a)for “a telecommunications code system” and “any telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(b)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(c)for “telecommunications code”, wherever occurring (except in the expression “telecommunications code system”), there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”;

(d)for “that system”, “any such system” and “the system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted, respectively, “ that network ”, “ any such network ” and “ the network ”;

(e)for “the telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I559Sch. 17 para. 128 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I560Sch. 17 para. 128 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Value Added Tax Act 1994U.K.

129(1)The Value Added Tax Act 1994 (c. 23) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 33 (refunds of VAT in certain cases)—

(a)in subsection (3), for paragraph (j) there shall be substituted—

(j)the appointed news provider referred to in section 280 of the Communications Act 2003; and;

(b)in subsection (5), for “a nominated” there shall be substituted “ an appointed ”.

(3)In Part 2 of Schedule 9 (exemptions), in Note (1) in Group 12 (fund-raising events by charities etc.), for “a telecommunications system (within the meaning of the Telecommunications Act 1984)” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

Commencement Information

I561Sch. 17 para. 129(1)(3) in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I562Sch. 17 para. 129(1) (3) in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

I563Sch. 17 para. 129(2) in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Criminal Justice and Public Order Act 1994U.K.

130(1)Section 163 of the Criminal Justice and Public Order Act 1994 (c. 33) (local authority powers to provide closed-circuit television) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For subsection (1)(b) there shall be substituted—

(b)providing within their area an electronic communications service which is distributed—

(i)only to persons on a single set of premises; and

(ii)by an electronic communications network which is wholly within those premises and is not connected to an electronic communications network any part of which is outside those premises;.

(3)In subsection (1)(c), for “telecommunications system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications network or electronic communications service ”.

(4)After subsection (3), there shall be inserted—

(3A)For the purposes of subsection (1)(b)—

(a)a set of premises is a single set of premises if, and only if, the same person is the occupier of all the premises; and

(b)two or more vehicles are capable of constituting a single set of premises if, and only if, they are coupled together.

(5)In subsection (4), for the definition of “telecommunications system” there shall be substituted—

premises” includes a vehicle; and

vehicle” includes a vessel, aircraft or hovercraft.

Commencement Information

I564Sch. 17 para. 130 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I565Sch. 17 para. 130 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Airports (Northern Ireland) Order 1994U.K.

131U.K.In Article 12 of the Airports (Northern Ireland) Order 1994 (S.I. 1994/426 (N.I. 1)) (provisions as to telecommunications apparatus)—

(a)for “telecommunications apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “the telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the electronic communications code ”;

(c)for “a telecommunications code system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”;

(d)in paragraph (3), for “that system” there shall be substituted “ that network ”.

Commencement Information

I566Sch. 17 para. 131 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I567Sch. 17 para. 131 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Merchant Shipping Act 1995U.K.

132U.K.In section 91(7) of the Merchant Shipping Act 1995 (c. 21) (report of dangers to navigation), in the definition of “controlled station for wireless telegraphy”—

(a)after “Secretary of State” there shall be inserted “ or by the Office of Communications ”; and

(b)for “by him” there shall be substituted “ by the Office of Communications ”.

Commencement Information

I568Sch. 17 para. 132 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Criminal Procedure (Scotland) Act 1995U.K.

133(1)The Criminal Procedure (Scotland) Act 1995 (c. 46) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 302(9)(a) (interpretation), at the end there shall be inserted “ nor an offence to which Schedule 6 to the Communications Act 2003 (fixed penalties for wireless telegraphy offences) applies. ”

(3)In Schedule 9 (certificates as to proof of certain routine matters), at the end there shall be inserted—

The Communications Act 2003

Section 363(1) and (2) (offence of unauthorised installation or use of a television receiver)

A person authorised to do so by the British Broadcasting CorporationIn relation to premises at an address specified in the certificate, whether on a date so specified any television licence (for the purposes of that section) was, in records maintained on behalf of the Corporation in relation to such licences, recorded as being in force; and, if so, particulars so specified of such record of that licence.

Commencement Information

I569Sch. 17 para. 133(1) (3) in force at 1.4.2004 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 4(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 11)

British Waterways Act 1995U.K.

134U.K.In section 3(1) of the British Waterways Act 1995 (c. i) (interpretation), in the definition of “relevant undertaker”, in paragraph (f), for the words from the beginning to “in that Act)” there shall be substituted “ any provider of an electronic communications network having any electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I570Sch. 17 para. 134 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I571Sch. 17 para. 134 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Street Works (Northern Ireland) Order 1995U.K.

135(1)Paragraph 7 of Schedule 2 to the Street Works (Northern Ireland) Order 1995 (S.I. 1995/3210 (N.I. 19)) (streets with special engineering difficulties) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

(3)In sub-paragraph (3)(c)—

(a)for “a telecommunication system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”;

(b)for “a system” there shall be substituted “ a network ”.

Commencement Information

I572Sch. 17 para. 135 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I573Sch. 17 para. 135 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Housing Act 1996U.K.

F104136U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

Commencement Information

I574Sch. 17 para. 136 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I575Sch. 17 para. 136 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Housing Grants, Construction and Regeneration Act 1996U.K.

137U.K.In section 105(1)(b) of the Housing Grants, Construction and Regeneration Act 1996 (c. 53) (meaning of “construction operations”), for “telecommunication apparatus” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I576Sch. 17 para. 137 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I577Sch. 17 para. 137 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Channel Tunnel Rail Link Act 1996U.K.

138U.K.In Schedule 6 to the Channel Tunnel Rail Link Act 1996 (c. 61) (planning conditions), in the table in paragraph 6(4) and the table in paragraph 15(4), for “telecommunications masts”, in each place, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications masts ”.

Commencement Information

I578Sch. 17 para. 138 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I579Sch. 17 para. 138 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

139(1)Part 4 of Schedule 15 to that Act (protection of telecommunications operators) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraph 1(1), for “telecommunications operator” there shall be substituted “ an operator of an electronic communications code network ”.

(3)In paragraphs 2 to 4—

(a)for “telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”;

(b)for “telecommunications apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(c)for “a telecommunications operator”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an operator ”;

(d)for “any telecommunications operator”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ any operator of an electronic communications code network ”;

(e)for “the telecommunications operator”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ the operator ”;

(f)for “telecommunications system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code network ”.

(4)In paragraph 5—

(a)for “telecommunications apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “telecommunications operator”, in the first place where it occurs, there shall be substituted “ operator of an electronic communications code network ”;

(c)for “telecommunications operator”, in each other place where it occurs, there shall be substituted “ operator ”.

Commencement Information

I580Sch. 17 para. 139 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I581Sch. 17 para. 139 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Gas (Northern Ireland) Order 1996U.K.

140U.K.The Gas (Northern Ireland) Order 1996 (S.I. 1996/275 (N.I. 2)) shall be amended as follows.

Commencement Information

I582Sch. 17 para. 140 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I583Sch. 17 para. 140 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

141U.K.In Article 44 (restrictions on disclosure of information)—

(a)in paragraph (3)(b), for head (vi) there shall be substituted—

(vi)the Office of Communications;;

(b)in paragraph (4), after sub-paragraph (v) there shall be inserted—

(w)the Communications Act 2003.

Commencement Information

I584Sch. 17 para. 141 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I585Sch. 17 para. 141 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

142(1)Schedule 3 (other powers etc. of licence holders) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraph 1(1)—

(a)for “a public telecommunications operator” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code operator ”;

(b)for “telecommunication system” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications network ”.

(3)In paragraphs 4 and 6 for “public telecommunications operator” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code operator ”.

(4)In paragraphs 3(1), (2) and (3), 5(1) and (2), 6(1) and 8—

(a)for “telecommunication apparatus”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”;

(b)for “a telecommunication system”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”;

(c)for “telecommunications code”, wherever occurring, there shall be substituted “ electronic communications code ”.

Commencement Information

I586Sch. 17 para. 142 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I587Sch. 17 para. 142 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Construction Contracts (Northern Ireland) Order 1997U.K.

143U.K.In Article 4(1)(b) of the Construction Contracts (Northern Ireland) Order 1997 (S.I. 1997/274 (N.I. 1)) (meaning of “construction operations”), for “telecommunication apparatus” there shall be substituted “ electronic communications apparatus ”.

Commencement Information

I588Sch. 17 para. 143 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I589Sch. 17 para. 143 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Waste and Contaminated Land (Northern Ireland) Order 1997U.K.

144U.K.In Article 2(2) of the Waste and Contaminated Land (Northern Ireland) Order 1997 (S.I. 1997/2778 (N.I. 19)) (meaning of “industrial waste” for “telecommunication services”) there shall be substituted “ communications services ”.

Commencement Information

I590Sch. 17 para. 144 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I591Sch. 17 para. 144 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Wireless Telegraphy Act 1998U.K.

F105145U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F105Sch. 17 paras. 145-151 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I592Sch. 17 para. 145 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F105146U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F105Sch. 17 paras. 145-151 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I593Sch. 17 para. 146 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F105147U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F105Sch. 17 paras. 145-151 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I594Sch. 17 para. 147 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I595Sch. 17 para. 147 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F105148U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F105Sch. 17 paras. 145-151 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I596Sch. 17 para. 148 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F105149U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F105Sch. 17 paras. 145-151 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I597Sch. 17 para. 149 in force at 18.9.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I598Sch. 17 para. 149 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

F105150U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F105Sch. 17 paras. 145-151 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I599 (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I600Sch. 17 para. 150 in force at 18.9.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I601Sch. 17 para. 150 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

F105151U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F105Sch. 17 paras. 145-151 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I602Sch. 17 para. 151 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Finance Act 1998U.K.

F106152U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F106Sch. 17 para. 152 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 381(1) of the amending Act) by Taxation (International and Other Provisions) Act 2010 (c. 8), s. 381(1), Sch. 10 Pt. 12 (with Sch. 9 paras. 1-9, 22)

Commencement Information

I603Sch. 17 para. 152 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I604Sch. 17 para. 152 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Competition Act 1998U.K.

153(1)Schedule 7 to the Competition Act 1998 (c. 41) (members of Commission appointed under certain enactments) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In paragraph 2(1)(d), for sub-paragraph (iii) there shall be substituted—

(iii)section 194(1) of the Communications Act 2003;.

(3)In paragraph 19A(9), in the definition of “special reference group”, after paragraph (n) there shall be inserted or

(o)section 193 of the Communications Act 2003.

Commencement Information

I605Sch. 17 para. 153 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I606Sch. 17 para. 153 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

154U.K.In paragraph 1 of Schedule 7A to that Act (procedural rules), in the definition of “special investigation”, for “and (n)” there shall be substituted “ , (n) and (o) ”.

Commencement Information

I607Sch. 17 para. 154 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I608Sch. 17 para. 154 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Regional Development Agencies Act 1998U.K.

F107155U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F107Sch. 17 para. 155 repealed (1.7.2012 at 0.02 a.m.) by Public Bodies Act 2011 (c. 24), s. 38(3), Sch. 6 (with Sch. 6 Note 1); S.I. 2012/1662, art. 2(2)(b)

Commencement Information

I609Sch. 17 para. 155 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I610Sch. 17 para. 155 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Finance Act 1999U.K.

156U.K.In section 132(10) of the Finance Act 1999 (c. 16) (power to provide for use of electronic communications), for “a telecommunication system (within the meaning of the Telecommunications Act 1984)” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications service ”.

Commencement Information

I611Sch. 17 para. 156 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I612Sch. 17 para. 156 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Greater London Authority Act 1999U.K.

157(1)Section 235 of the Greater London Authority Act 1999 (c. 29) (restrictions on disclosure of information) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (2)(c), for sub-paragraph (iv) there shall be substituted—

(iv)the Office of Communications,.

(3)In subsection (3), after paragraph (rs) there shall be inserted—

(rt)the Communications Act 2003;.

Commencement Information

I613Sch. 17 para. 157 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I614Sch. 17 para. 157 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Electronic Communications Act 2000U.K.

158U.K.In section 15(1) of the Electronic Communications Act 2000 (c. 7) (general interpretation), in the definition of “electronic communication”, for “a telecommunication system (within the meaning of the Telecommunications Act 1984)” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

Commencement Information

I615Sch. 17 para. 158 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I616Sch. 17 para. 158 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Television Licences (Disclosure of Information) Act 2000U.K.

159U.K.In section 5 of the Television Licences (Disclosure of Information) Act 2000 (c. 15) (interpretation)—

(a)for the definitions of “the BBC” and “television licence” there shall be substituted—

the BBC” means the British Broadcasting Corporation;;

(b)after the definition of “prescribed” there shall be inserted—

television licence” means a licence for the purposes of section 363 of the Communications Act 2003;.

Commencement Information

I617Sch. 17 para. 159 in force at 1.4.2004 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 4(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 11)

Finance Act 2000MU.K.

160U.K.In paragraph 8 of Schedule 38 to the Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) (regulations for providing incentives for electronic communications), in the definition of “electronic communications”, for “a telecommunication system (within the meaning of the Telecommunications Act 1984)” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications service ”.

Commencement Information

I618Sch. 17 para. 160 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I619Sch. 17 para. 160 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Regulation of Investigatory Powers Act 2000U.K.

161(1)The Regulation of Investigatory Powers Act 2000 (c. 23) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 26(6)(a) (surveillance carried out for detecting unlicensed TV use), for “section 1 of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949)” there shall be substituted “ Part 4 of the Communications Act 2003) ”.

(3)In Part 1 of Schedule 1 (relevant public authorities for the purposes of sections 28 and 29 of that Act), after paragraph 23 there shall be inserted—

23AThe Office of Communications.

Commencement Information

I620Sch. 17 para. 161(1) (3) in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

I621Sch. 17 para. 161(2) in force at 1.4.2004 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 4(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 11)

Postal Services Act 2000U.K.

162(1)The Postal Services Act 2000 (c. 26) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 125(2)(a) (communications delivered otherwise than electronically), for “a telecommunication system (within the meaning of the Telecommunications Act 1984)” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

F108(3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F108Sch. 17 para. 162(3) omitted (1.10.2011) by virtue of Postal Services Act 2011 (c. 5), s. 93(2)(3), Sch. 12 para. 70; S.I. 2011/2329, art. 3

Commencement Information

I622Sch. 17 para. 162 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I623Sch. 17 para. 162 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Utilities Act 2000U.K.

163(1)Section 105 of the Utilities Act 2000 (c. 27) (general restrictions on disclosure of information) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In subsection (5), for paragraph (d) there shall be substituted—

(d)the Office of Communications;.

(3)In subsection (6), after paragraph (s) there shall be inserted—

(t)the Communications Act 2003.

Commencement Information

I624Sch. 17 para. 163 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I625Sch. 17 para. 163 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Freedom of Information Act 2000U.K.

164U.K.In Part 6 of Schedule 1 to the Freedom of Information Act 2000 (c. 36) (public authorities), there shall be inserted at the appropriate place—

The Consumer Panel established under section 16 of the Communications Act 2003.

Commencement Information

I626Sch. 17 para. 164 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Countryside and Rights of Way Act 2000U.K.

165(1)The Countryside and Rights of Way Act 2000 (c. 37) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 17(4) (byelaws not to interfere with certain rights), for paragraph (c) there shall be substituted—

(c)with the provision of an electronic communications code network or the exercise of any right conferred by or in accordance with the electronic communications code on the operator of any such network.

(3)In paragraph 8 of Schedule 1 (excepted land), for “a telecommunications code system” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications code network ”.

Commencement Information

I627Sch. 17 para. 165 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I628Sch. 17 para. 165 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Transport Act 2000U.K.

166(1)Paragraph 3 of Schedule 9 to the Transport Act 2000 (c. 38) (air traffic information) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In sub-paragraph (2), for paragraph (d) there shall be substituted—

(d)the Office of Communications;.

(3)In sub-paragraph (3)—

(a)after paragraph (q) there shall be inserted—

(qa)the Broadcasting Act 1996;;

(b)after paragraph (ra) there shall be inserted—

(rb)the Communications Act 2003;.

Commencement Information

I629Sch. 17 para. 166(1)(2)(3)(b) in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I630Sch. 17 para. 166(1) (2) (3)(b) in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

I631Sch. 17 para. 166(3)(a) in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Political Parties, Elections and Referendums Act 2000U.K.

167(1)The Political Parties, Elections and Referendums Act 2000 (c. 41) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 11(3) (broadcasters to have regard to Electoral Commission’s views on political broadcasts), for the words from “and Sianel” to “regard” there shall be substituted “ shall have regard, in determining its policy with respect to party political broadcasts, ”.

(3)In paragraph 4(6) of Schedule 12 (broadcasters to have regard to Electoral Commission’s views on referendum campaign broadcasts), for the words from “and Sianel” to “regard” there shall be substituted “ shall have regard, in determining its policy with respect to referendum campaign broadcasts by designated organisations, ”.

Commencement Information

I632Sch. 17 para. 167 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Vehicles (Crime) Act 2001U.K.

168U.K.In sections [F10916(2)(a),] 31(2)(a) and 40(6) of the Vehicles (Crime) Act 2001 (c. 3) (transmission of representations and service of notices etc.), for “a telecommunication system (within the meaning of the Telecommunications Act 1984 (c. 12))” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

Textual Amendments

F109Word in Sch. 17 para. 168 repealed (E.W.) (1.10.2013) by Scrap Metal Dealers Act 2013 (c. 10), ss. 19(1)(e), 23(2); S.I. 2013/1966, art. 3(r) (with art. 5)

Commencement Information

I633Sch. 17 para. 168 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I634Sch. 17 para. 168 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Criminal Justice and Police Act 2001U.K.

169U.K.In the table in section 1(1) of the Criminal Justice and Police Act 2001 (c. 16) (offences leading to penalties on the spot), after the entry relating to section 12 of that Act there shall be inserted—

Section 127(2) of the Communications Act 2003Using public electronic communications network in order to cause annoyance, inconvenience or needless anxiety.

Commencement Information

I635Sch. 17 para. 169 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I636Sch. 17 para. 169 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Electronic Communications Act (Northern Ireland) 2001U.K.

170U.K.In section 4(1) of the Electronic Communications Act (Northern Ireland) 2001 (c. 9 (N.I.)) (interpretation), in the definition of “electronic communication”, for “a telecommunication system (within the meaning of the Telecommunications Act 1984)” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

Commencement Information

I637Sch. 17 para. 170 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I638Sch. 17 para. 170 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Office of Communications Act 2002U.K.

171U.K.Sections 2, 4, 5 and 6 of the Office of Communications Act 2002 (c. 11) shall cease to have effect.

Commencement Information

I639Sch. 17 para. 171 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

172(1)The Schedule to that Act shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)The following shall cease to have effect—

(a)paragraph 1(4);

(b)paragraph 8(5);

(c)paragraph 17(8) and (9); and

(d)paragraph 20.

(3)For paragraph 8(1) there shall be substituted—

(1)It shall be the duty of OFCOM so to conduct their affairs as to secure that their revenues so far as they —

(a)derive from the exercise of powers to impose charges or fees in respect of the carrying out of particular functions, and

(b)do not fall to be paid into the Consolidated Fund of the United Kingdom or of Northern Ireland,

are at least sufficient to enable OFCOM to meet the costs of carrying out the functions to which the revenues relate.

(4)After paragraph 14(3) (executive committees of OFCOM to include member or employee of OFCOM) there shall be inserted—

(3A)Sub-paragraph (3) has effect in the case of a committee of OFCOM which—

(a)is not the Content Board, but

(b)has functions that are confined to functions falling within section 13(2) of the Communications Act 2003 (functions within the Content Board’s remit),

as if the reference in that sub-paragraph to a member of OFCOM included a reference to a member of the Content Board who is not a member of OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I640Sch. 17 para. 172 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Tobacco Advertising and Promotion Act 2002U.K.

173(1)Section 12 of the Tobacco Advertising and Promotion Act 2002 (c. 36) (exclusion from that Act of advertising on television and radio) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)For subsection (3) there shall be substituted—

(3)This subsection applies to —

(a)a service falling within section 211(1) of the Communications Act 2003 (independent television services regulated by the Office of Communications) which is not an additional television service (within the meaning of Part 3 of that Act); and

(b)an additional television service comprised in the public teletext service (within the meaning of that Part).

(3)For subsection (5) there shall be substituted—

(5)This subsection applies to a service which—

(a)falls within section 245(1) of the Communications Act 2003 (independent radio services regulated by the Office of Communications); but

(b)is not a digital additional sound service (within the meaning of Part 3 of that Act).

Commencement Information

I641Sch. 17 para. 173 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Enterprise Act 2002U.K.

174(1)The Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

(2)In section 126(6) (service of documents electronically), for “a telecommunication system (within the meaning of the Telecommunications Act 1984 (c. 12))” there shall be substituted “ an electronic communications network ”.

(3)In section 128(5) (supply of services and market for services etc.), for “section 189(2) of the Broadcasting Act 1990 (c. 42)” there shall be substituted “ paragraph 29 of Schedule 2 to the Telecommunications Act 1984 ”.

(4)In section 136 (investigations and reports on market investigation references)—

(a)in subsection (7), after paragraph (g) there shall be inserted—

(h)in relation to the Office of Communications, sections 370 and 371 of the Communications Act 2003.;

(b)in subsection (8), for “or the Civil Aviation Authority” there shall be substituted “ , the Civil Aviation Authority or the Office of Communications ”.

(5)In section 168 (regulated markets)—

(a)in subsection (3)(e), for “section 39(1) of the Broadcasting Act 1990 (c. 42)” there shall be substituted “ section 290 of the Communications Act 2003 ”;

(b)for subsection (4)(e), there shall be substituted—

(e)in relation to any networking arrangements (within the meaning given by section 290 of the Communications Act 2003), the duty of the Office of Communications under subsection (1) of section 3 of that Act to secure the matters mentioned in subsection (2)(c) of that section;;

(c)for subsection (5)(g), there shall be substituted—

(g)the Office of Communications;.

(6)In section 234(5) (supply of services), for “section 189(2) of the Broadcasting Act 1990 (c. 42)” there shall be substituted “ paragraph 29 of Schedule 2 to the Telecommunications Act 1984 ”.

(7)In Schedule 15 (enactments conferring functions), in the appropriate place, there shall be inserted— “ Communications Act 2003. ”

Commencement Information

I642Sch. 17 para. 174(1)(2)(4)(6)(7) in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I643Sch. 17 para. 174(1) (2) (4) (6) (7) in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

I644Sch. 17 para. 174(3) (5) in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003U.K.

175(1)The Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1) shall be amended as follows.U.K.

F110(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

F111(3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F110Sch. 17 para. 175(2) repealed (19.7.2006 with effect in accordance with Sch. 26 Pt. 3(6) Note of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2006 (c. 25), Sch. 26 Pt. 3(6)

F111Sch. 17 para. 175(3) repealed (19.7.2006 with effect in accordance with Sch. 26 Pt. 3(7) Note of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2006 (c. 25), Sch. 26 Pt. 3(7)

Commencement Information

I645Sch. 17 para. 175 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I646Sch. 17 para. 175 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Section 406

SCHEDULE 18U.K.Transitional Provisions

GeneralU.K.

1(1)This paragraph applies where, at any time before the coming into force of a transfer made by virtue of section 2—U.K.

(a)any subordinate legislation has been made in the carrying out of the transferred functions by the person from whom the transfer is made; or

(b)any other thing has been done by or in relation to that person for the purposes of or in connection with the carrying out of those functions.

(2)The subordinate legislation or other thing—

(a)is to have effect, on and after the coming into force of the transfer, and so far as necessary for its purposes, as if it had been made or done by or in relation to OFCOM; and

(b)in the case of subordinate legislation to which section 403 applies when it is made by OFCOM, shall so have effect as if made in accordance with the requirements of that section.

(3)Where any subordinate legislation, direction, authorisation or notice has effect in accordance with this paragraph—

(a)so much of it as authorises or requires anything to be done by or in relation to the person from whom the transfer is made is to have effect in relation to times after the coming into force of the transfer as if it authorised or required that thing to be done by or in relation to OFCOM; and

(b)other references in the subordinate legislation, direction, authorisation or notice to the person from whom the transfer is made are to have effect, in relation to such times, as references to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I647Sch. 18 para. 1 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I648Sch. 18 para. 1 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Steps taken in anticipation of passing or coming into force of ActU.K.

2(1)This paragraph applies where the Secretary of State or OFCOM is or are required—U.K.

(a)by a provision of this Act, or

(b)by virtue of an amendment made by this Act,

to take steps before exercising a power or performing a duty.

(2)The requirement is capable of being satisfied by the taking of the steps in anticipation of effect being given to the provision by virtue of which the power or duty is—

(a)conferred or imposed on the Secretary of State or OFCOM; or

(b)transferred to OFCOM.

(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2) it is immaterial—

(a)that the provision by virtue of which the power or duty is conferred, imposed or transferred had not been enacted, or had not come into force, when the steps were taken; and

(b)in the case of steps taken before the enactment of that provision, that the provision the effect of which was anticipated was modified before being enacted.

(4)In relation to provisions brought into force as mentioned in subsection (1) of section 408 for the purpose of enabling specified functions to be carried out by the Director or the Secretary of State—

(a)this paragraph has effect in relation to steps taken by the Director or the Secretary of State as it has in relation to steps taken by OFCOM; and

(b)subsection (5) of that section applies in relation to steps taken by the Director or the Secretary of State in anticipation of effect being given to those provisions as it would apply to anything done by the Director or the Secretary of State for the purposes of, or in connection with, the carrying out of those functions.

(5)Where a requirement is satisfied by virtue of this paragraph by steps taken in anticipation of effect being given to a provision—

(a)representations made to or other things done in relation to OFCOM, or the Director or the Secretary of State, in consequence of the taking of those steps, and

(b)any requirements framed by reference to the time at which those steps were taken,

are to have effect as if the provision in question had come into force before those steps were taken.

Commencement Information

I649Sch. 18 para. 2 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I650Sch. 18 para. 2 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Savings for agreements referring to the termination of a 1984 Act licenceU.K.

3(1)This paragraph applies where a term or condition of an agreement in force immediately before the abolition of licensing provides—U.K.

(a)for the agreement, or a provision of it, to cease to have effect,

(b)for the agreement to become capable of being terminated,

(c)for a requirement to pay or repay an amount (whether liquidated or unliquidated) to arise under the agreement, or to arise earlier than it would otherwise have arisen,

(d)for a security to become enforceable, or

(e)for rights or obligations of a person under the agreement to be different or to be modified,

if a person (whether or not a party to the agreement) ceases to hold a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act, or ceases to do so in a manner or in circumstances described in the agreement.

(2)Where a person ceases to hold a licence in consequence of the provisions of this Act removing the requirement to hold a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act—

(a)the term or condition is not to apply; and

(b)the rights and obligations of the parties to the agreement are to be the same (subject to the following sub-paragraphs) as they would have been had the person in question continued to hold such a licence.

(3)In relation to times after the abolition of licensing, that term or condition is to have effect as if the reference in that term or condition—

(a)to a person’s ceasing to hold a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act, or

(b)to his ceasing to do so in a particular manner or particular circumstances,

were a reference to his becoming subject to a direction under this Act by virtue of which he is prohibited from providing the whole or a part of an electronic communications network or electronic communications service.

(4)In sub-paragraph (3) the reference to a person’s becoming subject to a direction by virtue of which he is prohibited from providing the whole or a part of an electronic communications network or electronic communications service—

(a)does not include a reference to his becoming subject to a direction imposing a prohibition for a fixed period of less than eighteen months or to a direction that will have to be revoked if not confirmed; but

(b)except in the case of a direction imposing a prohibition for such a fixed period, does include a reference to the confirmation of a direction that would otherwise have had to be revoked.

(5)This paragraph does not apply in the case of a term or condition of an agreement if, on an application to the court by one or both of the parties to the agreement, the court directs—

(a)that this paragraph is not to apply; or

(b)that it is to apply with such modifications, or subject to the payment of such compensation, as the court may specify in the direction.

(6)In determining whether to give a direction under sub-paragraph (5) or what modifications or compensation to specify in such a direction the court must have regard to the following—

(a)whether either or both of the parties to the agreement contemplated the abolition of the licensing requirements of the 1984 Act when they entered into the agreement; and

(b)the extent (if any) to which the provisions of this paragraph represent what it would have been reasonable for the parties to have agreed had they both known at that time what provision was to be made by this Act and when it was to come into force.

(7)For the purposes of this paragraph—

(a)references to ceasing to hold a licence include references to its expiring or being revoked; and

(b)references to a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act include references to a licence under that section of a particular description.

(8)In this paragraph “the court” means the High Court or the Court of Session.

(9)This paragraph has effect subject to paragraph 14.

Commencement Information

I651Sch. 18 para. 3 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I652Sch. 18 para. 3 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Saving for agreements with special provision for 1984 Act licence holdersU.K.

4(1)This paragraph applies in a case to which paragraph 3 does not apply and in which a term or condition of an agreement in force immediately before the abolition of licensing provides for rights or obligations of a person (“the contracting party”) under the agreement to be different or to be modified according to whether or not he or another person (whether or not a party to the agreement)—U.K.

(a)is or has become the holder of a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act; or

(b)is or has become the holder of such a licence in a manner or in circumstances described in the agreement.

(2)In relation to times after the abolition of licensing, that term or condition is to have effect as if the rights and obligations to which the contracting party is entitled or subject under the agreement were, except in a case falling within sub-paragraph (3), those for which the agreement provides in relation to a case in which the person in question—

(a)is or has become the holder of such a licence; or

(b)is or has become the holder of such a licence in that manner or in those circumstances.

(3)The excepted case is where that person is subject to a direction under this Act by virtue of which he is prohibited from providing the whole or a part of an electronic communications network or electronic communications service.

(4)In sub-paragraph (3) the reference to a person’s being subject to a direction by virtue of which he is prohibited from providing the whole or a part of an electronic communications network or electronic communications service—

(a)does not include a reference to his being subject to a direction imposing a prohibition for a fixed period of less than eighteen months or to a direction that will have to be revoked if not confirmed; but

(b)except in the case of a direction imposing a prohibition for such a fixed period, does include a reference to his being subject to a direction which would have had to be revoked if not confirmed but which has been confirmed.

(5)This paragraph does not apply in the case of a term or condition of an agreement if, on an application to the court by one or both of the parties to the agreement, the court directs—

(a)that this paragraph is not to apply; or

(b)that it is to apply with such modifications, or subject to the payment of such compensation, as the court may specify in the direction.

(6)In determining whether to give a direction under sub-paragraph (5) or what modifications or compensation to specify in such a direction the court must have regard to the following—

(a)whether either or both of the parties to the agreement contemplated the abolition of the licensing requirements of the 1984 Act when they entered into the agreement; and

(b)the extent (if any) to which the provisions of this paragraph represent what it would have been reasonable for the parties to have agreed had they both known at that time what provision was to be made by this Act and when it was to come into force.

(7)For the purposes of this paragraph references to a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act include references to a licence under that section of a particular description.

(8)In this paragraph “the court” means the High Court or the Court of Session.

Commencement Information

I653Sch. 18 para. 4 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I654Sch. 18 para. 4 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

General saving for agreements conditional on certain Broadcasting Act licencesU.K.

5(1)This paragraph has effect where an agreement in force immediately before the coming into force of a provision of this Act removing a requirement for a relevant Broadcasting Act licence provides—U.K.

(a)for the agreement to cease to have effect, or

(b)for it to be capable of being terminated,

if a party to the agreement ceases to hold a relevant Broadcasting Act licence of a particular description, or so ceases in a manner described in the agreement.

(2)In this paragraph “relevant Broadcasting Act licence” means—

(a)a licence under Part 1 of the 1990 Act to provide a satellite television service or a licensable programme service;

(b)a licence under that Part to provide the service mentioned in section 49(2) of that Act;

(c)a licence under Part 2 of that Act to provide a local delivery service; or

(d)a licence under Part 3 of that Act to provide a formerly regulated radio service (within the meaning of section 251 of this Act).

(3)The agreement is not to cease to have effect, or to be capable of being terminated, by reason only of the coming into force of the provisions of this Act under which the requirement for the licence is removed.

(4)In relation to times after the commencement of the provision of this Act removing the requirement for a licence to provide a satellite television service or a licensable programme service, a reference to such a licence in the provision of the agreement in question is to have effect as a reference to a licence granted or having effect as if granted as a licence to provide a television licensable content service.

(5)In relation to times after the commencement of the provision of this Act removing the requirement for a licence to provide the service mentioned in section 49(2) of the 1990 Act, a reference to such a licence in the provision of the agreement in question is to have effect as a reference to a licence to provide the public teletext service.

(6)In relation to times after the commencement of the provision of this Act removing the requirement for a licence to provide a licensable sound programme service, a reference to such a licence in the provision of the agreement in question is to have effect as a reference to a licence to provide a radio licensable content service.

(7)References in this paragraph to a provision having effect if a person ceases to hold a licence include references—

(a)to a provision having effect if a licence of his expires without being renewed; and

(b)to a provision having effect if his licence is revoked.

(8)Expressions used in this paragraph and in Part 3 of this Act have the same meanings in this paragraph as in that Part.

Commencement Information

I655Sch. 18 para. 5 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Orders under Part 2 of the Deregulation and Contracting Out Act 1994U.K.

F1126U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F112Sch. 18 para. 6 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I656Sch. 18 para. 6 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Pre-commencement proposals relating to universal service mattersU.K.

7(1)Where a proposal for the designation of a person as a universal service provider has been confirmed under regulation 4(10) of the Electronic Communications (Universal Service) Regulations 2003 (S.I. 2003/33), the designation is to have effect after the commencement of section 66 of this Act as a designation in accordance with regulations under that section.U.K.

(2)Where in any person’s case a proposal to set a condition has been confirmed under regulation 4(10) or 5(4) of those regulations, that condition is to have effect after the commencement of that section as a condition set by OFCOM under section 45 of this Act and applied to that person.

(3)Where an appeal under regulation 6 of those regulations against a decision under them has been brought but not concluded before the commencement of section 192 of this Act—

(a)that appeal is to be stayed or sisted as from the commencement of the section; but

(b)the appellant is to have a new right of appeal under the section against the decision (as it has effect by virtue of this paragraph) as if—

(i)it were the corresponding decision made by OFCOM under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act; and

(ii)it had been made immediately after the commencement of the section.

(4)Tribunal rules (within the meaning of Chapter 3 of Part 2 of this Act) may, in relation to an appeal stayed or sisted under sub-paragraph (3), make transitional provision for requiring steps taken and things done for the purposes of that appeal to be taken into account, to the extent set out in the rules, in the case of an appeal brought by virtue of paragraph (b) of that sub-paragraph.

Commencement Information

I657Sch. 18 para. 7 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I658Sch. 18 para. 7 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Local loop notificationsU.K.

8(1)This paragraph applies where, as a result of a market power determination made by OFCOM for the purposes of a provision of Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act, they conclude that a person who is for the time being LLU notified is no longer a person falling to be so notified.U.K.

(2)OFCOM must give a notification of their conclusion to—

(a)the Secretary of State; and

(b)the notified person.

(3)On receiving a notification under sub-paragraph (2) the Secretary of State must withdraw the LLU notification of the person in question.

(4)For the purposes of this paragraph a person is LLU notified if he is a person who, for the purposes of Regulation (EC) No. 2887/2000 of the European Parliament and of the Council on unbundled access to the local loop, is notified to the European Commission as having significant market power in an identified market, and “LLU notification” shall be construed accordingly.

(5)Section 192 applies to a decision by OFCOM to give a notification under this paragraph as it applies to a decision by them under Part 2 of this Act.

Commencement Information

I659Sch. 18 para. 8 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I660Sch. 18 para. 8 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Conditions relating to premium rate services and conditions corresponding to SMP or access-related conditionsU.K.

9(1)This paragraph applies where OFCOM give a continuation notice to the holder of a licence granted under section 7 of the 1984 Act.U.K.

(2)A continuation notice is a notice that a provision contained in a condition of the licence is to have effect, after the abolition of licensing—

(a)to the extent specified in the notice; and

(b)subject to such modifications (if any) as may be so specified.

(3)OFCOM are not to give a continuation notice except to the extent that they consider that provision to which it will give effect, as modified by the notice, (“the continued provision”)—

(a)regulates the provision of premium rate services; or

(b)falls within sub-paragraph (4).

(4)The continued provision falls within this sub-paragraph in so far as it corresponds to provision of one or more of the following descriptions—

(a)provision that OFCOM have power to include in SMP conditions;

(b)provision authorised by section 73(2) or (4) for inclusion in access-related conditions;

(c)provision relating to matters mentioned in Article 16 of the Universal Service Directive or Article 7 of the Access Directive.

(5)A continuation notice relating to provision corresponding to anything that OFCOM have power to include in SMP conditions—

(a)may identify the market by reference to which an SMP condition replacing the provision would have to be set; and

(b)in so far as the provision corresponds to anything that OFCOM have power to include only in SMP apparatus conditions, must do so.

(6)OFCOM are not to give a continuation notice relating to provision corresponding to anything that OFCOM have power to include only in SMP apparatus conditions except to the extent that it has effect in relation to the supply of electronic communications apparatus of a description supplied in the market identified in the notice as the market by reference to which SMP conditions replacing the continued provision would have to be set.

(7)The modifications for which a continuation notice may provide—

(a)must be confined to modifications for the purpose of securing that the provision to which they relate continues to have effect for so long as the notice is in force; but

(b)in the case of provision which is expressed to impose a requirement to be met before the abolition of licensing, may include a modification under which that requirement must continue to be met for so long as the notice remains in force.

(8)Notwithstanding any repeal or revocation made by this Act—

(a)the continued provision,

(b)every provision made by a direction, determination or consent given or made for the purposes of the continued provision, and

(c)so far as necessary for giving effect to anything mentioned in paragraph (a) or (b), every provision made by or under the licence under the 1984 Act that is not so mentioned,

are to remain in force for so long as the continuation notice is in force.

(9)A continuation notice shall cease to have effect if OFCOM give a notice to that effect to the holder of the licence.

(10)Where the continued provision is one that OFCOM have power to include only in an SMP apparatus condition, it shall be their duty, as soon as reasonably practicable after giving the continuation notice—

(a)to carry out an analysis of the market which, under sub-paragraph (5), is identified in that notice;

(b)to take all other steps necessary for enabling them to decide whether or not to set an SMP apparatus condition by reference to that market for the purpose of replacing the continued provision; and

(c)to decide whether or not to exercise their power to set such a condition for that purpose.

(11)In the case of every other continued provision falling within sub-paragraph (4), it shall be OFCOM’s duty, as soon as reasonably practicable after giving the continuation notice—

(a)to take all steps necessary for enabling them to decide whether or not to set a condition of any other description under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act for the purpose of replacing the continued provision; and

(b)to decide whether or not to exercise their power to set a condition under that Chapter for that purpose.

(12)It shall be the duty of OFCOM—

(a)as soon as reasonably practicable after making a decision required by sub-paragraph (10) or (11), but

(b)in a case where that decision is a decision to set a condition, not before the coming into force of that condition,

to give a notice under sub-paragraph (9) with respect to the continuation notice.

(13)The duties imposed by sub-paragraphs (10) to (12) apply only where OFCOM have not previously given a notice under sub-paragraph (9) with respect to the continuation notice in question.

(14)This paragraph has effect in the case of a licence granted under section 7 of the 1984 Act to persons of a particular class as if—

(a)references to the holder of that licence were references to the members of that class; and

(b)the manner in which a continuation notice or notice under sub-paragraph (9) is to be given to members of that class were by its publication in such manner as, in OFCOM’s opinion, is appropriate for bringing it to the attention of the members of that class who are affected by the notice.

[F113(14A)Sections 185 to 191 apply to a dispute relating to a provision of a kind mentioned in paragraph (4), other than a dispute relating to provision that OFCOM have power to include in SMP apparatus conditions, as they apply to disputes of a kind mentioned in subsections (1A) and (2) of section 185.]

(15)Section 192 applies to a decision by OFCOM to give a notice under this paragraph as it applies to a decision by them under Part 2 of this Act.

(16)In this paragraph “Access Directive”, “electronic communications apparatus”, “the provision of premium rate services”, “SMP condition”, “SMP apparatus condition” and “Universal Service Directive” each has the same meaning as in Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act.

Textual Amendments

Commencement Information

I661Sch. 18 para. 9 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I662Sch. 18 para. 9 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Pre-commencement proposals relating to market power determinationsU.K.

10(1)Sub-paragraph (2) has effect where a proposal for—U.K.

(a)the identification of a market,

(b)the making of a market power determination, or

(c)the setting of conditions by reference to a proposal for a market power determination,

has been confirmed under regulation 8 of the Electronic Communications (Market Analysis) Regulations 2003 (S.I. 2003/330).

(2)If, at any time after the commencement of section 45, OFCOM—

(a)are satisfied that a procedure has been followed in relation to the proposal that satisfies the requirements of Article 7 of the Framework Directive, and

(b)publish a notification to that effect in such manner as they consider appropriate for bringing it to the attention of the persons who, in their opinion, are likely to be affected by the proposal,

the proposal (with such modifications, if any, as are specified in the notification) is to have effect, from the publication of the notification, in accordance with sub-paragraph (3).

(3)The proposal is to have effect as follows—

(a)in the case of a proposal for identifying a market, as an identification of a services market in accordance with and for the purposes of section 79 of this Act;

(b)in the case of a proposal for the making of a market power determination, as a market power determination made in accordance with and for the purposes of Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act; and

(c)in the case of a proposal for setting conditions, as if the conditions were SMP services conditions set under section 45 of this Act and applied to the same person as the condition in the proposal.

(4)Where an appeal under regulation 11 of those regulations against a decision under them has been brought but not concluded before the commencement of section 192 of this Act—

(a)that appeal is to be stayed or sisted as from the commencement of the section; but

(b)the appellant is to have a new right of appeal under the section against the decision (as it has effect by virtue of this paragraph) as if—

(i)it were the corresponding decision made by OFCOM under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act; and

(ii)it had been made immediately after the commencement of the section.

(5)Tribunal rules (within the meaning of Chapter 3 of Part 2 of this Act) may, in relation to an appeal stayed or sisted under sub-paragraph (4), make transitional provision for requiring steps taken and things done for the purposes of that appeal to be taken into account, to the extent set out in the rules, in the case of an appeal brought by virtue of paragraph (b) of that sub-paragraph.

(6)Section 192 applies to a decision by OFCOM to publish a notification under this paragraph as it applies to a decision by them under Part 2 of this Act.

(7)In this paragraph “the Framework Directive” has the same meaning as in Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act.

Commencement Information

I663Sch. 18 para. 10 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I664Sch. 18 para. 10 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Savings for licence conditions relating to accountingU.K.

11(1)This paragraph applies where a licence granted under section 7 of the 1984 Act contains conditions which impose requirements with respect to—U.K.

(a)the keeping of accounts or financial information; or

(b)the provision of accounts and financial information to the Director.

(2)OFCOM may give a notice to the holder of the licence as respects so much of those conditions as relates to—

(a)the keeping of accounts for a period current at the time of the abolition of licensing; and

(b)the provision of accounts and financial information in relation to any such period or in relation to periods ending before the abolition of licensing.

(3)In the case of a licence granted otherwise than to a particular person, a notice under this paragraph may be given to the licence holders by being published in such manner as OFCOM consider appropriate for bringing it to their attention.

(4)Notwithstanding any repeal or revocation made by this Act—

(a)the licence under the 1984 Act is to continue in force to the extent that it imposes requirements as respects which a notice has been given under this paragraph; but

(b)those requirements, so far as they require the provision of accounts or information to the Director, are to have effect in relation to times after the abolition of licensing, as requirements to provide the accounts or information to OFCOM.

(5)Section 192 applies to a decision by OFCOM to give a notice under this paragraph as it applies to a decision by them under Part 2 of this Act.

Commencement Information

I665Sch. 18 para. 11 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I666Sch. 18 para. 11 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Charges under Telecommunications Act licencesU.K.

12(1)Where any amount is required by a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act to be paid to the Director in respect of a period beginning before the abolition of licensing, that liability is to have effect after the abolition of licensing as a liability to pay to OFCOM so much of that amount as does not relate to times after the abolition of licensing.U.K.

(2)For the purpose of determining how much of an amount payable to the Director relates to times after the abolition of licensing, an apportionment is to be made according to how much of that period had expired before the abolition of licensing.

Commencement Information

I667Sch. 18 para. 12 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I668Sch. 18 para. 12 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Enforcement of breaches of licence conditionsU.K.

13(1)This paragraph applies to—U.K.

(a)any provision to which effect is given, after the abolition of licensing, by a continuation notice under paragraph 9;

(b)conditions in respect of which notices under paragraph 11 have been given;

(c)liabilities under paragraph 12; and

(d)conditions of a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act requiring compliance by the licence holder with directions given by the Director under regulation 6 of the Telecommunications (Interconnection) Regulations 1997 (S.I. 1997/2931).

(2)Notwithstanding any repeal or revocation made by this Act, after the abolition of licensing, OFCOM are, for the purpose of enforcing anything to which this paragraph applies, to have all the enforcement powers previously exercisable by the Director under the 1984 Act.

(3)Those powers are to be exercisable in accordance with this paragraph irrespective of whether the contraventions occurred before or after the abolition of licensing.

(4)For the purpose of exercising those powers, references to the likelihood that a person will again be in contravention of a condition include references to whether he will be in contravention of any equivalent obligation imposed—

(a)by section 38 of this Act;

(b)by conditions set under section 45 of this Act; or

(c)by directions under section 190 of this Act.

(5)OFCOM are not to exercise any powers conferred by virtue of this paragraph if they consider that the exercise of those powers [F114would, immediately before exit day, have been] incompatible with the requirements of the Directives.

(6)In this paragraph “enforcement powers” includes—

(a)the Director’s powers under sections 16 to 18 and 53 of the 1984 Act; and

(b)in the case of a licence issued to a particular person, every power of his under the licence to require information for the purpose of computing the amount of the liability to a charge.

(7)In this paragraph “the Directives” means the Authorisation Directive or any of the following Directives (as defined in Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act)—

(a)the Access Directive;

(b)the Framework Directive;

(c)the Universal Service Directive.

(8)In sub-paragraph (7) “the Authorisation Directive” means Directive 2002/20/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council on the authorisation of electronic communications networks and services [F115, as amended by Directive 2009/140/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council] .

Textual Amendments

Commencement Information

I669Sch. 18 para. 13 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I670Sch. 18 para. 13 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Saving for agreements having effect by reference to licensing regimeU.K.

14(1)This paragraph has effect where an agreement entered into for the purposes of a condition of a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act has effect immediately before the abolition of licensing subject to a provision which entitles a party to it to terminate the agreement if he or another party ceases to be a Schedule 2 public operator.U.K.

(2)The right of termination is not to be exercisable by reason of the effect of the coming into force of any provision of this Act if—

(a)a general condition,

(b)an access-related condition, or

(c)a provision made by or having effect as if made under an SMP condition,

imposes requirements on one or both of the parties to the agreement that correspond to those for the purposes of which the agreement was originally entered into.

(3)In any such case, the agreement shall have effect in relation to times after the abolition of licensing as if references in the agreement to a Schedule 2 public operator were references to the provider of a public electronic communications network.

(4)In this paragraph “Schedule 2 public operator” has the same meaning as in Schedule 1 to the Telecommunications (Licence Modifications) (Standard Schedules) Regulations 1999 (S.I. 1999/2450).

(5)Expressions used in this paragraph and in Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act have the same meanings in this paragraph as in that Chapter.

Commencement Information

I671Sch. 18 para. 14 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I672Sch. 18 para. 14 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Fees for approvals for the purposes of licence conditionsU.K.

15(1)This paragraph has effect where a general condition set under section 45 of this Act requires apparatus to be approved by reference to a standard previously designated for the purposes of section 24(6) of the 1984 Act.U.K.

(2)The Secretary of State may by order provide for the charging of fees in respect of the giving of approvals for the purposes of the condition.

(3)Fees charged under this paragraph are be paid to the person giving the approvals and, to the extent authorised by the Secretary of State, may be retained by that person.

(4)To the extent that they are not retained by that person, the fees must be paid into the Consolidated Fund.

(5)Any order made under section 24(13) of the 1984 Act that is in force immediately before the coming into force of the repeal of section 24 of that Act shall have effect after the coming into force of the repeal as an order made under this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I673Sch. 18 para. 15 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I674Sch. 18 para. 15 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Allocated telephone numbersU.K.

16(1)Where immediately before the abolition of licensing telephone numbers are allocated to a person holding a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act for the purposes of the conditions of that licence, those numbers shall be treated, after the abolition of licensing as allocated to that person for the purposes of general conditions such as are mentioned in section 58 of this Act.U.K.

(2)An allocation having effect by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) may be withdrawn by OFCOM at any time, but only in accordance with section 61 of this Act.

(3)An allocation shall only continue to have effect in accordance with this paragraph for so long as the person to whom the allocation was made for the purposes of the licence conditions is a communications provider.

(4)The power by virtue of section 58 for general conditions to make provision for the making of periodic payments in respect of the allocation of telephone numbers shall be exercisable, at any time after the coming into force of that section, in relation to an allocation having effect by virtue of this paragraph as it has effect in relation to an allocation made under that section.

(5)Expressions used in this paragraph and in Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act have the same meanings in this paragraph as in that Chapter.

Commencement Information

I675Sch. 18 para. 16 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I676Sch. 18 para. 16 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Electronic communications codeU.K.

17(1)Sub-paragraph (2) applies where, immediately before the coming into force of section 106 of this Act, the telecommunications code set out in Schedule 2 to the 1984 Act applies to a person by virtue of the provisions of his licence under section 7 of that Act.U.K.

(2)That person shall be treated after the commencement of section 106 of this Act as a person in whose case the electronic communications code applies by virtue of a direction given by OFCOM.

(3)The deemed direction shall be assumed to be one given in relation to so much of any electronic communications network as—

(a)was included immediately before the commencement of section 106 of this Act in the telecommunication system which was the operator’s system for the purposes of the application of the code; or

(b)which would have been so included if it had been being provided at that time.

(4)So much of the code in Schedule 2 to the 1984 Act as has effect immediately before the commencement of Schedule 3 to this Act—

(a)in relation to telecommunication apparatus, or

(b)in relation a telecommunication system,

is to have effect after the commencement of that Schedule in relation to so much of the apparatus or system as is electronic communications apparatus or the operator’s network for the purposes of the application of that Schedule to this Act by virtue of this paragraph or section 106(3)(b) of this Act.

(5)A right which for the purposes of the code in Schedule 2 to the 1984 Act has effect immediately before the commencement of Schedule 3 to this Act as conferred for purposes connected with the provision of a telecommunication service is to have effect after the commencement of that Schedule as conferred for the purposes of the corresponding electronic communications service.

(6)Any agreement which, immediately before the repeal of the provisions contained in section 10(3A) and (3B) of the 1984 Act or section 189 of the 1990 Act, is a relevant agreement for the purposes of those provisions shall be deemed in relation to times after the coming into force of that repeal to be a relevant agreement for the purposes of paragraph 29 of the electronic communications code.

(7)In this paragraph “the electronic communications code” has the same meaning as in Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act.

Commencement Information

I677Sch. 18 para. 17 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I678Sch. 18 para. 17 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Saving for guarantees of liabilities of telecommunications code operatorsU.K.

18(1)This paragraph applies where, immediately before the abolition of licensing, a person holding a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act (“the operator”) —U.K.

(a)is a person to whom the telecommunications code applies in respect of the running of a telecommunications system by him (“the operator’s system”); and

(b)in pursuance of a condition of his licence imposed for the purpose of securing that sufficient funds are available to meet code-related liabilities specified in the licence, is a party to any guarantee arrangements.

(2)Arrangements are guarantee arrangements for the purposes of this paragraph if they are arrangements under which a person (the “guarantor”) is obliged, in circumstances specified in the arrangements, to make payments in respect of a failure by the operator to meet a code-related liability specified in the licence.

(3)The guarantor’s obligation to make payments under the guarantee arrangements is not to arise by reason only of the abolition of licensing.

(4)In relation to times after the abolition of licensing, the guarantee arrangements are to have effect, notwithstanding the operator’s licence having ceased to have effect on the abolition of licensing and subject to sub-paragraph (7), as if the following references continued to have effect—

(a)references in those arrangements to the code-related liabilities specified in the licence; and

(b)(subject to sub-paragraph (5)(a)) references, for the purposes of any provision identifying the circumstances in which payments are to be made under the arrangements, to events specified in the licence.

(5)In relation to such times, those arrangements are also to have effect—

(a)as if references (directly or indirectly) to the revocation, or to the expiration without renewal, of the operator’s licence were references to his becoming subject to a direction by virtue of which he is prohibited from providing the whole or a part of his network; and

(b)as if references to the telecommunications code were references to the electronic communications code.

(6)In sub-paragraph (5) the reference to a person’s becoming subject to a direction by virtue of which he is prohibited from providing the whole or a part of an electronic communications network—

(a)does not include a reference to his becoming subject to a direction imposing a prohibition for a fixed period of less than eighteen months or to a direction that will have to be revoked if not confirmed; but

(b)except in the case of a direction imposing a prohibition for such a fixed period, does include a reference to the confirmation of a direction that would otherwise have had to be revoked.

(7)The guarantor is not to be liable in respect of any liability arising in connection with or as a result of activities carried on after the abolition of licensing except in so far as those activities are activities carried on for the purposes of providing the operator’s network.

(8)In this paragraph “code-related liabilities”, in relation to the operator, means liabilities arising or incurred by him—

(a)by reason of the application to him of the telecommunications code;

(b)by reason of its ceasing to apply to him; or

(c)otherwise in respect of activities carried on by him in connection with running the operator’s system.

(9)In this paragraph—

  • the electronic communications code” has the same meaning as in Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act;

  • the operator’s network” means so much of any electronic communications network provided by the operator as is a network in relation to which the electronic communications code applies in the operator’s case by virtue of paragraph 17(3)(a) of this Schedule;

  • the telecommunications code” means the code set out in Schedule 2 to the 1984 Act (as it had effect immediately before the abolition of licensing).

Commencement Information

I679Sch. 18 para. 18 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I680Sch. 18 para. 18 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Compulsory purchaseU.K.

19U.K.Where—

(a)a compulsory purchase order made under section 34 or 35 of the 1984 Act,

(b)a vesting order, or an application for a vesting order, made under section 36 of that Act, or

(c)an authorisation given by the Secretary of State under section 37, 38 or 39 of that Act,

is effective immediately before the commencement of Schedule 4 to this Act, it is to have effect after the commencement of that Schedule as if made or given under that Schedule.

Commencement Information

I681Sch. 18 para. 19 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I682Sch. 18 para. 19 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Notices under section 1D of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949U.K.

F11620U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F116Sch. 18 para. 20 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I683Sch. 18 para. 20 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Notices under regulations under section 3 of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1998U.K.

F11721U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F117Sch. 18 para. 21 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I684Sch. 18 para. 21 in force at 18.9.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I685Sch. 18 para. 21 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Disputes about interconnectionU.K.

22(1)Where—U.K.

(a)before the revocation by this Act of the Telecommunications (Interconnection) Regulations 1997 (S.I. 1997/2931) a dispute was referred to the Director under regulation 6 of those regulations, and

(b)that dispute has not been resolved when the revocation comes into force,

Chapter 3 of Part 2 of this Act (except sections 189 and 190) is to have effect as if that dispute were a dispute which, immediately after the commencement of section 185 of this Act, was referred to OFCOM under that section.

(2)Where a dispute—

(a)has arisen or arises about anything occurring or existing before the time when the revocation of those regulations comes into force (“the relevant time”),

(b)relates to matters disputes about which would (before that time) have been referable to the Director under regulation 6,

(c)is neither a dispute which was referred to him before that time nor a dispute arising after that time which is referable to OFCOM under section 185, and

(d)is referred to OFCOM after that time either during the transitional period or in a case in which OFCOM are satisfied that the circumstances that prevented the making of a reference before the end of that period are exceptional,

sub-paragraph (1) is to have effect as if the dispute were a dispute arising before the relevant time in the case of which a reference to the Director had been made under regulation 6 before that time.

(3)Where OFCOM make a determination for resolving a dispute falling to be resolved in accordance with sub-paragraph (1) or (2)—

(a)their powers on making that determination are to be those which would have been exercisable by the Director under those regulations (instead of those under Chapter 3 of Part 2);

(b)conditions of a licence under section 7 of the 1984 Act requiring compliance with directions given by the Director under regulation 6 of those regulations are to continue to have effect as if they also applied to directions given by OFCOM by virtue of paragraph (a); and

(c)paragraph 13 of this Schedule has effect as if the reference in sub-paragraph (1)(d) to directions given by the Director under that regulation included a reference to directions given by OFCOM by virtue of paragraph (a) of this sub-paragraph.

(4)But OFCOM are not to give a direction by virtue of sub-paragraph (3)(a) containing provision which they would have no power to include in—

(a)a condition set under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act; or

(b)a direction under section 190.

(5)Where the Director gave a direction under regulation 6 of those regulations at any time before the coming into force of their revocation, the direction is to continue, after the revocation comes into force, to have effect (and be enforceable in accordance with paragraph 13 of this Schedule) to the extent that it is continued in force under this paragraph.

(6)The direction is continued in force under this paragraph only where OFCOM have at any time after the passing of this Act given notice to the persons to whom it applies that it is continued in force.

(7)OFCOM are to give such a notice only if they consider that the direction makes provision corresponding to that which they have power to include in—

(a)conditions set under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act; or

(b)directions under section 190.

(8)OFCOM may at any time by notice to the person to whom it applies revoke (in whole or in part) a direction which—

(a)was given by virtue of sub-paragraph (3)(a); or

(b)is a direction to which a notice under sub-paragraph (6) relates.

(9)Where a direction which OFCOM have power to revoke under sub-paragraph (8) makes provision corresponding to anything that OFCOM have power to include in a condition set under Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act, it shall be their duty, as soon as reasonably practicable after giving the direction or as the case may be the notice under sub-paragraph (6)—

(a)to take all steps necessary for enabling them to decide whether or not to set such a condition for the purpose of replacing the direction; and

(b)to decide whether or not to exercise their power to set a condition under that Chapter for that purpose.

(10)It shall be the duty of OFCOM—

(a)as soon as reasonably practicable after making a decision required by sub-paragraph (9), but

(b)in a case where that decision is a decision to set a condition, not before the coming into force of that condition,

to give a notice under sub-paragraph (8) revoking the direction in question.

(11)The duties imposed by sub-paragraphs (9) and (10) apply only where OFCOM have not previously revoked the direction in question.

(12)Section 192 applies to a decision by OFCOM to give a notice under this paragraph as it applies to a decision by them under Part 2 of this Act.

(13)In this paragraph “transitional period” means the period which is the transitional period (within the meaning of section 408) in relation to this paragraph.

Commencement Information

I686Sch. 18 para. 22 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I687Sch. 18 para. 22 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Appeals against wireless telegraphy and telecommunications decisionsU.K.

23(1)This paragraph applies where—U.K.

(a)a decision was made before the commencement of section 192;

(b)the decision has effect after the commencement of a provision of this Act as a decision made by OFCOM, or is a decision not to do something which (if done) would so have had effect; and

(c)the decision is one against which an appeal was or could have been brought under—

F118(i). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

(ii)section 46B of the 1984 Act.

(2)If no such appeal has been brought before the commencement of section 192 of this Act, that section applies to the decision as it applies to decisions by OFCOM under Part 2 of this Act F119..., but as if that section had been in force when the decision was made.

(3)If an appeal under F120... section 46B of the 1984 Act—

(a)has been brought against the decision, but

(b)has not been concluded before the commencement of section 192 of this Act,

the court in which it was brought may stay or sist the appeal as from the commencement of that section of this Act.

(4)If the court stays or sists the appeal under sub-paragraph (3), the appellant is to have a new right of appeal under section 192 against the decision as if (subject to sub-paragraph (7)) it were a decision to which that section applies that had been made immediately after the commencement of that section.

(5)Tribunal rules (within the meaning of Chapter 3 of Part 2 of this Act) may, in relation to an appeal stayed or sisted under sub-paragraph (3), make transitional provision—

(a)for requiring steps taken and things done for the purposes of that appeal to be taken into account, to the extent set out in the rules, in the case of an appeal brought by virtue of sub-paragraph (4); and

(b)for enabling the Tribunal in an appeal under sub-paragraph (4) to give directions to OFCOM as to the carrying out of functions of theirs that are the same as or correspond to those in the course of carrying out which the maker of the appealed decision made that decision.

(6)If, in a case falling within sub-paragraph (3), the court does not stay or sist the appeal—

(a)it must determine the appeal in the manner in which the Tribunal is required under section 195 of this Act to determine an appeal under section 192; but

(b)its powers on determining the appeal include a power to give directions to OFCOM as to the carrying out of any functions of theirs that correspond to those in the course of which the appealed decision was made.

(7)On an appeal brought or continued under this paragraph against a decision, the court or the Tribunal, in determining what was the appropriate action for the maker of the decision to take, must determine that question according to the law in force at the time when the decision was made.

Textual Amendments

F118Sch. 18 para. 23(1)(c)(i) repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

F119Words in Sch. 18 para. 23(2) repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

F120Words in Sch. 18 para. 23(3) repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I688Sch. 18 para. 23 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I689Sch. 18 para. 23 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Section 94 of the Telecommunications Act 1984U.K.

F12124U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

Competition Commission: specialist panel membersU.K.

25U.K.The persons who—

(a)have been appointed as members of the Competition Commission by the Secretary of State under section 13(10) of the 1984 Act, and

(b)hold office immediately before the date on which section 194 comes into force,

shall continue to hold office as members of the Competition Commission as if they had been appointed to that office by the Secretary of State under section 194(1).

Commencement Information

I690Sch. 18 para. 25 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I691Sch. 18 para. 25 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Transitory amendments to telecommunications terms in Broadcasting Act 1990U.K.

26(1)This paragraph has effect, in the case of each of the provisions of the 1990 Act to which it applies, in relation to times between—U.K.

(a)the commencement of Chapter 1 of Part 2 of this Act; and

(b)the commencement of so much of this Act (apart from this paragraph) as amends or repeals that provision.

(2)The provisions of the 1990 Act set out in sub-paragraph (3) shall have effect (subject to sub-paragraph (4)) as if—

(a)for every reference to a telecommunication system there were substituted a reference to an electronic communications network; and

(b)for references to running such a system there were substituted references to providing it.

(3)Those provisions of the 1990 Act are—

(a)section 46 (licensable programme services);

(b)section 51(1)(a) (procedures for consideration of applications for additional services licences);

(c)section 72 (local delivery services);

(d)section 75 (procedures for consideration of applications for local delivery licences);

(e)section 112 (licensable sound programme services);

(f)section 117(1)(a) (procedures for consideration of applications for additional services licences);

(g)section 181 (apparatus deemed to be apparatus for wireless telegraphy).

(4)Sections 46(2) (licensable programme services), 112(2) (licensable sound programme services) and 201(2) (programme services) of the 1990 Act shall each have effect as if for paragraph (b) there were substituted—

(b)a service which satisfies the conditions in section 233(5) of the Communications Act 2003;.

(5)In sections 48 and 114 of the 1990 Act (additional services), references to electronic signals shall have effect as references to signals within the meaning of section 32 of this Act.

(6)Section 75(2) of the 1990 Act (consultation with relevant licensing authorities) shall have effect as if in paragraph (b) for the words “would be required to be licensed” there were substituted “ is a system which (but for repeals made by the Communications Act 2003) would have been required to be licensed ”.

(7)In section 181 of the 1990 Act (apparatus deemed to be apparatus for wireless telegraphy), “connected”—

(a)shall continue to be construed in accordance (notwithstanding its repeal) with section 4 of the 1984 Act; but

(b)shall be so construed as if, in that section of the 1984 Act, a reference to an electronic communications network were substituted for every reference to a telecommunication system.

(8)Part 5 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act (restriction on holding of licences by operators of public telecommunication systems) and the Broadcasting (Restrictions on the Holding of Licences) Order 1991 (S.I. 1991/1176) shall have effect as if references to a national public telecommunications operator were references to a person who provides an electronic communications network so as to make it available for use by members of the public in the whole, or substantially the whole, of the United Kingdom.

Commencement Information

I692Sch. 18 para. 26 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I693Sch. 18 para. 26 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Activities of the Welsh AuthorityU.K.

27(1)No approval shall be required under section 205 for the continued provision after the commencement of that section of any service that was being provided by the Welsh Authority immediately before the commencement of that section.U.K.

(2)Where any activities are being carried on immediately before the commencement of section 206 by the Welsh Authority, no approval is required under that section in respect of the continued carrying on of the activities by the Authority.

(3)Where any activities are being carried on immediately before the commencement of section 206 by an S4C company, no approval is required under that section in respect of the carrying on after that commencement by that company or another S4C company of those activities.

Commencement Information

I694Sch. 18 para. 27 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Gaelic BroadcastingU.K.

28U.K.The persons who are members of Comataidh Craolaidh Gaidhlig immediately before the date on which section 208 comes into force—

(a)shall continue to hold office as members of Seirbheis nam Meadhanan Gàidhlig as if they had been appointed to that office by OFCOM;

(b)shall hold and vacate office in accordance with the terms of their appointment by the ITC;

(c)shall hold office for the period for which they were appointed by the ITC; and

(d)after the end of that period, shall be eligible for re-appointment as members of Seirbheis nam Meadhanan Gàidhlig.

Commencement Information

I695Sch. 18 para. 28 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

29(1)The continuance in force of the Multiplex Licence (Broadcasting of Programmes in Gaelic) Order 1996 (S.I. 1996/2758) made under section 32 of the 1996 Act is not affected by the amendment of that section by Schedule 15 to this Act.U.K.

(2)But in relation to times after the television transfer date, that order shall have effect as if—

(a)the reference in that order to the ITC were a reference to OFCOM; and

(b)the reference to the application of section 28 of the 1996 Act to a frequency were omitted.

Commencement Information

I696Sch. 18 para. 29 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Pre-transfer Broadcasting Act licencesU.K.

30(1)Subject to any express provision made by this Act in relation to a particular description of Broadcasting Act licence, neither—U.K.

(a)the transfer from a pre-commencement regulator to OFCOM of the function of granting or awarding such licences or of any other power exercisable in relation to such licences, nor

(b)any other modification by or by virtue of this Act of the power to grant or award such licences or of a provision having effect in relation to such licences,

shall affect the continuing validity of a licence by or under which the provision of a service is authorised immediately before the coming into force of the transfer or modification.

(2)Accordingly, such a licence shall continue to have effect, after the coming into force of the transfer or modification—

(a)on the same terms and conditions and for the same period as it would have done if this Act had not been passed; but

(b)as if, in relation to times after the coming into force of any relevant transfer of functions to OFCOM, every reference in the licence to a pre-commencement regulator were a reference to OFCOM.

(3)Sub-paragraph (2) is subject to the following provisions of this Act—

(a)those under which a licence is to have effect as if the period for which it is granted were the period determined under this Act; and

(b)those under which the conditions of a licence fall to be varied for the purpose of imposing a condition required by this Act.

(4)Anything done at any time before the relevant transfer date under or for the purposes of enforcing any provision of a Broadcasting Act licence is to have effect in relation to times on or after that date—

(a)to the extent that it was done by or in relation to the ITC or Radio Authority, and

(b)so far as necessary for preserving its effect or for facilitating the taking of further action by OFCOM,

as a thing done by or in relation to OFCOM.

(5)In sub-paragraph (4) “relevant transfer date”—

(a)in relation to licences under Part 1 of the 1990 Act or Part 1 of the 1996 Act, means the television transfer date; and

(b)in relation to licences under Part 3 of the 1990 Act or Part 2 of the 1996 Act, means the radio transfer date.

Commencement Information

I697Sch. 18 para. 30 in force at 25.7.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(1), Sch. 1

Channels 3 and 5U.K.

31U.K.A determination made by the ITC under or for the purposes of section 14 or 28 of the 1990 Act (Channels 3 and 5) is to have effect on and after the television transfer date as a determination under that section by OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I698Sch. 18 para. 31 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Saving pending replacement of licences for Channels 3 and 5 and the public teletext serviceU.K.

32(1)The regulatory regime for a Channel 3 service, and that for Channel 5 and the existing teletext service, shall not include the self-regulation conditions in any case in which the service or (as the case may be) Channel 5 is provided under a licence granted before the television transfer date.U.K.

(2)In sub-paragraph (1) “the self-regulation conditions” means the conditions which (apart from that sub-paragraph) are included by virtue of sections 265 to 269 of this Act in the regulatory regime for Channel 3 services, for Channel 5 and for the public teletext service.

(3)In relation to a licence granted before the television transfer date for a Channel 3 service, Channel 5 or the existing teletext service, section 263 shall have effect as if the reference in subsection (3)(a) of that section to a corresponding or additional service to be provided in analogue form were a reference to a corresponding or additional service to be provided in digital form.

(4)In this paragraph “the existing teletext service” means the existing service within the meaning of section 221 of this Act.

Commencement Information

I699Sch. 18 para. 32 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Digital additional licencesU.K.

33(1)This paragraph applies where immediately before the coming into force of section 242 of this Act a person holds a digital additional services licence under Part 1 of the 1996 Act in respect of a digital sound programme service and with a view to the inclusion of the broadcasting of that service by means of a television multiplex service licensed under Part 1 of the 1996 Act.U.K.

(2)The licence is to have effect on and after the coming into force of section 242 of this Act as if it were a national digital sound programme licence or (as the case may be) were comprised in any national digital sound programme licence already held by the licence holder for the service in question.

(3)Where a licence has effect in accordance with this paragraph, it shall not (to the extent that it so has effect) authorise the broadcasting of the digital sound programme service in question by means of a radio multiplex service.

(4)In this paragraph—

  • digital additional services licence” has the same meaning as in Part 1 of the 1996 Act; and

  • national digital sound programme licence” has the same meaning as in Part 2 of that Act.

Commencement Information

I700Sch. 18 para. 33 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Programme quotasU.K.

34U.K.Any order which—

(a)was made under section 16(5)(a) of the 1990 Act (definitions of “qualifying programmes” and “independent productions”), and

(b)is in force immediately before the commencement of sections 277 and 309 of this Act and paragraphs 1 and 7 of Schedule 12 to this Act,

is to have effect in relation to times after the commencement of those sections and those paragraphs as an order made in exercise of the corresponding powers conferred by those sections and those paragraphs.

Commencement Information

I701Sch. 18 para. 34 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Continuity in relation to appointed news providerU.K.

35U.K.Where a body holds an appointment for the purposes of section 31(2) of the 1990 Act immediately before the date of the commencement of section 280 of this Act—

(a)that appointment shall have effect in relation to times on and after that date as an appointment for the purposes of arrangements entered into in accordance with conditions imposed under section 280 of this Act;

(b)the arrangements under which that appointment was made shall have effect in relation to such times as arrangements so entered into; and

(c)so much of the appointment or arrangements, or of any agreement to which the body is a party, as makes provision by reference to the body’s ceasing to be nominated under section 32 of the 1990 Act shall have effect in relation to such times as if references to ceasing to be so nominated were references to becoming a body falling within section 281(2) of this Act.

Commencement Information

I702Sch. 18 para. 35 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Networking arrangementsU.K.

36(1)Where arrangements approved for the purposes of section 39 of the 1990 Act (networking arrangements) are in force immediately before the commencement of section 291 of this Act, those arrangements are to have effect for the purposes of this Act, and of any conditions imposed under that section of this Act, as approved networking arrangements.U.K.

(2)For the purposes of proceedings in relation to a report under Schedule 4 to the 1990 Act at any time after the commencement of Schedule 11 to this Act, that report is to have effect as if it were a report under that Schedule to this Act.

Commencement Information

I703Sch. 18 para. 36 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Determination of qualifying revenueU.K.

37(1)A statement of the ITC that is for the time being in force immediately before the television transfer date for the purposes of—U.K.

(a)Schedule 7 to the 1990 Act (statement of principles for determining qualifying revenue), or

(b)Schedule 1 to the 1996 Act (corresponding statement for the purposes of that Act,

is to have effect on and after that date as a statement by OFCOM.

(2)On and after the television transfer date a determination by the ITC under paragraph 2 of Part 1 of either of those Schedules is to have effect as a determination under that paragraph by OFCOM, and sub-paragraph (2) of that paragraph is to have effect accordingly.

Commencement Information

I704Sch. 18 para. 37 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Rules for political broadcastsU.K.

38U.K.Where—

(a)rules made by the ITC for the purposes of section 36 of the 1990 Act (party political broadcasts on Channel 3, Channel 4 or Channel 5), or

(b)rules made by the Radio Authority for the purposes of section 107 of the 1990 Act (party political broadcasts on national radio services),

are in force immediately before the commencement of section 333 of this Act, those rules are to have effect after its commencement as rules made by OFCOM for the purposes of that section of this Act.

Commencement Information

I705Sch. 18 para. 38 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Functions under section 88 of the 1990 ActU.K.

39U.K.A requirement imposed or notice given before the radio transfer date by the Radio Authority under section 88 of the 1990 Act (restriction on holding of licences) is to have effect on and after that date as if it were imposed or given by OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I706Sch. 18 para. 39 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Notices under section 94 of the 1990 ActU.K.

40U.K.A notice given by the Secretary of State or any other Minister of the Crown under section 94 of the 1990 Act (government control over licensed services) is to have effect on and after the radio transfer date as a notice given to OFCOM under section 336 of this Act.

Commencement Information

I707Sch. 18 para. 40 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Programme standards: televisionU.K.

41(1)This paragraph applies as respects times on or after the television transfer date and before the first coming into force, in the case of the holder of a licence under Part 1 of the 1990 Act or Part 1 of the 1996 Act, of conditions imposed under section 325 of this Act.U.K.

(2)Sections 6 to 12 of the 1990 Act (general provisions about the content of licensed services) are to have effect in the case of that licence holder as if references in those sections to the ITC were references to OFCOM.

(3)A code drawn up by the ITC under section 6, 7 or 9 of the 1990 Act is to have effect as if it had been drawn up by OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I708Sch. 18 para. 41 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Programme standards: radioU.K.

42(1)This paragraph applies as respects times on or after the radio transfer date and before the first coming into force, in the case of the holder of a licence under Part 3 of the 1990 Act or Part 2 of the 1996 Act, of conditions imposed under section 325 of this Act.U.K.

(2)Sections 90 to 96 of the 1990 Act (general provisions about the content of licensed services) are to have effect as if references in those sections to the Radio Authority were references to OFCOM.

(3)A code drawn up by the Radio Authority under section 90, 91 or 93 of the 1990 Act is to have effect as if it had been drawn up by OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I709Sch. 18 para. 42 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Standards codeU.K.

43(1)In relation to any time after the commencement of section 319 of this Act, a code in force immediately before its commencement as a code drawn up under section 6, 7, 9, 90, 91 or 93 of the 1990 Act or section 108 of the 1996 Act is to have effect (subject to sub-paragraphs (2) and (3)) as if it were a code issued by OFCOM for the purpose of setting standards under section 319 of this Act.U.K.

(2)A code under the 1990 Act shall have effect by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) in relation only to the following—

(a)in the case of the codes under sections 6, 7 and 9, services the provision of which is authorised by licences under Part 1 of the 1990 Act and S4C; and

(b)in the case of the codes under sections 90, 91 and 93, services the provision of which is authorised by licences under Part 3 of that Act.

(3)In the case of the code under section 108 of the 1996 Act, the code shall have effect by virtue of sub-paragraph (1)—

(a)in relation only to services provided by the BBC or the Welsh Authority; and

(b)to the extent only that it contains provision that applies to those services and, in the case of services provided by the Welsh Authority, relates to matters other than advertising and impartiality.

Commencement Information

I710Sch. 18 para. 43 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Local and national radio licencesU.K.

44(1)Section 103 of the 1990 Act (restriction on changes of control affecting holders of national licences) is to apply in relation to a pre-transfer national licence as it applies in relation to a national licence within the meaning of Part 3 of the 1990 Act.U.K.

(2)Anything done by or in relation to the Radio Authority under any of sections 98 to 102 or 103A of the 1990 Act, so far as it has been done—

(a)before the radio transfer date, and

(b)for the purposes of, or in connection with, the grant or renewal of a pre-transfer national licence,

is to have effect for the purposes of, and in connection with, the grant or renewal of a licence at times on or after that date as if done by or in relation to OFCOM in connection with or for the purposes of the grant or renewal of national licence (within the meaning of Part 3 of that Act).

(3)Anything done by or in relation to the Radio Authority under any of sections 104 to 105 of the 1990 Act, so far as it has been done—

(a)before the radio transfer date, and

(b)for the purposes of, or in connection with, the grant or renewal of a pre-transfer local licence,

is to have effect for the purposes of, and in connection with, the grant or renewal of a licence at times on or after that date as if done by or in relation to OFCOM in connection with, or for the purposes of, the grant or renewal of local licence (within the meaning of Part 3 of that Act).

(4)In this paragraph “pre-transfer local licence” and “pre-transfer national licence” each has the same meaning as in section 253 of this Act.

Commencement Information

I711Sch. 18 para. 44 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 111B of the 1990 ActU.K.

45(1)Section 111B of the 1990 Act (power to suspend satellite services) is to have effect in relation to a licence to provide a formerly regulated radio service (within the meaning of section 251) as it applies in relation to a licence to provide a radio licensable content service, but as if the reference in subsection (1)(b) of that section to a condition included in the licence in pursuance of the provisions there mentioned included a reference to a condition included in the licence in pursuance of section 90(1)(a) of that Act.U.K.

(2)In relation to any time falling—

(a)on or after the radio transfer date, and

(b)before the first coming into force, in the case of the holder of a licence under Part 3 of the 1990 Act or Part 2 of the 1996 Act, of conditions imposed under section 325 of this Act,

section 111B of the 1990 Act is to have effect in relation to a licence to provide a radio licensable content service as if the reference in subsection (1)(b) of section 111B of that Act to a condition included in the licence in pursuance of the provisions there mentioned were a reference to a condition included in the licence in pursuance of section 90(1)(a) of that Act.

Commencement Information

I712Sch. 18 para. 45 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 185 of the 1990 ActU.K.

46(1)A determination or nomination made for the purposes of section 185 of the 1990 Act (the national television archive) by the ITC is to have effect on and after the television transfer date as a determination or nomination made by OFCOM.U.K.

(2)Sub-paragraph (1) applies in the case of a determination so far only as it relates to a financial year beginning on or after the television transfer date.

Commencement Information

I713Sch. 18 para. 46 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 28 of the 1996 ActU.K.

47(1)The repeal by this Act of section 28 of the 1996 Act does not affect any power to vary a licence under Part 1 of the 1990 Act which is—U.K.

(a)conferred on the ITC by an order under that section; and

(b)transferred to OFCOM by this Act.

(2)Nor does it affect so much of any order under that section in force immediately before the repeal as—

(a)modifies section 16 of the 1996 Act in its application in relation to the renewal of a licence first granted before the television transfer date; or

(b)imposes a prohibition on the use of digital capacity reserved before that date;

but so much of any such prohibition as requires the consent of the ITC for the use of any digital capacity shall have effect after the television transfer date as if the consent required were OFCOM’s consent.

(3)Sub-paragraph (1) only saves the power so far as it is exercisable in relation to a licence granted before the television transfer date.

Commencement Information

I714Sch. 18 para. 47 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Section 48 of the 1996 ActU.K.

48U.K.Subsections (4) to (6) of section 48 of the 1996 Act (reservations of capacity for national radio multiplex licences to independent national broadcasters) are to apply in relation to conditions included in pursuance of that section in licences granted before the radio transfer date as they apply in relation to conditions included in licences by virtue of the amendments of that section made by this Act.

Commencement Information

I715Sch. 18 para. 48 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Applications for extension of pre-transfer licencesU.K.

49(1)Section 253(4)(a) does not prevent the determination by OFCOM of a day falling less than one year after the making of the determination where—U.K.

(a)OFCOM consider that the day by which they would need to publish a notice is a day which is not more than 15 months after the commencement date; and

(b)the determination of that day is made as soon as practicable after the commencement date.

(2)Where the day determined by OFCOM for the purposes of paragraph (b) of section 253(3) is a day in the period of three months beginning with the day after the determination, that paragraph shall have effect as if for the words “three months before” there were substituted “ on ”.

(3)In this paragraph, the “commencement date” is the date on which section 253 comes into force.

Commencement Information

I716Sch. 18 para. 49 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Applications for renewal of licences under 1990 Act and 1996 ActU.K.

50(1)A provision set out in sub-paragraph (2) does not prevent the determination by OFCOM of a date falling less than one year after the making of the determination where—U.K.

(a)OFCOM consider that the relevant date for the purposes of the section in question is a date which is not more than 15 months after the commencement date; and

(b)the determination of the relevant date is made as soon as practicable after the commencement date.

(2)Those provisions are—

(a)section 53(12) of the 1990 Act;

(b)section 103A(12) of the 1990 Act;

(c)section 104A(14) of the 1990 Act;

(d)section 16(12A) of the 1996 Act;

(e)section 58(12A) of the 1996 Act.

(3)An application which is made before the commencement date in accordance with a provision set out in sub-paragraph (5) shall be treated after that date as if it had been made in accordance with that provision as amended by this Act.

(4)Where, in a case where a provision set out in sub-paragraph (5) applies, the relevant date for the purposes of the section in question is a date in the period of three months beginning with—

(a)the commencement date, or

(b)the day after the day on which the relevant date is determined,

that provision shall have effect as if the words “the day falling three months before” were omitted.

(5)Those provisions are—

(a)section 53(2) of the 1990 Act;

(b)section 103A(2) of the 1990 Act;

(c)section 104A(3) of the 1990 Act;

(d)section 16(3) of the 1996 Act;

(e)section 58(3) of the 1996 Act.

(6)In this paragraph, the “commencement date”, in relation to any provision set out in sub-paragraph (2) or (5) is the date on which the provision of Schedule 15 inserting or amending that provision comes into force.

Commencement Information

I717Sch. 18 para. 50 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Listed events rulesU.K.

51(1)Subject to sub-paragraph (2), Part 4 of the 1996 Act (sporting and other events of national interest) is to have effect in relation to times on or after the television transfer date as if anything done before that date by or in relation to the ITC had been done by or in relation to OFCOM.U.K.

(2)The code drawn up by the ITC under section 104 of the 1996 Act (code of guidance as to the operation of Part 4) and in force immediately before the commencement of section 301 of this Act is to continue to have effect (notwithstanding the substitutions made by that section of this Act)—

(a)until the code drawn up by OFCOM under that section comes into force; but

(b)in relation to times on or after the transfer date and before the coming into force of OFCOM’s code, as if references in section 104(2) of that Act and in the code to the ITC were references to OFCOM.

(3)If a provision of sections 300 to 302 of this Act comes into force before the television transfer date, a reference to OFCOM in an amendment made by that provision is to be construed in relation to times before that date as a reference to the ITC.

(4)On the date on which section 300 of this Act comes into force, the Secretary of State shall revise the list maintained for the purposes of Part 4 of the 1996 Act in order to allocate each event which is a listed event on that date either to Group A or to Group B.

(5)Where—

(a)the events listed in the list in force immediately before the Secretary of State revises it under sub-paragraph (4) are treated, for any of the purposes of the code in force under section 104 of the 1996 Act at that time, as divided into two categories, and

(b)the Secretary of State’s revision under that sub-paragraph makes the same division,

section 97(2) of the 1996 Act shall not apply in relation to that revision of that list.

(6)In this paragraph “the transfer date” is the date on which paragraph 13 of Schedule 1 comes into force.

Commencement Information

I718Sch. 18 para. 51 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Complaints to the Broadcasting Standards CommissionU.K.

52(1)On and after the transfer to OFCOM under this Act of the functions of the Broadcasting Standards Commission under Part 5 of the 1996 Act, that Part is to have effect in relation to a fairness complaint made to, but not disposed of by, the Commission before the transfer as if—U.K.

(a)anything done, or treated as done, by or in relation to the Commission for the purposes of, or in connection with, that complaint had been done by or in relation OFCOM; and

(b)those functions had been functions of OFCOM at the time when it was done.

(2)Where immediately before the commencement of section 327 of this Act a licence to provide a licensed service (within the meaning of Part 5 of the 1996 Act) contains a condition included in that licence by virtue of section 119(7) of that Act (conditions requiring compliance with BSC directions), that condition is to have effect on and after the coming into force of section 327 of this Act as a condition requiring the licence holder to comply with directions given to him by OFCOM.

(3) In this paragraph “fairness complaint” has the same meaning as in Part 5 of the 1996 Act.

Commencement Information

I719Sch. 18 para. 52 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Codes of practice drawn up by the Broadcasting Standards CommissionU.K.

53U.K.The code of practice drawn up by the Broadcasting Standards Commission under section 107 of the 1996 Act (code in respect of unjust and unfair treatment and infringements of privacy) is to have effect on and after the transfer under this Act to OFCOM of the Commission’s functions under Part 5 of that Act as if it were the code required to be drawn up under that section by OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I720Sch. 18 para. 53 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Media ownership provisionsU.K.

54(1)Part 4 of Schedule 14 to this Act is to have effect—U.K.

(a)in relation to times before the television transfer date as if references to OFCOM were, in relation to licences under Part 1 of the 1990 Act or Part 1 of the 1996 Act, references to the ITC; and

(b)in relation to times before the radio transfer date as if references to OFCOM were, in relation to licences under Part 3 of the 1990 Act or Part 2 of the 1996 Act, references to the Radio Authority.

(2)A determination by the ITC or the Radio Authority under paragraph 2(2) of Part 2 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act which is in force immediately before the commencement of Part 4 of Schedule 14 to this Act is to have effect on and after its commencement as a determination under paragraph 15 of that Schedule to this Act.

(3)Any guidance issued by the ITC and the Radio Authority under paragraph 2(3) of Part 2 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act and in force immediately before the commencement of Part 4 of Schedule 14 to this Act is to have effect on and after its commencement as guidance published under paragraph 15(4) of that Schedule to this Act.

(4)Anything done under paragraph 15 of Schedule 14 by the ITC or the Radio Authority which is in force immediately before the relevant transfer date is to have effect on and after that date as if done under that paragraph by OFCOM.

(5)The following powers under enactments in force before the relevant transfer date shall be exercisable by OFCOM at all times on or after that date in relation to a pre-commencement contravention of a requirement imposed by or under Parts 3 to 5 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act—

(a)all the powers and duties of the ITC under section 5 of the 1990 Act and section 5 of the 1996 Act;

(b)all the powers and duties of the Radio Authority under section 88 of the 1990 Act and section 44 of the 1996 Act; and

(c)all the other powers and duties of the ITC or the Radio Authority in relation to contraventions of conditions imposed under section 5 or 88 of the 1990 Act or section 5 or 44 of the 1996 Act.

(6)For the purpose of determining whether anything occurring after the relevant transfer date is a pre-commencement contravention of a requirement imposed by or under Parts 3 to 5 of Schedule 2 to the 1990 Act, references in those Parts of that Schedule to the ITC or to the Radio Authority are to be construed as including references to OFCOM.

(7)In this paragraph—

  • pre-commencement contravention” means a contravention of a requirement which occurred before the coming into force of the repeal by this Act of the provision by or under which the requirement was imposed; and

  • “the relevant transfer date”—

    (a)

    in relation to the ITC, means the television transfer date; and

    (b)

    in relation to the Radio Authority, means the radio transfer date.

Commencement Information

I721Sch. 18 para. 54(1)-(4) in force at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, art. 2(2), Sch. 2

I722Sch. 18 para. 54(5)-(7) in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

TV licencesU.K.

F12255U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F122Sch. 18 para. 55 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I723Sch. 18 para. 55 in force at 1.4.2004 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 4(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 11)

Functions under the Enterprise Act 2002U.K.

56(1)This section has effect in so far as, at any time before the coming into force of section 370 of this Act, anything has been done or is treated as done by or in relation to the Director for the purposes of, or in connection with, the carrying out of any of his functions under the Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40).U.K.

(2)That thing is to have effect on and after that date, and OFCOM may carry out their functions and continue anything begun by that Director, as if—

(a)that thing had been done by or in relation to OFCOM for the purposes of, or in connection with, their functions under that Act by virtue of that section; and

(b)the provisions conferring those functions on OFCOM had been in force at the time it was done.

(3)Sub-paragraph (1) does not apply to anything that could not be done by or in relation to OFCOM for the purposes of, or in connection with, the carrying out of their functions under the Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40).

(4)Where, by virtue of sub-paragraph (3), sub-paragraph (1) does not apply to something, that thing is to have effect instead as if done by or in relation to the Office of Fair Trading

Commencement Information

I724Sch. 18 para. 56 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I725Sch. 18 para. 56 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Functions under the Competition Act 1998U.K.

57(1)This paragraph applies in so far as, at any time before the coming into force of section 371 of this Act, anything has been done by or in relation to the Director for the purposes of, or in connection with, the carrying out of any of his functions under the Competition Act 1998 (c. 41).U.K.

(2)That thing is to have effect on and after that date, and OFCOM may carry out their functions and continue anything begun by that Director, as if—

(a)that thing had been done by or in relation to OFCOM for the purposes of, or in connection with, their functions under that Act by virtue of that section; and

(b)the provisions conferring those functions on OFCOM had been in force at the time it was done.

(3)Sub-paragraph (1) does not apply to anything that could not be done by or in relation to OFCOM for the purposes of, or in connection with, the carrying out of their functions under the Competition Act 1998.

(4)Where, by virtue of sub-paragraph (3), sub-paragraph (1) does not apply to something, that thing is to have effect instead as if done by or in relation to the Office of Fair Trading

Commencement Information

I726Sch. 18 para. 57 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I727Sch. 18 para. 57 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

58(1)Where any regulations made under section 54(4) of the Competition Act 1998 (regulations about concurrent functions of regulators and the Office of Fair Trading) are in force at the coming into force of section 371 of this Act, those regulations—U.K.

(a)shall, from that time have effect in relation to functions exercisable concurrently by virtue of section 371 of this Act as they have effect in relation to functions exercisable concurrently by virtue of Part 2 of Schedule 10 to the Competition Act 1998; but

(b)shall so have effect subject to any amendments or revocations coming into force at or after that time.

(2)Where, at any time before the coming into force of section 371, anything has been done by or in relation to the Director under or for the purposes of any regulations made under section 54(4) of the Competition Act 1998 that thing is to have effect, so far as necessary for the purposes of paragraph 57 of this Schedule, as if done by or in relation to OFCOM.

Commencement Information

I728Sch. 18 para. 58 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I729Sch. 18 para. 58 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Newspaper mergersU.K.

59(1)Chapter 2 of Part 5 and any related repeals shall, subject to sub-paragraph (2), not apply in relation to—U.K.

(a)a transfer of a newspaper or of newspaper assets (within the meaning given by section 57(2) of the Fair Trading Act 1973 (c. 41)) which has been made before the coming into force of section 373 of this Act; or

(b)a proposed transfer of a newspaper or of newspaper assets in relation to which an application for the consent of the Secretary of State under section 58 of the Act of 1973 has been made before the coming into force of section 373 of this Act.

(2)Chapter 2 of Part 5 and any related repeals shall apply in relation to a proposed transfer of a newspaper or of newspaper assets if—

(a)an application for the consent of the Secretary of State under section 58 of the Act of 1973 has been made;

(b)the application is expressed to depend on the operation of subsection (3) or (4) of that section;

(c)no consent is given by the Secretary of State under subsection (3) or (4) of that section; and

(d)no further application has been made for the consent of the Secretary of State under that section before the coming into force of section 373 of this Act.

Commencement Information

I730Sch. 18 para. 59 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

60U.K.Chapter 2 of Part 5 and any related repeals shall apply in relation to any transfer of a newspaper or of newspaper assets which is proposed (and not made) before the coming into force of section 373 of this Act and in relation to which no application has been made for the consent of the Secretary of State under section 58 of the Act of 1973 before the coming into force of that section.

Commencement Information

I731Sch. 18 para. 60 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

61U.K.References in paragraphs 59 and 60 to Chapter 2 of Part 5 do not include references to subsections (2) to (4) of section 389 (powers to make transitional and consequential amendments etc.).

Commencement Information

I732Sch. 18 para. 61 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

62(1)The Secretary of State may, instead of any or all of the conditions attached to a consent given by him (or treated as so given) under section 58 of the Fair Trading Act 1973 (c. 41)), accept undertakings under this paragraph to take, or refrain from taking, action specified or described in the undertakings.U.K.

(2)If, and so far as, the Secretary of State accepts an undertaking under this paragraph instead of a condition, that condition shall cease to have effect.

(3)In deciding whether to accept an undertaking under this paragraph, the Secretary of State may, in particular, consult the Office of Fair Trading and OFCOM.

(4)An undertaking under this paragraph—

(a)shall come into force when accepted;

(b)may be varied or superseded by another undertaking; and

(c)may be released by the Secretary of State.

(5)The Secretary of State shall, as soon as reasonably practicable, consider any representations received by him in relation to varying or releasing an undertaking under this paragraph.

(6)Paragraph 10 of Schedule 7 to the Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40) (order-making power where final undertakings not fulfilled) shall apply in relation to an undertaking under this paragraph as it applies in relation to an undertaking under paragraph 9 of that Schedule to that Act but as if—

(a)in sub-paragraph (2) the words from “for any” to “66(6)” were omitted; and

(b)sub-paragraph (3) were omitted.

(7)The following provisions of the Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40) shall apply in relation to an undertaking under this paragraph or an order made by virtue of sub-paragraph (6) as they apply in relation to an undertaking under paragraph 9 of Schedule 7 to that Act or (as the case may be) an order under paragraph 10 of that Schedule to that Act—

(a)section 90 and Schedule 10 (procedural requirements for certain undertakings and orders);

(b)section 91 (register of undertakings and orders);

(c)section 92 (duty of OFT to monitor undertakings and orders);

(d)section 93 (further role of OFT in relation to undertakings and orders); and

(e)section 94 (rights to enforce undertakings and orders).

(8)Section 402 of this Act shall not apply in relation to the power of the Secretary of State to make an order which is exercisable by virtue of sub-paragraph (6) but supplementary provisions of Part 3 of the Enterprise Act 2002 which relate to the making of an order under paragraph 10 of Schedule 7 to that Act shall apply in relation to the making of an order by virtue of sub-paragraph (6).

(9)Section 402 of this Act shall not apply in relation to the power of the Secretary of State to make an order under section 91(6)(a) of the Enterprise Act 2002 as applied by virtue of sub-paragraph (7)(b) above but supplementary provisions of Part 3 of the Enterprise Act 2002 which relate to the making of an order under section 91(6)(a) of that Act shall apply in relation to the making of an order under that provision as applied by virtue of sub-paragraph (7)(b) above.

Commencement Information

I733Sch. 18 para. 62 in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Orders in Council under section 6 of the Continental Shelf Act 1964U.K.

F12363U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F123Sch. 18 para. 63 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

Commencement Information

I734Sch. 18 para. 63 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I735Sch. 18 para. 63 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Interpretation of ScheduleU.K.

64U.K.In this Schedule—

  • the 1984 Act” means the Telecommunications Act 1984 (c. 12);

  • the abolition of licensing” means the coming into force of the repeal by this Act of section 7 of the 1984 Act;

  • the Director” means the Director General of Telecommunications;

  • the ITC” means the Independent Television Commission.

Commencement Information

I736Sch. 18 para. 64 in force at 25.7.2003 for specified purposes by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I737Sch. 18 para. 64 in force at 29.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

Section 406

SCHEDULE 19U.K.Repeals

(1) Enactments

Short title and chapterExtent of repeal
Telegraph Act 1899 (c. 38)The whole Act.
Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949 (c. 54)

In section 1—

(a)

subsection (1A);

(b)

in subsection (4), the words “other than a television licence” and the words from “; and a television licence” onwards;

(c)

subsections (6) and (7).

Section 1D(1), (2), (7) and (8).

Section 1F.

Section 2.

In section 3(1), the words after paragraph (d) from “and different” to “classes of case:”.

Section 9.

In section 10(2), the words after paragraph (b).

In section 11(1)—

(a)

paragraph (i) of the proviso;

(b)

in paragraph (ii) of the proviso the words “, and paragraph (i) of this proviso shall not apply”.

Section 14(1A)(e), (2) and (3)(b).

Section 15(4)(c) and the word “or” immediately preceding it.

Section 19(2A) and (9).

Schedule 2.

Army Act 1955 (3 & 4 Eliz. 2 c. 18)In section 44B(5), the definition of “telecommunication system” and the word “and” immediately preceding it.
Air Force Act 1955 (3 & 4 Eliz. 2 c. 19)In section 44B(5), the definition of “telecommunication system” and the word “and” immediately preceding it.
Naval Discipline Act 1957 (c. 53)In section 29B(5), the definition of “telecommunication system” and the word “and” immediately preceding it.
Opencast Coal Act 1958 (c. 69)In section 45(3), the word “a” before “telecommunication apparatus”.
Continental Shelf Act 1964 (c. 29)Section 6.
Parliamentary Commissioner Act 1967 (c. 13)In Schedule 2, the entries relating to the Broadcasting Standards Commission and the Office of the Director General of Telecommunications.
Marine, &c., Broadcasting (Offences) Act 1967 (c. 41)Section 6(2) and (7).
Wireless Telegraphy Act 1967 (c. 72)

Section 4.

In section 7(5), paragraph (b) and the word “or” immediately preceding it.

Fair Trading Act 1973 (c. 41)

Sections 57 to 62.

In section 93B—

(a)

in subsection (1)(b), the words “the Telecommunications Act 1984 or”;

(b)

in subsection (5), the words “section 13B of the Telecommunications Act 1984 or”.

House of Commons Disqualification Act 1975 (c. 24)

In Part 2 of Schedule 1, the entries relating to—

(a)

the Broadcasting Standards Commission;

(b)

Comataidh Craolaidh Gaidhlig;

(c)

the Independent Television Commission;

(d)

the Radio Authority.

In Part 3 of Schedule 1, the entry relating to the Director General of Telecommunications.

Northern Ireland Assembly Disqualification Act 1975 (c. 25)

In Part 2 of Schedule 1, the entries relating to—

(a)

the Broadcasting Standards Commission;

(b)

the Independent Television Commission;

(c)

the Radio Authority;

(d)

the Tribunal established under Part 2 of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949.

In Part 3 of Schedule 1, the entries relating to—

(a)

the Director General of Telecommunications;

(b)

a Director of the successor company within the meaning of Part 5 of the Telecommunications Act 1984.

Welsh Development Agency Act 1975 (c. 70)In section 19(11), the definition of “appropriate authority”.
British Telecommunications Act 1981 (c. 38)

In section 88—

(a)

in subsection (1), the words from “, and the special” to “Schedule 5,”;

(b)

in subsection (2), the words “and 5”.

In Schedule 4, paragraphs 2 to 18, 21 and 22.

In Schedule 5, paragraphs 1 and 3 to 22.

Acquisition of Land Act 1981 (c. 67)In section 28, paragraph (f).
Telecommunications Act 1984 (c. 12)

Sections 1 to 30.

Sections 34 to 49.

In section 50, subsections (2) to (6A).

Sections 51 to 55.

Section 60.

Section 61(1) to (6).

Section 62.

Section 63(1) to (4).

Sections 64 to 67.

Sections 69 to 71.

In section 72—

(a)

in subsection (1), the words from the beginning to “this Act,” and the words “and development land tax”;

(b)

subsections (2), (4) and (5).

Section 73.

Sections 80 and 81.

Section 88.

Section 90.

In section 91—

(a)

in subsection (2), the words “or section 80(9)(b) above” and the words “for an offence or (as the case may be) for the forfeiture of any apparatus under that section”;

(b)

in subsection (4), the words “and in section 80(9)(b) above”.

Section 92(4).

Section 93.

Sections 95 to 97.

In section 98(9), the words “and ‘telecommunication apparatus’”.

In section 101—

(a)

in subsection (2)(a), the words “or transferred”;

(b)

subsection (4).

Section 102.

In section 104—

(a)

in subsection (1), the words “2, 27L 60(1) or (3), 69(2) or” and “, or paragraph 1 of Schedule 5,”;

(b)

subsection (3).

In section 106(1), the definitions of—

(a)

“commercial activities connected with telecommunications”;

(b)

“consumer”, “monopoly situation”, “practice” and “supply”;

(c)

“the Director”;

(d)

“directory information service”;

(e)

“disabled person” and “disabled”;

(f)

“public telecommunications operator”;

(g)

“public telecommunications system”;

(h)

“telecommunication apparatus”;

(i)

“telecommunication service”;

(j)

“telecommunications operator”;

(k)

“telecommunication system”;

(l)

“transitional period”.

Section 107(1), (2) and (4).

In section 109—

(a)

subsections (2) and (3);

(b)

in subsection (4), the words “and the special transitional provisions with respect to patents for inventions and registered designs contained in Schedule 6 to this Act”;

(c)

subsections (5) to (7).

Schedule 1.

In Schedule 2—

(a)

in paragraph 1(1), the words from “‘telecommunications apparatus’ includes any apparatus” onwards;

(b)

in paragraph 9(2), the words “section 11(1) of this Act,”;

(c)

in paragraph 10(2)(b), the words “(within the meaning of section 6 of this Act)”;

(d)

in paragraph 27(1), the words “section 109(2) or (3) of or”.

In Schedule 4, paragraphs 2, 3, 12, 16, 28(2), 40, 55(1) and (7), 65, 80(1), 86(1), 89(5) and 90.

In Schedule 5—

(a)

paragraphs 1 to 7;

(b)

paragraph 8(2) and (4);

(c)

paragraphs 9 to 14;

(d)

paragraphs 16 to 29;

(e)

paragraphs 31 to 33;

(f)

paragraph 35;

(g)

paragraphs 38 to 42;

(h)

paragraph 47;

(i)

in paragraph 48, in sub-paragraph (1), the words “Part 1 of the Industry Act 1972 and” and in sub-paragraph (2), the words “Part 1 of the Industry Act 1972 or”;

(j)

paragraphs 49 to 51.

Schedule 6.

Companies Consolidation (Consequential Provisions) Act 1985 (c. 9)In Schedule 2, the entries relating to sections 60(3), 61(4), 66, 70 and 73(1) of and Schedule 5 to the Telecommunications Act 1984.
Surrogacy Arrangements Act 1985 (c. 49)Section 3(6).
Interception of Communications Act 1985 (c. 56)Schedule 2.
Housing Act 1985 (c. 68)Section 298(1).
Airports Act 1986 (c. 31)Section 62(8).
Insolvency Act 1986 (c. 45)In Schedule 2A, paragraph 10(1)(a).
Consumer Protection Act 1987 (c. 43)In Schedule 4, in paragraph 9(1), the words “28(6) and”.
Channel Tunnel Act 1987 (c. 53)In Part 10 of Schedule 7, paragraph 1(2).
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1)In Schedule 29, in the Table in paragraph 32, the entries relating to sections 62(7) and 72(4) of the Telecommunications Act 1984.
Legal Aid Act 1988 (c. 34)In Schedule 5, paragraph 11.
Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 (c. 48)

In section 69(2), the word “or” at the end of paragraph (b).

In Schedule 2, the word “or” at the end of paragraph 17(2)(b).

In Schedule 7, paragraph 27.

Housing Act 1988 (c. 50)In Part 2 of Schedule 10, paragraph 19.
Electricity Act 1989 (c. 29)In Schedule 4, in paragraph 12, the definitions of “public telecommunications operator” and of “telecommunication apparatus”, “telecommunication system” and “the telecommunications code”.
Companies Act 1989 (c. 40)

In Schedule 18, paragraph 28.

In Schedule 20, paragraph 2.

Planning (Consequential Provisions) Act 1990 (c. 11)In Schedule 2, paragraph 63.
Courts and Legal Services Act 1990 (c. 41)In Schedule 10, paragraph 8.
Broadcasting Act 1990 (c. 42)

Sections 1 and 2.

In section 4(3), the words from “and the amount” onwards.

In section 5—

(a)

subsection (6A)(a);

(b)

subsection (6B).

Sections 6 to 12.

In section 15(3), paragraphs (c) to (e).

In section 16—

(a)

subsections (2) and (3);

(b)

in subsection (4), the words from “; and in applying” onwards;

(c)

subsections (5) to (8).

Section 20.

Section 21A.

In section 24, subsections (4) to (6).

Sections 25 to 27.

In section 29—

(a)

in subsection (2), paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding it;

(b)

subsection (3).

Sections 30 to 36.

Sections 38 and 39.

In section 42A, paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding it.

Chapters 3 and 4 of Part 1.

Section 48(5).

In section 50—

(a)

in subsection (1)(b)(ii), the words “(subject to the approval of the Secretary of State)”;

(b)

subsection (7).

Section 51(2) and (7).

In section 53(4), the words “before the relevant date”.

Section 54(2)

In section 56(1)(b), the words “, and have the functions conferred by,”.

Section 57.

Section 59.

Section 60(1) to (3) and (6).

In section 61A—

(a)

subsection (1);

(b)

in subsection (2) the words “on or after the notified date”;

(c)

subsections (5) and (6).

Section 62.

Section 65.

In section 66A(2), paragraphs (c) and (d).

Sections 68 to 70.

In section 71(1)—

(a)

in the definition of “Channel 3”, the words “by the Commission”;

(b)

the definitions of “the Commission”, “licensable programme service” and “satellite television service”.

Part 2.

Sections 83 and 84.

In section 85, subsections (3) and (4).

In section 87—

(a)

in subsection (2)(b), sub-paragraph (ii) and the word “or” immediately preceding it;

(b)

in subsection (3), the words from “and the amount” onwards.

In section 88—

(a)

subsection (6A)(a); and

(b)

subsection (6B).

Section 89(2).

Sections 90 to 96.

In section 98(3)(a), the word “both” and sub-paragraph (ii) and the word “and” immediately preceding it.

In section 99(1)(a), the word “both” and sub-paragraph (ii) and the word “and” immediately preceding it.

In section 103A—

(a)

in subsection (3), the words “before the relevant date”, paragraph (a) and, in paragraph (b), the words “in any other case”;

(b)

in subsection (8), the words from “(whether because” to “any other reason)”;

(c)

subsection (10);

(d)

in subsection (11), the definition of “simulcast radio service”.

In section 104A(5), at the end of paragraph (a), the word “and”.

In section 104B—

(a)

subsection (1)(b);

(b)

subsections (6) and (7).

In section 106(1), the words from “, except” onwards.

Sections 106A to 108.

Section 110(7).

Sections 112 and 113.

Section 114(5).

In section 116(1)(b)(iii), the words “(subject to the approval of the Secretary of State)”.

Section 117(2) and (7).

Section 119(2).

Section 122 to 125.

In section 126(1), the definitions of “assigned frequency”, “the Authority” and “licensable sound programme service”.

Section 134.

In section 177(6), the definition of “relevant foreign satellite service”.

Section 180(2) and (3).

Section 181.

In section 183—

(a)

in subsection (3), the words “, which shall be called” onwards;

(b)

subsection (3A);

(c)

subsections (6) and (7).

In section 185(5), the definition of “the Commission”.

Section 186.

Section 187(1) and (2).

In section 188(2), paragraphs (b), (d) and (e).

Sections 189 to 191.

In section 196—

(a)

in subsection (1)(a), the words “, 82”;

(b)

subsection (2).

Section 197.

Section 199(1) to (4) and (6).

In section 201(1), the words “under this Act”.

In section 202—

(a)

in subsection (1), the definition of “telecommunication system”;

(b)

in subsection (2)(b), the words “1” and “8”;

(c)

in subsection (5)(a), the words “for general reception, or”.

Schedule 1.

In Part 1 of Schedule 2—

(a)

in paragraph 1(1), the definitions of “coverage area”, of “digital programme service”, of “local delivery licence” and “local delivery service”, of “local digital sound programme service” and “national digital sound programme service”, of “local radio multiplex service” and “national radio multiplex service” and of “television multiplex service”;

(b)

paragraph 1(8);

(c)

paragraph 3A;

(d)

paragraph 3B;

(e)

paragraph 4.

In Part 2 of Schedule 2—

(a)

paragraph 1(1)(a) and (b);

(b)

in paragraph 1(1)(j)(i), the words “(a), (b) or”;

(c)

paragraph 1(2) and (3);

(d)

in paragraph 5A(1)(a), the words “granted by the Commission”;

(e)

paragraph 5A(1)(b) and the word “and” immediately preceding it;

(f)

in paragraph 5A(2), the words “granted by the Authority”;

(g)

paragraph 5A(3).

Parts 3 to 5 of Schedule 2.

Schedule 4.

Schedule 5.

In Schedule 6—

(a)

paragraph 2(1);

(b)

in paragraph 13(2), the words from “and shall include” onwards.

Schedule 8.

Schedule 12.

In Schedule 18—

(a)

in Part 1, paragraphs 1(4) to (6), 2(1) and (3) and 4;

(b)

in Part 2, paragraphs 1(d) and 5.

In Schedule 19—

(a)

in paragraph 8(c), the words “and (where the expenses relate to the Commission’s functions in connection with sound programmes) the Radio Authority”;

(b)

in paragraph 11(4), the words “or the Radio Authority” and “or, as the case may be, the Authority”.

In Schedule 20—

(a)

paragraph 9;

(b)

paragraph 24(c)(ii);

(c)

paragraph 38;

(d)

paragraph 54.

In Schedule 22—

(a)

paragraphs 1 to 3;

(b)

in paragraph 4, the words “and 45”;

(c)

paragraph 5.

New Roads and Street Works Act 1991 (c. 22)

In Schedule 4, in paragraph 7(4), the definitions of “telecommunication apparatus” and “telecommunication system”.

In Schedule 6, in paragraph 7(4), the definitions of “telecommunication apparatus” and “telecommunication system”.

Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12)In Schedule 10, paragraph 7.
Charities Act 1992 (c. 41)In section 60(10), the definition of “telecommunication apparatus”.
Competition and Service (Utilities) Act 1992 (c. 43)

Sections 1 to 10.

Section 49.

In Schedule 1, paragraphs 1, 2, 3(b) and 4.

Carriage of Goods by Sea Act 1992 (c. 50)In section 5(1), the definition of “telecommunication system” and the word “and” immediately preceding it.
Tribunals and Inquiries Act 1992 (c. 53)In Part 1 of Schedule 1, the entry at paragraph 45 relating to wireless telegraphy.
Judicial Pensions and Retirement Act 1993 (c. 8)

Section 26(8)(a).

In Schedule 5, the entry relating to the President of the tribunal established under section 9 of the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949.

In Schedule 6, paragraph 58.

In Schedule 7, paragraph 5(5)(xxxii).

Leasehold Reform, Housing and Urban Development Act 1993 (c. 28)In Part 2 of Schedule 20, paragraph 19(1).
Cardiff Bay Barrage Act 1993 (c. 42)

In Schedule 4, in paragraph 3(2), the words following paragraph (c).

In Schedule 7, paragraph 21(10).

Local Government (Wales) Act 1994 (c. 19)In Schedule 16, paragraph 72.
Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 (c. 22)In Schedule 3, paragraph 3(a)(i).
Criminal Justice and Public Order Act 1994 (c. 33)Section 92.
Deregulation and Contracting Out Act 1994 (c. 40)

Section 8.

In Schedule 4, paragraph 3(a).

Criminal Procedure (Consequential Provisions) (Scotland) Act 1995 (c. 40)In Schedule 4, paragraph 48(2) and (3).
Criminal Procedure (Scotland) Act 1995 (c. 46)In Schedule 9, the entry relating to the Wireless Telegraphy Act 1949.
Arbitration Act 1996 (c. 23)In Schedule 3, paragraph 7.
Broadcasting Act 1996 (c. 55)

Section 1(1A) to (3).

Section 2(1), (6) and (7).

In section 4(3), the words from “and the amount” onwards.

Section 5(7)(a).

Section 6.

In section 11(5), the words from “not exceeding” onwards.

Section 12(7).

In section 16(6), the words “before the relevant date”.

Section 18(5) and (6).

Section 19(2) and (4) to (10).

Sections 20 to 22.

Section 25(5) and (6).

Section 28.

In section 29(2), the word “59,”.

Sections 30 and 31.

In section 33(3)(c), the words “or II”.

Section 34.

Section 38.

In section 39(1), the definitions of “the Commission” and “qualifying teletext service”.

In section 40(4), the words “provided on a frequency or frequencies assigned to the Authority under section 45(1)”.

In section 43—

(a)

in subsection (2)(b), sub-paragraph (ii) and the word “or” immediately preceding it;

(b)

in subsection (3), the words from “and the amount” onwards.

Section 44(7)(a).

Section 45.

In section 46(1), paragraph (e).

Section 47(4).

Section 54(7).

In section 56(1)(a)(i), the words “to which the licence relates”.

In section 58—

(a)

subsection (5);

(b)

in subsection (6), the words “before the relevant date”.

In section 60, subsections (7) to (10).

In section 61, subsections (3) and (4).

Section 68.

Section 71.

In section 72(1), the definition of “the Authority”.

Sections 74 to 76.

Sections 78 and 79.

Section 80(2).

Sections 82 to 84.

Section 86(3).

Sections 87 to 90.

Section 91.

Section 93.

In section 95, subsections (3) to (7).

In section 97(3)(b), the words “by the Commission” and “by them”.

In section 104(4)(d), the words “by the Commission” and “by them”.

In section 105(1), the definitions of “the Commission” and “live”.

Section 106.

In section 107—

(a)

subsection (2);

(b)

in subsection (4)(a), the words “or regulatory”.

Sections 108 and 109.

In section 110—

(a)

subsection (2);

(b)

in subsection (3), the words from “; and in exercising” onwards;

(c)

in subsection (4), the definition of “a standards complaint” and the word “and” immediately preceding it.

Sections 112 and 113.

In section 114—

(a)

in subsection (1), the words “or a standards complaint”;

(b)

in subsection (2), the words “or a standards complaint” and in paragraph (b) the words “, in the case of a fairness complaint,”.

In section 115—

(a)

in subsection (2), paragraph (c);

(b)

in subsection (3), paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding it.

Section 116.

In section 118, the words “or a standards complaint”.

In section 119—

(a)

in subsection (3), paragraph (c);

(b)

in subsection (8), the words “or standards complaint” and in paragraph (c) the words “, a regulatory body”;

(c)

in subsection (9), the words “or standards complaint” and “, 113(1)”;

(d)

subsection (12).

In section 120(1), the words “or a standards complaint”.

Sections 122 to 129.

In section 130—

(a)

in subsection (1), in the definition of “licensed service”, the words from “, subject to” to “125(6),”;

(b)

the definitions in that subsection of “the appropriate regulatory body”, “the BSC”, “financial year”, “local delivery service”, “regulatory body”, “sexual conduct” and “standards complaint”;

(c)

in subsection (2), paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding it.

Section 142.

Section 143(3) and (4).

Section 144(5).

In section 145(8), the definition of “the relevant authority”.

In Schedule 2, paragraphs 1(2)(d) to (f), 4, 5, 6(3), 10 and 11.

Schedule 3.

Schedule 4.

In Schedule 8, paragraph 4.

In Schedule 10, paragraphs 1, 3 to 6, 8, 11 to 14, 16, 18 to 20, 22 to 25, 26(a)(ii) and (b) and 27(a).

Channel Tunnel Rail Link Act 1996 (c. 61)In Part 4 of Schedule 15, in paragraph 1(2), the definitions of “telecommunications code”, “telecommunications operator” and “operator”, “telecommunication apparatus”, “telecommunications code system” and “telecommunication system”.
Telecommunications (Fraud) Act 1997 (c. 4)The whole Act.
Planning (Consequential Provisions) (Scotland) Act 1997 (c. 11)In Schedule 2, paragraph 37.
Wireless Telegraphy Act 1998 (c. 6)

In section 1(1), the words “other than a television licence as defined in section 1(7) of that Act”.

In section 1(3)—

(a)

paragraph (a);

(b)

in paragraph (b) the words from “or provide” to “the Secretary of State”;

(c)

paragraph (d) and the word “and” immediately preceding it.

In section 3—

(a)

in subsection (1), the words “or determined by him under” and paragraph (a) and the word “and” immediately after it;

(b)

subsection (2);

(c)

in subsection (3), paragraph (h) and the word “and” immediately preceding it.

Section 5.

Schedule 1.

Petroleum Act 1998 (c. 17)

In Schedule 4—

(a)

in paragraph 2(3), the words “section 6 (wireless telegraphy) and”;

(b)

paragraph 19.

Competition Act 1998 (c. 41)

In Schedule 1, paragraph 3.

In Schedule 7—

(a)

paragraph 2(1)(d)(iii);

(b)

in paragraph 19A(9), in the definition of “merger reference group”, the words “section 59 of the Fair Trading Act 1973 (c. 41),” and in the definition of “special reference group” paragraphs (b) and (f) and the word “or” at the end of paragraph (m).

In Schedule 7A, in paragraph 1, in the definition of “merger investigation”, the words “section 59 of the Fair Trading Act 1973 (c. 41),”.

In Schedule 10—

(a)

paragraph 2(1) to (6), (8) and (9);

(b)

paragraph 9(2) to (4) and (6).

In Schedule 12, paragraph 14(3).

In Schedule 13, paragraph 35(2)(a).

Regional Development Agencies Act 1998 (c. 45)In Schedule 6, paragraph 16(1).
Access to Justice Act 1999 (c. 22)In Schedule 4, paragraph 26.
Electronic Communications Act 2000 (c. 7)Sections 11 and 12.
Regulation of Investigatory Powers Act 2000 (c. 23)

Section 18(12)(e).

In Schedule 4, paragraph 3.

Postal Services Act 2000 (c. 26)In Schedule 7, paragraph 3(2)(g).
Freedom of Information Act 2000 (c. 36)

In Part 6 of Schedule 1, the entries relating to—

(a)

the Broadcasting Standards Commission;

(b)

the Independent Television Commission;

(c)

the Radio Authority;

(d)

the Scottish Advisory Committee on Telecommunications;

(e)

the Welsh Advisory Committee on Telecommunications.

In Part 7 of Schedule 1, the entry relating to the Northern Ireland Advisory Committee on Telecommunications.

Countryside and Rights of Way Act 2000 (c. 37)In section 45(1), the definitions of “telecommunications code” and “telecommunications code system”.
Transport Act 2000 (c. 38)

In Schedule 8, paragraph 14(2).

In Schedule 9, paragraph 3(2)(e).

Political Parties, Elections and Referendums Act 2000 (c. 41)

Section 11(1) and (2).

In Schedule 12, in paragraph 4, sub-paragraphs (1) to (5) and in sub-paragraph (7) the definitions of “the 1990 Act”, “licence”, “licensed” and “the licensing body”.

In Schedule 21, paragraph 8.

Criminal Justice and Police Act 2001 (c. 16)In the table in section 1(1), the entry relating to section 43(1)(b) of the Telecommunications Act 1984.
Anti-terrorism, Crime and Security Act 2001 (c. 24)In Schedule 4, paragraph 29.
Office of Communications Act 2002 (c. 11)

Section 2.

Sections 4 to 6.

In the Schedule, paragraphs 1(4), 8(5), 17(8) and (9) and 20.

Tobacco Advertising and Promotion Act 2002 (c. 36)Section 12(4).
Enterprise Act 2002 (c. 40)

In section 22(3)(a), the words “69(1),”.

In section 33(3)(a), the words “69(1),”.

In section 46(1)(a), the words “69(1),”.

In section 62(4), the words “section 69(1) or”.

In section 67(1)(b), the words from “which” to “or 33”.

In section 68(2)(c), the words from “which”, where it occurs for the second time, to “or 33”.

Section 69.

In section 121—

(a)

in subsection (1), the words “, Part V of the Fair Trading Act 1973 (c. 41)”;

(b)

in subsection (2), paragraph (b) and the word “or” at the end of the paragraph;

(c)

in subsection (4)(c), sub-paragraph (i), the word “and” at the end of the sub-paragraph and, in sub-paragraph (ii), the words “in any other case,”;

(d)

in subsection (8), the words “, Part V of the Act of 1973”;

(e)

subsection (10).

In section 136—

(a)

in subsection (7), paragraph (a) and the word “and” immediately preceding paragraph (g);

(b)

in subsection (8), the words “the Director of Telecommunications,”.

Section 168(3)(a), (4)(a) and (5)(d).

In Schedule 9, paragraphs 1 and 16.

In Schedule 25, paragraphs 13(2) to (8), 24(2) to (6), (8) and (9) and 34.

Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1)In section 320(7), paragraph (d).
European Parliament (Representation) Act 2003(c. 7)In section 12(4), in the definition of “programme services”, the words from “(including” to “local delivery services”.

Commencement Information

I738Sch. 19(1) in force for specified purposes at 25.7.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I739Sch. 19(1) in force for specified purposes at 18.9.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I740Sch. 19(1) in force for specified purposes at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1), Sch. 1 (with arts. 5, 6, 10, 11)

I741Sch. 19(1) in force for specified purposes at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

I742Sch. 19(1) in force for specified purposes at 1.4.2004 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 4(2), Sch. 2 (with art. 11)

NoteU.K.

F1241U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F124Sch. 19 Note 1 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

2U.K.The repeal of section 63 of the Telecommunications Act 1984 (c. 12) does not affect the power of the Secretary of State or the Treasury to acquire or subscribe for securities of the successor company or of any subsidiary of the successor company other than pursuant to an enactment.

Commencement Information

I743Sch. 19(1) Note 2 in force for specified purposes at 25.7.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I744Sch. 19(1) Note 2 in force in so far as not already in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

F1253U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Textual Amendments

F125Sch. 19 Note 3 repealed (8.2.2007) by Wireless Telegraphy Act 2006 (c. 36), s. 126(2), Sch. 9 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 8 Pt. 1)

4U.K.The repeal of paragraph 20 of Schedule 5 to the Telecommunications Act 1984 shall be disregarded for the purposes of Schedule 18 to this Act.

Commencement Information

I745Sch. 19(1) Note 4 in force for specified purposes at 25.7.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I746Sch. 19(1) Note 4 in force in so far as not already in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

5U.K.The repeals of sections 27A to 27L and in section 50 of the Telecommunications Act 1984 and the repeal of sections 1 to 10 of the Competition and Service Utilities Act 1992 do not have effect in relation to any dispute or other matter referred to the Director General of Telecommunications before the coming into force of the repeals.

Commencement Information

I747Sch. 19(1) Note 5 in force for specified purposes at 25.7.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I748Sch. 19(1) Note 5 in force in so far as not already in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

6U.K.The repeals of sections 26 and 27 of the 1990 Act have effect subject to section 201(2) of this Act.

Commencement Information

I749Sch. 19(1) Note 6 in force for specified purposes at 25.7.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I750Sch. 19(1) Note 6 in force in so far as not already in force at 29.12.2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(2) (with art. 11)

(2) Instruments

Title and numberExtent of revocation
Planning (Northern Ireland) Order 1991 (S.I. 1991/1220 (N.I. 11))Article 104(5).
Electricity (Northern Ireland) Order 1992 (S.I. 1992/231 (N.I. 1))In Schedule 4, in paragraph 1(1), the definitions of “public telecommunications operator” and of “telecommunication apparatus”, “telecommunication system” and “the telecommunications code”.
Telecommunications (Single Emergency Call Number) Regulations 1992 (S.I. 1992/2875)The whole regulations.
Roads (Northern Ireland) Order 1993 (S.I. 1993/3160 (N.I. 15))In Article 2(2), the definitions of “telecommunication apparatus”, “the telecommunications code” and “telecommunications code system”.
Airports (Northern Ireland) Order 1994 (S.I. 1994/426 (N.I. 1))Article 12(7).
Street Works (Northern Ireland) Order 1995 (S.I. 1995/3210 (N.I. 19))In Schedule 2, in paragraph 7(4), the definitions of “telecommunication apparatus” and “telecommunication system”.
Gas (Northern Ireland) Order 1996 (S.I. 1996/275 (N.I. 2))In Schedule 3, in paragraph 1, the definitions of “public telecommunications operator” and of “telecommunication apparatus”, “telecommunication system” and “the telecommunications code”.
Race Relations (Northern Ireland) Order 1997 (S.I. 1997/869 (N.I. 6))Paragraphs 4 and 9 of Schedule 2.
Telecommunications (Voice Telephony) Regulations 1997 (S.I. 1997/1886)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Interconnection) Regulations 1997 (S.I. 1997/2931)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Open Network Provision and Leased Lines) Regulations 1997 (S.I. 1997/2932)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Open Network Provision) (Voice Telephony) Regulations 1998 (S.I. 1998/1580)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (Standard Schedules) Regulations 1999 (S.I. 1999/2450)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (Fixed Voice Telephony and International Facilities Operator Licences) Regulations 1999 (S.I. 1999/2451)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (Mobile Public Telecommunications Operators) Regulations 1999 (S.I. 1999/2452)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (British Telecommunications plc) Regulations 1999 (S.I. 1999/2453)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (Cable and Local Delivery Operator Licences) Regulations 1999 (S.I. 1999/2454)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (Kingston Communications (Hull) PLC) Regulations 1999 (S.I. 1999/2455)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Interconnection) (Carrier Pre-section) Regulations 1999 (S.I. 1999/3448)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Interconnection) (Number Portability, etc.) Regulations 1999 (S.I. 1999/3449)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (Satellite Operator Licences) Regulations 2000 (S.I. 2000/1711)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (Regional Public Access Mobile Radio Operator Licences) Regulations 2000 (S.I. 2000/1712)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (Amendment) Regulations 2000 (S.I. 2000/1713)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (Mobile Data Operator Licences) Regulations 2000 (S.I. 2000/1714)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modification) (Paging Operator Licences) Regulations 2000 (S.I. 2000/1715)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Services for Disabled Persons) Regulations 2000 (S.I. 2000/2410)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modifications) (Amendment No. 2) Regulations 2000 (S.I. 2000/2998)The whole regulations.
Telecommunications (Licence Modifications) (Amendment) Regulations 2001 (S.I. 2001/2495)The whole regulations.

Commencement Information

I751Sch. 19(2) in force for specified purposes at 25.7.2003 by S.I. 2003/1900, arts. 1(2), 2(1), Sch. 1 (with art. 3) (as amended by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 1(3))

I752Sch. 19(2) in force in so far as not already in force at 29.12 .2003 by S.I. 2003/3142, art. 3(1)(2), Sch. 1 (with art. 11)

Back to top

Options/Help

Print Options

You have chosen to open the Whole Act

The Whole Act you have selected contains over 200 provisions and might take some time to download. You may also experience some issues with your browser, such as an alert box that a script is taking a long time to run.

Would you like to continue?

You have chosen to open the Whole Act without Schedules

The Whole Act without Schedules you have selected contains over 200 provisions and might take some time to download. You may also experience some issues with your browser, such as an alert box that a script is taking a long time to run.

Would you like to continue?

You have chosen to open Schedules only

The Schedules you have selected contains over 200 provisions and might take some time to download. You may also experience some issues with your browser, such as an alert box that a script is taking a long time to run.

Would you like to continue?

Close

Legislation is available in different versions:

Latest Available (revised):The latest available updated version of the legislation incorporating changes made by subsequent legislation and applied by our editorial team. Changes we have not yet applied to the text, can be found in the ‘Changes to Legislation’ area.

Original (As Enacted or Made): The original version of the legislation as it stood when it was enacted or made. No changes have been applied to the text.

Point in Time: This becomes available after navigating to view revised legislation as it stood at a certain point in time via Advanced Features > Show Timeline of Changes or via a point in time advanced search.

Close

See additional information alongside the content

Geographical Extent: Indicates the geographical area that this provision applies to. For further information see ‘Frequently Asked Questions’.

Show Timeline of Changes: See how this legislation has or could change over time. Turning this feature on will show extra navigation options to go to these specific points in time. Return to the latest available version by using the controls above in the What Version box.

Close

Opening Options

Different options to open legislation in order to view more content on screen at once

Close

Explanatory Notes

Text created by the government department responsible for the subject matter of the Act to explain what the Act sets out to achieve and to make the Act accessible to readers who are not legally qualified. Explanatory Notes were introduced in 1999 and accompany all Public Acts except Appropriation, Consolidated Fund, Finance and Consolidation Acts.

Close

More Resources

Access essential accompanying documents and information for this legislation item from this tab. Dependent on the legislation item being viewed this may include:

  • the original print PDF of the as enacted version that was used for the print copy
  • lists of changes made by and/or affecting this legislation item
  • confers power and blanket amendment details
  • all formats of all associated documents
  • correction slips
  • links to related legislation and further information resources
Close

Timeline of Changes

This timeline shows the different points in time where a change occurred. The dates will coincide with the earliest date on which the change (e.g an insertion, a repeal or a substitution) that was applied came into force. The first date in the timeline will usually be the earliest date when the provision came into force. In some cases the first date is 01/02/1991 (or for Northern Ireland legislation 01/01/2006). This date is our basedate. No versions before this date are available. For further information see the Editorial Practice Guide and Glossary under Help.

Close

More Resources

Use this menu to access essential accompanying documents and information for this legislation item. Dependent on the legislation item being viewed this may include:

  • the original print PDF of the as enacted version that was used for the print copy
  • correction slips

Click 'View More' or select 'More Resources' tab for additional information including:

  • lists of changes made by and/or affecting this legislation item
  • confers power and blanket amendment details
  • all formats of all associated documents
  • links to related legislation and further information resources